]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/calc.texi
Merge calc news from lisp/calc/README into etc/NEWS files
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @include emacsver.texi
11
12 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
13 @c @texline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
15 @c @infoline foo
16 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
17
18 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
19 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
20
21 @iftex
22 @macro texline
23 @end macro
24 @alias infoline=comment
25 @alias expr=math
26 @alias tfn=code
27 @alias mathit=expr
28 @alias summarykey=key
29 @macro cpi{}
30 @math{@pi{}}
31 @end macro
32 @macro cpiover{den}
33 @math{@pi/\den\}
34 @end macro
35 @end iftex
36
37 @ifnottex
38 @alias texline=comment
39 @macro infoline{stuff}
40 \stuff\
41 @end macro
42 @alias expr=samp
43 @alias tfn=t
44 @alias mathit=i
45 @macro summarykey{ky}
46 \ky\
47 @end macro
48 @macro cpi{}
49 @expr{pi}
50 @end macro
51 @macro cpiover{den}
52 @expr{pi/\den\}
53 @end macro
54 @end ifnottex
55
56
57 @tex
58 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
59 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
60 @end tex
61
62 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
63 @iftex
64 @finalout
65 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
66 @tex
67 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
68
69 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
70 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
71 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
72 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
73 @end tex
74 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
75 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
76 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
77 @ignore
78 @newcount@calcpageno
79 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
80 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
81 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
82 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
83 \r@ggedbottomtrue
84 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
85 @end ignore
86 @end iftex
87
88 @copying
89 @ifinfo
90 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
91 @end ifinfo
92 @ifnotinfo
93 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with
94 GNU Emacs @value{EMACSVER}.
95 @end ifnotinfo
96
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1990--1991, 2001--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 @quotation
100 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
101 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
102 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
103 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
104 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
105 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
106 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
107
108 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
109 modify this GNU manual.''
110 @end quotation
111 @end copying
112
113 @dircategory Emacs misc features
114 @direntry
115 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
116 @end direntry
117
118 @titlepage
119 @sp 6
120 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
121 @sp 4
122 @center GNU Emacs Calc
123 @c [volume]
124 @sp 5
125 @center Dave Gillespie
126 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
127 @page
128
129 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
130 @insertcopying
131 @end titlepage
132
133
134 @summarycontents
135
136 @c [end]
137
138 @contents
139
140 @c [begin]
141 @ifnottex
142 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
143 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
144
145 @noindent
146 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
147 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
148
149 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
150 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
151 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
152 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
153 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
154 @end ifnottex
155
156 @ifinfo
157 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
158 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
159 longer Info tutorial.)
160 @end ifinfo
161
162 @insertcopying
163
164 @menu
165 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
166 @ifinfo
167 * Interactive Tutorial::
168 @end ifinfo
169 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
170
171 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
172 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
173 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
174 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
175 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
176 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
177 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
178 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
179 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
180 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
181 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
182 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
183 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
184 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
185 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
186
187 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
188 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
189 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
190 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
191
192 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
193
194 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
195 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
196 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
197 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
198 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
199 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
200 @end menu
201
202 @ifinfo
203 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
204 @end ifinfo
205 @ifnotinfo
206 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
207 @end ifnotinfo
208 @chapter Getting Started
209 @noindent
210 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
211 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
212 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
213
214 @menu
215 * What is Calc::
216 * About This Manual::
217 * Notations Used in This Manual::
218 * Demonstration of Calc::
219 * Using Calc::
220 * History and Acknowledgments::
221 @end menu
222
223 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
224 @section What is Calc?
225
226 @noindent
227 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
228 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
229 series of calculators, its many features include:
230
231 @itemize @bullet
232 @item
233 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
234
235 @item
236 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
237
238 @item
239 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
240 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
241 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
242 and algebraic formulas.
243
244 @item
245 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
246
247 @item
248 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
249
250 @item
251 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
252
253 @item
254 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
255 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
256
257 @item
258 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
259
260 @item
261 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
262
263 @item
264 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
265 inside any editing buffer.
266
267 @item
268 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
269
270 @item
271 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
272 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
273 @end itemize
274
275 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
276 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
277 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
278 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
279 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
280 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
281 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
282 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
283
284 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
285 @section About This Manual
286
287 @noindent
288 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
289 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
290 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
291 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
292 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
293 regularly.
294
295 This manual is divided into three major parts: the ``Getting
296 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial, and the Calc
297 reference manual.
298 @c [when-split]
299 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
300 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
301 @c chapter.
302
303 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
304 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
305 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
306 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
307 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
308
309 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
310 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
311 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
312 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
313 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
314 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
315 to use its features.
316
317 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
318 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
319 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
320 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
321 need to know.
322
323 @c @cindex Marginal notes
324 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
325 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
326 variables also have their own indices.
327 @c @texline Each
328 @c @infoline In the printed manual, each
329 @c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
330 @c in the margin with its index entry.
331
332 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
333 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
334 the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
335 @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
336 @kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
337 command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
338 necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
339 to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
340 manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
341 @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
342
343 @ifnottex
344 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
345 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
346 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
347 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
348 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
349 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
350 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
351 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
352 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
353 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
354 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
355 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
356 The result will be a device-independent output file called
357 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
358 for your system. On many systems, the command is
359
360 @example
361 lpr -d calc.dvi
362 @end example
363
364 @noindent
365 or
366
367 @example
368 dvips calc.dvi
369 @end example
370 @end ifnottex
371 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
372 @c Foundation.
373
374 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
375 @section Notations Used in This Manual
376
377 @noindent
378 This section describes the various notations that are used
379 throughout the Calc manual.
380
381 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
382 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
383 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
384 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
385 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
386 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
387 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
388 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
389 regularly using Emacs.
390
391 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
392 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
393 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
394 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
395 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
396
397 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
398 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
399 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
400
401 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
402 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
403 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
404 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
405
406 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
407 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
408 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
409 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
410 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
411
412 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
413 [@code{sincos}].
414
415 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
416 @section A Demonstration of Calc
417
418 @noindent
419 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
420 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
421 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
422 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
423 Tutorial.
424
425 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
426 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
427 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
428 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
429
430 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
431 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
432 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
433 Delete, and Space keys.
434
435 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
436 then the command to operate on the numbers.
437
438 @noindent
439 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
440 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
441 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
442
443 @noindent
444 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
445 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
446 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
447
448 @noindent
449 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
450
451 @noindent
452 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
453 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
454
455 @noindent
456 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
457
458 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
459 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
460 use the apostrophe key.
461
462 @noindent
463 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
464 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
465 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
466
467 @noindent
468 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
469 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
470 @infoline `pi' squared.
471 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
472
473 @noindent
474 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
475 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
476
477 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
478 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
479 the next section.)
480
481 @noindent
482 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
483 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
484
485 @noindent
486 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
487
488 @noindent
489 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
490
491 @noindent
492 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
493
494 @noindent
495 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
496 the Keypad Calculator off.
497
498 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
499 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
500 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
501 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
502 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
503 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
504 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
505
506 @example
507 @group
508 1.23 1.97
509 1.6 2
510 1.19 1.08
511 @end group
512 @end example
513
514 @noindent
515 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
516 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
517
518 @noindent
519 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
520 the product of the numbers.
521
522 @noindent
523 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
524 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
525 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
526
527 @noindent
528 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
529 @texline @math{3\times2}
530 @infoline 3x2
531 matrix into a
532 @texline @math{2\times3}
533 @infoline 2x3
534 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
535 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
536 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
537 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
538
539 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
540 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
541 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
542
543 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
544 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
545 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
546 many weeks have passed since then.
547
548 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
549 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
550 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
551 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
552 in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
553 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
554
555 @noindent
556 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
557 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
558 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
559 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the @LaTeX{} typesetting
560 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
561
562 @noindent
563 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
564 (That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
565
566 @ifnotinfo
567 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
568 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
569 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
570 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
571 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
572 @end ifnotinfo
573 @ifinfo
574 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
575 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
576 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
577 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
578 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
579 @end ifinfo
580
581 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
582 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
583
584 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgments, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
585 @section Using Calc
586
587 @noindent
588 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
589 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
590 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
591
592 @menu
593 * Starting Calc::
594 * The Standard Interface::
595 * Quick Mode Overview::
596 * Keypad Mode Overview::
597 * Standalone Operation::
598 * Embedded Mode Overview::
599 * Other C-x * Commands::
600 @end menu
601
602 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
603 @subsection Starting Calc
604
605 @noindent
606 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
607 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
608 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
609
610 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
611 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
612 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
613 which Calc interface you want to use.
614
615 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
616 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
617 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
618 a complete list.
619
620 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
621 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
622 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
623
624 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
625 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
626 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
627 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
628 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
629
630 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
631 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
632
633 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
634 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
635
636 @noindent
637 @cindex Standard user interface
638 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
639 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
640 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
641 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
642
643 @smallexample
644 @group
645
646 ...
647 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
648 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
649 2: 17.3 | 17.3
650 1: -5 | 3
651 . | 2
652 | 4
653 | * 8
654 | ->-5
655 |
656 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
657 @end group
658 @end smallexample
659
660 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
661 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
662 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
663 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
664 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
665 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
666 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
667 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
668 you do.
669
670 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
671 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
672 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
673 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
674 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
675
676 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
677 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
678 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
679
680 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
681 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
682 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
683 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
684 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
685 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
686 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
687
688 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
689 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
690 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
691 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
692 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
693 as Calc commands.
694
695 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
696 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
697 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
698 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
699 Calculator.
700
701 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
702 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
703 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
704 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
705 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
706 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
707 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
708
709 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
710
711 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
712 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
713 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
714 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
715 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
716 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
717 normal partial-screen mode.
718
719 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
720 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
721 editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
722 then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
723 switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
724 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
725 type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
726
727 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
728 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
729
730 @noindent
731 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
732 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
733 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
734
735 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
736 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
737 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
738 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
739 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
740 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
741 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
742 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
743
744 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
745 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
746
747 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
748 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
749
750 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
751 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
752
753 @noindent
754 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
755 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
756 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
757 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
758
759 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
760 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
761 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
762 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
763
764 @tex
765 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
766 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
767 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
768 \medskip
769 @end tex
770 @smallexample
771 @group
772 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
773 |2: 17.3
774 |1: -5
775 | .
776 |--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
777 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
778 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
779 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
780 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
781 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
782 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
783 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
784 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
785 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
786 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
787 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
788 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
789 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
790 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
791 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
792 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
793 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
794 @end group
795 @end smallexample
796
797 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
798 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
799 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
800 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
801 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
802 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
803
804 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
805 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
806 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
807 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
808 the stack).
809
810 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
811 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
812 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
813 numbers.
814
815 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
816 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
817 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
818 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
819 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
820
821 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
822 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
823 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
824
825 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
826 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
827
828 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
829 @subsection Standalone Operation
830
831 @noindent
832 @cindex Standalone Operation
833 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
834 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
835 can give the commands:
836
837 @example
838 emacs -f full-calc
839 @end example
840
841 @noindent
842 or
843
844 @example
845 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
846 @end example
847
848 @noindent
849 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
850 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
851 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
852 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
853 itself.
854
855 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
856 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
857
858 @noindent
859 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
860 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
861 document like this:
862
863 @smallexample
864 @group
865 The derivative of
866
867 ln(ln(x))
868
869 is
870 @end group
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
875 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
876 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
877 you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
878 formula:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @group
882 The derivative of
883
884 ln(ln(x))
885
886 is
887
888 ln(ln(x))
889 @end group
890 @end smallexample
891
892 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
893 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
894 how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
895 stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
896 the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
897 (in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
898 change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
899 @samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
900 buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
901 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
902 derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
903
904 @smallexample
905 @group
906 The derivative of
907
908 ln(ln(x))
909
910 is
911
912 1 / x ln(x)
913 @end group
914 @end smallexample
915
916 (Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
917 so that @samp{1 / x ln(x)} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (x ln(x))}.)
918
919 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
920 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
921
922 @smallexample
923 @group
924 The derivative of
925
926 ln(ln(x))
927
928 is
929 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
930 % [calc-mode: language: big]
931
932 1
933 -------
934 x ln(x)
935 @end group
936 @end smallexample
937
938 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
939 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
940 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
941 @LaTeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
942 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
943 out of the way.)
944
945 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
946 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
947
948 @smallexample
949 @group
950 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
951 % [calc-mode: language: big]
952 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
953
954 1
955 ------- (1)
956 ln(x) x
957 @end group
958 @end smallexample
959
960 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
961 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
962
963 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
964 generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
965 expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
966 Here's an example of its use (before you try this, remove the Calc
967 annotations or use a new buffer so that the extra settings in the
968 annotations don't take effect):
969
970 @smallexample
971 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
972 @end smallexample
973
974 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
975 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
976 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
977 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
978
979 @smallexample
980 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
981 @end smallexample
982
983 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
984 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
985
986 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
987 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
988
989 @noindent
990 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
991 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
992 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
993 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
994 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
995
996 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
997 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
998 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
999 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
1000 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1001 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1002 formula.
1003
1004 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1005 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1006 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1007
1008 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1009 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1010 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1011 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1012 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1013 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1014 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1015 is something on the Calc stack.
1016
1017 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1018 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1019 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1020
1021 @noindent
1022 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1023
1024 @table @kbd
1025 @item *
1026 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1027
1028 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1029 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1030
1031 @item C
1032 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1033 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1034 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1035
1036 @item O
1037 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1038 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1039 move it out of that window.
1040
1041 @item B
1042 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1043
1044 @item Q
1045 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1046
1047 @item K
1048 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1049
1050 @item E
1051 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1052
1053 @item J
1054 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1055
1056 @item W
1057 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1058
1059 @item Z
1060 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1061
1062 @item X
1063 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1064 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1065 @end table
1066 @iftex
1067 @sp 2
1068 @end iftex
1069
1070 @noindent
1071 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1072
1073 @table @kbd
1074 @item G
1075 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1076
1077 @item R
1078 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1079
1080 @item :
1081 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1082
1083 @item _
1084 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1085
1086 @item Y
1087 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1088 @end table
1089 @iftex
1090 @sp 2
1091 @end iftex
1092
1093 @noindent
1094 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1095
1096 @table @kbd
1097 @item A
1098 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1099 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1100 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1101
1102 @item D
1103 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1104 the duplicate.
1105
1106 @item F
1107 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1108
1109 @item N
1110 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1111
1112 @item P
1113 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1114
1115 @item U
1116 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1117
1118 @item `
1119 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1120 @end table
1121 @iftex
1122 @sp 2
1123 @end iftex
1124
1125 @noindent
1126 Miscellaneous commands:
1127
1128 @table @kbd
1129 @item I
1130 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1131 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1132
1133 @item T
1134 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1135
1136 @item S
1137 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1138
1139 @item L
1140 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1141 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1142
1143 @item M
1144 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1145 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1146
1147 @item 0
1148 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1149 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1150 @end table
1151
1152 @node History and Acknowledgments, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1153 @section History and Acknowledgments
1154
1155 @noindent
1156 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1157 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1158 the value of
1159 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1160 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1161 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1162 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1163 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1164 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1165 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1166 all.
1167
1168 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1169 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1170 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1171 got too far out of hand.
1172
1173 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1174 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1175 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1176
1177 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1178 this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1179 only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so (at the time)---not
1180 enough for a decent calculator. So I had to write my own
1181 high-precision integer code as well, and once I had this I figured
1182 that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large integers.
1183 Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step. Also,
1184 since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1185 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it
1186 practical to support fractions as well as floats. All these features
1187 inspired me to look around for other data types that might be worth
1188 having.
1189
1190 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1191 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1192 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1193 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1194 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1195 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1196 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1197 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1198 implement what they needed for themselves.
1199
1200 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1201 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1202 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1203
1204 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1205 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1206 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1207
1208 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1209 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1210 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1211 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1212 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1213 algebra system for microcomputers.
1214
1215 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1216 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1217 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1218 rules, and many other algebra features;
1219 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1220 @infoline Francois
1221 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1222 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1223 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1224 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1225 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1226 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1227 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1228 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1229 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1230 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1231 well as many other things.
1232
1233 @cindex Bibliography
1234 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1235 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1236 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1237 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1238 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1239 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1240 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1241 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1242 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1243 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1244 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1245 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1246 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1247 Dan LaLiberte.
1248
1249 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1250 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1251 finished in two weeks.
1252
1253 @c [tutorial]
1254
1255 @ifinfo
1256 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1257 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1258 @chapter Tutorial
1259
1260 @noindent
1261 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1262
1263 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1264 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1265 for this).
1266
1267 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1268 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1269 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1270 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1271
1272 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1273 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1274 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1275 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1276 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1277
1278 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1279
1280 Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1281
1282 @menu
1283 * Tutorial::
1284 @end menu
1285
1286 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1287 @end ifinfo
1288 @ifnotinfo
1289 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1290 @end ifnotinfo
1291 @chapter Tutorial
1292
1293 @noindent
1294 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1295 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1296 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1297 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1298 @c [not-split]
1299 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1300 @c [when-split]
1301 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1302
1303 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1304 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1305 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1306 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1307 the Embedded mode interface.
1308
1309 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1310 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1311 @kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1312 current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1313 Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1314 window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1315 (If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1316 that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
1317
1318 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1319 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1320 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1321 general areas.
1322
1323 @ifnottex
1324 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1325 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1326 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1327 @end ifnottex
1328 @iftex
1329 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1330 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1331 Calc.
1332 @end iftex
1333
1334 @menu
1335 * Basic Tutorial::
1336 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1337 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1338 * Types Tutorial::
1339 * Algebra Tutorial::
1340 * Programming Tutorial::
1341
1342 * Answers to Exercises::
1343 @end menu
1344
1345 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1346 @section Basic Tutorial
1347
1348 @noindent
1349 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1350 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1351 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1352
1353 @menu
1354 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1355 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1356 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1357 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1358 @end menu
1359
1360 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1361 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1362
1363 @cindex RPN notation
1364 @noindent
1365 @ifnottex
1366 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1367 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1368 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1369 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1370 @end ifnottex
1371 @tex
1372 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1373 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1374 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1375 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1376 @end tex
1377
1378 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1379 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1380 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1381 from the top of the stack.
1382
1383 @cindex Operators
1384 @cindex Operands
1385 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1386 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1387 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1388 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1389 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1390 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1391
1392 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1393 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1394 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1395 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1396 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1397 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1398 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1399 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1400 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1401
1402 @smallexample
1403 @group
1404 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1405 . 1: 3 .
1406 .
1407
1408 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1409 @end group
1410 @end smallexample
1411
1412 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1413 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1414 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1415 less distracting in regular use.
1416
1417 @cindex Stack levels
1418 @cindex Levels of stack
1419 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1420 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1421 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1422 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1423 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1424 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1425 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1426
1427 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1428 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1429 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1430 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1431 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1432 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1433 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1434 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1435 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1436 if you are interested.
1437
1438 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1439 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1440 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1441 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1442 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1443
1444 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1445 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1446
1447 @smallexample
1448 @group
1449 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1450 . 1: 3 .
1451 .
1452
1453 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1454 @end group
1455 @end smallexample
1456
1457 @noindent
1458 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1459 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1460 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1461
1462 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1463 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1464 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1465 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1466 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1467 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1468 return to where you were.)
1469
1470 @noindent
1471 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1472 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1473 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1474 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1475
1476 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1477 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.5) + {5\over4}}
1478 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1479 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1480
1481 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1482 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1483 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1484 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1485 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1486 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1487 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1488 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1489 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1490
1491 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1492 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1493 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1494
1495 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1496 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1497 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1498 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1499 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1500
1501 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1502 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1503 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1504
1505 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1506 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1507 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1508
1509 @smallexample
1510 @group
1511 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1512 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1513 . .
1514
1515 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1516 @end group
1517 @end smallexample
1518
1519 @noindent
1520 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1521 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1522
1523 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1524 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1525 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1526
1527 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1528 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1529 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1530 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1531 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1532
1533 @smallexample
1534 @group
1535 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1536 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1537 . .
1538
1539 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1540 @end group
1541 @end smallexample
1542
1543 @noindent
1544 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1545
1546 @smallexample
1547 @group
1548 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1549 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1550 . 1: 3 .
1551 .
1552
1553 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1554 @end group
1555 @end smallexample
1556
1557 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1558 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1559 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1560
1561 @smallexample
1562 @group
1563 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1564 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1565 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1566 . . .
1567
1568 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1569 @end group
1570 @end smallexample
1571
1572 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1573 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1574 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1575 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1576
1577 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1578 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1579 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1580 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1581
1582 @smallexample
1583 @group
1584 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1585 . . 1: 16 . .
1586 .
1587
1588 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1589 @end group
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1594 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1595
1596 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1597 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1598 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1599 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1600 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1601
1602 @smallexample
1603 @group
1604 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1605 . 1: 4 .
1606 .
1607
1608 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1609 @end group
1610 @end smallexample
1611
1612 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1613 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1614 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1615 prefix for you:
1616
1617 @smallexample
1618 @group
1619 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1620 . 1: 4 .
1621 .
1622
1623 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1624 @end group
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1632 . . .
1633
1634 4 @key{RET} n Q
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent
1639 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1640 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1641 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1642 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1643
1644 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1645 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1646 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1647 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1648 complex result.)
1649
1650 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1651 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 @group
1655 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1656 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1657 . .
1658
1659 ( 2 , 3 )
1660 @end group
1661 @end smallexample
1662
1663 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1664 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1665
1666 @smallexample
1667 @group
1668 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1669 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1670 . 1: 3 . .
1671 .
1672 (error)
1673 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1674 @end group
1675 @end smallexample
1676
1677 @noindent
1678 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1679 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1680
1681 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1682 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 @group
1686 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1687 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1688 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1689 . . .
1690
1691 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1692 @end group
1693 @end smallexample
1694
1695 @noindent
1696 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1697 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1698 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1699 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1700
1701 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1702 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1703 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1704 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1705 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1706
1707 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1708 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1709 the tutorial.
1710
1711 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1712 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1713 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1714 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1715 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1716 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1717 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1718
1719 @smallexample
1720 @group
1721 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1722 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1723 . 1: 30 1: 30
1724 . .
1725
1726 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1727 @end group
1728 @end smallexample
1729
1730 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1731 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1732 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1733 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1734 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 @group
1738 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1739 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1740 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1741 . . 1: 20
1742 .
1743
1744 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1745 @end group
1746 @end smallexample
1747
1748 @cindex Clearing the stack
1749 @cindex Emptying the stack
1750 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1751 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1752 entire stack.)
1753
1754 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1755 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1756
1757 @noindent
1758 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1759 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1760 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1761 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1762
1763 @strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1764 that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1765 standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
1766
1767 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1768 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1769 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1770 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1771 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1772 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1773 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1774
1775 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1776 The result should be the number 9.
1777
1778 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1779 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1780 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1781 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1782 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1783
1784 @example
1785 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1786 @end example
1787
1788 @noindent
1789 is equivalent to
1790
1791 @example
1792 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1793 @end example
1794
1795 @noindent
1796 or, in large mathematical notation,
1797
1798 @ifnottex
1799 @example
1800 @group
1801 3 * 4 * 5
1802 2 + --------- - 9
1803 8
1804 6 * 7
1805 @end group
1806 @end example
1807 @end ifnottex
1808 @tex
1809 \beforedisplay
1810 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1811 \afterdisplay
1812 @end tex
1813
1814 @noindent
1815 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1816
1817 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1818 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1819 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1820 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1821
1822 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1823 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1824 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1825 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1826
1827 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1828 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1829 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1830 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1831 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1832
1833 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1834
1835 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1836 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1837 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1838 an algebraic entry.
1839
1840 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1841 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1842 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1843 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1844 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1845
1846 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1847 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1848
1849 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1850 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1851 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1852 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1853 rule to use!
1854
1855 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1856 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1857 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1858
1859 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1860
1861 @smallexample
1862 @group
1863 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1864 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1865 . .
1866
1867 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1868 @end group
1869 @end smallexample
1870
1871 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1872 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1873 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1874
1875 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1876 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1877 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1878 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1879 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1880 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1881 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1882
1883 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1884
1885 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1886 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1887 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1888 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1889 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1890 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1891 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1892 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1893 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1894 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1895 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1896 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1897 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1898
1899 @smallexample
1900 @group
1901 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1902 . . .
1903
1904 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1905 @end group
1906 @end smallexample
1907
1908 @noindent
1909 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1910 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1911
1912 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1913 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1914 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1915 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1916
1917 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1918 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1919
1920 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1921 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1922 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1923 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1924 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1925 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1926 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1927
1928 @smallexample
1929 @group
1930 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1931 . . .
1932
1933 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1934 @end group
1935 @end smallexample
1936
1937 @noindent
1938 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1939 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1940
1941 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1942 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1943 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1944
1945 @smallexample
1946 @group
1947 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1948 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1949 . 1: 2 .
1950 .
1951
1952 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1953 @end group
1954 @end smallexample
1955
1956 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1957 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1958 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1959 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1960 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1961 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1962
1963 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1964 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1965
1966 @smallexample
1967 @group
1968 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 2 b + 34
1969 . .
1970
1971 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1972 @end group
1973 @end smallexample
1974
1975 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1976 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1977
1978 @smallexample
1979 @group
1980 1: log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3) + 2
1981 .
1982
1983 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1984 @end group
1985 @end smallexample
1986
1987 @noindent
1988 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1989 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1990 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1991 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1992 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1993 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1994 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1995 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1996 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1997 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1998 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
1999 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
2000 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2001 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2002
2003 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2004 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2005 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2006 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2007 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2008
2009 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2010 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2011 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2012
2013 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2014 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2015 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2016 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2017 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2018 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2019 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2020 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2021
2022 @smallexample
2023 @group
2024 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2025 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2026 . .
2027
2028 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2029 @end group
2030 @end smallexample
2031
2032 @noindent
2033 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2034 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2035 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2036 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2037 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2038
2039 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2040
2041 @smallexample
2042 @group
2043 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2044 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2045 .
2046
2047 s u a @key{RET}
2048 @end group
2049 @end smallexample
2050
2051 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2052 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2053
2054 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2055 @subsection Undo and Redo
2056
2057 @noindent
2058 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2059 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2060 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2061 with a clean slate. Now:
2062
2063 @smallexample
2064 @group
2065 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2066 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2067 . .
2068
2069 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2070 @end group
2071 @end smallexample
2072
2073 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2074 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2075 above example, you could type:
2076
2077 @smallexample
2078 @group
2079 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2080 . 1: 3 .
2081 .
2082 (error)
2083 U U U U
2084 @end group
2085 @end smallexample
2086
2087 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2088 mistakenly.
2089
2090 @smallexample
2091 @group
2092 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2093 . 1: 3 . .
2094 .
2095 (error)
2096 D D D D
2097 @end group
2098 @end smallexample
2099
2100 @noindent
2101 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2102 by something other than an undo command.
2103
2104 @cindex Time travel
2105 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2106 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2107 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2108 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2109 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2110 was an earlier undo command.
2111
2112 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2113 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2114 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2115 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2116
2117 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2118 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2119 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2120 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2121 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2122 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2123 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2124 stack.
2125
2126 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2127 went into the trail.
2128
2129 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2130 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2131 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2132 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2133 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2134 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2135 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2136 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2137
2138 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2139 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2140 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2141 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2142 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2143
2144 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2145 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2146 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2147 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2148 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2149 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2150 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2151 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2152 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2153 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2154 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2155
2156 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2157
2158 @smallexample
2159 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2160 @end smallexample
2161
2162 @noindent
2163 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2164 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2165 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2166 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2167 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2168 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2169 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2170
2171 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2172 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2173 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2174 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2175 the prefix.
2176
2177 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2178 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2179 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2180 to edit a stack entry.
2181
2182 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2183 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2184 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2185 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2186 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2187 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2188 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2189 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2190
2191 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2192 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2193
2194 @noindent
2195 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2196 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2197 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2198 try some of the most common ones here.
2199
2200 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2201 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2202
2203 @smallexample
2204 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2205 @end smallexample
2206
2207 @noindent
2208 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2209 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2210 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2211 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2212 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2213 leading and trailing zeros.
2214
2215 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2216 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2217 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2218
2219 @smallexample
2220 @group
2221 1: 0.142857142857
2222 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2223 .
2224 @end group
2225 @end smallexample
2226
2227 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2228 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2229 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2230 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2231
2232 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2233 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2234
2235 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2236 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2237 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2238 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2239 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2240 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2241 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2242
2243 @smallexample
2244 @group
2245 1: 0.142857142857
2246 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2247 3: 1.14285714286
2248 .
2249 @end group
2250 @end smallexample
2251
2252 @noindent
2253 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2254 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2255
2256 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2257 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2258 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2259 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2260 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2261 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2262 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2263 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2264 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2265 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2266 arithmetic.
2267
2268 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2269 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2270 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2271
2272 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2273
2274 @smallexample
2275 @group
2276 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2277 . 1: 10000 .
2278 .
2279
2280 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2281 @end group
2282 @end smallexample
2283
2284 @noindent
2285 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2286 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2287 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2288 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2289 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2290
2291 @smallexample
2292 @group
2293 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2294 . 1: 10000. .
2295 .
2296
2297 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2298 @end group
2299 @end smallexample
2300
2301 @cindex Round-off errors
2302 @noindent
2303 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2304 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2305 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2306 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2307 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2308 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2309 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2310 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2311 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2312 out:
2313
2314 @smallexample
2315 @group
2316 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2317 . 1: 10000. .
2318 .
2319
2320 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2321 @end group
2322 @end smallexample
2323
2324 @noindent
2325 @cindex Guard digits
2326 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2327 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2328 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2329 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2330 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2331 last place.
2332
2333 @cindex Guard digits
2334 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2335 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2336 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2337 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2338 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2339 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2340 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2341
2342 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2343 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2344 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2345 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2346 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2347 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2348 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2349 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2350 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2351 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2352 numbers shown here:
2353
2354 @smallexample
2355 @group
2356 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2357 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2358 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2359 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2360 . . . . .
2361
2362 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2363 @end group
2364 @end smallexample
2365
2366 @noindent
2367 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2368 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2369 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2370 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2371 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2372 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2373
2374 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2375 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2376 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2377 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2378
2379 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2380 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2381 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2382 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2383 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2384
2385 @smallexample
2386 @group
2387 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2388 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2389 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2390 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2391 . . . . .
2392
2393 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2394 @end group
2395 @end smallexample
2396
2397 @noindent
2398 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2399 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2400 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2401 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2402 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2403 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2404 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2405
2406 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2407 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2408 displayed exactly.
2409
2410 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2411 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2412 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2413
2414 @example
2415 2417851639229258349412352
2416 @end example
2417
2418 @noindent
2419 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2420
2421 @example
2422 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2423 @end example
2424
2425 @noindent
2426 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2427 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2428 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2429
2430 @example
2431 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2432 @end example
2433
2434 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2435 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2436 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2437
2438 @example
2439 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2440 @end example
2441
2442 @noindent
2443 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2444 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2445
2446 @example
2447 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2448 @end example
2449
2450 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2451 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2452
2453 @example
2454 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2455 @end example
2456
2457 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2458 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2459 restore the default precision.
2460
2461 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2462 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2463 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2464 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2465
2466 @example
2467 16#200000000000000000000
2468 @end example
2469
2470 @noindent
2471 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2472 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2473 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2474 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2475 form:
2476
2477 @example
2478 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2479 @end example
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2483 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2484 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2485 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2486 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2487 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2488
2489 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2490 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2491 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2492 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2493 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2494
2495 @example
2496 2#101,1111,1110
2497 @end example
2498
2499 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2500 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2501 other radix.
2502
2503 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2504
2505 @example
2506 1,534
2507 @end example
2508
2509 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2510 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2511 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2512 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2513
2514 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2515 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2516 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2517 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2518 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2519 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2520 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2521 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2522 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2523
2524 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2525 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2526 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2527 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2528 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2529 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2530 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2531 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2532
2533 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2534 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2535 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2536 the way they are actually computed.
2537
2538 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2539 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2540 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2541 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2542
2543 @smallexample
2544 @group
2545 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2546 . . . .
2547
2548 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2549 @end group
2550 @end smallexample
2551
2552 @noindent
2553 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2554 of 45 degrees is
2555 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2556 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2557 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2558 roundoff error because the representation of
2559 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2560 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2561 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2562 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2563 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2564
2565 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2566 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2567 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2568 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2569 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2570
2571 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2572 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2573 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2574 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2575 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2576
2577 @smallexample
2578 @group
2579 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2580 . . .
2581
2582 P 4 / m r S
2583 @end group
2584 @end smallexample
2585
2586 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2587 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2588
2589 @smallexample
2590 @group
2591 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2592 . . .
2593
2594 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2595 @end group
2596 @end smallexample
2597
2598 @noindent
2599 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2600 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2601 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2602 first in radians, then in degrees.
2603
2604 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2605 and vice-versa.
2606
2607 @smallexample
2608 @group
2609 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2610 . . .
2611
2612 45 c r c d
2613 @end group
2614 @end smallexample
2615
2616 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2617 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2618 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2619 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2620 number, instead.
2621
2622 @smallexample
2623 @group
2624 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2625 1: 9 . .
2626 .
2627
2628 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2629 @end group
2630 @end smallexample
2631
2632 @noindent
2633 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2634 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2635
2636 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2637 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2638 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2639 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2640 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2641 what to do when dividing two integers.
2642
2643 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2644 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2645 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2646 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2647 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2648
2649 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2650 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2651 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2652 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2653 recompute for you.
2654
2655 @smallexample
2656 @group
2657 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2658 . . .
2659
2660 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2661 @end group
2662 @end smallexample
2663
2664 @noindent
2665 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2666 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2667 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2668 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2669 might affect their values.
2670
2671 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2672 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2673
2674 @noindent
2675 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2676 available in the Calculator.
2677
2678 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2679 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2680 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2681 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2682
2683 @smallexample
2684 @group
2685 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2686 . . . . .
2687
2688 5 & & n n
2689 @end group
2690 @end smallexample
2691
2692 @cindex Binary operators
2693 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2694 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2695 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2696 a negative prefix.
2697
2698 @smallexample
2699 @group
2700 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2701 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2702 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2703 . . 1: 10 .
2704 .
2705
2706 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2707 @end group
2708 @end smallexample
2709
2710 @cindex Unary operators
2711 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2712 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2713
2714 @smallexample
2715 @group
2716 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2717 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2718 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2719 . . .
2720
2721 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2722 @end group
2723 @end smallexample
2724
2725 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2726 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2727 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2728 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2729 integer.
2730
2731 @smallexample
2732 @group
2733 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2734 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2735 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2736 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2737 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2738 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2739 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2740 . . .
2741
2742 M-7 F U M-7 R
2743 @end group
2744 @end smallexample
2745
2746 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2747 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2748 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2749 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2750 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2751
2752 @smallexample
2753 @group
2754 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2755 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2756 . .
2757
2758 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2759 @end group
2760 @end smallexample
2761
2762 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2763
2764 @smallexample
2765 @group
2766 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2767 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2768 . .
2769
2770 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2771 @end group
2772 @end smallexample
2773
2774 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2775 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2776 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2777 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2778 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2779
2780 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2781 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2782 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2783 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2784 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2785
2786 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2787 identity
2788 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2789 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2790 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2791 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 @group
2795 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2796 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2797 . . . .
2798
2799 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2800 @end group
2801 @end smallexample
2802
2803 @noindent
2804 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2805 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2806
2807 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2808 of squares, command.
2809
2810 Another identity is
2811 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2812 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2813 @smallexample
2814 @group
2815
2816 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2817 1: 0.43837 . .
2818 .
2819
2820 U / I T
2821 @end group
2822 @end smallexample
2823
2824 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2825 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2826 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2827 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2828
2829 @smallexample
2830 @group
2831 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2832 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2833 . .
2834
2835 U U M-2 n / I T
2836 @end group
2837 @end smallexample
2838
2839 @noindent
2840 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2841 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2842 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2843 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2844 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2845 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2846 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2847
2848 @smallexample
2849 @group
2850 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2851 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2852 . 1: 0.43837 .
2853 .
2854
2855 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2856 @end group
2857 @end smallexample
2858
2859 @noindent
2860 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2861 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2862
2863 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2864 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2865 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2866 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2867 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2868 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2869 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2870 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2871
2872 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2873 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2874 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2875 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2876 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2877
2878 @smallexample
2879 @group
2880 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2881 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2882 . . . . .
2883
2884 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2885 @end group
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2890 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2891 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2892 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2893 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2894 error.
2895
2896 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2897 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2898 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2899 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2900
2901 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2902 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2903
2904 @cindex Common logarithm
2905 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2906 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2907 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2908 prefix.
2909
2910 @smallexample
2911 @group
2912 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2913 . . . .
2914
2915 1000 L U H L
2916 @end group
2917 @end smallexample
2918
2919 @noindent
2920 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2921 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2922
2923 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2924 value of @var{b}.
2925
2926 @smallexample
2927 @group
2928 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2929 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2930 . .
2931
2932 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2933 @end group
2934 @end smallexample
2935
2936 @noindent
2937 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2938 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2939 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2940 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2941 onto the stack.
2942
2943 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2944 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2945 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2946 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2947 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2948 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2949 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2950 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2951 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2952 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2953
2954 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2955 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2956 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2957
2958 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2959 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2960 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2961
2962 @smallexample
2963 @group
2964 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2965 . . . .
2966
2967 100 ! U c f !
2968 @end group
2969 @end smallexample
2970
2971 @noindent
2972 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2973 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2974 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2975 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2976 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2977 in this case).
2978
2979 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2980 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2981 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2982 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2983 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2984
2985 @smallexample
2986 @group
2987 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2988 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2989 1: 5. 1: 120.
2990 . .
2991
2992 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2993 @end group
2994 @end smallexample
2995
2996 @noindent
2997 Here we verify the identity
2998 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
2999 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
3000
3001 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3002 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3003 is defined by
3004 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3005 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3006 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3007 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3008 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3009 large intermediate values.
3010
3011 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3012 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3013 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3014
3015 @smallexample
3016 @group
3017 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3018 1: 20 . .
3019 .
3020
3021 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3022 @end group
3023 @end smallexample
3024
3025 @noindent
3026 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3027 together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3028 number, 30045015.
3029
3030 @cindex Hash tables
3031 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3032 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3033 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3034
3035 @smallexample
3036 @group
3037 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3038 . . .
3039
3040 10000 k n I k n
3041 @end group
3042 @end smallexample
3043
3044 @noindent
3045 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3046 10000.
3047
3048 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3049 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3050 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3051 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3052
3053 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3054 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3055 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3056
3057 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3058 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3059
3060 @noindent
3061 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3062 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3063 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3064 a vector as a list of objects.
3065
3066 @menu
3067 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3068 * Matrix Tutorial::
3069 * List Tutorial::
3070 @end menu
3071
3072 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3073 @subsection Vector Analysis
3074
3075 @noindent
3076 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3077 elements, taken pairwise.
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 @group
3081 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3082 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3083 .
3084
3085 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3086 @end group
3087 @end smallexample
3088
3089 @noindent
3090 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3091 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3092 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3093 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3094
3095 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3096 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3097 of the vectors.
3098
3099 @smallexample
3100 @group
3101 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3102 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3103 .
3104
3105 r 1 r 2 *
3106 @end group
3107 @end smallexample
3108
3109 @cindex Dot product
3110 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3111 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3112 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3113 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3114 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3115 vector.
3116
3117 @smallexample
3118 @group
3119 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3120 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3121 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3122 . .
3123
3124 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3125 @end group
3126 @end smallexample
3127
3128 @noindent
3129 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3130 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3131 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3132 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3133 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3134 is about 56 degrees.
3135
3136 @cindex Cross product
3137 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3138 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3139 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3140 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3141 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3142 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3143 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3144
3145 @smallexample
3146 @group
3147 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3148 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3149 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3150 .
3151
3152 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3153 @end group
3154 @end smallexample
3155
3156 @noindent
3157 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3158 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3159 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3160 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3161
3162 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3163 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3164 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3165 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3166 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3167 prefix keys have this property.)
3168
3169 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3170 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3171 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3172
3173 @smallexample
3174 @group
3175 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3176 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3177 . .
3178
3179 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3180 @end group
3181 @end smallexample
3182
3183 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3184 @cindex Unit vectors
3185 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3186 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3187 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3188 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3189
3190 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3191 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3192 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3193 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3194 Find the average position of the particle.
3195 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3196
3197 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3198 @subsection Matrices
3199
3200 @noindent
3201 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3202 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3203 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3204 both methods here:
3205
3206 @smallexample
3207 @group
3208 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3209 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3210 . .
3211
3212 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3213 @end group
3214 @end smallexample
3215
3216 @noindent
3217 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3218
3219 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3220 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3221 the second example.
3222
3223 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3224 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3225 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3226 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3227 of the right matrix.
3228
3229 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3230 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3231
3232 @smallexample
3233 @group
3234 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3235 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3236 .
3237
3238 @key{RET} *
3239 @end group
3240 @end smallexample
3241
3242 @noindent
3243 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3244 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3245 been left in symbolic form.
3246
3247 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3248
3249 @smallexample
3250 @group
3251 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3252 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3253 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3254 [ 2, 5 ] .
3255 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3256 .
3257
3258 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3259 @end group
3260 @end smallexample
3261
3262 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3263 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3264 matrix, as happened here!
3265
3266 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3267 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3268 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3269 as a row or column as appropriate.
3270
3271 @smallexample
3272 @group
3273 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3274 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3275 1: [1, 2, 3]
3276 .
3277
3278 r 4 r 1 *
3279 @end group
3280 @end smallexample
3281
3282 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3283 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3284 vector.
3285
3286 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3287 of the above
3288 @texline @math{2\times3}
3289 @infoline 2x3
3290 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3291 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3292 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3293
3294 @cindex Identity matrix
3295 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3296 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3297 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3298 the original matrix.
3299
3300 @smallexample
3301 @group
3302 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3303 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3304 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3305 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3306 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3307 .
3308
3309 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3310 @end group
3311 @end smallexample
3312
3313 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3314 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3315 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3316 inverse of a matrix.
3317
3318 @smallexample
3319 @group
3320 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3321 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3322 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3323 . .
3324
3325 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3326 @end group
3327 @end smallexample
3328
3329 @noindent
3330 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3331 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3332 our matrix to make it square.
3333
3334 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3335
3336 @smallexample
3337 @group
3338 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3339 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3340 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3341 . .
3342
3343 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3344 @end group
3345 @end smallexample
3346
3347 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3348 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3349 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3350 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3351
3352 @ifnottex
3353 @group
3354 @example
3355 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3356 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3357 7a + 6b = 3
3358 @end example
3359 @end group
3360 @end ifnottex
3361 @tex
3362 \beforedisplayh
3363 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3364 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3365 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3368 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3369 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3370 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3371 $$
3372 \afterdisplayh
3373 @end tex
3374
3375 @noindent
3376 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3377
3378 @ifnottex
3379 @group
3380 @example
3381 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3382 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3383 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3384 @end example
3385 @end group
3386 @end ifnottex
3387 @tex
3388 \beforedisplay
3389 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3390 \times
3391 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3392 $$
3393 \afterdisplay
3394 @end tex
3395
3396 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3397 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3398
3399 @smallexample
3400 @group
3401 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3402 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3403 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3404 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3405 .
3406
3407 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3408 @end group
3409 @end smallexample
3410
3411 @noindent
3412 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3413 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3414 inverse.)
3415
3416 Let's verify this solution:
3417
3418 @smallexample
3419 @group
3420 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3421 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3422 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3423 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3424 .
3425
3426 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3427 @end group
3428 @end smallexample
3429
3430 @noindent
3431 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3432 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3433 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3434 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3435 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3436 vectors, use explicit
3437 @texline @math{N\times1}
3438 @infoline Nx1
3439 or
3440 @texline @math{1\times N}
3441 @infoline 1xN
3442 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3443 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3444
3445 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3446 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3447 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3448 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3449
3450 @ifnottex
3451 @group
3452 @example
3453 x + a y = 6
3454 x + b y = 10
3455 @end example
3456 @end group
3457 @end ifnottex
3458 @tex
3459 \beforedisplay
3460 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3461 x &+ b y = 10}
3462 $$
3463 \afterdisplay
3464 @end tex
3465
3466 @noindent
3467 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3468
3469 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3470 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3471 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3472 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3473 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3474 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3475 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3476 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3477 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3478 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3479 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3480 @ifnottex
3481 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3482 @end ifnottex
3483 @tex
3484 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3485 @end tex
3486 Now
3487 @texline @math{A^T A}
3488 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3489 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3490 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3491 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3492 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3493 system:
3494
3495 @ifnottex
3496 @group
3497 @example
3498 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3499 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3500 7a + 6b = 3
3501 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3502 @end example
3503 @end group
3504 @end ifnottex
3505 @tex
3506 \beforedisplayh
3507 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3508 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3509 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3510 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3511 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3512 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3513 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3514 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3515 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3516 $$
3517 \afterdisplayh
3518 @end tex
3519
3520 @noindent
3521 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3522
3523 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3524 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3525
3526 @noindent
3527 @cindex Lists
3528 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3529 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3530 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3531 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3532 number.
3533
3534 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3535
3536 @smallexample
3537 @group
3538 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3539 2: 20 . 2: 20
3540 1: 30 1: 30
3541 . .
3542
3543 M-3 v p v u
3544 @end group
3545 @end smallexample
3546
3547 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3548 of many copies of a given value:
3549
3550 @smallexample
3551 @group
3552 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3553 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3554 . .
3555
3556 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3557 @end group
3558 @end smallexample
3559
3560 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3561 @dfn{map} command.
3562
3563 @smallexample
3564 @group
3565 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3566 . . .
3567
3568 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3569 @end group
3570 @end smallexample
3571
3572 @noindent
3573 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3574 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3575 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3576 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3577 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3578 of each element.
3579
3580 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3581 from
3582 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3583 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3584 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3585
3586 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3587 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3588 elements in the vector:
3589
3590 @smallexample
3591 @group
3592 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3593 . . .
3594
3595 123123 k f V R *
3596 @end group
3597 @end smallexample
3598
3599 @noindent
3600 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3601 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3602
3603 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3604 reduction:
3605
3606 @smallexample
3607 @group
3608 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3609 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3610 .
3611
3612 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3613 @end group
3614 @end smallexample
3615
3616 @noindent
3617 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3618 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3619 for the dot product as before.
3620
3621 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3622 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3623 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3624
3625 @smallexample
3626 @group
3627 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3628 . .
3629
3630 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3631 @end group
3632 @end smallexample
3633
3634 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3635 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3636 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3637 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3638 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3639 vector size).
3640
3641 @smallexample
3642 @group
3643 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3644 . .
3645
3646 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3647 @end group
3648 @end smallexample
3649
3650 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3651 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3652 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3653
3654 @smallexample
3655 @group
3656 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3657 . .
3658
3659 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3660 @end group
3661 @end smallexample
3662
3663 @noindent
3664 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3665 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3666 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3667 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3668 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3669 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3670 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3671
3672 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3673 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3674 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3675
3676 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3677 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3678 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3679 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3680 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3681 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3682 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3683 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3684 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3685 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3686
3687 @smallexample
3688 x y
3689 --- ---
3690 1.34 0.234
3691 1.41 0.298
3692 1.49 0.402
3693 1.56 0.412
3694 1.64 0.466
3695 1.73 0.473
3696 1.82 0.601
3697 1.91 0.519
3698 2.01 0.603
3699 2.11 0.637
3700 2.22 0.645
3701 2.33 0.705
3702 2.45 0.917
3703 2.58 1.009
3704 2.71 0.971
3705 2.85 1.062
3706 3.00 1.148
3707 3.15 1.157
3708 3.32 1.354
3709 @end smallexample
3710
3711 @noindent
3712 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3713 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3714 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3715 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3716
3717 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3718 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3719 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3720 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3721 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3722 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3723 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3724 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3725
3726 @smallexample
3727 @group
3728 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3729 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3730 @dots{}
3731 @end group
3732 @end smallexample
3733
3734 @noindent
3735 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3736 large matrix.)
3737
3738 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3739 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3740 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3741 of row vectors on the stack.
3742
3743 @smallexample
3744 @group
3745 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3746 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3747 . .
3748
3749 v t v u
3750 @end group
3751 @end smallexample
3752
3753 @noindent
3754 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3755
3756 @smallexample
3757 @group
3758 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3759 .
3760
3761 t 2 t 1
3762 @end group
3763 @end smallexample
3764
3765 @noindent
3766 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3767 stored value from the stack.)
3768
3769 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3770
3771 @ifnottex
3772 @example
3773 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3774 @end example
3775 @end ifnottex
3776 @tex
3777 \beforedisplay
3778 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3779 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3780 \afterdisplay
3781 @end tex
3782
3783 @noindent
3784 where
3785 @texline @math{\sum x}
3786 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3787 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3788 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3789 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3790 this formula uses.
3791
3792 @smallexample
3793 @group
3794 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3795 . .
3796
3797 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3798
3799 @end group
3800 @end smallexample
3801 @noindent
3802 @smallexample
3803 @group
3804 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3805 . .
3806
3807 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3808 @end group
3809 @end smallexample
3810
3811 @ifnottex
3812 @noindent
3813 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3814 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3815 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3816 @end ifnottex
3817 @tex
3818 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3819 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3820 $\sum x y$.)
3821 @end tex
3822
3823 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3824 the length of either of our lists.
3825
3826 @smallexample
3827 @group
3828 1: 19
3829 .
3830
3831 r 1 v l t 7
3832 @end group
3833 @end smallexample
3834
3835 @noindent
3836 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3837
3838 Now we grind through the formula:
3839
3840 @smallexample
3841 @group
3842 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3843 . 1: 566.70919 .
3844 .
3845
3846 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3847
3848 @end group
3849 @end smallexample
3850 @noindent
3851 @smallexample
3852 @group
3853 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3854 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3855 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3856 .
3857
3858 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3859 @end group
3860 @end smallexample
3861
3862 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3863 be found with the simple formula,
3864
3865 @ifnottex
3866 @example
3867 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3868 @end example
3869 @end ifnottex
3870 @tex
3871 \beforedisplay
3872 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3873 \afterdisplay
3874 \vskip10pt
3875 @end tex
3876
3877 @smallexample
3878 @group
3879 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3880 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3881 .
3882
3883 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3884 @end group
3885 @end smallexample
3886
3887 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3888 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3889 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3890 and compare it with the original data.
3891
3892 @smallexample
3893 @group
3894 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3895 . .
3896
3897 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3898 @end group
3899 @end smallexample
3900
3901 @noindent
3902 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3903 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3904 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3905 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3906
3907 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3908 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3909
3910 @smallexample
3911 @group
3912 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3913 . . .
3914
3915 r 2 - V M A V R X
3916 @end group
3917 @end smallexample
3918
3919 @noindent
3920 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3921 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3922 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3923 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3924 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3925 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3926 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3927 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3928 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3929
3930 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3931 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3932 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3933 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3934 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3935
3936 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3937 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3938 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3939 plotting of data.
3940
3941 @smallexample
3942 @group
3943 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3944 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3945 .
3946
3947 r 1 r 2 g f
3948 @end group
3949 @end smallexample
3950
3951 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3952 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3953 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3954 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3955 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3956 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3957
3958 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3959 @ifinfo
3960 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3961 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3962 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3963 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3964 @end ifinfo
3965
3966 @smallexample
3967 @group
3968 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3969 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3970 .
3971
3972 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3973 @end group
3974 @end smallexample
3975
3976 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3977 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3978 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3979
3980 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3981 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3982 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3983 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3984 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3985 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3986
3987 @cindex Geometric mean
3988 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3989 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3990 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3991 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3992 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
3993 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
3994
3995 @example
3996 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
3997 15 14 7.5
3998 2.5
3999 @end example
4000
4001 @noindent
4002 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4003 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4004 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4005
4006 @ifnottex
4007 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4008 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4009 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4010 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4011 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4012 for @expr{n=6}.
4013 @end ifnottex
4014 @tex
4015 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4016 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4017 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4018 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4019 for \cite{n=6}.
4020 @end tex
4021
4022 @smallexample
4023 @group
4024 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4025 . .
4026
4027 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4028
4029 @end group
4030 @end smallexample
4031 @noindent
4032 @smallexample
4033 @group
4034 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4035 . .
4036
4037 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4038 @end group
4039 @end smallexample
4040
4041 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4042 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4043 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4044 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4045 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4046
4047 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4048 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4049 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4050 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4051 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4052 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4053
4054 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4055 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4056 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4057 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4058 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4059 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4060 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4061 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4062 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4063 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4064 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4065 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4066 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4067 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4068 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4069
4070 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4071 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4072 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4073 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4074
4075 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4076 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4077 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4078 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4079 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4080 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4081
4082 @cindex Divisor functions
4083 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4084 @tex
4085 $\sigma_k(n)$
4086 @end tex
4087 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4088 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4089 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4090 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4091 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4092
4093 @cindex Square-free numbers
4094 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4095 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4096 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4097 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4098 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4099 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4100 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4101 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4102
4103 @cindex Triangular lists
4104 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4105 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4106 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4107
4108 @smallexample
4109 @group
4110 1: [ [1],
4111 [1, 2],
4112 [1, 2, 3],
4113 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4114 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4115 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4116 @end group
4117 @end smallexample
4118
4119 @noindent
4120 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4121
4122 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4123
4124 @smallexample
4125 @group
4126 1: [ [0],
4127 [1, 2],
4128 [3, 4, 5],
4129 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4130 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4131 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4132 @end group
4133 @end smallexample
4134
4135 @noindent
4136 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4137
4138 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4139 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4140 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4141 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4142 @infoline @expr{J1}
4143 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4144 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4145 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4146 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4147 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4148 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4149 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4150
4151 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4152 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4153 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4154 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4155 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4156 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4157 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4158 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4159 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4160 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4161 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4162
4163 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4164 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4165 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4166
4167 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4168 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4169 @texline @math{2\times2}
4170 @infoline 2x2
4171 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4172 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4173 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4174 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4175 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4176 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4177 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4178 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4179 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4180 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4181
4182 @cindex Matchstick problem
4183 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4184 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4185 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4186 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4187 a line turns out to be
4188 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4189 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4190 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4191 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4192 one turns out to be
4193 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4194 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4195 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4196 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4197
4198 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4199 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4200 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4201 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4202 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4203 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4204 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4205 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4206 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4207 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4208 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4209 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4210 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4211 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4212 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4213 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4214 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4215 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4216
4217 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4218 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4219 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4220 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4221 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4222 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4223 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4224 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4225 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4226 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4227 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4228 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4229
4230 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4231 @section Types Tutorial
4232
4233 @noindent
4234 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4235 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4236
4237 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4238 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4239 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4240 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4241 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4242
4243 @smallexample
4244 @group
4245 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4246 . 1: 49 . . .
4247 .
4248
4249 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4250 @end group
4251 @end smallexample
4252
4253 @noindent
4254 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4255 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4256 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4257 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4258 fraction beginning with 49.
4259
4260 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4261 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4262
4263 @smallexample
4264 @group
4265 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4266 . .
4267
4268 c f c F
4269 @end group
4270 @end smallexample
4271
4272 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4273 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4274 same, to within the current precision.
4275
4276 @smallexample
4277 @group
4278 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4279 . . . .
4280
4281 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4282 @end group
4283 @end smallexample
4284
4285 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4286 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4287 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4288 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4289
4290 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4291
4292 @smallexample
4293 @group
4294 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4295 . . . . .
4296
4297 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4298 @end group
4299 @end smallexample
4300
4301 @noindent
4302 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4303 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4304 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4305 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4306
4307 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4308 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4309 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4310 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4311 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4312 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4313 algebraic entry.
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 @group
4317 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4318 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4319 . . . .
4320
4321 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4322 @end group
4323 @end smallexample
4324
4325 @noindent
4326 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4327 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4328 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4329 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4330 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4331 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4332 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4333 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4334 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4335 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4336 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4337 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4338 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4339
4340 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4341 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4342 to turn on Infinite mode.
4343
4344 @smallexample
4345 @group
4346 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4347 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4348 1: 0 . . .
4349 .
4350
4351 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4352 @end group
4353 @end smallexample
4354
4355 @noindent
4356 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4357 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4358 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4359 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4360 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4361 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4362 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4363 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4364 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4365 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4366 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4367 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4368 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4369 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4370 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4371 that matter, with anything else.
4372
4373 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4374 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4375 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4376 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4377 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4378
4379 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4380 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4381 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4382 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4383
4384 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4385 seconds.
4386
4387 @smallexample
4388 @group
4389 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4390 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4391 .
4392
4393 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4394 @end group
4395 @end smallexample
4396
4397 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4398 seconds.
4399
4400 @smallexample
4401 @group
4402 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4403 . . . .
4404
4405 0.5 I T c h S
4406 @end group
4407 @end smallexample
4408
4409 @noindent
4410 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4411 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4412 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4413
4414 @cindex Beatles
4415 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4416 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4417 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4418 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4419 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4420
4421 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4422 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4423 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4424
4425 @smallexample
4426 @group
4427 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4428 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4429 .
4430
4431 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4432 @end group
4433 @end smallexample
4434
4435 @noindent
4436 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4437 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4438 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4439 date form.
4440
4441 @smallexample
4442 @group
4443 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4444 . .
4445
4446 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4447 @end group
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4451 @noindent
4452 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4453 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4454 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4455 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4456 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4457 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4458
4459 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4460 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4461
4462 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4463 between now and the year 10001 AD@? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4464
4465 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4466 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4467 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4468 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4469 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4470 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4471 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4472 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4473
4474 @smallexample
4475 @group
4476 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4477 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4478 .
4479
4480 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4481 @end group
4482 @end smallexample
4483
4484 @noindent
4485 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4486 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4487 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4488
4489 @cindex Torus, volume of
4490 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4491 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4492 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4493 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4494 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4495 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4496 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4497 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4498
4499 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4500 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4501 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4502 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4503 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4504
4505 @smallexample
4506 @group
4507 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4508 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4509 .
4510
4511 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4512 @end group
4513 @end smallexample
4514
4515 @noindent
4516 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4517 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4518
4519 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4520 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4521 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4522 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4523 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4524 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4525 the other.
4526
4527 @smallexample
4528 @group
4529 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4530 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4531 .
4532
4533 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4534 @end group
4535 @end smallexample
4536
4537 @noindent
4538 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4539 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4540 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4541 or both endpoints.
4542
4543 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4544 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4545 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4546 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4547 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4548
4549 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4550 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4551 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4552 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4553 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4554
4555 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4556 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4557 or 24 hours.
4558
4559 @smallexample
4560 @group
4561 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4562 . . . .
4563
4564 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4565 @end group
4566 @end smallexample
4567
4568 @noindent
4569 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4570 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4571 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4572 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4573 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4574
4575 @smallexample
4576 @group
4577 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4578 . . . .
4579
4580 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4581 @end group
4582 @end smallexample
4583
4584 @noindent
4585 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4586 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4587 that arises in the second one.
4588
4589 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4590 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4591 says that
4592 @texline @math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}
4593 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4594 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4595 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4596 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4597 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4598 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4599 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4600
4601 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4602 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4603 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4604 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4605
4606 @smallexample
4607 @group
4608 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4609 . .
4610
4611 x time @key{RET} n
4612 @end group
4613 @end smallexample
4614
4615 @noindent
4616 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4617
4618 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4619 is about
4620 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4621 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4622 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4623 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4624
4625 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4626 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4627 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4628 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4629 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4630 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4631
4632 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4633 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4634 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4635 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4636 like centimeters and inches.
4637
4638 @smallexample
4639 @group
4640 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4641 . . . .
4642
4643 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4644 @end group
4645 @end smallexample
4646
4647 @noindent
4648 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4649 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4650 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4651 which in this case means meters.
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 @group
4655 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4656 . . . .
4657
4658 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4659
4660 @end group
4661 @end smallexample
4662 @noindent
4663 @smallexample
4664 @group
4665 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4666 . . .
4667
4668 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4669 @end group
4670 @end smallexample
4671
4672 @noindent
4673 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4674 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4675 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4676 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4677 being interpreted as unit names.
4678
4679 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4680 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4681 as its standard unit of length.
4682
4683 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4684
4685 @smallexample
4686 @group
4687 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4688 . . . .
4689
4690 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4691 @end group
4692 @end smallexample
4693
4694 @noindent
4695 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4696 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4697 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4698
4699 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4700 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4701 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4702 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4703 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4704 for them.
4705
4706 @smallexample
4707 @group
4708 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4709 . . . .
4710
4711 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET}
4712 @end group
4713 @end smallexample
4714
4715 @noindent
4716 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4717 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4718 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius.
4719
4720 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4721 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4722 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4723 numbers are in which units:
4724
4725 @smallexample
4726 @group
4727 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4728 . . .
4729
4730 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4731 @end group
4732 @end smallexample
4733
4734 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4735 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4736 at the units table.
4737
4738 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4739 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4740
4741 @cindex Speed of light
4742 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4743 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4744 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4745 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4746 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4747
4748 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4749 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4750 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4751 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4752 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4753
4754 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4755 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4756
4757 @noindent
4758 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4759 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4760 formulas.
4761
4762 @menu
4763 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4764 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4765 @end menu
4766
4767 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4768 @subsection Basic Algebra
4769
4770 @noindent
4771 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4772 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4773 formulas as regular data objects.
4774
4775 @smallexample
4776 @group
4777 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (3 x^2 + y) (6 - 2 x^2)
4778 . . .
4779
4780 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4781 @end group
4782 @end smallexample
4783
4784 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4785 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4786 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4787
4788 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4789 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4790
4791 @smallexample
4792 @group
4793 1: 18 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y - 2 y x^2 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4794 . .
4795
4796 a x a c x @key{RET}
4797 @end group
4798 @end smallexample
4799
4800 @noindent
4801 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4802 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4803
4804 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4805 is one-half.
4806
4807 @smallexample
4808 @group
4809 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4810 . .
4811
4812 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4813 @end group
4814 @end smallexample
4815
4816 @noindent
4817 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4818 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4819 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4820 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4821 back to its original value, if any.
4822
4823 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4824 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4825 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4826 properly.)
4827
4828 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4829 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4830 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4831 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4832 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4833 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4834 the function has a local maximum there.
4835
4836 @smallexample
4837 @group
4838 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4839 . .
4840
4841 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4842 @end group
4843 @end smallexample
4844
4845 @noindent
4846 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4847 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4848
4849 @smallexample
4850 @group
4851 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4852 . .
4853
4854 ' x @key{RET} / a x
4855
4856 @end group
4857 @end smallexample
4858 @noindent
4859 @smallexample
4860 @group
4861 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023
4862 . .
4863
4864 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4865 @end group
4866 @end smallexample
4867
4868 @noindent
4869 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4870
4871 @smallexample
4872 @group
4873 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4874 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4875 . .
4876
4877 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4878 @end group
4879 @end smallexample
4880
4881 @noindent
4882 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4883 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4884 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4885 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4886
4887 @smallexample
4888 @group
4889 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4890 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4891 . .
4892
4893 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4894 @end group
4895 @end smallexample
4896
4897 @noindent
4898 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4899 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4900 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4901
4902 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4903 @expr{0.70588 x^2 = 1} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4904 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4905 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4906 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4907 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4908 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4909
4910 @smallexample
4911 @group
4912 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4913 . . .
4914
4915 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4916 @end group
4917 @end smallexample
4918
4919 @noindent
4920 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4921 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4922 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4923 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4924 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4925
4926 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4927 into the original formula.
4928
4929 @smallexample
4930 @group
4931 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4932 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4933 .
4934
4935 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4936 @end group
4937 @end smallexample
4938
4939 @noindent
4940 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4941 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4942 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4943
4944 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4945 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4946
4947 @smallexample
4948 @group
4949 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4950 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4951 .
4952
4953 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4954 @end group
4955 @end smallexample
4956
4957 @noindent
4958 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4959 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4960 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4961 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4962 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4963 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4964 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4965 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4966 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4967 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4968
4969 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4970 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4971
4972 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4973 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4974 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4975 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4976 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4977 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4978 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4979 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4980
4981 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4982 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4983 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4984 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4985 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4986 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4987
4988 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
4989 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
4990 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
4991 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
4992
4993 @smallexample
4994 @group
4995 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
4996 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
4997 . .
4998
4999 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5000 @end group
5001 @end smallexample
5002
5003 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5004
5005 @smallexample
5006 @group
5007 3
5008 2: 34 x - 24 x
5009
5010 ____ ____
5011 V 51 V 51
5012 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5013 6 -6
5014
5015 .
5016
5017 d B
5018 @end group
5019 @end smallexample
5020
5021 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5022 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5023 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5024 and @LaTeX{} mode.
5025
5026 @smallexample
5027 @group
5028 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5029 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5030 . .
5031
5032 d C d F
5033
5034 @end group
5035 @end smallexample
5036 @noindent
5037 @smallexample
5038 @group
5039 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5040 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5041 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5042 .
5043
5044 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5045 @end group
5046 @end smallexample
5047
5048 @noindent
5049 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5050 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5051 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5052 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5053
5054 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5055 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5056 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5057 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5058 correct.
5059
5060 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5061 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5062 are shown in normal mode.)
5063
5064 @cindex Area under a curve
5065 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5066 This is simply the integral of the function:
5067
5068 @smallexample
5069 @group
5070 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5071 . .
5072
5073 r 1 a i x
5074 @end group
5075 @end smallexample
5076
5077 @noindent
5078 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5079 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5080
5081 @smallexample
5082 @group
5083 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5084 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5085
5086 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5087 @end group
5088 @end smallexample
5089
5090 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5091 of
5092 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5093 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5094 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5095 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5096 3}. (@bullet{})
5097
5098 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5099 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5100 under the curve
5101 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5102 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5103 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5104 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5105 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5106 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5107
5108 @cindex Integration, numerical
5109 @cindex Numerical integration
5110 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5111 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5112 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5113 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5114
5115 @smallexample
5116 @group
5117 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5118 2: 1 .
5119 1: 0.1
5120 .
5121
5122 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5123 @end group
5124 @end smallexample
5125
5126 @noindent
5127 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5128 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5129
5130 @smallexample
5131 @group
5132 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5133 1: ln(x) sin(x) .
5134 .
5135
5136 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5137
5138 @end group
5139 @end smallexample
5140 @noindent
5141 @smallexample
5142 @group
5143 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5144 . .
5145
5146 V R + 0.1 *
5147 @end group
5148 @end smallexample
5149
5150 @noindent
5151 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5152 to Radians mode?)
5153
5154 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5155 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5156 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5157 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5158 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5159 is the same for every box.)
5160
5161 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5162 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5163
5164 @smallexample
5165 @group
5166 1: ln(x) sin(x) 1: 0.84147 x + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5167 . .
5168
5169 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5170 @end group
5171 @end smallexample
5172
5173 @noindent
5174 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5175 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5176 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5177
5178 @smallexample
5179 @group
5180 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5181 . . .
5182
5183 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5184 @end group
5185 @end smallexample
5186
5187 @noindent
5188 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5189 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5190 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5191 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5192 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5193 of @expr{x=1}.)
5194
5195 @cindex Simpson's rule
5196 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5197 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5198 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5199 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5200 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5201 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5202 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5203 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5204 down to the formula,
5205
5206 @ifnottex
5207 @example
5208 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5209 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5210 @end example
5211 @end ifnottex
5212 @tex
5213 \beforedisplay
5214 $$ \displaylines{
5215 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5216 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5217 } $$
5218 \afterdisplay
5219 @end tex
5220
5221 @noindent
5222 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5223 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5224 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5225 method:
5226
5227 @ifnottex
5228 @example
5229 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5230 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5231 @end example
5232 @end ifnottex
5233 @tex
5234 \beforedisplay
5235 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5236 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5237 \afterdisplay
5238 @end tex
5239
5240 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5241 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5242 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5243 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5244 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5245
5246 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5247 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5248 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5249 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5250
5251 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5252 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5253 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5254 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5255 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5256 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5257 details and examples.
5258
5259 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5260 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5261
5262 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5263 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5264
5265 @noindent
5266 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5267 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5268 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5269 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5270
5271 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5272
5273 @smallexample
5274 @group
5275 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2
5276 .
5277
5278 ' 2sec(x)^2/tan(x)^2 - 2/tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s 1
5279 @end group
5280 @end smallexample
5281
5282 @noindent
5283 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably combine over the common
5284 denominator. The @kbd{a n} algebra command will do this, but we'll do
5285 it with a rewrite rule just for practice.
5286
5287 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5288
5289 @smallexample
5290 @group
5291 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2
5292 .
5293
5294 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5295 @end group
5296 @end smallexample
5297
5298 @noindent
5299 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5300 by itself the formula @samp{a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x} doesn't do anything,
5301 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5302 it as a rewrite rule.)
5303
5304 The lefthand side, @samp{a/x + b/x}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5305 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5306 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5307 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5308 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5309 the expression @samp{2 sec(x)^2}, the meta-variable @samp{b} matched
5310 the constant @samp{-2} and the meta-variable @samp{x} matched
5311 the expression @samp{tan(x)^2}.
5312
5313 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5314 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5315 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5316 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5317 denominators.
5318
5319 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5320 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5321 the subformula @samp{tan(x)^2}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5322 @samp{x}.
5323
5324 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5325 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5326 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5327 @samp{a = 2 sec(x)^2}, @samp{b = -2}, and @samp{x = tan(x)^2}.
5328
5329 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5330 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5331 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5332 @samp{(2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2}.
5333
5334 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5335 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5336 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5337 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5338 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5339 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5340
5341 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5342 @samp{tan(x)^2 + 1 = sec(x)^2}, but of course we must first rearrange
5343 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5344 would be @samp{@w{2 sec(x)^2 - 2} := 2 tan(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5345 that the rule @samp{sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2} will also work. The
5346 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5347 situations, too.
5348
5349 @smallexample
5350 @group
5351 1: 2
5352 .
5353
5354 a r sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET}
5355 @end group
5356 @end smallexample
5357
5358 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5359 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5360 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5361 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5362 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5363 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5364 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5365 having to retype it.
5366
5367 @smallexample
5368 @group
5369 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5370 ' sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s t secsqr @key{RET}
5371
5372 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5373 . .
5374
5375 r 1 a r merge @key{RET} a r secsqr @key{RET}
5376 @end group
5377 @end smallexample
5378
5379 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5380 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5381 the edited value back into the variable.
5382 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5383
5384 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5385 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5386 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5387 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5388 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5389 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5390 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5391 entering them on the fly.
5392
5393 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5394 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5395 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5396 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5397 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5398 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5399
5400 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5401 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5402
5403 @smallexample
5404 @group
5405 1: [merge, secsqr] 1: [a/x + b/x := (a + b)/x, ... ]
5406 . .
5407
5408 ' [merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5409
5410 @end group
5411 @end smallexample
5412 @noindent
5413 @smallexample
5414 @group
5415 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5416 . .
5417
5418 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET}
5419 @end group
5420 @end smallexample
5421
5422 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5423 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5424 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5425 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5426 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5427 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5428
5429 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5430 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5431 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5432 only one rewrite at a time.
5433
5434 @smallexample
5435 @group
5436 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5437 . .
5438
5439 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5440 @end group
5441 @end smallexample
5442
5443 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5444 of rewrites that occur.
5445
5446 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5447 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5448
5449 @smallexample
5450 @group
5451 1: sin(x + 2 pi) + sin(x + 3 pi) + sin(x + 4 pi)
5452 .
5453
5454 ' sin(x+2pi) + sin(x+3pi) + sin(x+4pi) @key{RET}
5455
5456 @end group
5457 @end smallexample
5458 @noindent
5459 @smallexample
5460 @group
5461 1: sin(x + 3 pi) + 2 sin(x)
5462 .
5463
5464 a r sin(a + k pi) := sin(a) :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5465 @end group
5466 @end smallexample
5467
5468 @noindent
5469 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5470 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5471
5472 An interesting point is that the variable @samp{pi} was matched
5473 literally rather than acting as a meta-variable.
5474 This is because it is a special-constant variable. The special
5475 constants @samp{e}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5476 A common error with rewrite
5477 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5478 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5479 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5480
5481 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5482 @ignore
5483 @starindex
5484 @end ignore
5485 @tindex fib
5486 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5487 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5488 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5489 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5490 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5491
5492 @smallexample
5493 @group
5494 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5495
5496 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5497 . .
5498
5499 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5500 @end group
5501 @end smallexample
5502
5503 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5504 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5505 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5506 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5507 be used preferentially.
5508
5509 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5510 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5511 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5512 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5513 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5514 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5515 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5516
5517 @smallexample
5518 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5519 @end smallexample
5520
5521 @noindent
5522 Now:
5523
5524 @smallexample
5525 @group
5526 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: fib(x) + fib(0) + 8
5527 . .
5528
5529 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5530 @end group
5531 @end smallexample
5532
5533 @noindent
5534 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5535 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5536 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5537 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5538 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5539
5540 @smallexample
5541 @group
5542 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5543 . .
5544
5545 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5546 @end group
5547 @end smallexample
5548
5549 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5550 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5551 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5552
5553 @smallexample
5554 @group
5555 fib(6) =
5556 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5557 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5558 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5559 @end group
5560 @end smallexample
5561
5562 @noindent
5563 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5564 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5565 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5566 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5567 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5568 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5569
5570 @smallexample
5571 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5572 @end smallexample
5573
5574 @noindent
5575 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5576 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5577 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5578 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5579 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5580 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5581
5582 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5583 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5584
5585 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5586 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5587 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5588 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5589 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5590
5591 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5592 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5593 un-store the variable.
5594
5595 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5596 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5597 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5598 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5599 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5600 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5601 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5602 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5603 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5604
5605 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5606 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5607 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5608 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5609
5610 @example
5611 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5612 @end example
5613
5614 @noindent
5615 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5616 to 1.''
5617
5618 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5619 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5620 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5621 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5622 and one for @samp{b}.
5623
5624 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5625 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5626 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5627 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5628
5629 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5630 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5631 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5632 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5633 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5634 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5635 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5636 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5637 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5638 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5639 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5640 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5641 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5642 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5643
5644 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5645 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5646 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5647 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5648 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5649 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5650
5651 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5652 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5653 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5654
5655 @ifnottex
5656 @example
5657 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5658 @end example
5659 @end ifnottex
5660 @tex
5661 \beforedisplay
5662 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5663 \afterdisplay
5664 @end tex
5665
5666 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5667 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5668 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5669 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5670 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5671
5672 @ifnottex
5673 @example
5674 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5675 @end example
5676 @end ifnottex
5677 @tex
5678 \beforedisplay
5679 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5680 \afterdisplay
5681 @end tex
5682
5683 @noindent
5684 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5685 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5686
5687 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5688 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5689 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5690 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5691 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5692 rearranged. (This one is rather tricky; the solution at the end of
5693 this chapter uses 6 rewrite rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)}
5694 condition tests whether @samp{x} is a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer
5695 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5696
5697 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5698 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5699 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5700
5701 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5702
5703 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5704 @section Programming Tutorial
5705
5706 @noindent
5707 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5708 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5709 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5710 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5711 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5712 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5713
5714 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5715 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5716 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5717 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5718 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5719
5720 @smallexample
5721 @group
5722 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1
5723 . .
5724
5725 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5726 @end group
5727 @end smallexample
5728
5729 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5730 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5731 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5732 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5733 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5734 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5735 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5736 arguments?''
5737
5738 @smallexample
5739 @group
5740 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5741 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5742 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5743 .
5744
5745 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5746 @end group
5747 @end smallexample
5748
5749 @noindent
5750 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5751 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5752 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5753 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5754 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5755 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5756 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5757
5758 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5759 @ignore
5760 @starindex
5761 @end ignore
5762 @tindex Si
5763 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5764 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5765 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5766 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5767 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5768 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5769 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5770 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5771 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5772 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5773 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5774 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5775 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5776 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5777 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5778 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5779
5780 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5781 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5782 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5783 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5784 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5785
5786 @smallexample
5787 @group
5788 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5789 . .
5790
5791 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5792
5793 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 n1 pi
5794 . .
5795
5796 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5797 @end group
5798 @end smallexample
5799
5800 @noindent
5801 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5802 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5803 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5804 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5805 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5806
5807 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5808
5809 @smallexample
5810 @group
5811 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5812 . .
5813
5814 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5815 @end group
5816 @end smallexample
5817
5818 @noindent
5819 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5820 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5821
5822 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5823
5824 @smallexample
5825 @group
5826 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5827 . . . .
5828
5829 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5830 @end group
5831 @end smallexample
5832
5833 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5834 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5835 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5836
5837 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5838 the following functions:
5839
5840 @enumerate
5841 @item
5842 Compute
5843 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5844 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5845 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5846
5847 @item
5848 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5849 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5850
5851 @item
5852 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5853 the stack.
5854 @end enumerate
5855 @noindent
5856 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5857
5858 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5859 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5860 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5861
5862 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5863 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5864 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5865
5866 @smallexample
5867 @group
5868 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5869 . 1: 4 .
5870 .
5871
5872 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5873 @end group
5874 @end smallexample
5875
5876 @noindent
5877 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5878 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5879 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5880 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5881
5882 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5883 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5884
5885 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5886 Here's another example:
5887
5888 @smallexample
5889 @group
5890 3: 1 2: 10946
5891 2: 1 1: 17711
5892 1: 20 .
5893 .
5894
5895 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5896 @end group
5897 @end smallexample
5898
5899 @noindent
5900 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5901 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5902 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5903 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5904
5905 @cindex Golden ratio
5906 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5907 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5908 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5909 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5910 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5911 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5912 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5913 @infoline @expr{phi},
5914 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5915 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5916 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5917 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5918 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5919
5920 @smallexample
5921 @group
5922 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5923 . . . .
5924
5925 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5926 @end group
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 @cindex Continued fractions
5930 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5931 representation of
5932 @texline @math{\phi}
5933 @infoline @expr{phi}
5934 is
5935 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5936 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5937 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5938 and then replacing the innermost
5939 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5940 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5941 by 1. Approximate
5942 @texline @math{\phi}
5943 @infoline @expr{phi}
5944 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5945 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5946
5947 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5948 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5949 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5950 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5951 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5952 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5953 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5954
5955 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5956 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5957 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5958 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5959
5960 @smallexample
5961 @group
5962 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5963 2: 1 .
5964 1: 20
5965 .
5966
5967 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5968 @end group
5969 @end smallexample
5970
5971 @noindent
5972 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
5973 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
5974 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
5975 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
5976 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
5977 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
5978 uses a step of one.
5979
5980 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
5981 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
5982 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
5983
5984 @smallexample
5985 @group
5986 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
5987 . 1: 20 .
5988 .
5989
5990 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
5991 @end group
5992 @end smallexample
5993
5994 @noindent
5995 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
5996 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
5997
5998 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
5999 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6000 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6001 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6002 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6003 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6004 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6005
6006 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6007 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6008 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6009
6010 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6011 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6012 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6013 fix, though:
6014
6015 @smallexample
6016 @group
6017 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6018 . . 2: 3.597739
6019 1: 0.6667
6020 .
6021
6022 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6023 @end group
6024 @end smallexample
6025
6026 @noindent
6027 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6028 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6029 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6030 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6031 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6032 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6033 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6034 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6035 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6036
6037 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6038 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6039 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6040 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6041 by the formula
6042 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6043 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6044 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6045 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6046 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6047 numbers are very large fractions.)
6048
6049 @smallexample
6050 @group
6051 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6052 . .
6053
6054 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6055 @end group
6056 @end smallexample
6057
6058 @noindent
6059 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6060 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6061 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6062 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6063 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6064 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6065 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6066
6067 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6068
6069 @smallexample
6070 @group
6071 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6072 2: 5:66 . . . .
6073 1: 0.0757575
6074 .
6075
6076 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6077 @end group
6078 @end smallexample
6079
6080 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6081 Bernoulli numbers.
6082
6083 @smallexample
6084 @group
6085 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6086 2: 2 .
6087 1: 30
6088 .
6089
6090 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6091 @end group
6092 @end smallexample
6093
6094 @noindent
6095 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6096 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6097 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6098 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6099 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6100 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6101 sequence of keystrokes.)
6102
6103 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6104 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6105 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6106 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6107 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6108
6109 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6110 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6111 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6112 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6113
6114 @smallexample
6115 @group
6116 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6117 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6118
6119 1 ;; calc digits
6120 RET ;; calc-enter
6121 2 ;; calc digits
6122 + ;; calc-plus
6123
6124 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6125 @end group
6126 @end smallexample
6127
6128 @noindent
6129 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6130 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6131 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6132 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6133 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6134 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6135 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6136 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6137 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6138 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6139
6140 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6141 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6142 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6143 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6144 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6145
6146 @smallexample
6147 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6148 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6149 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6150 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6151 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6152 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6153 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6154 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6155 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6156 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6157 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6158 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6159 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6160 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6161 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6162 @end smallexample
6163
6164 @noindent
6165 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6166
6167 @smallexample
6168 @group
6169 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6170 . .
6171
6172 20 z h
6173 @end group
6174 @end smallexample
6175
6176 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6177 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6178 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6179 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6180 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6181 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6182 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6183
6184 @example
6185 @group
6186 Z ` 0 t 1
6187 1 TAB
6188 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6189 r 1
6190 Z '
6191 @end group
6192 @end example
6193
6194 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6195 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6196 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6197 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6198 this formula over and over:
6199
6200 @ifnottex
6201 @example
6202 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6203 @end example
6204 @end ifnottex
6205 @tex
6206 \beforedisplay
6207 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f^{\prime}(x)} $$
6208 \afterdisplay
6209 @end tex
6210
6211 @noindent
6212 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6213 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6214 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6215 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6216 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6217 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6218 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6219 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6220 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6221 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6222 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6223 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6224 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6225 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6226
6227 @cindex Digamma function
6228 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6229 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6230 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6231 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6232 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6233 is defined as the derivative of
6234 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6235 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6236 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6237
6238 @ifnottex
6239 @example
6240 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6241 @end example
6242 @end ifnottex
6243 @tex
6244 \beforedisplay
6245 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6246 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6247 $$
6248 \afterdisplay
6249 @end tex
6250
6251 @noindent
6252 where
6253 @texline @math{\sum}
6254 @infoline @expr{sum}
6255 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6256 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6257 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6258 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6259 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6260 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6261 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6262 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6263 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6264 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6265 Fortunately, we can compute
6266 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6267 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6268 from
6269 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6270 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6271 using the recurrence
6272 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6273 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6274 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6275 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6276 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6277 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6278 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6279 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6280 to compute
6281 @texline @math{\gamma}
6282 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6283 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6284 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6285 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6286
6287 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6288 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6289 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6290 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6291 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6292 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6293 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6294 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6295 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6296
6297 @cindex Recursion
6298 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6299 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6300
6301 @ifnottex
6302 @example
6303 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6304 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6305 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6306 @end example
6307 @end ifnottex
6308 @tex
6309 \beforedisplay
6310 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6311 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6312 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6313 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6314 $$
6315 \afterdisplay
6316 \vskip5pt
6317 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6318 @end tex
6319
6320 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6321 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6322 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6323 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6324 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6325 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6326 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6327 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6328 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6329 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6330 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6331 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6332 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6333 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6334 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6335 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6336 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6337 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6338
6339 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6340 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6341 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6342 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6343 program can:
6344
6345 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6346 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6347 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6348 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6349
6350 @example
6351
6352 @end example
6353 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6354 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6355 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6356 @c [not-split]
6357 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6358 @c [when-split]
6359 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6360
6361 @page
6362 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6363 @section Answers to Exercises
6364
6365 @noindent
6366 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6367
6368 @menu
6369 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6370 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6371 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6372 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6373 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6374 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6375 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6376 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6377 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6378 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6379 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6380 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6381 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6382 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6383 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6384 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6385 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6386 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6387 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6388 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6389 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6390 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6391 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6392 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6393 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6394 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6395 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6396 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6397 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6398 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6399 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6400 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6401 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6402 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6403 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6404 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6405 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6406 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6407 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6408 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6409 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6410 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6411 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6412 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6413 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6414 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6415 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6416 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6417 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6418 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6419 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6420 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6421 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6422 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6423 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6424 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6425 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6426 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6427 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6428 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6429 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6430 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6431 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6432 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6433 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6434 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6435 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6436 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6437 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6438 @end menu
6439
6440 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6441 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6442 @tex
6443 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6444 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6445 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6446 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6447 @end tex
6448
6449 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6450 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6451
6452 @noindent
6453 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6454
6455 The result is
6456 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6457 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6458
6459 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6460 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6461
6462 @noindent
6463 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6464 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6465
6466 After computing the intermediate term
6467 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6468 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6469 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6470 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6471 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6472
6473 @smallexample
6474 @group
6475 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6476 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6477 . 1: 9.5 .
6478 .
6479
6480 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6481
6482 @end group
6483 @end smallexample
6484 @noindent
6485 @smallexample
6486 @group
6487 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6488 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6489 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6490 1: 4 .
6491 .
6492
6493 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6494 @end group
6495 @end smallexample
6496
6497 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6498 with the third term.
6499
6500 @smallexample
6501 @group
6502 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6503 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6504 . 1: 4 .
6505 .
6506
6507 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6508 @end group
6509 @end smallexample
6510
6511 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6512 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6513 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6514 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6515
6516 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6517 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6518
6519 @noindent
6520 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6521
6522 @smallexample
6523 @group
6524 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6525 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6526 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6527 . . 1: 1 . .
6528 .
6529
6530 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6531 @end group
6532 @end smallexample
6533
6534 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6535
6536 @smallexample
6537 @group
6538 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6539 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6540 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6541 . . . . .
6542
6543 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6544 @end group
6545 @end smallexample
6546
6547 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6548 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6549
6550 @noindent
6551 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6552 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6553
6554 @smallexample
6555 @group
6556 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6557 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6558 . . .
6559
6560 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6561 @end group
6562 @end smallexample
6563
6564 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6565 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6566 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6567 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6568 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6569
6570 @smallexample
6571 @group
6572 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6573 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6574 . . .
6575
6576 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6577 @end group
6578 @end smallexample
6579
6580 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6581 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6582 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6583 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6584
6585 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6586 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6587
6588 @noindent
6589 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6590
6591 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6592 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6593
6594 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6595 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6596 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6597
6598 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6599 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6600
6601 @noindent
6602 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6603 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6604 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6605 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6606
6607 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6608 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6609
6610 @noindent
6611 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6612 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6613 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6614 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6615 times anything is zero.''
6616
6617 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6618 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6619 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6620 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6621 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6622 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6623
6624 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6625 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6626
6627 @noindent
6628 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6629 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6630 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6631 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6632 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6633 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6634
6635 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6636 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6637 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6638 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6639 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6640 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6641 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6642 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6643 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6644 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6645 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6646
6647 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6648 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6649 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6650 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6651 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6652 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6653 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6654 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6655 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6656 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6657
6658 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6659 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6660 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6661 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6662 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6663 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6664 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6665 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6666 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6667 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6668
6669 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6670 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6671 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6672 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6673 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6674 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6675 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6676 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6677 in decimal display mode.
6678
6679 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6680 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6681 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6682 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6683
6684 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6685 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6686
6687 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6688 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6689 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6690 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6691 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6692 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6693 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6694 way to enter this number.
6695
6696 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6697 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6698 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6699 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6700 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6701 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6702 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6703
6704 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6705 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6706
6707 @noindent
6708 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6709
6710 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6711 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6712 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6713 their inputs.
6714
6715 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6716 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6717 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6718 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6719 determining facts like this.
6720
6721 @smallexample
6722 @group
6723 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6724 . .
6725
6726 45 S 2 ^
6727
6728 @end group
6729 @end smallexample
6730 @noindent
6731 @smallexample
6732 @group
6733 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6734 . . .
6735
6736 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6737 @end group
6738 @end smallexample
6739
6740 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6741 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6742 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6743 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6744 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6745
6746 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6747 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6748
6749 @noindent
6750 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6751 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6752 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6753 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6754 of time.
6755
6756 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6757 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6758 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6759 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6760 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6761 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6762
6763 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6764 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6765 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6766
6767 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6768 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6769
6770 @noindent
6771 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6772 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6773 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6774 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6775 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6776 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6777 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6778 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6779
6780 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6781 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6782 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6783 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6784 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6785 format.
6786
6787 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6788 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6789
6790 @noindent
6791 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6792 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6793
6794 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6795 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6796 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6797 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6798
6799 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6800 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6801
6802 @noindent
6803 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6804 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6805
6806 @smallexample
6807 @group
6808 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6809 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6810 .
6811
6812 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6813 @end group
6814 @end smallexample
6815
6816 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6817 indeed have unit length.
6818
6819 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6820 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6821
6822 @noindent
6823 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6824 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6825 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6826 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6827
6828 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6829 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6830
6831 @noindent
6832 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6833 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6834
6835 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6836 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6837
6838 @ifnottex
6839 @example
6840 @group
6841 x + a y = 6
6842 x + b y = 10
6843 @end group
6844 @end example
6845 @end ifnottex
6846 @tex
6847 \beforedisplay
6848 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6849 x &+ b y = 10}
6850 $$
6851 \afterdisplay
6852 @end tex
6853
6854 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6855 matrix as usual.
6856
6857 @smallexample
6858 @group
6859 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [4 a / (a - b) + 6, 4 / (b - a) ]
6860 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6861 [ 1, b ] ]
6862 .
6863
6864 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6865 @end group
6866 @end smallexample
6867
6868 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6869 mode:
6870
6871 @smallexample
6872 @group
6873 4 a 4
6874 1: [----- + 6, -----]
6875 a - b b - a
6876 @end group
6877 @end smallexample
6878
6879 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6880
6881 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6882 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6883
6884 @noindent
6885 To solve
6886 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6887 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6888 first we compute
6889 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6890 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6891 and
6892 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6893 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6894 now, we have a system
6895 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6896 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6897 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6898
6899 @ifnottex
6900 @example
6901 @group
6902 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6903 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6904 7a + 6b = 3
6905 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6906 @end group
6907 @end example
6908 @end ifnottex
6909 @tex
6910 \beforedisplayh
6911 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6912 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6913 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6914 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6915 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6916 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6917 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6918 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6919 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6920 $$
6921 \afterdisplayh
6922 @end tex
6923
6924 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6925 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6926 @texline @math{B'}
6927 @infoline @expr{B2}
6928 vector.
6929
6930 @smallexample
6931 @group
6932 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6933 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6934 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6935 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6936 . .
6937
6938 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6939 @end group
6940 @end smallexample
6941
6942 @noindent
6943 Now we compute the matrix
6944 @texline @math{A'}
6945 @infoline @expr{A2}
6946 and divide.
6947
6948 @smallexample
6949 @group
6950 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6951 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6952 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6953 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6954 .
6955
6956 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6957 @end group
6958 @end smallexample
6959
6960 @noindent
6961 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6962 round-off error.)
6963
6964 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6965 @texline @math{3\times3}
6966 @infoline 3x3
6967 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
6968 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
6969 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
6970 answer since the
6971 @texline @math{4\times3}
6972 @infoline 4x3
6973 system would be equivalent to the original
6974 @texline @math{3\times3}
6975 @infoline 3x3
6976 system.)
6977
6978 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
6979 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
6980 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
6981
6982 @smallexample
6983 @group
6984 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
6985 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
6986 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
6987 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
6988 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
6989 .
6990
6991 r 7 @key{TAB} *
6992 @end group
6993 @end smallexample
6994
6995 @noindent
6996 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
6997 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
6998
6999 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7000 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7001
7002 @noindent
7003 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7004 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7005 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7006 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7007
7008 @smallexample
7009 @group
7010 2: 2 2: 2
7011 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7012 . .
7013
7014 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7015 @end group
7016 @end smallexample
7017
7018 @noindent
7019 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7020 vector.
7021
7022 @smallexample
7023 @group
7024 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7025 .
7026
7027 V M ^
7028 @end group
7029 @end smallexample
7030
7031 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7032 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7033
7034 @noindent
7035 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7036 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7037
7038 @ifnottex
7039 @example
7040 m*x + b*1 = y
7041 @end example
7042 @end ifnottex
7043 @tex
7044 \beforedisplay
7045 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7046 \afterdisplay
7047 @end tex
7048
7049 Thus we want a
7050 @texline @math{19\times2}
7051 @infoline 19x2
7052 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7053 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7054 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7055
7056 @smallexample
7057 @group
7058 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7059 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7060 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7061 @dots{}
7062
7063 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7064 @end group
7065 @end smallexample
7066
7067 @noindent
7068 Now we compute
7069 @texline @math{A^T y}
7070 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7071 and
7072 @texline @math{A^T A}
7073 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7074 and divide.
7075
7076 @smallexample
7077 @group
7078 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7079 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7080 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7081 .
7082
7083 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7084 @end group
7085 @end smallexample
7086
7087 @noindent
7088 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7089
7090 @smallexample
7091 @group
7092 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7093 .
7094
7095 /
7096 @end group
7097 @end smallexample
7098
7099 Since we were solving equations of the form
7100 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7101 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7102 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7103 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7104 @kbd{V R}!
7105
7106 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7107 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7108 arithmetic functions!
7109
7110 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7111 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7112 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7113
7114 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7115 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7116
7117 @noindent
7118 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7119 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7120 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7121
7122 @smallexample
7123 @group
7124 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7125 .
7126 @end group
7127 @end smallexample
7128
7129 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7130 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7131
7132 @smallexample
7133 @group
7134 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7135 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7136 . .
7137
7138 @key{RET} V R *
7139
7140 @end group
7141 @end smallexample
7142 @noindent
7143 @smallexample
7144 @group
7145 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7146 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7147 . .
7148
7149 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7150 @end group
7151 @end smallexample
7152
7153 @noindent
7154 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7155 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7156 then raise the number to that power.)
7157
7158 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7159 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7160
7161 @noindent
7162 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7163 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7164 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7165 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7166
7167 @smallexample
7168 @group
7169 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7170 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7171 . .
7172
7173 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7174 @end group
7175 @end smallexample
7176
7177 @noindent
7178 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7179
7180 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7181 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7182
7183 @smallexample
7184 @group
7185 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7186 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7187 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7188 .
7189
7190 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7191 @end group
7192 @end smallexample
7193
7194 @noindent
7195 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7196 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7197
7198 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7199 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7200
7201 @noindent
7202 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7203 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7204 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7205 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7206
7207 @smallexample
7208 @group
7209 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7210 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7211 . .
7212
7213 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7214
7215 @end group
7216 @end smallexample
7217 @noindent
7218 @smallexample
7219 @group
7220 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7221 . . .
7222
7223 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7224 @end group
7225 @end smallexample
7226
7227 @noindent
7228 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7229 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7230 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7231 the job is pretty straightforward.
7232
7233 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7234 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7235 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7236 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7237 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7238
7239 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7240 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7241
7242 @noindent
7243 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7244 to get a list of lists of integers!
7245
7246 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7247 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7248
7249 @noindent
7250 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7251 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7252
7253 @smallexample
7254 @group
7255 1: [ [0],
7256 [0, 1],
7257 [0, 1, 2],
7258 @dots{}
7259
7260 1 -
7261 @end group
7262 @end smallexample
7263
7264 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7265 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7266 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7267 can be computed directly by the formula
7268 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7269 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7270
7271 @smallexample
7272 @group
7273 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7274 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7275 . .
7276
7277 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7278 @end group
7279 @end smallexample
7280
7281 @noindent
7282 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7283 result:
7284
7285 @smallexample
7286 @group
7287 1: [ [0],
7288 [1, 2],
7289 [3, 4, 5],
7290 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7291 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7292 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7293 .
7294
7295 V M +
7296 @end group
7297 @end smallexample
7298
7299 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7300 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7301 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7302 triangular list.
7303
7304 @smallexample
7305 @group
7306 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7307 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7308 . .
7309
7310 @key{RET} V M V R +
7311 @end group
7312 @end smallexample
7313
7314 @noindent
7315 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7316 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7317 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7318
7319 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7320 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7321
7322 @noindent
7323 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7324
7325 @smallexample
7326 @group
7327 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7328 . . .
7329
7330 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7331 @end group
7332 @end smallexample
7333
7334 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7335
7336 @smallexample
7337 @group
7338 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7339 .
7340
7341 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7342 @end group
7343 @end smallexample
7344
7345 @noindent
7346 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7347
7348 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7349 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7350
7351 @smallexample
7352 @group
7353 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7354 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7355 . .
7356
7357 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7358 @end group
7359 @end smallexample
7360
7361 @noindent
7362 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7363 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7364 @texline @math{\sin x}
7365 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7366 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7367
7368 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7369 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7370 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 @group
7374 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7375 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7376 .
7377
7378 r 1 V M * V R +
7379 @end group
7380 @end smallexample
7381
7382 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7383 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7384 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7385 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7386 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7387 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7388
7389 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7390 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7391 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7392
7393 @smallexample
7394 @group
7395 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7396 1: [0 .. 5] .
7397 .
7398
7399 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7400 @end group
7401 @end smallexample
7402
7403 @noindent
7404 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7405 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7406 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7407
7408 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7409 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7410
7411 @noindent
7412 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7413
7414 @smallexample
7415 @group
7416 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7417 . 2: 10
7418 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7419 .
7420
7421 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7422
7423 @end group
7424 @end smallexample
7425 @noindent
7426 @smallexample
7427 @group
7428 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7429 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7430 .
7431
7432 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7433 @end group
7434 @end smallexample
7435
7436 @noindent
7437 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7438
7439 @smallexample
7440 @group
7441 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7442 .
7443
7444 10 V M % s 2
7445 @end group
7446 @end smallexample
7447
7448 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7449 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7450 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7451 the right of it are nines.
7452
7453 @smallexample
7454 @group
7455 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7456 . .
7457
7458 9 V M a = v v
7459
7460 @end group
7461 @end smallexample
7462 @noindent
7463 @smallexample
7464 @group
7465 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7466 . .
7467
7468 V U * v v 1 |
7469 @end group
7470 @end smallexample
7471
7472 @noindent
7473 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7474 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7475 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7476 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7477 rightmost digit.
7478
7479 @smallexample
7480 @group
7481 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7482 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7483 .
7484
7485 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7486 @end group
7487 @end smallexample
7488
7489 @noindent
7490 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7491 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7492 digits that generated them.
7493
7494 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7495
7496 @smallexample
7497 @group
7498 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7499 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7500 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7501 .
7502
7503 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7504
7505 @end group
7506 @end smallexample
7507 @noindent
7508 @smallexample
7509 @group
7510 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7511 . .
7512
7513 V M * V R +
7514 @end group
7515 @end smallexample
7516
7517 @noindent
7518 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7519 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 @group
7523 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7524 . .
7525
7526 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7527 @end group
7528 @end smallexample
7529
7530 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7531 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7532
7533 @noindent
7534 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7535 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7536 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7537 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7538
7539 Here's a more correct method:
7540
7541 @smallexample
7542 @group
7543 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7544 . 1: 7
7545 .
7546
7547 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7548
7549 @end group
7550 @end smallexample
7551 @noindent
7552 @smallexample
7553 @group
7554 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7555 . .
7556
7557 V M a = V R *
7558 @end group
7559 @end smallexample
7560
7561 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7562 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7563
7564 @noindent
7565 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7566 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7567 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7568
7569 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7570 commands.
7571
7572 @smallexample
7573 @group
7574 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7575 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7576 . .
7577
7578 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7579
7580 @end group
7581 @end smallexample
7582 @noindent
7583 @smallexample
7584 @group
7585 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7586 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7587 . .
7588
7589 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7590 @end group
7591 @end smallexample
7592
7593 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7594 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7595
7596 @smallexample
7597 @group
7598 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7599 . . .
7600
7601 + 1 V M a < V R +
7602 @end group
7603 @end smallexample
7604
7605 @noindent
7606 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7607
7608 @smallexample
7609 @group
7610 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7611 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7612
7613 100 / 4 * P /
7614 @end group
7615 @end smallexample
7616
7617 @noindent
7618 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7619 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7620 not very efficient!
7621
7622 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7623 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7624
7625 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7626 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7627
7628 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7629 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7630
7631 @noindent
7632 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7633 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7634 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7635 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7636 @texline @math{\theta},
7637 @infoline @expr{theta},
7638 and see if @expr{x} and
7639 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7640 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7641 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7642 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7643 numbers surround an integer.
7644
7645 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7646 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7647 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7648 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7649 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7650
7651 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7652 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7653 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7654 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7655 Pick random @expr{x} and
7656 @texline @math{\theta},
7657 @infoline @expr{theta},
7658 compute
7659 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7660 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7661 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7662
7663 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7664 commands.
7665
7666 @smallexample
7667 @group
7668 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7669 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7670 .
7671
7672 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7673 @end group
7674 @end smallexample
7675
7676 @noindent
7677 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7678
7679 @smallexample
7680 @group
7681 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7682 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7683 .
7684
7685 m d V M C +
7686
7687 @end group
7688 @end smallexample
7689 @noindent
7690 @smallexample
7691 @group
7692 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7693 . . .
7694
7695 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7696 @end group
7697 @end smallexample
7698
7699 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7700 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7701 a random integer.
7702
7703 @smallexample
7704 @group
7705 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7706 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7707 . .
7708
7709 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7710
7711 @end group
7712 @end smallexample
7713 @noindent
7714 @smallexample
7715 @group
7716 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7717 . . .
7718
7719 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7720
7721 @end group
7722 @end smallexample
7723 @noindent
7724 @smallexample
7725 @group
7726 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7727 . .
7728
7729 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7730 @end group
7731 @end smallexample
7732
7733 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7734 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7735
7736 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7737 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7738
7739 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7740 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7741
7742 @noindent
7743 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7744
7745 @smallexample
7746 @group
7747 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7748 .
7749
7750 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7751 @end group
7752 @end smallexample
7753
7754 @noindent
7755 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7756 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7757 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7758 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7759
7760 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7761 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7762 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7763 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7764
7765 @smallexample
7766 @group
7767 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7768 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7769 . .
7770
7771 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7772
7773 @end group
7774 @end smallexample
7775 @noindent
7776 @smallexample
7777 @group
7778 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7779 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7780 .
7781
7782 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7783 @end group
7784 @end smallexample
7785
7786 @noindent
7787 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7788 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7789 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7790 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7791 plus its second argument.
7792
7793 @smallexample
7794 @group
7795 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7796 . .
7797
7798 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7799 @end group
7800 @end smallexample
7801
7802 @noindent
7803 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7804 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7805 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7806
7807 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7808 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7809 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7810 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7811 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7812 the operations are faster.
7813
7814 @smallexample
7815 @group
7816 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7817 . .
7818
7819 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7820 @end group
7821 @end smallexample
7822
7823 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7824 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7825 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7826 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7827
7828 @ifnottex
7829 @example
7830 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7831 @end example
7832 @end ifnottex
7833 @tex
7834 \beforedisplay
7835 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7836 \afterdisplay
7837 @end tex
7838
7839 @noindent
7840 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7841 the distributive law yields
7842
7843 @ifnottex
7844 @example
7845 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7846 @end example
7847 @end ifnottex
7848 @tex
7849 \beforedisplay
7850 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7851 \afterdisplay
7852 @end tex
7853
7854 @noindent
7855 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7856 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7857 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7858 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7859
7860 @ifnottex
7861 @example
7862 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7863 @end example
7864 @end ifnottex
7865 @tex
7866 \beforedisplay
7867 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n^{\prime} $$
7868 \afterdisplay
7869 @end tex
7870
7871 @noindent
7872 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7873 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7874
7875 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7876 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7877 modulo some value @var{m}.
7878
7879 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7880 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7881
7882 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7883 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7884 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7885
7886 @smallexample
7887 @group
7888 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7889 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7890 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7891 ...
7892
7893 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7894 @end group
7895 @end smallexample
7896
7897 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7898 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7899 before nesting even begins.
7900
7901 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7902 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7903 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7904
7905 @smallexample
7906 @group
7907 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7908 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7909 .
7910
7911 v t v u g f
7912 @end group
7913 @end smallexample
7914
7915 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7916 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7917 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7918
7919 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7920 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7921 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7922 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7923
7924 @smallexample
7925 @group
7926 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7927 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7928 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7929 ...
7930
7931 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7932 @end group
7933 @end smallexample
7934
7935 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7936
7937 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7938 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7939 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7940 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7941 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7942 Schwartz.)
7943
7944 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7945 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7946
7947 @noindent
7948 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7949 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7950
7951 @smallexample
7952 @group
7953 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7954 . . .
7955
7956 2 ^ P / c F
7957 @end group
7958 @end smallexample
7959
7960 @noindent
7961 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7962 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
7963 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
7964 irrational number to within 12 digits.
7965
7966 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
7967 precision slightly and try again:
7968
7969 @smallexample
7970 @group
7971 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
7972 . .
7973
7974 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
7975 @end group
7976 @end smallexample
7977
7978 @noindent
7979 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
7980 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
7981 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
7982 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
7983
7984 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
7985 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
7986 to the current precision before they begin.
7987
7988 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7989 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
7990
7991 @noindent
7992 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
7993 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
7994
7995 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
7996 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
7997 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are the same size.
7998 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
7999 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8000 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8001
8002 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8003 the input is infinite.
8004
8005 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8006 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8007 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8008 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8009 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8010
8011 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8012 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8013 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8014 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8015
8016 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8017 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8018
8019 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8020 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8021 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8022 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8023
8024 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8025 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8026
8027 @noindent
8028 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8029 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8030 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8031 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8032 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8033 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8034
8035 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8036 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8037 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8038 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8039
8040 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8041 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8042 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8043 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8044 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8045
8046 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8047 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8048
8049 @smallexample
8050 @group
8051 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8052 1: 17 .
8053 .
8054
8055 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8056 @end group
8057 @end smallexample
8058
8059 @noindent
8060 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8061
8062 @smallexample
8063 @group
8064 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8065 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8066 .
8067
8068 20" + 17 *
8069 @end group
8070 @end smallexample
8071
8072 @noindent
8073 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8074
8075 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8076 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8077
8078 @noindent
8079 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8080 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8081 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8082
8083 @smallexample
8084 @group
8085 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8086 . . .
8087
8088 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8089 @end group
8090 @end smallexample
8091
8092 @noindent
8093 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8094
8095 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8096 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8097 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8098 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8099 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8100
8101 @smallexample
8102 @group
8103 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8104 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8105 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8106 .
8107
8108 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8109 @end group
8110 @end smallexample
8111
8112 @noindent
8113 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8114
8115 @smallexample
8116 @group
8117 1: 242
8118 .
8119
8120 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8121 @end group
8122 @end smallexample
8123
8124 @noindent
8125 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8126
8127 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8128 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8129
8130 @noindent
8131 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8132 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8133 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8134 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8135 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8136 don't know the leap year rule.
8137
8138 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8139 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8140 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8141 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8142 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8143
8144 @smallexample
8145 @group
8146 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8147 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8148 .
8149
8150 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8151
8152 @end group
8153 @end smallexample
8154 @noindent
8155 @smallexample
8156 @group
8157 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8158 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8159 1: 1991 . .
8160 .
8161
8162 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8163 @end group
8164 @end smallexample
8165
8166 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8167 @noindent
8168 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8169 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8170 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8171 background information in that regard.)
8172
8173 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8174 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8175
8176 @noindent
8177 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8178 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8179
8180 @smallexample
8181 @group
8182 1: 1. 2: 1.
8183 . 1: 0.2
8184 .
8185
8186 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8187 @end group
8188 @end smallexample
8189
8190 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8191
8192 @smallexample
8193 @group
8194 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8195 . . .
8196
8197 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8198 @end group
8199 @end smallexample
8200
8201 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8202 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8203
8204 @smallexample
8205 @group
8206 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8207 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8208 1: 706.21 .
8209 .
8210
8211 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8212 @end group
8213 @end smallexample
8214
8215 @noindent
8216 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8217
8218 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8219 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8220
8221 @noindent
8222 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8223 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8224 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8225 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8226 but with no upper bound.
8227
8228 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8229
8230 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8231 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8232 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8233 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8234
8235 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8236 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8237 as a possible value.
8238
8239 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8240 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8241 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8242 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8243 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8244 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8245 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8246 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8247 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8248 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8249
8250 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8251 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8252
8253 @smallexample
8254 @group
8255 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8256 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8257 . .
8258
8259 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8260 @end group
8261 @end smallexample
8262
8263 @noindent
8264 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8265 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8266 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8267
8268 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8269 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8270 for different numbers.
8271
8272 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8273
8274 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8275 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8276
8277 @noindent
8278 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8279
8280 @smallexample
8281 @group
8282 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8283 . 811749612 .
8284 .
8285
8286 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8287 @end group
8288 @end smallexample
8289
8290 @noindent
8291 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8292 must not be prime.
8293
8294 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8295 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8296 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8297 use this method to test the second number.
8298
8299 @smallexample
8300 @group
8301 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8302 1: 15485863 .
8303 .
8304
8305 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8306 @end group
8307 @end smallexample
8308
8309 @noindent
8310 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8311 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8312
8313 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8314 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8315 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8316
8317 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8318 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8319 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8320 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8321
8322 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8323 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8324
8325 @noindent
8326 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8327 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8328 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8329
8330 @smallexample
8331 @group
8332 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8333 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8334 .
8335
8336 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8337
8338 @end group
8339 @end smallexample
8340 @noindent
8341 @smallexample
8342 @group
8343 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8344 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8345 .
8346
8347 x time @key{RET} +
8348 @end group
8349 @end smallexample
8350
8351 @noindent
8352 It will be just after six in the morning.
8353
8354 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8355 HMS form:
8356
8357 @smallexample
8358 @group
8359 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8360 . .
8361
8362 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8363 @end group
8364 @end smallexample
8365
8366 @noindent
8367 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8368 the actual number 3.14159...
8369
8370 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8371 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8372
8373 @noindent
8374 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8375 each.
8376
8377 @smallexample
8378 @group
8379 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8380 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8381 .
8382
8383 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8384
8385 @end group
8386 @end smallexample
8387 @noindent
8388 @smallexample
8389 @group
8390 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8391 .
8392
8393 17 *
8394 @end group
8395 @end smallexample
8396
8397 @noindent
8398 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8399
8400 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8401 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8402
8403 @noindent
8404 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8405
8406 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8407 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8408
8409 @noindent
8410 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8411 to the other?
8412
8413 @smallexample
8414 @group
8415 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8416 . .
8417
8418 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8419 @end group
8420 @end smallexample
8421
8422 @noindent
8423 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8424
8425 @smallexample
8426 @group
8427 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356
8428 2: 4.1 ns .
8429 .
8430
8431 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} /
8432 @end group
8433 @end smallexample
8434
8435 @noindent
8436 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8437 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8438 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8439
8440 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8441 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8442
8443 @noindent
8444 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8445 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8446
8447 @smallexample
8448 @group
8449 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8450 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8451 .
8452
8453 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8454 @end group
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8458 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8459 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8460
8461 @smallexample
8462 @group
8463 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8464 . 1: 2 .
8465 .
8466
8467 u s 2 B
8468 @end group
8469 @end smallexample
8470
8471 @noindent
8472 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8473
8474 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8475 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8476
8477 @noindent
8478 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8479 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8480 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8481 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8482 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8483 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8484 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8485
8486 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8487 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8488
8489 @noindent
8490 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8491 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8492 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8493 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8494 familiar form.
8495
8496 @smallexample
8497 @group
8498 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8499 . .
8500
8501 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8502
8503 @end group
8504 @end smallexample
8505 @noindent
8506 @smallexample
8507 @group
8508 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: x*(x + 1.19023) (x - 1.19023)
8509 . .
8510
8511 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8512
8513 @end group
8514 @end smallexample
8515 @noindent
8516 @smallexample
8517 @group
8518 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8519 . .
8520
8521 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8522 @end group
8523 @end smallexample
8524
8525 @noindent
8526 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8527 same as the original polynomial.
8528
8529 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8530 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8531
8532 @smallexample
8533 @group
8534 1: x sin(pi x) 1: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8535 . .
8536
8537 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8538
8539 @end group
8540 @end smallexample
8541 @noindent
8542 @smallexample
8543 @group
8544 1: [y, 1]
8545 2: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8546 .
8547
8548 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8549
8550 @end group
8551 @end smallexample
8552 @noindent
8553 @smallexample
8554 @group
8555 1: [sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi, 1 / pi]
8556 .
8557
8558 V M $ @key{RET}
8559
8560 @end group
8561 @end smallexample
8562 @noindent
8563 @smallexample
8564 @group
8565 1: sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi - 1 / pi
8566 .
8567
8568 V R -
8569
8570 @end group
8571 @end smallexample
8572 @noindent
8573 @smallexample
8574 @group
8575 1: sin(3.14159 y) / 9.8696 - y cos(3.14159 y) / 3.14159 - 0.3183
8576 .
8577
8578 =
8579
8580 @end group
8581 @end smallexample
8582 @noindent
8583 @smallexample
8584 @group
8585 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8586 .
8587
8588 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8589 @end group
8590 @end smallexample
8591
8592 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8593 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8594
8595 @noindent
8596 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8597 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8598 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8599 coefficients. Here's one way:
8600
8601 @smallexample
8602 @group
8603 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8604 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8605 . .
8606
8607 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8608
8609 @end group
8610 @end smallexample
8611 @noindent
8612 @smallexample
8613 @group
8614 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8615 . .
8616
8617 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8618 @end group
8619 @end smallexample
8620
8621 @noindent
8622 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8623 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8624
8625 @smallexample
8626 @group
8627 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8628 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8629 .
8630
8631 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8632
8633 @end group
8634 @end smallexample
8635 @noindent
8636 @smallexample
8637 @group
8638 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8639 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8640 .
8641
8642 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8643 @end group
8644 @end smallexample
8645
8646 @noindent
8647 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8648 same thing.
8649
8650 @smallexample
8651 @group
8652 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8653 . . .
8654
8655 * .1 * 3 /
8656 @end group
8657 @end smallexample
8658
8659 @noindent
8660 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8661
8662 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8663 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8664
8665 @noindent
8666 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8667
8668 @smallexample
8669 @group
8670 ___
8671 V 2 + 2
8672 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: ---------
8673 . ___
8674 V 2 + 1
8675
8676 .
8677
8678 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8679 @end group
8680 @end smallexample
8681
8682 @noindent
8683 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8684
8685 @smallexample
8686 @group
8687 ___ ___
8688 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8689 .
8690
8691 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8692
8693 @end group
8694 @end smallexample
8695 @noindent
8696 @smallexample
8697 @group
8698 ___
8699 1: V 2
8700 .
8701
8702 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c
8703 @end group
8704 @end smallexample
8705
8706 @noindent
8707 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8708 second step.)
8709
8710 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8711 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8712 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8713
8714 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8715 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8716
8717 @noindent
8718 Here is the rule set:
8719
8720 @smallexample
8721 @group
8722 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8723 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8724 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8725 @end group
8726 @end smallexample
8727
8728 @noindent
8729 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8730 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8731 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8732 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8733 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8734 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8735 numbers.
8736
8737 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8738 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8739 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8740 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8741 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8742
8743 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8744 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8745 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8746 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8747 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8748 function.
8749
8750 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8751 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8752
8753 @noindent
8754 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8755 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8756 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8757 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8758 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8759 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8760 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8761
8762 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8763 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8764 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8765 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8766 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8767 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8768 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8769 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8770 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8771
8772 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8773 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8774
8775 @noindent
8776 @ignore
8777 @starindex
8778 @end ignore
8779 @tindex seq
8780 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8781
8782 @smallexample
8783 @group
8784 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8785 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8786 @end group
8787 @end smallexample
8788
8789 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8790 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8791
8792 @example
8793 seq( 3, 1)
8794 seq(10, 2)
8795 seq( 5, 3)
8796 seq(16, 4)
8797 seq( 8, 5)
8798 seq( 4, 6)
8799 seq( 2, 7)
8800 seq( 1, 8)
8801 @end example
8802
8803 @noindent
8804 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8805
8806 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8807
8808 @smallexample
8809 @group
8810 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8811 seq(1, c) := c,
8812 ... ]
8813 @end group
8814 @end smallexample
8815
8816 @noindent
8817 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8818 as the result.
8819
8820 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8821
8822 @smallexample
8823 @group
8824 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8825 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8826 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8827 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8828 @end group
8829 @end smallexample
8830
8831 @noindent
8832 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8833
8834 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8835 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8836 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8837 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8838
8839 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8840 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8841 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8842 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8843 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8844
8845 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8846 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8847
8848 @noindent
8849 @ignore
8850 @starindex
8851 @end ignore
8852 @tindex nterms
8853 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8854 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8855 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8856
8857 @smallexample
8858 @group
8859 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8860 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8861 @end group
8862 @end smallexample
8863
8864 @noindent
8865 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8866 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8867 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8868
8869 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8870 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8871
8872 @noindent
8873 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8874
8875 @smallexample
8876 @group
8877 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8878 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8879 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8880 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8881 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8882 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8883 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8884 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8885 @end group
8886 @end smallexample
8887
8888 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8889 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8890 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8891 say, @code{O}, first.
8892
8893 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8894 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8895 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8896 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8897 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8898
8899 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O@.
8900 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8901 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8902 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8903
8904 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8905
8906 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8907 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8908 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8909
8910 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8911 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8912 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8913 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8914 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8915
8916 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8917
8918 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8919 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8920 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8921 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8922 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8923 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8924 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8925 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8926 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8927 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8928 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8929
8930 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8931 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8932 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8933 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8934 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8935 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8936 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8937 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8938 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8939 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8940 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8941 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8942 in Lisp.)
8943
8944 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8945 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8946
8947 @noindent
8948 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8949 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8950 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8951 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8952 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8953
8954 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8955 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8956
8957 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8958 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8959
8960 @noindent
8961 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8962 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
8963
8964 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
8965 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
8966
8967 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
8968 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
8969 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
8970
8971 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
8972 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
8973
8974 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8975 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
8976
8977 @noindent
8978 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
8979 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
8980
8981 @noindent
8982 Computing
8983 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
8984 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
8985
8986 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
8987
8988 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
8989
8990 @noindent
8991 Computing the logarithm:
8992
8993 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
8994
8995 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
8996
8997 @noindent
8998 Computing the vector of integers:
8999
9000 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9001 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9002 from the stack.)
9003
9004 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9005 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9006 next command.)
9007
9008 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9009
9010 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9011 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9012
9013 @noindent
9014 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9015
9016 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9017 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9018
9019 @smallexample
9020 @group
9021 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9022 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9023 . .
9024
9025 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9026 @end group
9027 @end smallexample
9028
9029 @noindent
9030 This answer is quite accurate.
9031
9032 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9033 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9034
9035 @noindent
9036 Here is the matrix:
9037
9038 @example
9039 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9040 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9041 @end example
9042
9043 @noindent
9044 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9045 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9046
9047 @example
9048 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9049 @end example
9050
9051 @noindent
9052 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9053 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9054 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9055 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9056 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9057 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9058 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9059 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9060
9061 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9062 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9063
9064 @noindent
9065 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9066 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9067 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9068
9069 @smallexample
9070 @group
9071 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9072 . 1: 4
9073 .
9074
9075 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9076 @end group
9077 @end smallexample
9078
9079 @noindent
9080 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9081 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9082 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9083 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9084 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9085 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9086 loop counter exceeds 4.
9087
9088 @smallexample
9089 @group
9090 2: 31 3: 31
9091 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9092 . 1: 4.02724519544
9093 .
9094
9095 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9096 @end group
9097 @end smallexample
9098
9099 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9100 harmonic number is 4.02.
9101
9102 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9103 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9104
9105 @noindent
9106 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9107 the formula
9108 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9109 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9110
9111 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9112 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9113 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9114 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9115 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9116 just for purposes of illustration.)
9117
9118 @smallexample
9119 @group
9120 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9121 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9122 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9123 .
9124
9125 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9126
9127 @end group
9128 @end smallexample
9129 @noindent
9130 @smallexample
9131 @group
9132 2: 4.5
9133 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9134 .
9135
9136 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9137 @end group
9138 @end smallexample
9139
9140 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9141 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9142 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9143 repetitions are done.)
9144
9145 @smallexample
9146 @group
9147 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9148 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9149 1: 4.5 .
9150 .
9151
9152 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9153 @end group
9154 @end smallexample
9155
9156 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9157 old one to see if we've converged.
9158
9159 @smallexample
9160 @group
9161 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9162 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9163 1: 4.5 .
9164 .
9165
9166 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9167 @end group
9168 @end smallexample
9169
9170 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9171 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9172
9173 @smallexample
9174 @group
9175 2: 5.26345856348
9176 1: 0.499999999997
9177 .
9178
9179 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9180 @end group
9181 @end smallexample
9182
9183 Let's test the new definition again:
9184
9185 @smallexample
9186 @group
9187 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9188 1: 1 .
9189 .
9190
9191 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9192 @end group
9193 @end smallexample
9194
9195 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9196
9197 @example
9198 @group
9199 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9200 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9201 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9202 Z >
9203 Z '
9204 C-x )
9205 @end group
9206 @end example
9207
9208 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9209 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9210 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9211 to see how to use it.
9212
9213 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9214 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9215 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9216 @xref{Root Finding}.
9217
9218 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9219 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9220
9221 @noindent
9222 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9223 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9224 reduce the problem using
9225 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9226 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9227 on to compute
9228 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9229 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9230 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9231 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9232
9233 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9234 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9235 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9236 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9237 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9238 just for purposes of illustration.)
9239
9240 @smallexample
9241 @group
9242 1: 1. 1: 1.
9243 . .
9244
9245 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9246 @end group
9247 @end smallexample
9248
9249 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9250 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9251
9252 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9253 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9254 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9255 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9256
9257 @smallexample
9258 @group
9259 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9260 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9261 1: 5 .
9262 .
9263
9264 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9265 @end group
9266 @end smallexample
9267
9268 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9269 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9270 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9271 minus the adjustment factor.
9272
9273 @smallexample
9274 @group
9275 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9276 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9277 . .
9278
9279 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9280 @end group
9281 @end smallexample
9282
9283 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9284 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9285 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9286
9287 @smallexample
9288 @group
9289 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9290 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9291 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9292 . . 1: 36.
9293 .
9294
9295 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9296
9297 @end group
9298 @end smallexample
9299 @noindent
9300 @smallexample
9301 @group
9302 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9303 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9304 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9305 . .
9306
9307 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9308 @end group
9309 @end smallexample
9310
9311 This is the value of
9312 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9313 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9314 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9315 a higher precision:
9316
9317 @smallexample
9318 @group
9319 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9320 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9321
9322 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9323 @end group
9324 @end smallexample
9325
9326 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9327
9328 @example
9329 @group
9330 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9331 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9332 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9333 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9334 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9335 2 Z )
9336 Z '
9337 C-x )
9338 @end group
9339 @end example
9340
9341 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9342 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9343
9344 @noindent
9345 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9346 a term like
9347 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9348 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9349 Taking the derivative of a constant
9350 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9351 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9352 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9353
9354 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9355 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9356 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9357 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9358 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9359 just for purposes of illustration.)
9360
9361 @smallexample
9362 @group
9363 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9364 1: 6 2: 0
9365 . 1: 6
9366 .
9367
9368 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9369 @end group
9370 @end smallexample
9371
9372 @noindent
9373 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9374
9375 @smallexample
9376 @group
9377 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9378 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9379 . 1: 1 .
9380 .
9381
9382 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9383 @end group
9384 @end smallexample
9385
9386 @noindent
9387 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9388 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9389 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9390
9391 @smallexample
9392 @group
9393 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9394 . . .
9395
9396 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9397 @end group
9398 @end smallexample
9399
9400 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9401 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9402
9403 @smallexample
9404 @group
9405 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9406 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9407 . .
9408
9409 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9410
9411 @end group
9412 @end smallexample
9413 @noindent
9414 @smallexample
9415 @group
9416 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9417 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9418 .
9419
9420 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9421 @end group
9422 @end smallexample
9423
9424 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9425
9426 @example
9427 @group
9428 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9429 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9430 a d x @key{RET}
9431 1 Z ) r 1
9432 Z '
9433 C-x )
9434
9435 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9436 @end group
9437 @end example
9438
9439 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9440 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9441
9442 @noindent
9443 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9444 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9445 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9446 sure the stack comes out right.
9447
9448 @smallexample
9449 @group
9450 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9451 1: 2 . 1: 2
9452 . .
9453
9454 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9455 @end group
9456 @end smallexample
9457
9458 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9459 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9460 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9461 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9462
9463 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9464 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9465
9466 @smallexample
9467 @group
9468 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9469 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9470 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9471 1: 2 .
9472 .
9473
9474 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9475
9476 @end group
9477 @end smallexample
9478 @noindent
9479 @smallexample
9480 @group
9481 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9482 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9483 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9484 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9485 . . .
9486
9487 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9488 @end group
9489 @end smallexample
9490
9491 @noindent
9492 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9493 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9494
9495 @smallexample
9496 @group
9497 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9498 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9499 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9500 . 1: 2 .
9501 .
9502
9503 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9504
9505 @end group
9506 @end smallexample
9507 @noindent
9508 @smallexample
9509 @group
9510 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9511 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9512 . .
9513
9514 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9515 @end group
9516 @end smallexample
9517
9518 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9519 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9520 the right answers.
9521
9522 Here's the full program once again:
9523
9524 @example
9525 @group
9526 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9527 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9528 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9529 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9530 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9531 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9532 Z ]
9533 Z ]
9534 C-x )
9535 @end group
9536 @end example
9537
9538 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9539 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9540 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9541 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9542 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9543
9544 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9545 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9546
9547 @noindent
9548 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9549 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9550
9551 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9552 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9553
9554 @smallexample
9555 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9556 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9557 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9558 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9559 C-c C-c
9560 @end smallexample
9561
9562 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9563
9564 @smallexample
9565 @group
9566 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9567 1: 2 . .
9568 .
9569
9570 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9571 @end group
9572 @end smallexample
9573
9574 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9575 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9576 the last rule.
9577
9578 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9579 @tex
9580 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9581 @end tex
9582
9583 @c [reference]
9584
9585 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9586 @chapter Introduction
9587
9588 @noindent
9589 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9590 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9591 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9592
9593 @c [when-split]
9594 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9595
9596 @menu
9597 * Basic Commands::
9598 * Help Commands::
9599 * Stack Basics::
9600 * Numeric Entry::
9601 * Algebraic Entry::
9602 * Quick Calculator::
9603 * Prefix Arguments::
9604 * Undo::
9605 * Error Messages::
9606 * Multiple Calculators::
9607 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9608 @end menu
9609
9610 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9611 @section Basic Commands
9612
9613 @noindent
9614 @pindex calc
9615 @pindex calc-mode
9616 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9617 @cindex Running the Calculator
9618 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9619 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9620 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9621 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9622 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9623 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9624 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9625 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9626 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9627 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9628 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9629 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9630
9631 @kindex C-x * c
9632 @kindex C-x * *
9633 @ignore
9634 @mindex @null
9635 @end ignore
9636 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9637 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9638 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9639 in its Keypad mode.
9640
9641 @kindex x
9642 @kindex M-x
9643 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9644 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9645 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9646 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9647 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9648 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9649 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9650 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9651
9652 Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9653 Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9654 arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9655 numbers.
9656
9657 @cindex Extensions module
9658 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9659 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9660 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9661 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9662 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9663 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9664 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9665 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9666 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9667 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9668 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9669
9670 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9671 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9672 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9673 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9674 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9675 to auto-load the Calculator.
9676
9677 @kindex C-x * b
9678 @pindex full-calc
9679 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9680 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9681 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9682 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9683 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9684 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9685 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9686
9687 @kindex C-x * o
9688 @pindex calc-other-window
9689 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9690 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9691 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9692 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9693 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9694 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9695
9696 @ignore
9697 @mindex C-x * q
9698 @end ignore
9699 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9700 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9701 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9702 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9703
9704 @ignore
9705 @mindex C-x * k
9706 @end ignore
9707 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9708 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9709 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9710 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9711
9712 @kindex q
9713 @pindex calc-quit
9714 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9715 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9716 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9717 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9718 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9719 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9720 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9721 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9722 Calculator on and off.
9723
9724 @kindex C-x * x
9725 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9726 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9727 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9728
9729 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9730 @pindex calc-refresh
9731 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9732 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9733 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9734 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9735 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9736
9737 @ignore
9738 @mindex o
9739 @end ignore
9740 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9741 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9742
9743 @kindex <
9744 @kindex >
9745 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9746 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9747 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9748 @cindex Scrolling
9749 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9750 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9751 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9752 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9753 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9754 window whenever it can.)
9755
9756 @kindex @{
9757 @kindex @}
9758 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9759 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9760 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9761 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9762 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9763 height of the Calc window.
9764
9765 @kindex C-x * 0
9766 @pindex calc-reset
9767 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9768 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9769 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9770 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9771 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9772 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9773 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9774 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9775 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9776 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9777 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9778
9779 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9780 @section Help Commands
9781
9782 @noindent
9783 @cindex Help commands
9784 @kindex ?
9785 @kindex a ?
9786 @kindex b ?
9787 @kindex c ?
9788 @kindex d ?
9789 @kindex f ?
9790 @kindex g ?
9791 @kindex j ?
9792 @kindex k ?
9793 @kindex m ?
9794 @kindex r ?
9795 @kindex s ?
9796 @kindex t ?
9797 @kindex u ?
9798 @kindex v ?
9799 @kindex V ?
9800 @kindex z ?
9801 @kindex Z ?
9802 @pindex calc-help
9803 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9804 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs's
9805 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9806 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9807 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9808 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9809
9810 @kindex h h
9811 @pindex calc-full-help
9812 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9813 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9814 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9815
9816 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9817 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9818 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9819
9820 @kindex h i
9821 @kindex C-x * i
9822 @kindex i
9823 @pindex calc-info
9824 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9825 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9826 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9827 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9828 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9829 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9830 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9831 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9832 different command in a future version of Calc.
9833
9834 @kindex h t
9835 @kindex C-x * t
9836 @pindex calc-tutorial
9837 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9838 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9839 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9840 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9841 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9842 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9843 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9844 all times).
9845
9846 @kindex h s
9847 @kindex C-x * s
9848 @pindex calc-info-summary
9849 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9850 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9851 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9852
9853 @kindex h k
9854 @pindex calc-describe-key
9855 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9856 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9857 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9858 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9859 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9860 node indicated by the index.
9861
9862 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9863 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9864 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9865 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9866
9867 @kindex h c
9868 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9869 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9870 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9871 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9872 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9873 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9874 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9875 gives the description:
9876
9877 @smallexample
9878 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9879 @end smallexample
9880
9881 @noindent
9882 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9883 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9884 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9885 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9886 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9887
9888 @kindex h f
9889 @pindex calc-describe-function
9890 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9891 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9892 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9893 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9894 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9895 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9896 @samp{=>}.
9897
9898 @kindex h v
9899 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9900 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9901 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9902 @code{PlotRejects}.
9903
9904 @kindex h b
9905 @pindex describe-bindings
9906 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9907 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9908 listed.
9909
9910 @kindex h n
9911 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9912 the ``news'' or change history of Emacs, and jumps to the most recent
9913 portion concerning Calc (if present).
9914
9915 @kindex h C-c
9916 @kindex h C-d
9917 @kindex h C-w
9918 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9919 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9920 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9921 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9922
9923 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9924 @section Stack Basics
9925
9926 @noindent
9927 @cindex Stack basics
9928 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9929 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9930 Tutorial}.
9931
9932 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9933 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9934 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9935 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9936 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9937 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9938 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9939 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9940
9941 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9942 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9943 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9944 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9945 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9946 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9947
9948 @kindex d l
9949 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9950 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9951 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9952 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9953 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9954 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9955
9956 @kindex o
9957 @pindex calc-realign
9958 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9959 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9960 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9961 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9962
9963 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9964 two consecutive numbers.
9965 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9966 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9967 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9968 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9969
9970 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9971 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9972 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9973 commands.
9974
9975 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9976 @section Numeric Entry
9977
9978 @noindent
9979 @kindex 0-9
9980 @kindex .
9981 @kindex e
9982 @cindex Numeric entry
9983 @cindex Entering numbers
9984 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
9985 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
9986 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
9987 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
9988 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
9989
9990 @cindex Minus signs
9991 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
9992 @kindex _
9993 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
9994 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
9995 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
9996 different keys for these operations, respectively:
9997 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
9998 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
9999 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10000 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10001 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10002 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10003 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10004
10005 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10006 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10007 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10008 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10009
10010 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10011
10012 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10013 @section Algebraic Entry
10014
10015 @noindent
10016 @kindex '
10017 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10018 @cindex Algebraic notation
10019 @cindex Formulas, entering
10020 The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10021 calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10022 apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
10023
10024 @example
10025 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10026 @end example
10027
10028 @noindent
10029 This will compute
10030 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10031 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10032 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10033 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10034 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10035 clear previous results off the stack.
10036
10037 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10038 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10039 this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10040 keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10041
10042 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10043 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10044 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10045 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10046
10047 @kindex m a
10048 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10049 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10050 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10051 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10052 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10053 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10054 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10055 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10056 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10057 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10058 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10059
10060 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10061 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10062 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10063 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10064 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10065
10066 @kindex m t
10067 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10068 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10069 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10070 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10071 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10072 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10073 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10074 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10075 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10076 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10077 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10078 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10079 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10080
10081 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10082 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10083 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10084
10085 @kindex $
10086 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10087 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10088 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10089 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10090 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10091 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10092 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10093 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10094 first character in the new formula.
10095
10096 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10097 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10098 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10099 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10100 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10101 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10102 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10103
10104 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10105 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10106 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10107 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10108 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10109 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10110
10111 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10112 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10113 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10114 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10115 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10116 @key{TAB} key.
10117
10118 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10119 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10120 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10121 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10122
10123 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10124 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables simplification
10125 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10126 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10127 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10128 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10129
10130 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10131 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10132
10133 @noindent
10134 @kindex C-x * q
10135 @pindex quick-calc
10136 @cindex Quick Calculator
10137 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10138 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10139 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10140 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10141 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10142
10143 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10144 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10145 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10146 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10147 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10148 @samp{$} as the formula.
10149
10150 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10151 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10152 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10153 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10154 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10155 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10156 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10157 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10158
10159 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10160 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10161
10162 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10163 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10164 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10165 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10166 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10167 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10168
10169 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10170 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10171 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10172
10173 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10174 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10175 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10176 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10177 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10178 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10179
10180 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10181 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10182 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10183 an ASCII character.
10184
10185 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10186 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10187 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10188 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10189 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10190 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10191 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10192
10193 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10194 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10195 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10196 small calculations.
10197
10198 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10199 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10200
10201 @noindent
10202 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10203 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10204 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10205 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10206 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10207
10208 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10209 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10210 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10211 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10212 on the entire stack.
10213
10214 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10215 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10216 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10217 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10218 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10219 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10220 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10221 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10222 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10223 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10224 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10225 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10226 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10227 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10228 argument for some other purpose.
10229
10230 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10231 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10232 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10233 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10234
10235 @kindex ~
10236 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10237 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10238 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10239 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10240 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10241 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10242
10243 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10244 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10245
10246 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10247 @section Undoing Mistakes
10248
10249 @noindent
10250 @kindex U
10251 @kindex C-_
10252 @pindex calc-undo
10253 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10254 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10255 @cindex Errors, undoing
10256 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10257 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10258 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10259 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10260 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10261 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10262 specified number of operations. When the Calculator is quit, as with
10263 the @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command, the undo history will be
10264 truncated to the length of the customizable variable
10265 @code{calc-undo-length} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), which by default
10266 is @expr{100}. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is synonymous with
10267 @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this also truncates the
10268 undo history.)
10269
10270 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10271 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10272 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10273
10274 @kindex D
10275 @pindex calc-redo
10276 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10277 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10278 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10279 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10280 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10281 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10282 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10283 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10284
10285 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10286 @pindex calc-last-args
10287 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10288 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10289 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10290 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10291 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10292 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10293 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10294 onto the stack.
10295
10296 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10297 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10298
10299 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10300 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10301
10302 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10303
10304 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10305 @section Error Messages
10306
10307 @noindent
10308 @kindex w
10309 @pindex calc-why
10310 @cindex Errors, messages
10311 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10312 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10313 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10314 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10315 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10316 reasons for this to happen.
10317
10318 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10319 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10320 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10321 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10322 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10323 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10324 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10325
10326 @kindex d w
10327 @pindex calc-auto-why
10328 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10329 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10330 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10331 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10332 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10333 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10334
10335 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10336 @section Multiple Calculators
10337
10338 @noindent
10339 @pindex another-calc
10340 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10341 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10342 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10343 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10344 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10345 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10346 this would ordinarily never be done.
10347
10348 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10349 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10350 Calculator buffer.
10351
10352 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10353 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10354 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10355 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10356 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10357 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10358
10359 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10360 Calculator buffers.
10361
10362 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10363 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10364
10365 @noindent
10366 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10367 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10368
10369 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10370 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10371
10372 @menu
10373 * Autoloading Problems::
10374 * Recursion Depth::
10375 * Caches::
10376 * Debugging Calc::
10377 @end menu
10378
10379 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10380 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10381
10382 @noindent
10383 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10384 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10385 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10386 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10387 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10388
10389 @kindex C-x * L
10390 @pindex calc-load-everything
10391 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10392 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10393 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10394 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10395
10396 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10397 @subsection Recursion Depth
10398
10399 @noindent
10400 @kindex M
10401 @kindex I M
10402 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10403 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10404 @cindex Recursion depth
10405 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10406 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10407 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10408 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10409 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10410 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10411 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10412 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10413 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10414 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10415
10416 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10417 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10418 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10419 The default value is 1000.
10420
10421 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10422 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10423
10424 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10425 @subsection Caches
10426
10427 @noindent
10428 @cindex Caches
10429 @cindex Flushing caches
10430 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10431 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10432 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10433 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10434 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10435 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10436 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10437 @cpiover{4} and
10438 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10439 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10440 The visible effect of caching is that
10441 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10442 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10443 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10444 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10445
10446 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10447 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10448 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10449 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10450 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10451 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10452
10453 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10454 @subsection Debugging Calc
10455
10456 @noindent
10457 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10458 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10459 your own Calc commands.
10460
10461 @kindex Z T
10462 @pindex calc-timing
10463 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10464 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10465 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10466 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10467 accurate only to within one second.
10468
10469 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10470 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10471 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10472 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10473 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10474 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10475 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10476 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10477 to execute the whole macro.
10478
10479 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10480 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10481 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10482 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10483 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10484 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10485 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10486
10487 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10488 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10489 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10490 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10491 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10492 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10493 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10494
10495 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10496 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10497 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10498 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10499 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10500 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10501 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10502 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10503 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10504 will be lost.
10505
10506 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10507 @chapter Data Types
10508
10509 @noindent
10510 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10511 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10512 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10513 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10514
10515 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10516 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10517 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10518 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10519 arbitrarily: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10520 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10521 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10522
10523 @menu
10524 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10525 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10526 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10527 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10528 * Infinities::
10529 * Vectors and Matrices::
10530 * Strings::
10531 * HMS Forms::
10532 * Date Forms::
10533 * Modulo Forms::
10534 * Error Forms::
10535 * Interval Forms::
10536 * Incomplete Objects::
10537 * Variables::
10538 * Formulas::
10539 @end menu
10540
10541 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10542 @section Integers
10543
10544 @noindent
10545 @cindex Integers
10546 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10547 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10548 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10549 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10550 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10551 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10552
10553 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10554 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10555 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10556 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10557
10558 @kindex #
10559 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10560 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10561 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10562 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10563 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10564 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10565 number, the current display radix is used.
10566
10567 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10568 @section Fractions
10569
10570 @noindent
10571 @cindex Fractions
10572 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10573 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10574 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10575 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10576 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10577 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10578 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10579
10580 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10581 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10582 display formats.
10583
10584 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10585 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10586 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10587
10588 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10589 @section Floats
10590
10591 @noindent
10592 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10593 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10594 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10595 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10596 range of acceptable values is from
10597 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10598 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10599 (inclusive) to
10600 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10601 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10602 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10603
10604 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10605 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10606 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10607 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10608 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10609 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10610 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10611 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10612 would have overflowed!)
10613
10614 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10615 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10616 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10617 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10618
10619 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10620 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10621 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10622 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10623 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10624 or 0.235.
10625
10626 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10627 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10628 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10629 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10630
10631 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10632 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10633 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10634 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10635 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10636 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10637 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10638 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10639 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10640 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10641 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10642 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10643 way.
10644
10645 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10646 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10647 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10648 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10649 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10650 current precision. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10651 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10652 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10653 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10654 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10655 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10656 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10657 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10658 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10659 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10660 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10661
10662 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10663 @section Complex Numbers
10664
10665 @noindent
10666 @cindex Complex numbers
10667 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10668 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10669 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10670 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10671 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10672 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10673
10674 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10675 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10676 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10677 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10678 @texline @math{\theta}
10679 @infoline @var{theta}
10680 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10681 @texline @math{\theta}
10682 @infoline @var{theta}
10683 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10684 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10685 in radians.
10686
10687 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10688 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10689
10690 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10691 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10692 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10693 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10694 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10695
10696 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10697 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10698 number.
10699
10700 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10701 @section Infinities
10702
10703 @noindent
10704 @cindex Infinity
10705 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10706 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10707 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10708 @vindex inf
10709 @vindex uinf
10710 @vindex nan
10711 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10712 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10713 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10714 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10715 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10716 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10717 entered using algebraic entry.
10718
10719 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10720 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10721 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10722 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10723 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10724 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10725 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10726 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10727 @texline @math{e^x}
10728 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10729 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10730 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10731 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10732 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10733
10734 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10735 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10736 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10737 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10738 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10739 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10740 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10741 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10742 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10743 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10744 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10745
10746 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10747 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10748 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10749 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10750 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10751 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10752 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10753 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10754 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10755 some cases.
10756
10757 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10758 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10759 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10760 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10761 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10762 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10763 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10764 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10765 notation.
10766
10767 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10768 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10769 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10770 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10771 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10772 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10773 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10774 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10775 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10776 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10777 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10778 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10779 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10780 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10781 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10782 (as described above).
10783
10784 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10785 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10786
10787 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10788 @section Vectors and Matrices
10789
10790 @noindent
10791 @cindex Vectors
10792 @cindex Plain vectors
10793 @cindex Matrices
10794 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10795 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10796 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10797 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10798 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10799
10800 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10801 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10802 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10803 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10804 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10805 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10806 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10807 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10808 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10809 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10810 this case.
10811
10812 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10813 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10814 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10815 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10816 of its elements.
10817
10818 @ignore
10819 @starindex
10820 @end ignore
10821 @tindex vec
10822 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10823 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10824 @texline @math{n\times m}
10825 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10826 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10827 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10828
10829 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10830 @section Strings
10831
10832 @noindent
10833 @kindex "
10834 @cindex Strings
10835 @cindex Character strings
10836 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10837 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10838 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10839 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10840 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10841 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10842
10843 @example
10844 @group
10845 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10846 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10847 \e 27 \^[ 27
10848 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10849 \n 10 \^] 29
10850 \r 13 \^^ 30
10851 \t 9 \^_ 31
10852 \^? 127
10853 @end group
10854 @end example
10855
10856 @noindent
10857 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10858 character from its ASCII code.
10859
10860 @kindex d "
10861 @pindex calc-display-strings
10862 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10863 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10864 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10865 instead.
10866
10867 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10868 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10869 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10870 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10871 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10872 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10873
10874 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10875 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10876 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10877
10878 @ignore
10879 @starindex
10880 @end ignore
10881 @tindex string
10882 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10883 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10884 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10885 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10886 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10887 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10888 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10889 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10890 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10891
10892 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10893 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10894 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10895 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10896
10897 @ignore
10898 @starindex
10899 @end ignore
10900 @tindex bstring
10901 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10902 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10903 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10904 character in the string.
10905
10906 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10907 @section HMS Forms
10908
10909 @noindent
10910 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10911 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10912 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10913 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10914 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10915 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10916 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10917 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10918
10919 @kindex @@
10920 @ignore
10921 @mindex @null
10922 @end ignore
10923 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10924 @ignore
10925 @mindex @null
10926 @end ignore
10927 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10928 @ignore
10929 @mindex @null
10930 @end ignore
10931 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10932 @ignore
10933 @mindex @null
10934 @end ignore
10935 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10936 @ignore
10937 @mindex @null
10938 @end ignore
10939 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10940 @ignore
10941 @mindex @null
10942 @end ignore
10943 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10944 The default format for HMS values is
10945 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10946 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10947 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10948 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10949 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10950 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10951 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10952 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10953 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10954 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10955 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10956 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10957
10958 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10959 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10960 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10961 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10962
10963 @pindex calc-time
10964 @cindex Time of day
10965 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10966 the stack as an HMS form.
10967
10968 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10969 @section Date Forms
10970
10971 @noindent
10972 @cindex Date forms
10973 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10974 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10975 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10976 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10977 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10978 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10979 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10980
10981 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
10982 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
10983 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
10984 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
10985 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
10986
10987 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
10988 of days since midnight on the morning of December 31 of the year 1 BC@.
10989 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
10990 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
10991 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Thu Jan 10, 1991>}
10992 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
10993 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
10994 time can be stored without roundoff error.
10995
10996 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
10997 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
10998 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
10999 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11000 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11001 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11002 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11003 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11004 never an issue for them.
11005
11006 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11007 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11008 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11009
11010 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11011 year numbers represent years BC@. There is no ``year 0''; the day
11012 before @samp{<Mon Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Sun Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11013 days 1 and 0 respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme. The
11014 Gregorian calendar is used for all dates, including dates before the
11015 Gregorian calendar was invented (although that can be configured; see
11016 below). Thus Calc's use of the day number @mathit{-10000} to
11017 represent August 15, 28 BC should be taken with a grain of salt.
11018
11019 @cindex Julian calendar
11020 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11021 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11022 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the confusion
11023 caused by the irregular Roman calendar that was used before that time.
11024 The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in all years divisible by
11025 four. After some initial confusion, the calendar was adopted around
11026 the year we call 8 AD@. Some centuries later it became
11027 apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was itself not quite
11028 right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the Gregorian calendar,
11029 which added the new rule that years divisible by 100, but not by 400,
11030 were not to be considered leap years despite being divisible by four.
11031 Many countries delayed adoption of the Gregorian calendar
11032 because of religious differences. For example, Great Britain and the
11033 British colonies switched to the Gregorian calendar in September
11034 1752, when the Julian calendar was eleven days behind the
11035 Gregorian calendar. That year in Britain, the day after September 2
11036 was September 14. To take another example, Russia did not adopt the
11037 Gregorian calendar until 1918, and that year in Russia the day after
11038 January 31 was February 14. Calc's reckoning therefore matches English
11039 practice starting in 1752 and Russian practice starting in 1918, but
11040 disagrees with earlier dates in both countries.
11041
11042 When the Julian calendar was introduced, it had January 1 as the first
11043 day of the year. By the Middle Ages, many European countries
11044 had changed the beginning of a new year to a different date, often to
11045 a religious festival. Almost all countries reverted to using January 1
11046 as the beginning of the year by the time they adopted the Gregorian
11047 calendar.
11048
11049 Some calendars attempt to mimic the historical situation by using the
11050 Gregorian calendar for recent dates and the Julian calendar for older
11051 dates. The @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations does this,
11052 for example. While January 1 wasn't always the beginning of a calendar
11053 year, these hybrid calendars still use January 1 as the beginning of
11054 the year even for older dates. The customizable variable
11055 @code{calc-gregorian-switch} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}) can be set to
11056 have Calc's date forms switch from the Julian to Gregorian calendar at
11057 any specified date.
11058
11059 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second''.
11060 These do not occur regularly and Calc does not take these minor
11061 effects into account. (If it did, it would have to report a
11062 non-integer number of days between, say,
11063 @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11064 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11065
11066 @cindex Julian day counting
11067 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11068 ``Julian.'' Julian days go from noon to noon. The Julian day number
11069 is the numbers of days since 12:00 noon (GMT) on November 24, 4714 BC
11070 in the Gregorian calendar (i.e., January 1, 4713 BC in the Julian
11071 calendar). In Calc's scheme (in GMT) the Julian day origin is
11072 @mathit{-1721422.5}, because Calc starts at midnight instead of noon.
11073 Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11074 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721422.5 after
11075 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11076 command performs this conversion for you.
11077
11078 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11079 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11080 since it involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11081 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11082 Julian cycle is based on three other cycles: the indiction cycle, the
11083 Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15 year
11084 cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later used to
11085 date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year cycle; 19
11086 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year and a lunar
11087 month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will occur on the
11088 same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year cycle; the Julian
11089 calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The smallest time period
11090 which contains multiples of all three cycles is the least common
11091 multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which (since they're
11092 pairwise relatively prime) is
11093 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11094 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11095 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11096 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scaliger
11097 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11098 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11099 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11100 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11101 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11102 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11103 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11104 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11105 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11106 noon GMT@.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11107
11108 @cindex Unix time format
11109 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11110 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11111 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11112 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11113 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11114 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11115 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11116 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11117 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11118 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11119 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11120 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11121 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11122 conversions.
11123
11124 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11125 @section Modulo Forms
11126
11127 @noindent
11128 @cindex Modulo forms
11129 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11130 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11131 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11132 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11133 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11134 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11135 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11136 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11137 integers but this is not required.
11138
11139 @ignore
11140 @mindex M
11141 @end ignore
11142 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11143 @ignore
11144 @mindex mod
11145 @end ignore
11146 @tindex mod (operator)
11147 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11148 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11149 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11150 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11151 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11152 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11153
11154 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11155 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11156 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11157 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11158 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11159 the result always lies in the desired range.
11160
11161 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11162 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11163 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11164 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11165 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11166 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11167 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11168 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11169
11170 @cindex Modulo division
11171 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11172 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11173 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11174 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11175 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11176 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11177 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11178 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11179 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11180 in the sense of reducing
11181 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11182 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11183 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11184 number-theoretical point of view.)
11185
11186 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11187 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11188 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11189 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11190 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11191 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11192 24 radians!
11193
11194 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11195 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11196 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11197
11198 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11199 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11200
11201 @ignore
11202 @starindex
11203 @end ignore
11204 @tindex makemod
11205 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11206 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11207
11208 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11209 @section Error Forms
11210
11211 @noindent
11212 @cindex Error forms
11213 @cindex Standard deviations
11214 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11215 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11216 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11217 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11218 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11219 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11220 deviation or ``error''
11221 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11222 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11223 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11224 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11225 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11226 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11227 regular number by the Calculator.
11228
11229 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11230 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11231 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11232 @texline @math{\sin x}
11233 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11234 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11235 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11236 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11237 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11238 @tex
11239 $$ \eqalign{
11240 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11241 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11242 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11243 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11244 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11245 \right| \right)^2
11246 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11247 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11248 } $$
11249 @end tex
11250 Note that this
11251 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11252 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11253 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11254 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11255 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11256 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11257 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11258
11259 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11260 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11261 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11262 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11263 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11264 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11265 is
11266 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11267 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11268 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11269 @texline @math{\cos x}
11270 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11271 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11272 @texline @math{\sigma};
11273 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11274 this makes sense, since
11275 @texline @math{\sin x}
11276 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11277 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11278 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11279 @texline @math{\cos x}
11280 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11281 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11282 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11283 has relatively little effect on the value of
11284 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11285 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11286 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11287 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11288 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11289 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11290 @texline @math{\sin x}
11291 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11292 would indeed have been negligible.
11293
11294 @ignore
11295 @mindex p
11296 @end ignore
11297 @kindex p (error forms)
11298 @tindex +/-
11299 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11300 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11301 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11302 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11303 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11304
11305 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11306 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11307 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11308 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11309 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11310 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11311 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11312 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11313
11314 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11315 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11316
11317 @ignore
11318 @starindex
11319 @end ignore
11320 @tindex sdev
11321 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11322
11323 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11324 @section Interval Forms
11325
11326 @noindent
11327 @cindex Interval forms
11328 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11329 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11330 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11331 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11332 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11333 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11334 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11335 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11336 set of possible values of the input.
11337
11338 @ifnottex
11339 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11340 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11341 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11342 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11343 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11344 terms,
11345 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11346 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11347 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11348 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11349 @end ifnottex
11350 @tex
11351 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11352 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11353 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11354 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11355 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11356 terms,
11357 $$ \eqalign{
11358 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11359 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11360 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11361 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11362 } $$
11363 @end tex
11364
11365 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11366 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11367 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11368 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11369 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11370 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11371 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11372 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11373 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11374 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11375 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11376 the real infinities.
11377
11378 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11379 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11380 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11381 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11382 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11383 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11384 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11385
11386 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11387 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11388 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11389 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11390 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11391 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11392 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11393 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11394 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11395
11396 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11397 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11398 form
11399 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11400 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11401 means a variable is random, and its value could
11402 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11403 @texline @math{\sigma}
11404 @infoline @var{sigma}
11405 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11406 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11407 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11408 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11409 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11410 answer.
11411
11412 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11413 HMS forms or date forms.
11414
11415 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11416 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11417
11418 @ignore
11419 @starindex
11420 @end ignore
11421 @tindex intv
11422 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11423 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11424 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11425 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11426
11427 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11428 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11429 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11430 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11431 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11432 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11433 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11434 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11435 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11436 error.
11437
11438 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11439 @section Incomplete Objects
11440
11441 @noindent
11442 @ignore
11443 @mindex [ ]
11444 @end ignore
11445 @kindex [
11446 @ignore
11447 @mindex ( )
11448 @end ignore
11449 @kindex (
11450 @kindex ,
11451 @ignore
11452 @mindex @null
11453 @end ignore
11454 @kindex ]
11455 @ignore
11456 @mindex @null
11457 @end ignore
11458 @kindex )
11459 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11460 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11461 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11462 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11463 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11464 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11465 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11466 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11467 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11468
11469 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11470 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11471 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11472
11473 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11474 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11475 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11476 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11477
11478 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11479 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11480 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11481 from the list.
11482
11483 @kindex ;
11484 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11485 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11486 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11487 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11488
11489 @kindex ..
11490 @pindex calc-dots
11491 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11492 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11493 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11494 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11495 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11496 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11497
11498 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11499 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11500
11501 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11502 @section Variables
11503
11504 @noindent
11505 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11506 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11507 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11508 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11509 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11510 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11511 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11512 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11513 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11514 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11515 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11516 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11517 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11518 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11519 refer to the same variable.)
11520
11521 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11522 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11523 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11524 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11525 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11526 @code{foo}.
11527
11528 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11529 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11530 (@key{'}) key.
11531
11532 @kindex =
11533 @pindex calc-evaluate
11534 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11535 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11536 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11537 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11538 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11539 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11540 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11541 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11542 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11543 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11544 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11545 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11546
11547 @cindex @code{e} variable
11548 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11549 @cindex @code{i} variable
11550 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11551 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11552 @vindex e
11553 @vindex pi
11554 @vindex i
11555 @vindex phi
11556 @vindex gamma
11557 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11558 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11559 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11560 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11561 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11562 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11563
11564 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11565 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11566 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11567 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11568 a value into any of these special variables.
11569
11570 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11571
11572 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11573 @section Formulas
11574
11575 @noindent
11576 @cindex Formulas
11577 @cindex Expressions
11578 @cindex Operators in formulas
11579 @cindex Precedence of operators
11580 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11581 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11582 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11583 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11584 Parentheses may
11585 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11586 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11587 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11588 with their equivalent function names, are:
11589
11590 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11591
11592 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11593
11594 prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11595
11596 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11597 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11598
11599 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11600 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11601
11602 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11603
11604 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11605
11606 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11607
11608 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11609 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11610
11611 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11612
11613 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11614
11615 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11616 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11617
11618 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11619
11620 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11621
11622 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11623
11624 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11625
11626 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11627
11628 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11629
11630 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11631
11632 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11633
11634 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11635
11636 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11637 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11638 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11639 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11640
11641 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11642 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11643 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11644 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11645 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11646 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11647 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11648 as in @samp{f(x)},
11649 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11650 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11651 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11652 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11653 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11654
11655 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11656 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11657 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11658 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11659 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11660 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11661 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11662 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11663 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11664 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11665 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11666
11667 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11668 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11669 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11670 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11671 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11672 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11673 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11674 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11675 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11676 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11677
11678 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11679 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11680 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11681 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11682
11683 @cindex Function call notation
11684 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11685 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11686 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11687 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11688 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11689 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11690 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11691 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11692 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11693 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11694 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11695
11696 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11697 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11698 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11699 represent the same operation.
11700
11701 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11702 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11703 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11704 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11705 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11706 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11707 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11708
11709 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11710 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11711 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11712 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11713
11714 @example
11715 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11716 c + d,
11717 %% last line is coming up:
11718 e + f ]
11719 @end example
11720
11721 @noindent
11722 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11723
11724 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11725 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11726 formats.
11727
11728 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11729
11730 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11731 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11732
11733 @noindent
11734 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11735 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11736 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11737
11738 @menu
11739 * Stack Manipulation::
11740 * Editing Stack Entries::
11741 * Trail Commands::
11742 * Keep Arguments::
11743 @end menu
11744
11745 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11746 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11747
11748 @noindent
11749 @kindex @key{RET}
11750 @kindex @key{SPC}
11751 @pindex calc-enter
11752 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11753 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11754 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11755 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11756 several elements at the top of the stack.
11757 Given a negative argument,
11758 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11759 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11760 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11761 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11762 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11763 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11764 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11765
11766 @kindex @key{LFD}
11767 @pindex calc-over
11768 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11769 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11770 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11771 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11772 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11773 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11774 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11775
11776 @kindex @key{DEL}
11777 @kindex C-d
11778 @pindex calc-pop
11779 @cindex Removing stack entries
11780 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11781 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11782 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11783 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11784 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11785 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11786 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11787 stack is emptied.
11788 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11789 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11790 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11791 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11792 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11793
11794 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11795 @pindex calc-pop-above
11796 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11797 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11798 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11799 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11800 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11801 the third stack element.
11802
11803 @kindex @key{TAB}
11804 @pindex calc-roll-down
11805 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11806 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11807 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11808 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11809 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11810 top-for-bottom.
11811 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11812 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11813 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11814 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11815 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11816
11817 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11818 @pindex calc-roll-up
11819 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11820 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11821 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11822 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11823 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11824 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11825 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11826 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11827
11828 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11829 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11830 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11831 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11832 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11833 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11834 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11835
11836 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11837 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11838 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11839 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @var{n}, also
11840 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11841
11842 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11843 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11844
11845 @kindex C-xC-t
11846 @pindex calc-transpose-lines
11847 @cindex Moving stack entries
11848 The command @kbd{C-x C-t} (@code{calc-transpose-lines}) will transpose
11849 the stack object determined by the point with the stack object at the
11850 next higher level. For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the
11851 stack and the point on the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-x C-t}
11852 creates @samp{10 20 40 30 50}. More generally, @kbd{C-x C-t} acts on
11853 the stack objects determined by the current point (and mark) similar
11854 to how the text-mode command @code{transpose-lines} acts on
11855 lines. With argument @var{n}, @kbd{C-x C-t} will move the stack object
11856 at the level above the current point and move it past N other objects;
11857 for example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack and the point on
11858 the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-u 2 C-x C-t} creates
11859 @samp{10 40 20 30 50}. With an argument of 0, @kbd{C-x C-t} will switch
11860 the stack objects at the levels determined by the point and the mark.
11861
11862 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11863 @section Editing Stack Entries
11864
11865 @noindent
11866 @kindex `
11867 @pindex calc-edit
11868 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11869 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11870 The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11871 (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11872 Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11873 numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11874 at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11875 argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11876
11877 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11878 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11879 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11880 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11881 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11882
11883 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11884 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11885 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11886 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11887 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11888 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11889 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11890
11891 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11892 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11893 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11894 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11895
11896 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11897 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11898 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11899 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11900 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11901 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11902 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11903 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11904 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11905
11906 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11907 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11908 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11909 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11910 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11911
11912 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11913 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11914 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11915
11916 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11917 @section Trail Commands
11918
11919 @noindent
11920 @cindex Trail buffer
11921 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11922 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11923
11924 @kindex t d
11925 @pindex calc-trail-display
11926 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11927 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11928 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11929 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11930 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11931 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11932 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11933 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11934 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11935
11936 @kindex t i
11937 @pindex calc-trail-in
11938 @kindex t o
11939 @pindex calc-trail-out
11940 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11941 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11942 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11943 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11944 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11945 in the Calculator window.
11946
11947 @cindex Trail pointer
11948 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11949 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11950 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11951 trail pointer in various ways.
11952
11953 @kindex t y
11954 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11955 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11956 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11957 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11958 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11959 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11960 trail pointer.
11961
11962 @kindex t <
11963 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11964 @kindex t >
11965 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11966 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11967 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11968 window left or right by one half of its width.
11969
11970 @kindex t n
11971 @pindex calc-trail-next
11972 @kindex t p
11973 @pindex calc-trail-previous
11974 @kindex t f
11975 @pindex calc-trail-forward
11976 @kindex t b
11977 @pindex calc-trail-backward
11978 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11979 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11980 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11981 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11982 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11983 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11984
11985 @kindex t [
11986 @pindex calc-trail-first
11987 @kindex t ]
11988 @pindex calc-trail-last
11989 @kindex t h
11990 @pindex calc-trail-here
11991 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
11992 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
11993 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
11994 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
11995 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
11996
11997 @kindex t s
11998 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
11999 @kindex t r
12000 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12001 @ifnottex
12002 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12003 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12004 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12005 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12006 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12007 it was when the search began.
12008 @end ifnottex
12009 @tex
12010 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12011 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12012 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12013 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12014 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12015 it was when the search began.
12016 @end tex
12017
12018 @kindex t m
12019 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12020 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12021 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12022 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12023 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12024 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12025
12026 @kindex t k
12027 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12028 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12029 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12030 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12031 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12032 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12033
12034 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12035 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12036
12037 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12038 @section Keep Arguments
12039
12040 @noindent
12041 @kindex K
12042 @pindex calc-keep-args
12043 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12044 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12045 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12046 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12047 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12048
12049 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12050 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12051 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12052 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12053 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12054 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12055 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12056 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12057 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12058 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12059 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12060 extra work.
12061
12062 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12063 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12064 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12065
12066 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12067 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12068 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12069 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12070 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12071 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12072
12073 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12074 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12075 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12076 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12077 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12078 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12079
12080 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12081 @chapter Mode Settings
12082
12083 @noindent
12084 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12085 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12086 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12087
12088 @menu
12089 * General Mode Commands::
12090 * Precision::
12091 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12092 * Calculation Modes::
12093 * Simplification Modes::
12094 * Declarations::
12095 * Display Modes::
12096 * Language Modes::
12097 * Modes Variable::
12098 * Calc Mode Line::
12099 @end menu
12100
12101 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12102 @section General Mode Commands
12103
12104 @noindent
12105 @kindex m m
12106 @pindex calc-save-modes
12107 @cindex Continuous memory
12108 @cindex Saving mode settings
12109 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12110 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12111 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12112 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12113 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})
12114 command. This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time
12115 it starts up. The modes saved in the file include everything
12116 controlled by the @kbd{m} and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current
12117 precision and binary word size, whether or not the trail is displayed,
12118 the current height of the Calc window, and more. The current
12119 interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *}) is also saved. If there
12120 were already saved mode settings in the file, they are replaced.
12121 Otherwise, the new mode information is appended to the end of the
12122 file.
12123
12124 @kindex m R
12125 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12126 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12127 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12128 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12129 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12130 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12131 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12132 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12133 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12134
12135 @kindex m F
12136 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12137 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12138 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12139 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12140 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12141 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12142 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12143 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12144 file name is @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12145 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12146 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12147
12148 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12149 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12150 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12151 to reread. You can give
12152 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12153 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12154 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12155 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12156 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12157 modes present in the file you were using before.
12158
12159 @kindex m x
12160 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12161 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12162 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12163 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12164 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12165 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12166 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12167 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12168
12169 @kindex m S
12170 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12171 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12172 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12173 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12174 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12175 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12176 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12177 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12178 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12179 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12180 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12181 shifted-prefix mode.
12182
12183 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12184 @section Precision
12185
12186 @noindent
12187 @kindex p
12188 @pindex calc-precision
12189 @cindex Precision of calculations
12190 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12191 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12192 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12193 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12194 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12195
12196 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12197 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12198
12199 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12200 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12201 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12202 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12203 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12204 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12205 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12206 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12207 existing value to a new precision.
12208
12209 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12210 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12211 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12212 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12213 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12214 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12215 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12216 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12217 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12218 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12219 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12220 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12221 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12222
12223 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12224 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12225 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12226 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12227 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12228 of the numbers involved.
12229
12230 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12231 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12232 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12233 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12234 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12235 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12236
12237 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12238 issues.
12239
12240 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12241 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12242
12243 @noindent
12244 @kindex I
12245 @pindex calc-inverse
12246 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12247 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12248 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12249 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12250 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12251
12252 @kindex H
12253 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12254 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12255 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12256 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12257 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12258 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12259 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12260
12261 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12262 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12263 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12264 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12265
12266 @kindex O
12267 @pindex calc-option
12268 The @kbd{O} key (@code{calc-option}) sets another flag, the
12269 @dfn{Option Flag}, which also can alter the subsequent Calc command in
12270 various ways.
12271
12272 The Inverse, Hyperbolic and Option flags apply only to the next
12273 Calculator command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They
12274 are also cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits
12275 you type after @kbd{I}, @kbd{H} or @kbd{O} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as
12276 prefix arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The
12277 same is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means
12278 to subtract and keep arguments).
12279
12280 Another Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12281 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12282
12283 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12284 @section Calculation Modes
12285
12286 @noindent
12287 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12288 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12289 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12290 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12291
12292 @menu
12293 * Angular Modes::
12294 * Polar Mode::
12295 * Fraction Mode::
12296 * Infinite Mode::
12297 * Symbolic Mode::
12298 * Matrix Mode::
12299 * Automatic Recomputation::
12300 * Working Message::
12301 @end menu
12302
12303 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12304 @subsection Angular Modes
12305
12306 @noindent
12307 @cindex Angular mode
12308 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12309 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12310 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12311 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12312 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12313 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12314
12315 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12316 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12317 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12318 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12319 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12320 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12321 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12322
12323 @kindex m r
12324 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12325 @kindex m d
12326 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12327 @kindex m h
12328 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12329 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12330 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12331 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12332 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12333
12334 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12335 @subsection Polar Mode
12336
12337 @noindent
12338 @cindex Polar mode
12339 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12340 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12341 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12342 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12343 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12344
12345 @kindex m p
12346 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12347 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12348 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12349 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12350
12351 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12352 @subsection Fraction Mode
12353
12354 @noindent
12355 @cindex Fraction mode
12356 @cindex Division of integers
12357 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12358 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12359 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12360 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12361 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12362 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12363 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12364
12365 @kindex m f
12366 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12367 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12368 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12369 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12370 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12371 Float mode.
12372
12373 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12374 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12375 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12376
12377 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12378 @subsection Infinite Mode
12379
12380 @noindent
12381 @cindex Infinite mode
12382 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12383 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12384 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12385 results.
12386
12387 @kindex m i
12388 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12389 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12390 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12391 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12392 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12393 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12394 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12395
12396 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12397 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12398 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12399 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12400 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12401 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12402 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12403 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12404
12405 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12406 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12407 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12408 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12409 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12410 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12411 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12412 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12413 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12414 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12415 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12416
12417 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12418 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12419
12420 @noindent
12421 @cindex Symbolic mode
12422 @cindex Inexact results
12423 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12424 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12425 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12426 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12427 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12428
12429 @kindex m s
12430 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12431 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12432 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12433 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12434 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12435
12436 @kindex N
12437 @pindex calc-eval-num
12438 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12439 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12440 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12441 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12442 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12443 of the command.
12444
12445 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12446 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12447 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12448 variables.)
12449
12450 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12451 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12452
12453 @noindent
12454 @cindex Matrix mode
12455 @cindex Scalar mode
12456 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12457 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12458 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12459 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12460
12461 @kindex m v
12462 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12463 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12464 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12465 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12466 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12467 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12468 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12469 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12470 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12471 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12472 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12473 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12474 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12475 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12476 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12477 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12478 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12479 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12480 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12481
12482 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12483 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12484 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12485 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12486 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12487 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12488 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12489
12490 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12491
12492 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12493 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12494 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12495 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12496 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12497 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12498 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12499
12500 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12501 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12502 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12503 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12504 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12505 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12506
12507 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12508 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12509 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12510 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12511 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12512 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12513 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12514
12515 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12516 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12517 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12518 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12519 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12520 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12521
12522 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12523 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12524
12525 @noindent
12526 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12527 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12528 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12529 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12530
12531 @kindex m C
12532 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12533 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12534 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12535 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12536 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12537 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12538 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12539 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12540 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12541
12542 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12543 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12544 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12545
12546 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12547 @subsection Working Messages
12548
12549 @noindent
12550 @cindex Performance
12551 @cindex Working messages
12552 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12553 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12554 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12555 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12556 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12557 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12558 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12559
12560 @kindex m w
12561 @pindex calc-working
12562 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12563 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12564 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12565 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12566 the current mode.
12567
12568 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12569 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12570 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12571 to turn the messages off.
12572
12573 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12574 @section Simplification Modes
12575
12576 @noindent
12577 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12578 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12579 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12580 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12581 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12582 are done automatically but can be turned off when necessary.
12583
12584 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12585 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12586 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12587 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12588
12589 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12590 followed by a shifted letter.
12591
12592 @kindex m O
12593 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12594 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12595 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12596 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12597 in this mode. Explicit simplification commands, such as @kbd{=} or
12598 @kbd{a s}, can still be given to simplify any formulas.
12599 @xref{Algebraic Definitions}, for a sample use of
12600 No-Simplification mode.
12601
12602
12603 @kindex m N
12604 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12605 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12606 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12607 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12608 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12609 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12610 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12611 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12612 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12613 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12614 elements are constant.
12615
12616 @kindex m I
12617 @pindex calc-basic-simplify-mode
12618 The @kbd{m I} (@code{calc-basic-simplify-mode}) command does some basic
12619 simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12620 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12621 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12622 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12623
12624 @kindex m B
12625 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12626 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the basic
12627 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12628 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12629 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12630 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12631 results (after the basic simplifications) are left alone.
12632
12633 @kindex m A
12634 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12635 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does standard
12636 algebraic simplifications. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12637
12638 @kindex m E
12639 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12640 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended'', or
12641 ``unsafe'', algebraic simplification. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12642
12643 @kindex m U
12644 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12645 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12646 simplification. @xref{Simplification of Units}. These include the
12647 algebraic simplifications, plus variable names which
12648 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12649 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12650
12651 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12652 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12653 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12654 perform higher types of simplifications on demand.
12655 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12656 @section Declarations
12657
12658 @noindent
12659 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12660 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12661 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12662 take the fully general situation into account.
12663
12664 @menu
12665 * Declaration Basics::
12666 * Kinds of Declarations::
12667 * Functions for Declarations::
12668 @end menu
12669
12670 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12671 @subsection Declaration Basics
12672
12673 @noindent
12674 @kindex s d
12675 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12676 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12677 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12678 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12679 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12680 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12681 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12682 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12683
12684 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12685 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12686 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12687 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12688 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12689 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12690 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12691 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12692
12693 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12694 @vindex Decls
12695 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12696 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12697 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12698 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12699 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12700 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12701 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12702 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12703 permanently if you wish.
12704
12705 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12706 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12707 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12708 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12709 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12710
12711 For example, the declaration matrix
12712
12713 @smallexample
12714 @group
12715 [ [ foo, real ]
12716 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12717 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12718 @end group
12719 @end smallexample
12720
12721 @noindent
12722 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12723 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12724 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12725
12726 @vindex All
12727 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12728 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12729 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12730 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12731 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12732 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12733 response to the variable-name prompt.
12734
12735 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12736 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12737
12738 @noindent
12739 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12740 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12741 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12742 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12743 for the variable.
12744
12745 @smallexample
12746 @group
12747 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12748 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12749 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12750 @end group
12751 @end smallexample
12752
12753 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12754 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12755 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12756 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12757 nearly equivalent (see below).
12758
12759 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12760 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12761 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12762 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12763
12764 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12765 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12766 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12767 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12768 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12769 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12770
12771 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12772 stored in a variable:
12773
12774 @table @code
12775 @item int
12776 Integers.
12777 @item numint
12778 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12779 @item frac
12780 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12781 @item rat
12782 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12783 @item float
12784 Floating-point numbers.
12785 @item real
12786 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12787 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12788 reals here.)
12789 @item pos
12790 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12791 @item nonneg
12792 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12793 @item number
12794 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12795 @end table
12796
12797 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12798 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12799 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12800 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12801 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12802 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12803 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12804 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12805 of the formula.
12806
12807 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12808 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12809 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12810 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12811 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12812 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12813
12814 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12815 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12816 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12817 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12818 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12819
12820 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12821 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12822 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12823 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12824 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12825 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12826
12827 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12828 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12829 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12830 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12831 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12832 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12833 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12834 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12835 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12836 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12837
12838 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12839 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12840
12841 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12842 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12843 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12844 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12845 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12846 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12847 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12848
12849 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12850 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12851 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12852 type symbol.
12853
12854 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12855 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12856 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12857 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12858 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12859
12860 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12861 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12862 shown above).
12863
12864 Calc's algebraic simplifications also make use of declarations when
12865 simplifying equations and inequalities. They will cancel @code{x}
12866 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12867 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12868 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12869 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12870 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12871 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12872 including canceling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12873 not known to be nonzero.
12874
12875 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12876
12877 @table @code
12878 @item scalar
12879 The value is not a vector.
12880 @item vector
12881 The value is a vector.
12882 @item matrix
12883 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12884 @item sqmatrix
12885 The value is a square matrix.
12886 @end table
12887
12888 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12889 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12890 is a matrix of integers.
12891
12892 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12893 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12894 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12895 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12896 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12897 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12898 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12899 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12900 declarations.)
12901
12902 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12903 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12904 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12905
12906 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12907 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12908
12909 @table @code
12910 @item const
12911 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12912 @end table
12913
12914 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12915 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12916 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12917 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12918 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12919 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12920 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12921 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12922 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12923 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12924
12925 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12926 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12927
12928 @noindent
12929 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12930 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12931 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12932 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12933 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12934 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12935 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12936 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12937 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12938
12939 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12940 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12941 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12942 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12943 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12944
12945 @ignore
12946 @starindex
12947 @end ignore
12948 @tindex dint
12949 @ignore
12950 @starindex
12951 @end ignore
12952 @tindex dnumint
12953 @ignore
12954 @starindex
12955 @end ignore
12956 @tindex dnatnum
12957 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12958 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12959 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12960 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12961 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12962 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12963 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12964 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12965
12966 @ignore
12967 @starindex
12968 @end ignore
12969 @tindex drat
12970 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12971 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12972 and error forms do not.
12973
12974 @ignore
12975 @starindex
12976 @end ignore
12977 @tindex dreal
12978 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12979 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12980
12981 @ignore
12982 @starindex
12983 @end ignore
12984 @tindex dimag
12985 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
12986 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
12987
12988 @ignore
12989 @starindex
12990 @end ignore
12991 @tindex dpos
12992 @ignore
12993 @starindex
12994 @end ignore
12995 @tindex dneg
12996 @ignore
12997 @starindex
12998 @end ignore
12999 @tindex dnonneg
13000 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13001 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13002 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13003 equal to zero. Note that Calc's algebraic simplifications, which are
13004 effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules, can simplify
13005 an expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}.
13006 So the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13007 are rarely necessary.
13008
13009 @ignore
13010 @starindex
13011 @end ignore
13012 @tindex dnonzero
13013 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13014 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13015 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13016 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13017 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13018 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13019 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13020
13021 @ignore
13022 @starindex
13023 @end ignore
13024 @tindex deven
13025 @ignore
13026 @starindex
13027 @end ignore
13028 @tindex dodd
13029 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13030 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13031 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13032 Calc's algebraic simplifications use this to simplify a test of the form
13033 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13034
13035 @ignore
13036 @starindex
13037 @end ignore
13038 @tindex drange
13039 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13040 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13041 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13042 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13043 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13044 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13045 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13046 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13047 remains unevaluated.
13048
13049 @ignore
13050 @starindex
13051 @end ignore
13052 @tindex dscalar
13053 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13054 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13055 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13056 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13057 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13058 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13059 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13060 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13061 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13062 information to tell.
13063
13064 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13065 @section Display Modes
13066
13067 @noindent
13068 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13069 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13070 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13071 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13072 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13073 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13074
13075 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13076 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13077 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13078 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13079 reflect the latest mode settings.
13080
13081 @kindex d @key{RET}
13082 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13083 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13084 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13085 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13086 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13087 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13088 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13089 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13090
13091 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13092 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13093 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13094 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13095
13096 @menu
13097 * Radix Modes::
13098 * Grouping Digits::
13099 * Float Formats::
13100 * Complex Formats::
13101 * Fraction Formats::
13102 * HMS Formats::
13103 * Date Formats::
13104 * Truncating the Stack::
13105 * Justification::
13106 * Labels::
13107 @end menu
13108
13109 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13110 @subsection Radix Modes
13111
13112 @noindent
13113 @cindex Radix display
13114 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13115 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13116 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13117 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13118 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13119 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13120 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13121
13122 @kindex d 2
13123 @kindex d 8
13124 @kindex d 6
13125 @kindex d 0
13126 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13127 @cindex Octal integers
13128 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13129 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13130 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13131 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13132 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13133 as decimal.
13134
13135 @kindex d r
13136 @pindex calc-radix
13137 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13138 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13139 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13140
13141 @kindex d z
13142 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13143 @cindex Leading zeros
13144 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13145 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13146 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13147 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13148 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13149 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13150 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13151 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13152 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13153 entirety.)
13154
13155 @cindex Two's complements
13156 Calc can display @expr{w}-bit integers using two's complement
13157 notation, although this is most useful with the binary, octal and
13158 hexadecimal display modes. This option is selected by using the
13159 @kbd{O} option prefix before setting the display radix, and a negative word
13160 size might be appropriate (@pxref{Binary Functions}). In two's
13161 complement notation, the integers in the (nearly) symmetric interval
13162 from
13163 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13164 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13165 to
13166 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13167 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13168 are represented by the integers from @expr{0} to @expr{2^w-1}:
13169 the integers from @expr{0} to
13170 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13171 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13172 are represented by themselves and the integers from
13173 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13174 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13175 to @expr{-1} are represented by the integers from
13176 @texline @math{2^{w-1}}
13177 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)}
13178 to @expr{2^w-1} (the integer @expr{k} is represented by @expr{k+2^w}).
13179 Calc will display a two's complement integer by the radix (either
13180 @expr{2}, @expr{8} or @expr{16}), two @kbd{#} symbols, and then its
13181 representation (including any leading zeros necessary to include all
13182 @expr{w} bits). In a two's complement display mode, numbers that
13183 are not displayed in two's complement notation (i.e., that aren't
13184 integers from
13185 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13186 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13187 to
13188 @c (
13189 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1})
13190 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1})
13191 will be represented using Calc's usual notation (in the appropriate
13192 radix).
13193
13194 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13195 @subsection Grouping Digits
13196
13197 @noindent
13198 @kindex d g
13199 @pindex calc-group-digits
13200 @cindex Grouping digits
13201 @cindex Digit grouping
13202 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13203 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13204 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13205 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13206 separated by commas.
13207
13208 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13209 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13210 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13211 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13212 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13213 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13214 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13215
13216 @kindex d ,
13217 @pindex calc-group-char
13218 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13219 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13220 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13221 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13222 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13223 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13224 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13225
13226 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13227 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13228 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13229 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13230 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13231
13232 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13233 @subsection Float Formats
13234
13235 @noindent
13236 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13237 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13238 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13239 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13240 formats for floats.
13241
13242 @kindex d n
13243 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13244 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13245 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13246 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13247 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13248 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13249 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13250 current precision is 12.)
13251
13252 @kindex d f
13253 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13254 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13255 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13256 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13257 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13258 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13259 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13260 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13261
13262 @kindex d s
13263 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13264 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13265 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13266 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13267 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13268 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13269 The default is to display all significant digits.
13270
13271 @kindex d e
13272 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13273 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13274 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13275 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13276 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13277 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13278 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13279
13280 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13281 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13282 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13283 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13284 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13285 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13286 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13287 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13288 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13289
13290 @kindex d .
13291 @pindex calc-point-char
13292 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13293 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13294 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13295 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13296 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13297
13298 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13299 @subsection Complex Formats
13300
13301 @noindent
13302 @kindex d c
13303 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13304 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13305 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13306 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13307 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13308
13309 @kindex d i
13310 @pindex calc-i-notation
13311 @kindex d j
13312 @pindex calc-j-notation
13313 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13314 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13315 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13316 in some disciplines.
13317
13318 @cindex @code{i} variable
13319 @vindex i
13320 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13321 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13322 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13323 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13324 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13325 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13326 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13327 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13328
13329 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13330 @subsection Fraction Formats
13331
13332 @noindent
13333 @kindex d o
13334 @pindex calc-over-notation
13335 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13336 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13337 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13338 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13339 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13340 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13341 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13342 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13343
13344 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13345 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13346 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13347 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13348 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13349
13350 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13351 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13352 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13353 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13354 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13355 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13356 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13357 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13358 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13359 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13360 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13361
13362 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13363 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13364 never affects floats.
13365
13366 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13367 @subsection HMS Formats
13368
13369 @noindent
13370 @kindex d h
13371 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13372 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13373 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13374 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13375 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13376 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13377 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13378 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13379
13380 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13381 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13382 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13383 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13384 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13385 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13386 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13387 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13388 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13389 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13390 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13391 entry.
13392
13393 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13394 @subsection Date Formats
13395
13396 @noindent
13397 @kindex d d
13398 @pindex calc-date-notation
13399 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13400 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13401 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13402 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13403 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13404 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13405 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13406 pure dates.
13407
13408 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13409 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13410 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13411 reestablished.
13412
13413 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13414 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13415 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13416
13417 @menu
13418 * ISO 8601::
13419 * Date Formatting Codes::
13420 * Free-Form Dates::
13421 * Standard Date Formats::
13422 @end menu
13423
13424 @node ISO 8601, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats, Date Formats
13425 @subsubsection ISO 8601
13426
13427 @noindent
13428 @cindex ISO 8601
13429 The same date can be written down in different formats and Calc tries
13430 to allow you to choose your preferred format. Some common formats are
13431 ambiguous, however; for example, 10/11/2012 means October 11,
13432 2012 in the United States but it means November 10, 2012 in
13433 Europe. To help avoid such ambiguities, the International Organization
13434 for Standardization (ISO) provides the ISO 8601 standard, which
13435 provides three different but easily distinguishable and unambiguous
13436 ways to represent a date.
13437
13438 The ISO 8601 calendar date representation is
13439
13440 @example
13441 @var{YYYY}-@var{MM}-@var{DD}
13442 @end example
13443
13444 @noindent
13445 where @var{YYYY} is the four digit year, @var{MM} is the two-digit month
13446 number (01 for January to 12 for December), and @var{DD} is the
13447 two-digit day of the month (01 to 31). (Note that @var{YYYY} does not
13448 correspond to Calc's date formatting code, which will be introduced
13449 later.) The year, which should be padded with zeros to ensure it has at
13450 least four digits, is the Gregorian year, except that the year before
13451 0001 (1 AD) is the year 0000 (1 BC). The date October 11, 2012 is
13452 written 2012-10-11 in this representation and November 10, 2012 is
13453 written 2012-11-10.
13454
13455 The ISO 8601 ordinal date representation is
13456
13457 @example
13458 @var{YYYY}-@var{DDD}
13459 @end example
13460
13461 @noindent
13462 where @var{YYYY} is the year, as above, and @var{DDD} is the day of the year.
13463 The date December 31, 2011 is written 2011-365 in this representation
13464 and January 1, 2012 is written 2012-001.
13465
13466 The ISO 8601 week date representation is
13467
13468 @example
13469 @var{YYYY}-W@var{ww}-@var{D}
13470 @end example
13471
13472 @noindent
13473 where @var{YYYY} is the ISO week-numbering year, @var{ww} is the two
13474 digit week number (preceded by a literal ``W''), and @var{D} is the day
13475 of the week (1 for Monday through 7 for Sunday). The ISO week-numbering
13476 year is based on the Gregorian year but can differ slightly. The first
13477 week of an ISO week-numbering year is the week with the Gregorian year's
13478 first Thursday in it (equivalently, the week containing January 4);
13479 any day of that week (Monday through Sunday) is part of the same ISO
13480 week-numbering year, any day from the previous week is part of the
13481 previous year. For example, January 4, 2013 is on a Friday, and so
13482 the first week for the ISO week-numbering year 2013 starts on
13483 Monday, December 31, 2012. The day December 31, 2012 is then part of the
13484 Gregorian year 2012 but ISO week-numbering year 2013. In the week
13485 date representation, this week goes from 2013-W01-1 (December 31,
13486 2012) to 2013-W01-7 (January 6, 2013).
13487
13488 All three ISO 8601 representations arrange the numbers from most
13489 significant to least significant; as well as being unambiguous
13490 representations, they are easy to sort since chronological order in
13491 this formats corresponds to lexicographical order. The hyphens are
13492 sometimes omitted.
13493
13494 The ISO 8601 standard uses a 24 hour clock; a particular time is
13495 represented by @var{hh}:@var{mm}:@var{ss} where @var{hh} is the
13496 two-digit hour (from 00 to 24), @var{mm} is the two-digit minute (from
13497 00 to 59) and @var{ss} is the two-digit second. The seconds or minutes
13498 and seconds can be omitted, and decimals can be added. If a date with a
13499 time is represented, they should be separated by a literal ``T'', so noon
13500 on December 13, 2012 can be represented as 2012-12-13T12:00.
13501
13502 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, ISO 8601, Date Formats
13503 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13504
13505 @noindent
13506 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13507 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13508 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13509 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13510 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13511 below.
13512
13513 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13514 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13515 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13516 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13517 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13518 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13519 since Dec 31, 1 BC@. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13520 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13521
13522 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13523
13524 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13525 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13526 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13527 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13528 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13529
13530 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13531
13532 @table @asis
13533 @item Y
13534 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13535 @item YY
13536 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13537 @item BY
13538 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13539 @item YYY
13540 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13541 @item YYYY
13542 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13543 @item ZYYY
13544 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``0023'' for 23 AD, ``0000'' for 1 BC.
13545 @item IYYY
13546 Year: ISO 8601 week-numbering year.
13547 @item aa
13548 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13549 @item AA
13550 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13551 @item aaa
13552 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13553 @item AAA
13554 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13555 @item aaaa
13556 Year: ``a.d.@:'' or blank.
13557 @item AAAA
13558 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13559 @item bb
13560 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13561 @item BB
13562 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13563 @item bbb
13564 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13565 @item BBB
13566 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13567 @item bbbb
13568 Year: ``b.c.@:'' or blank.
13569 @item BBBB
13570 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13571 @item M
13572 Month: ``8'' for August.
13573 @item MM
13574 Month: ``08'' for August.
13575 @item BM
13576 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13577 @item MMM
13578 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13579 @item Mmm
13580 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13581 @item mmm
13582 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13583 @item MMMM
13584 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13585 @item Mmmm
13586 Month: ``August'' for August.
13587 @item D
13588 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13589 @item DD
13590 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13591 @item BD
13592 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13593 @item W
13594 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13595 @item w
13596 Weekday: ``1'' for Monday, ``7'' for Sunday.
13597 @item WWW
13598 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13599 @item Www
13600 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13601 @item www
13602 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13603 @item WWWW
13604 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13605 @item Wwww
13606 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13607 @item Iww
13608 Week number: ISO 8601 week number, ``W01'' for week 1.
13609 @item d
13610 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13611 @item ddd
13612 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13613 @item bdd
13614 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13615 @item T
13616 Letter: Literal ``T''.
13617 @item h
13618 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13619 @item hh
13620 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13621 @item bh
13622 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13623 @item H
13624 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13625 @item HH
13626 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13627 @item BH
13628 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13629 @item p
13630 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13631 @item P
13632 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13633 @item pp
13634 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13635 @item PP
13636 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13637 @item pppp
13638 AM/PM: ``a.m.@:'' or ``p.m.''.
13639 @item PPPP
13640 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13641 @item m
13642 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13643 @item mm
13644 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13645 @item bm
13646 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13647 @item s
13648 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13649 @item ss
13650 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13651 @item bs
13652 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13653 @item SS
13654 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13655 @item BS
13656 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13657 @item N
13658 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13659 @item n
13660 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13661 @item J
13662 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13663 @item j
13664 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13665 @item U
13666 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13667 @item X
13668 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13669 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13670 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13671 required for algebraic entry.
13672 @end table
13673
13674 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13675 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13676
13677 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13678 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13679 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13680 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13681 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13682
13683 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13684 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13685 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13686 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13687 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13688
13689 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13690 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13691 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13692
13693 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13694 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13695
13696 @noindent
13697 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13698 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13699 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13700 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13701 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13702
13703 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13704 while interpreting dates.
13705
13706 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13707 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13708 the date.
13709
13710 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13711 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13712 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13713 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13714 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13715 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13716 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13717 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13718 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13719 recognized with no number attached. Midnight will represent the
13720 beginning of a day.
13721
13722 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13723 format.
13724
13725 When reading the date portion, Calc first checks to see if it is an
13726 ISO 8601 week-numbering date; if the string contains an integer
13727 representing the year, a ``W'' followed by two digits for the week
13728 number, and an integer from 1 to 7 representing the weekday (in that
13729 order), then all other characters are ignored and this information
13730 determines the date. Otherwise, all words and numbers are isolated
13731 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must be
13732 either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which are
13733 ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13734 abbreviations.
13735
13736 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13737 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13738 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13739 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13740 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13741 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13742 current year is taken from the system clock.
13743
13744 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13745 words, then the input is rejected.
13746
13747 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13748 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13749 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13750 date components when the date was formatted.
13751
13752 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13753 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13754 minus sign on the year value.
13755
13756 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13757 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13758
13759 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13760 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13761
13762 @noindent
13763 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13764 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13765 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13766 to select the other formats.
13767
13768 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13769 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13770 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13771 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13772 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13773 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13774
13775 @table @asis
13776 @item 0
13777 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13778 @item 1
13779 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13780 @item 2
13781 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13782 @item 3
13783 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13784 @item 4
13785 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13786 @item 5
13787 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13788 @item 6
13789 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13790 @item 7
13791 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13792 @item 8
13793 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13794 @item 9
13795 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13796 @item 10
13797 @samp{ZYYY-MM-DD Www< hh:mm>} (Org mode format)
13798 @item 11
13799 @samp{IYYY-Iww-w<Thh:mm:ss>} (ISO 8601 week numbering format)
13800 @end table
13801
13802 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13803 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13804
13805 @noindent
13806 @kindex d t
13807 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13808 @cindex Truncating the stack
13809 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13810 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13811 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13812 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13813 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13814 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13815 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13816 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13817 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13818 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13819 the stack.
13820
13821 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13822 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13823 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13824 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13825 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13826 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13827 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13828
13829 @kindex d [
13830 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13831 @kindex d ]
13832 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13833 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13834 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13835 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13836
13837 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13838 @subsection Justification
13839
13840 @noindent
13841 @kindex d <
13842 @pindex calc-left-justify
13843 @kindex d =
13844 @pindex calc-center-justify
13845 @kindex d >
13846 @pindex calc-right-justify
13847 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13848 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13849 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13850 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13851 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13852 window.
13853
13854 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13855 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13856 text.
13857
13858 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13859 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13860 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13861
13862 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13863 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13864 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13865 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13866 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13867 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13868 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13869 mode.
13870
13871 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13872 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13873 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13874 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13875 line is indented to the origin.
13876
13877 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13878 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13879 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13880 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13881 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13882 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13883
13884 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13885 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13886 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13887 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13888 line width or Calc window width is used.
13889
13890 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13891 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13892 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13893 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13894 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13895 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13896 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13897
13898 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13899 @subsection Labels
13900
13901 @noindent
13902 @kindex d @{
13903 @pindex calc-left-label
13904 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13905 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13906 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13907 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13908 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13909 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13910 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13911
13912 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13913
13914 @kindex d @}
13915 @pindex calc-right-label
13916 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13917 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13918 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13919 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13920 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13921 justified to the line width.
13922
13923 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13924 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13925 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13926 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13927 left or right as you prefer.
13928
13929 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13930 @section Language Modes
13931
13932 @noindent
13933 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13934 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13935 other common language such as Pascal or @LaTeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13936 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13937 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13938 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13939
13940 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13941 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13942 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13943 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13944
13945 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13946 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13947 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13948 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13949 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13950 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13951 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13952 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13953
13954 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13955 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13956 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13957 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13958 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13959
13960 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a @LaTeX{}
13961 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13962 formula from the program in C mode, switch to @LaTeX{} mode, and yank the
13963 formula into the document in @LaTeX{} math-mode format.
13964
13965 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13966 shifted letter key.
13967
13968 @menu
13969 * Normal Language Modes::
13970 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13971 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13972 * Eqn Language Mode::
13973 * Yacas Language Mode::
13974 * Maxima Language Mode::
13975 * Giac Language Mode::
13976 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13977 * Maple Language Mode::
13978 * Compositions::
13979 * Syntax Tables::
13980 @end menu
13981
13982 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13983 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13984
13985 @noindent
13986 @kindex d N
13987 @pindex calc-normal-language
13988 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13989 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13990 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13991 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13992 keyboard.
13993
13994 @kindex d O
13995 @pindex calc-flat-language
13996 @cindex Matrix display
13997 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13998 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13999 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
14000 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
14001
14002 @kindex d b
14003 @pindex calc-line-breaking
14004 @cindex Line breaking
14005 @cindex Breaking up long lines
14006 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
14007 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
14008 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
14009 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
14010 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
14011 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
14012 long lines.
14013
14014 @kindex d B
14015 @pindex calc-big-language
14016 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
14017 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
14018 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
14019
14020 @example
14021 ____________
14022 | a + 1 2
14023 | ----- + c
14024 \| b
14025 @end example
14026
14027 @noindent
14028 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
14029
14030 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
14031 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
14032 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
14033 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
14034 notation.
14035
14036 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
14037
14038 @example
14039 3
14040 - -
14041 4
14042 @end example
14043
14044 @noindent
14045 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
14046 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
14047 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
14048 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
14049 typical use.
14050
14051 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
14052 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
14053 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
14054 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
14055 in Big mode.
14056
14057 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
14058 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
14059 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
14060 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
14061 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
14062
14063 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
14064 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
14065 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
14066 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
14067
14068 @kindex d U
14069 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
14070 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
14071 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
14072 shown above would be displayed:
14073
14074 @example
14075 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
14076 @end example
14077
14078 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
14079 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
14080 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
14081 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
14082 parentheses).
14083
14084 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
14085 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
14086
14087 @noindent
14088 @kindex d C
14089 @pindex calc-c-language
14090 @cindex C language
14091 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
14092 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
14093 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
14094 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
14095 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
14096 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
14097 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
14098
14099 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
14100 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
14101 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
14102 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
14103 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
14104 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
14105 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
14106
14107 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
14108 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
14109 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
14110 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
14111 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14112 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14113 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14114 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14115
14116 @kindex d P
14117 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14118 @cindex Pascal language
14119 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14120 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14121 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14122 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14123 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14124 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
14125 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14126 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14127 of handling these in Pascal.
14128
14129 @kindex d F
14130 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14131 @cindex FORTRAN language
14132 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14133 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14134 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14135 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14136 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14137 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14138 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14139 If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14140 @code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
14141 parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
14142 matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
14143 Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
14144 unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
14145 actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14146 function!).
14147
14148 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14149 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14150 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14151
14152 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14153 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14154 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14155 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14156 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14157 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14158
14159 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14160 @subsection @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} Language Modes
14161
14162 @noindent
14163 @kindex d T
14164 @pindex calc-tex-language
14165 @cindex TeX language
14166 @kindex d L
14167 @pindex calc-latex-language
14168 @cindex LaTeX language
14169 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14170 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14171 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14172 conventions of ``math mode'' in @LaTeX{}, a typesetting language that
14173 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's @LaTeX{} language mode can
14174 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although @LaTeX{}
14175 mode may display it differently.
14176
14177 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14178 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14179 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14180 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14181 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in @LaTeX{} mode.
14182 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14183 @LaTeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14184 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14185 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14186
14187 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14188 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14189 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in
14190 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14191 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14192 @code{\binom} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14193 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14194 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14195 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14196 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14197 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14198 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14199 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14200
14201 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14202 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14203 and @LaTeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14204 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14205 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14206 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14207 printed result is
14208 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14209 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14210 but
14211 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14212 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14213
14214 The @TeX{} specific unit names (@pxref{Predefined Units}) will not use
14215 the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
14216 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example.
14217
14218 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14219 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14220 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14221 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14222 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14223 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14224 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14225 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in @LaTeX{} mode. The
14226 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14227 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14228 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14229 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14230 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14231 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14232 any @TeX{} mode.)
14233
14234 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14235 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14236 @code{\bmatrix}. In @LaTeX{} mode this also applies to
14237 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14238 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14239 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14240 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14241 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14242 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14243 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14244 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14245 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14246 @LaTeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14247 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14248 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14249 form, such as
14250
14251 @example
14252 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14253 a & b \\
14254 c & d
14255 \end@{pmatrix@}
14256 @end example
14257
14258 @noindent
14259 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14260 expressions being displayed like
14261
14262 @example
14263 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14264 a & b \\
14265 c & d
14266 \end@{pmatrix@}
14267 @end example
14268
14269 @noindent
14270 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect @LaTeX{}.
14271 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14272
14273 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14274 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14275 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14276 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14277 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14278 in Calc, @TeX{}, @LaTeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14279
14280 @ignore
14281 @iftex
14282 @begingroup
14283 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14284 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14285 @end iftex
14286 @starindex
14287 @end ignore
14288 @tindex acute
14289 @ignore
14290 @starindex
14291 @end ignore
14292 @tindex Acute
14293 @ignore
14294 @starindex
14295 @end ignore
14296 @tindex bar
14297 @ignore
14298 @starindex
14299 @end ignore
14300 @tindex Bar
14301 @ignore
14302 @starindex
14303 @end ignore
14304 @tindex breve
14305 @ignore
14306 @starindex
14307 @end ignore
14308 @tindex Breve
14309 @ignore
14310 @starindex
14311 @end ignore
14312 @tindex check
14313 @ignore
14314 @starindex
14315 @end ignore
14316 @tindex Check
14317 @ignore
14318 @starindex
14319 @end ignore
14320 @tindex dddot
14321 @ignore
14322 @starindex
14323 @end ignore
14324 @tindex ddddot
14325 @ignore
14326 @starindex
14327 @end ignore
14328 @tindex dot
14329 @ignore
14330 @starindex
14331 @end ignore
14332 @tindex Dot
14333 @ignore
14334 @starindex
14335 @end ignore
14336 @tindex dotdot
14337 @ignore
14338 @starindex
14339 @end ignore
14340 @tindex DotDot
14341 @ignore
14342 @starindex
14343 @end ignore
14344 @tindex dyad
14345 @ignore
14346 @starindex
14347 @end ignore
14348 @tindex grave
14349 @ignore
14350 @starindex
14351 @end ignore
14352 @tindex Grave
14353 @ignore
14354 @starindex
14355 @end ignore
14356 @tindex hat
14357 @ignore
14358 @starindex
14359 @end ignore
14360 @tindex Hat
14361 @ignore
14362 @starindex
14363 @end ignore
14364 @tindex Prime
14365 @ignore
14366 @starindex
14367 @end ignore
14368 @tindex tilde
14369 @ignore
14370 @starindex
14371 @end ignore
14372 @tindex Tilde
14373 @ignore
14374 @starindex
14375 @end ignore
14376 @tindex under
14377 @ignore
14378 @starindex
14379 @end ignore
14380 @tindex Vec
14381 @ignore
14382 @starindex
14383 @end ignore
14384 @tindex VEC
14385 @ignore
14386 @iftex
14387 @endgroup
14388 @end iftex
14389 @end ignore
14390 @example
14391 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14392 ---- --- ----- ---
14393 acute \acute \acute
14394 Acute \Acute
14395 bar \bar \bar bar
14396 Bar \Bar
14397 breve \breve \breve
14398 Breve \Breve
14399 check \check \check
14400 Check \Check
14401 dddot \dddot
14402 ddddot \ddddot
14403 dot \dot \dot dot
14404 Dot \Dot
14405 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14406 DotDot \Ddot
14407 dyad dyad
14408 grave \grave \grave
14409 Grave \Grave
14410 hat \hat \hat hat
14411 Hat \Hat
14412 Prime prime
14413 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14414 Tilde \Tilde
14415 under \underline \underline under
14416 Vec \vec \vec vec
14417 VEC \Vec
14418 @end example
14419
14420 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14421 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14422 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14423 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14424 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14425 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14426 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14427 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14428
14429 @example
14430 \def\evalto@{@}
14431 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14432 @end example
14433
14434 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14435 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14436 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14437 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14438 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14439 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14440
14441 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14442 reading is:
14443
14444 @example
14445 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14446 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14447 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14448 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14449 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14450 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14451 \evalto
14452 @end example
14453
14454 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14455 @LaTeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14456 font information.
14457
14458 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14459 the same as @samp{*}.
14460
14461 @ifnottex
14462 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14463 end of this section.
14464 @end ifnottex
14465 @iftex
14466 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14467
14468 @example
14469 @group
14470 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14471 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14472 @end group
14473 @end example
14474 @tex
14475 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14476 @end tex
14477 @sp 1
14478
14479 @example
14480 @group
14481 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14482 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14483 @end group
14484 @end example
14485 @tex
14486 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14487 @end tex
14488 @sp 1
14489
14490 @example
14491 @group
14492 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14493 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14494 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14495 @end group
14496 @end example
14497 @tex
14498 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14499 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14500 @end tex
14501 @sp 1
14502
14503 @example
14504 @group
14505 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14506 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14507 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14508 @end group
14509 @end example
14510 @tex
14511 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14512 @end tex
14513 @sp 2
14514
14515 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14516 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14517 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14518
14519 @example
14520 @group
14521 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14522 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14523 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14524 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14525 @end group
14526 @end example
14527 @tex
14528 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14529 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14530 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14531 @end tex
14532 @sp 2
14533
14534 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14535
14536 @example
14537 @group
14538 2 + 3 => 5
14539 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14540 @end group
14541 @end example
14542 @tex
14543 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14544 $$ 5 $$
14545 @end tex
14546 @sp 2
14547
14548 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14549
14550 @example
14551 @group
14552 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14553 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14554 @end group
14555 @end example
14556 @tex
14557 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14558 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14559 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14560 @end tex
14561 @sp 2
14562
14563 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14564
14565 @example
14566 @group
14567 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14568 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14569 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14570 @end group
14571 @end example
14572 @tex
14573 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14574 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14575 @end tex
14576 @sp 2
14577 @end iftex
14578
14579 @node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14580 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14581
14582 @noindent
14583 @kindex d E
14584 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14585 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14586 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14587 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14588 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14589
14590 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14591 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14592 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14593 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14594 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14595 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14596
14597 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14598 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14599 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14600 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14601 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14602 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14603 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14604
14605 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14606 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14607 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14608 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14609 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14610 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14611 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14612 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14613 names, too.)
14614
14615 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14616 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14617 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14618 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14619 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14620
14621 As in @LaTeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14622 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14623 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14624 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14625
14626 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14627 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14628 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14629 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14630 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14631 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14632 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14633
14634 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14635 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14636 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14637 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14638 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14639 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14640 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14641 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14642
14643 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14644 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14645 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14646 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14647 recognized for these operators during reading.
14648
14649 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14650 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14651 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14652 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14653 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14654
14655 @node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14656 @subsection Yacas Language Mode
14657
14658 @noindent
14659 @kindex d Y
14660 @pindex calc-yacas-language
14661 @cindex Yacas language
14662 The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14663 conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14664 operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14665 of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14666 @samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14667 in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14668 mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14669 The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14670 @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14671 represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14672 represents @code{nan}.
14673
14674 Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14675 and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14676 example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14677 @w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14678
14679 Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14680 are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14681 use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14682 @samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14683
14684
14685 @node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14686 @subsection Maxima Language Mode
14687
14688 @noindent
14689 @kindex d X
14690 @pindex calc-maxima-language
14691 @cindex Maxima language
14692 The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14693 conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14694 function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14695 For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14696 @samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14697 standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14698 @code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14699 the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14700
14701 Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14702 variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14703 the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14704 @samp{o'o}.
14705
14706 Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14707 written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14708 the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14709
14710 @node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14711 @subsection Giac Language Mode
14712
14713 @noindent
14714 @kindex d A
14715 @pindex calc-giac-language
14716 @cindex Giac language
14717 The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14718 conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14719 names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14720 @samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14721 in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14722 and @code{uinf}.
14723
14724 Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14725 Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
14726 0, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14727 @samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14728 @samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14729
14730 The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14731 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14732 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14733 the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14734
14735 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
14736 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14737
14738 @noindent
14739 @kindex d M
14740 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14741 @cindex Mathematica language
14742 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14743 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14744 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14745 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14746 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14747 Mathematica mode.
14748
14749 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14750 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14751 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14752 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14753 Mathematica mode.
14754 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14755 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14756 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14757
14758 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14759 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14760
14761 @noindent
14762 @kindex d W
14763 @pindex calc-maple-language
14764 @cindex Maple language
14765 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14766 conventions of Maple.
14767
14768 Maple's language is much like C@. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14769 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14770 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14771 denote powers.
14772
14773 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14774 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14775 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14776 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14777 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14778 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14779
14780 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14781 notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
14782
14783 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14784 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14785 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14786 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14787
14788 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14789 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14790 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14791
14792 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14793 @subsection Compositions
14794
14795 @noindent
14796 @cindex Compositions
14797 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14798 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14799 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14800 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14801 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14802
14803 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14804 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14805 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14806 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14807 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14808 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14809 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14810 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14811
14812 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14813 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14814 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14815 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14816 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14817 the language modes.
14818
14819 @menu
14820 * Composition Basics::
14821 * Horizontal Compositions::
14822 * Vertical Compositions::
14823 * Other Compositions::
14824 * Information about Compositions::
14825 * User-Defined Compositions::
14826 @end menu
14827
14828 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14829 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14830
14831 @noindent
14832 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14833 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14834 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14835 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14836 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14837 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14838 For example, in the Big mode formula
14839
14840 @example
14841 @group
14842 2
14843 a + b
14844 17 + ------
14845 c
14846 @end group
14847 @end example
14848
14849 @noindent
14850 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14851 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14852 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14853
14854 @tex
14855 \bigskip
14856 @end tex
14857
14858 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14859 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14860 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14861 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14862 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14863
14864 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14865 following precedences:
14866
14867 @example
14868 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14869 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14870 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14871 mod 400
14872 +/- 300
14873 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14874 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14875 ^ 200
14876 - 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14877 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14878 / % \ 190
14879 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14880 | 170
14881 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14882 && 110
14883 || 100
14884 ? : 90
14885 !!! 85
14886 &&& 80
14887 ||| 75
14888 := 50
14889 :: 45
14890 => 40
14891 @end example
14892
14893 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14894 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14895 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14896 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14897 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14898 normally never get additional parentheses).
14899
14900 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14901 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14902 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14903 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14904 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14905 with one-higher precedence.
14906
14907 @ignore
14908 @starindex
14909 @end ignore
14910 @tindex cprec
14911 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14912 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14913 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14914 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14915 precedence than multiplication).
14916
14917 @tex
14918 \bigskip
14919 @end tex
14920
14921 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14922 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14923 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14924 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14925 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14926 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14927 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14928 view them.
14929
14930 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14931 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14932 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14933 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14934 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14935 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14936 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14937 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14938 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14939
14940 @example
14941 @group
14942 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14943 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14944 @end group
14945 @end example
14946
14947 @noindent
14948 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14949 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14950 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14951 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14952 itself been too large to fit.
14953
14954 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14955 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14956 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14957 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14958 end of the string.
14959
14960 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14961 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14962 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14963 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14964 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14965 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14966 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14967 object.
14968
14969 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14970 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14971
14972 @noindent
14973 @ignore
14974 @starindex
14975 @end ignore
14976 @tindex choriz
14977 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14978 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14979 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14980
14981 @example
14982 @group
14983 a b
14984 17---d
14985 c
14986 @end group
14987 @end example
14988
14989 @noindent
14990 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14991 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14992 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14993 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14994 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14995 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14996
14997 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14998 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14999 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
15000 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
15001 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
15002 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
15003
15004 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
15005 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
15006 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
15007 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
15008 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
15009
15010 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
15011 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
15012
15013 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
15014 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
15015
15016 @noindent
15017 @ignore
15018 @starindex
15019 @end ignore
15020 @tindex cvert
15021 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
15022 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
15023 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
15024 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
15025 formats in Big mode as
15026
15027 @example
15028 @group
15029 f( a , 2 )
15030 bb a + 1
15031 ccc 2
15032 b
15033 @end group
15034 @end example
15035
15036 @ignore
15037 @starindex
15038 @end ignore
15039 @tindex cbase
15040 There are several special composition functions that work only as
15041 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
15042 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
15043 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
15044 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
15045 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
15046
15047 @example
15048 @group
15049 2
15050 a + 1
15051 a 2
15052 f(bb , b )
15053 ccc
15054 @end group
15055 @end example
15056
15057 @ignore
15058 @starindex
15059 @end ignore
15060 @tindex ctbase
15061 @ignore
15062 @starindex
15063 @end ignore
15064 @tindex cbbase
15065 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
15066 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
15067 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
15068 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
15069 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
15070
15071 @example
15072 @group
15073 a
15074 a -
15075 - + a + b
15076 b -
15077 b
15078 @end group
15079 @end example
15080
15081 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
15082 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
15083 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
15084 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
15085 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
15086 item.
15087
15088 @ignore
15089 @starindex
15090 @end ignore
15091 @tindex crule
15092 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
15093 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
15094 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
15095 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
15096 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
15097 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
15098 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
15099
15100 @example
15101 @group
15102 a + 1
15103 =====
15104 2
15105 b
15106 @end group
15107 @end example
15108
15109 @ignore
15110 @starindex
15111 @end ignore
15112 @tindex clvert
15113 @ignore
15114 @starindex
15115 @end ignore
15116 @tindex crvert
15117 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15118 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15119 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15120 gives:
15121
15122 @example
15123 @group
15124 a + a
15125 bb bb
15126 ccc ccc
15127 @end group
15128 @end example
15129
15130 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15131 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15132 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15133
15134 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15135 @subsubsection Other Compositions
15136
15137 @noindent
15138 @ignore
15139 @starindex
15140 @end ignore
15141 @tindex csup
15142 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15143 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15144 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15145 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15146 bottom line is one above the baseline.
15147
15148 @ignore
15149 @starindex
15150 @end ignore
15151 @tindex csub
15152 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15153 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15154 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15155 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15156 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15157
15158 @ignore
15159 @starindex
15160 @end ignore
15161 @tindex cflat
15162 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15163 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15164 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15165 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15166 to improve its readability.
15167
15168 @ignore
15169 @starindex
15170 @end ignore
15171 @tindex cspace
15172 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15173 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15174 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15175 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15176 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15177 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15178 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15179
15180 @example
15181 @group
15182 2 2 2 2
15183 a a a a
15184 @end group
15185 @end example
15186
15187 @noindent
15188 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15189
15190 @ignore
15191 @starindex
15192 @end ignore
15193 @tindex cvspace
15194 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15195 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15196 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15197 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15198 height if used in a vertical composition.
15199
15200 @ignore
15201 @starindex
15202 @end ignore
15203 @tindex ctspace
15204 @ignore
15205 @starindex
15206 @end ignore
15207 @tindex cbspace
15208 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15209 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15210 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15211 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15212 displays as:
15213
15214 @example
15215 @group
15216 a
15217 -
15218 a b
15219 - a a
15220 b + - + -
15221 a b b
15222 - a
15223 b -
15224 b
15225 @end group
15226 @end example
15227
15228 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15229 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15230
15231 @noindent
15232 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15233 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15234 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15235
15236 @ignore
15237 @starindex
15238 @end ignore
15239 @tindex cwidth
15240 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15241 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15242 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15243 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15244 the composition functions described in this section.
15245
15246 @ignore
15247 @starindex
15248 @end ignore
15249 @tindex cheight
15250 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15251 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15252
15253 @ignore
15254 @starindex
15255 @end ignore
15256 @tindex cascent
15257 @ignore
15258 @starindex
15259 @end ignore
15260 @tindex cdescent
15261 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15262 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15263 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15264 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15265 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15266 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15267 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15268 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15269
15270 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15271 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15272
15273 @noindent
15274 @kindex Z C
15275 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15276 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15277 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15278 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15279 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15280 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15281 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15282 replaced.
15283
15284 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15285 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15286 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15287 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15288 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15289 affect the display at all.
15290
15291 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15292 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15293 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15294 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15295 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15296 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15297 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15298 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15299 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15300 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15301
15302 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15303 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15304 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15305
15306 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15307 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15308
15309 @example
15310 @group
15311 n
15312 ( )
15313 m
15314 @end group
15315 @end example
15316
15317 @noindent
15318 You might prefer the notation,
15319
15320 @example
15321 @group
15322 C
15323 n m
15324 @end group
15325 @end example
15326
15327 @noindent
15328 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15329 then put the formula
15330
15331 @smallexample
15332 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15333 @end smallexample
15334
15335 @noindent
15336 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15337 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15338 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15339 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15340 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15341 as an algebraic entry.
15342
15343 @example
15344 @group
15345 C + C
15346 a b 7 3
15347 @end group
15348 @end example
15349
15350 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15351 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15352 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15353 instead of parentheses.
15354
15355 @smallexample
15356 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15357 @end smallexample
15358
15359 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15360 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15361
15362 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15363 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15364 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15365 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15366 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15367 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15368 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15369 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15370 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15371 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15372 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15373 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15374
15375 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15376 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15377 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15378 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15379 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15380 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15381 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15382 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15383 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15384 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15385 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15386 symbolic form.
15387
15388 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15389 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15390 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15391 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15392 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15393 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15394 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15395 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15396 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15397
15398 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15399 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15400
15401 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15402 @subsection Syntax Tables
15403
15404 @noindent
15405 @cindex Syntax tables
15406 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15407 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15408 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15409 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15410
15411 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15412 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15413
15414 @kindex Z S
15415 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15416 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15417 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15418 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15419 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15420 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15421 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15422 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15423
15424 @menu
15425 * Syntax Table Basics::
15426 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15427 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15428 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15429 @end menu
15430
15431 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15432 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15433
15434 @noindent
15435 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15436 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15437 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15438 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15439 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15440 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15441 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15442 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15443 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15444 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15445
15446 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15447 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15448 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15449 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15450 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15451 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15452 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15453 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15454 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15455 completely different.)
15456
15457 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15458 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15459 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15460
15461 @example
15462 foo ( ) := 2+3
15463 @end example
15464
15465 @noindent
15466 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15467 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15468 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15469 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15470 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15471 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15472 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15473 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15474 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15475 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15476 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15477 calls would no longer recognize it!
15478
15479 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15480 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15481 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15482
15483 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15484 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15485 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15486 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15487 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15488 and postfix operator, respectively:
15489
15490 @example
15491 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15492 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15493 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15494 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15495 @end example
15496
15497 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15498 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15499
15500 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15501 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15502 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15503 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15504 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15505 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15506 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15507 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15508 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15509 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15510 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15511 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15512
15513 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15514 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15515 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15516 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15517 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15518 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15519 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15520 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15521
15522 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15523 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15524 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15525 rule,
15526
15527 @example
15528 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15529 @end example
15530
15531 @noindent
15532 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15533 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15534 define these operators quite easily:
15535
15536 @example
15537 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15538 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15539 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15540 @end example
15541
15542 @noindent
15543 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15544 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15545 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15546 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15547
15548 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15549 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15550
15551 @example
15552 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15553 @end example
15554
15555 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15556 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15557 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15558 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15559 backslashes in tokens.)
15560
15561 @example
15562 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15563 @end example
15564
15565 @noindent
15566 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15567
15568 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15569 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15570 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15571 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15572 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15573 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15574 respectively).
15575
15576 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15577 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15578
15579 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15580 @subsubsection Precedence
15581
15582 @noindent
15583 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15584 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15585
15586 @example
15587 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15588 @end example
15589
15590 @noindent
15591 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15592 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15593 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15594 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15595 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15596 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15597
15598 @example
15599 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15600 @end example
15601
15602 @noindent
15603 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15604 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15605 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15606 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15607 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15608 can create a right-associative operator.
15609
15610 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15611 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15612 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15613
15614 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15615 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15616
15617 @noindent
15618 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15619 write
15620
15621 @example
15622 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15623 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15624 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15625 @end example
15626
15627 @noindent
15628 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15629 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15630 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15631
15632 @example
15633 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15634 @end example
15635
15636 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15637 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15638 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15639 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15640 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15641 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15642 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15643 several expressions separated by commas.
15644
15645 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15646 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15647 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15648 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15649 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15650 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15651
15652 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15653 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15654 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15655 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15656 always be an empty vector.
15657
15658 @example
15659 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15660 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15661 @end example
15662
15663 @noindent
15664 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15665 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15666 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15667 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15668 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15669
15670 @example
15671 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15672 @end example
15673
15674 @noindent
15675 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15676 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15677
15678 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15679 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15680 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15681
15682 @example
15683 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15684 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15685 @end example
15686
15687 @noindent
15688 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15689 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15690 empty vector is produced.
15691
15692 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15693 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15694 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15695 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15696 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15697 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15698 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15699 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15700 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15701 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15702 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15703 as optional.
15704
15705 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15706 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15707
15708 @example
15709 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15710 @end example
15711
15712 @noindent
15713 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15714 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15715 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15716 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15717 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15718 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15719 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15720
15721 @example
15722 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15723 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15724 @end example
15725
15726 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15727 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15728 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15729 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15730 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15731 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15732 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15733
15734 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15735 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15736
15737 @noindent
15738 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15739 example, the rules
15740
15741 @example
15742 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15743 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15744 @end example
15745
15746 @noindent
15747 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15748 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15749 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15750 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15751 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15752 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15753
15754 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15755 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15756 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15757 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15758 using the algebraic simplifications (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15759 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15760 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15761 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15762 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15763 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15764 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15765
15766 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15767 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15768 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15769 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15770 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15771 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15772
15773 @example
15774 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15775 @end example
15776
15777 @noindent
15778 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15779 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15780 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15781 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15782
15783 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15784 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15785 rules.
15786
15787 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15788 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15789 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15790 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15791 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15792 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15793
15794 @example
15795 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15796 @end example
15797
15798 @noindent
15799 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15800 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15801 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15802 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15803 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15804 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15805 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15806 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15807
15808 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15809 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15810
15811 @noindent
15812 @kindex m g
15813 @pindex calc-get-modes
15814 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15815 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15816 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15817 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15818 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15819 on the current mode settings.
15820
15821 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15822 @vindex Modes
15823 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15824 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15825 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15826 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15827 command will continue to work, however.)
15828
15829 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15830 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15831 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15832 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15833
15834 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15835
15836 @enumerate
15837 @item
15838 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15839
15840 @item
15841 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15842
15843 @item
15844 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15845 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15846
15847 @item
15848 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15849
15850 @item
15851 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15852 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15853 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15854 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15855 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15856 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15857 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15858 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15859 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15860 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15861
15862 @item
15863 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15864 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15865
15866 @item
15867 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15868
15869 @item
15870 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15871
15872 @item
15873 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15874 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15875
15876 @item
15877 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15878 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15879 or @var{N} for
15880 @texline @math{N\times N}
15881 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15882 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15883
15884 @item
15885 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15886 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15887 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15888
15889 @item
15890 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15891 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15892 @end enumerate
15893
15894 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15895 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15896 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15897 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15898 keyboard macro.)
15899
15900 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15901 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15902
15903 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15904 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15905 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15906 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15907 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15908 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15909
15910 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15911 @section The Calc Mode Line
15912
15913 @noindent
15914 @cindex Mode line indicators
15915 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15916 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15917 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15918
15919 The basic mode line format is:
15920
15921 @example
15922 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15923 @end example
15924
15925 The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
15926 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15927 as if it were text.
15928
15929 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15930 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15931 that are in effect.
15932
15933 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15934 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15935 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15936
15937 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15938 on the mode line:
15939
15940 @table @code
15941 @item Alg
15942 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15943
15944 @item Alg[(
15945 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15946
15947 @item Alg*
15948 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15949
15950 @item Symb
15951 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15952
15953 @item Matrix
15954 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15955
15956 @item Matrix@var{n}
15957 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15958
15959 @item SqMatrix
15960 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15961
15962 @item Scalar
15963 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15964
15965 @item Polar
15966 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15967
15968 @item Frac
15969 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15970
15971 @item Inf
15972 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15973
15974 @item +Inf
15975 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15976
15977 @item NoSimp
15978 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15979
15980 @item NumSimp
15981 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15982
15983 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15984 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15985
15986 @item BasicSimp
15987 Basic simplification mode (@kbd{m I}).
15988
15989 @item ExtSimp
15990 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15991
15992 @item UnitSimp
15993 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15994
15995 @item Bin
15996 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15997
15998 @item Oct
15999 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
16000
16001 @item Hex
16002 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
16003
16004 @item Radix@var{n}
16005 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
16006
16007 @item Zero
16008 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
16009
16010 @item Big
16011 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
16012
16013 @item Flat
16014 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
16015
16016 @item Unform
16017 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
16018
16019 @item C
16020 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
16021
16022 @item Pascal
16023 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
16024
16025 @item Fortran
16026 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
16027
16028 @item TeX
16029 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
16030
16031 @item LaTeX
16032 @LaTeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
16033
16034 @item Eqn
16035 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
16036
16037 @item Math
16038 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
16039
16040 @item Maple
16041 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
16042
16043 @item Norm@var{n}
16044 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
16045
16046 @item Fix@var{n}
16047 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
16048
16049 @item Sci
16050 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
16051
16052 @item Sci@var{n}
16053 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
16054
16055 @item Eng
16056 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
16057
16058 @item Eng@var{n}
16059 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
16060
16061 @item Left@var{n}
16062 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
16063
16064 @item Right
16065 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
16066
16067 @item Right@var{n}
16068 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
16069
16070 @item Center
16071 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
16072
16073 @item Center@var{n}
16074 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
16075
16076 @item Wid@var{n}
16077 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
16078
16079 @item Wide
16080 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
16081
16082 @item Break
16083 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16084
16085 @item Save
16086 Record modes in @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
16087
16088 @item Local
16089 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16090
16091 @item LocEdit
16092 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16093
16094 @item LocPerm
16095 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16096
16097 @item Global
16098 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16099
16100 @item Manual
16101 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
16102 Recomputation}).
16103
16104 @item Graph
16105 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
16106
16107 @item Sel
16108 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16109
16110 @item Dirty
16111 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
16112
16113 @item Inv
16114 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
16115
16116 @item Hyp
16117 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16118
16119 @item Keep
16120 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16121
16122 @item Narrow
16123 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16124 @end table
16125
16126 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16127 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16128
16129 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16130 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
16131
16132 @noindent
16133 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16134 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16135 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16136 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16137 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16138 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16139 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16140
16141 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16142 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16143 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16144
16145 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16146 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16147 interpret a prefix argument.
16148
16149 @menu
16150 * Basic Arithmetic::
16151 * Integer Truncation::
16152 * Complex Number Functions::
16153 * Conversions::
16154 * Date Arithmetic::
16155 * Financial Functions::
16156 * Binary Functions::
16157 @end menu
16158
16159 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16160 @section Basic Arithmetic
16161
16162 @noindent
16163 @kindex +
16164 @pindex calc-plus
16165 @ignore
16166 @mindex @null
16167 @end ignore
16168 @tindex +
16169 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16170 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16171 onto the stack.
16172
16173 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16174 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16175 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16176 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16177 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16178 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16179 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16180 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16181 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16182 to every element of a vector.
16183
16184 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16185 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16186 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16187 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16188 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16189
16190 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16191 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16192 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16193 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16194 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16195
16196 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16197 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16198 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16199 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16200 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16201 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16202 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16203 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16204
16205 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16206 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16207 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16208 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16209 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16210 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16211 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16212 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16213
16214 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16215 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16216 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16217 the two values.
16218
16219 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16220 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16221 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16222 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16223
16224 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16225 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16226 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16227 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16228
16229 @kindex -
16230 @pindex calc-minus
16231 @ignore
16232 @mindex @null
16233 @end ignore
16234 @tindex -
16235 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16236 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16237 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16238 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16239
16240 @kindex *
16241 @pindex calc-times
16242 @ignore
16243 @mindex @null
16244 @end ignore
16245 @tindex *
16246 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16247 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16248 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16249 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16250 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16251 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16252 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16253 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16254 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16255
16256 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16257 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16258 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16259 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16260 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16261 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16262 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16263 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16264
16265 @kindex /
16266 @pindex calc-divide
16267 @ignore
16268 @mindex @null
16269 @end ignore
16270 @tindex /
16271 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16272
16273 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16274 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16275 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16276 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16277 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16278 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16279 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16280 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16281 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16282 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16283 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16284 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16285 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16286 @smallexample
16287 @group
16288 a b
16289 ---.
16290 c d
16291 @end group
16292 @end smallexample
16293
16294 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16295 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16296 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16297 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16298 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16299 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16300 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16301 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16302 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16303 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16304 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16305 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16306 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16307 transpose the result.
16308
16309 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16310 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16311 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16312 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16313 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16314 interval.
16315
16316 @kindex ^
16317 @pindex calc-power
16318 @ignore
16319 @mindex @null
16320 @end ignore
16321 @tindex ^
16322 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16323 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16324 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16325 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16326 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16327 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16328
16329 @kindex I ^
16330 @tindex nroot
16331 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16332 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16333 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16334
16335 @kindex \
16336 @pindex calc-idiv
16337 @tindex idiv
16338 @ignore
16339 @mindex @null
16340 @end ignore
16341 @tindex \
16342 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16343 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16344 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16345 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16346 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16347 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16348
16349 @kindex %
16350 @pindex calc-mod
16351 @ignore
16352 @mindex @null
16353 @end ignore
16354 @tindex %
16355 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16356 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16357 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16358 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16359 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16360 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16361 must be positive real number.
16362
16363 @kindex :
16364 @pindex calc-fdiv
16365 @tindex fdiv
16366 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16367 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16368 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16369 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16370 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16371 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16372 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16373 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16374
16375 @kindex n
16376 @pindex calc-change-sign
16377 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16378 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16379 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16380
16381 @kindex A
16382 @pindex calc-abs
16383 @tindex abs
16384 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16385 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16386 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16387 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16388 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16389 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16390 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16391 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16392 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16393
16394 @kindex f A
16395 @pindex calc-abssqr
16396 @tindex abssqr
16397 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16398 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16399
16400 @kindex f s
16401 @pindex calc-sign
16402 @tindex sign
16403 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16404 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16405 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16406 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16407 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16408
16409 @kindex &
16410 @pindex calc-inv
16411 @tindex inv
16412 @cindex Reciprocal
16413 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16414 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16415 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16416
16417 @kindex Q
16418 @pindex calc-sqrt
16419 @tindex sqrt
16420 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16421 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16422 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16423
16424 @kindex f h
16425 @pindex calc-hypot
16426 @tindex hypot
16427 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16428 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16429 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16430 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16431 magnitudes are used.
16432
16433 @kindex f Q
16434 @pindex calc-isqrt
16435 @tindex isqrt
16436 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16437 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16438 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16439 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16440 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16441 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16442 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16443
16444 @kindex f n
16445 @kindex f x
16446 @pindex calc-min
16447 @tindex min
16448 @pindex calc-max
16449 @tindex max
16450 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16451 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16452 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16453 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16454 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16455 all the arguments.)
16456
16457 @kindex f M
16458 @kindex f X
16459 @pindex calc-mant-part
16460 @tindex mant
16461 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16462 @tindex xpon
16463 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16464 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16465 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16466 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16467 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16468 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16469 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16470 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16471 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16472 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16473 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16474 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16475 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16476
16477 @kindex f S
16478 @pindex calc-scale-float
16479 @tindex scf
16480 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16481 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16482 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16483 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16484 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16485
16486 @kindex f [
16487 @kindex f ]
16488 @pindex calc-decrement
16489 @pindex calc-increment
16490 @tindex decr
16491 @tindex incr
16492 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16493 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16494 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16495 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16496 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16497 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16498 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16499 @samp{0.0} produces
16500 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16501 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16502 where @expr{p} is the current
16503 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16504 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16505
16506 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16507 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16508 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16509 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16510 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16511 way floating-point numbers work.
16512
16513 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16514 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16515
16516 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16517 @section Integer Truncation
16518
16519 @noindent
16520 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16521 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16522 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16523 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16524 to integer form.
16525
16526 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16527 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16528
16529 @cindex Integer part of a number
16530 @kindex F
16531 @pindex calc-floor
16532 @tindex floor
16533 @tindex ffloor
16534 @ignore
16535 @mindex @null
16536 @end ignore
16537 @kindex H F
16538 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16539 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16540 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16541 @mathit{-4}.
16542
16543 @kindex I F
16544 @pindex calc-ceiling
16545 @tindex ceil
16546 @tindex fceil
16547 @ignore
16548 @mindex @null
16549 @end ignore
16550 @kindex H I F
16551 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16552 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16553 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16554
16555 @kindex R
16556 @pindex calc-round
16557 @tindex round
16558 @tindex fround
16559 @ignore
16560 @mindex @null
16561 @end ignore
16562 @kindex H R
16563 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16564 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16565 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16566 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16567 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16568
16569 @kindex I R
16570 @pindex calc-trunc
16571 @tindex trunc
16572 @tindex ftrunc
16573 @ignore
16574 @mindex @null
16575 @end ignore
16576 @kindex H I R
16577 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16578 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16579 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16580 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16581
16582 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16583 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16584 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16585 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16586 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16587 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16588
16589 @ignore
16590 @starindex
16591 @end ignore
16592 @tindex rounde
16593 @ignore
16594 @starindex
16595 @end ignore
16596 @tindex roundu
16597 @ignore
16598 @starindex
16599 @end ignore
16600 @tindex frounde
16601 @ignore
16602 @starindex
16603 @end ignore
16604 @tindex froundu
16605 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16606 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16607 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16608 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16609 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16610 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16611 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16612 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16613 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16614 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16615 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16616 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16617 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16618 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16619 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16620
16621 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16622 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16623 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16624 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16625 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16626 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16627 no second argument at all.
16628
16629 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16630 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16631 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16632 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16633
16634 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16635 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16636 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16637 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16638
16639 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16640 @section Complex Number Functions
16641
16642 @noindent
16643 @kindex J
16644 @pindex calc-conj
16645 @tindex conj
16646 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16647 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16648 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16649 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16650 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16651
16652 @kindex G
16653 @pindex calc-argument
16654 @tindex arg
16655 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16656 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16657 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16658 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16659 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16660 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16661 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16662 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16663
16664 @pindex calc-imaginary
16665 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16666 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16667 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16668 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16669
16670 @kindex f r
16671 @pindex calc-re
16672 @tindex re
16673 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16674 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16675 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16676 the value part.)
16677
16678 @kindex f i
16679 @pindex calc-im
16680 @tindex im
16681 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16682 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16683 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16684
16685 @ignore
16686 @mindex v p
16687 @end ignore
16688 @kindex v p (complex)
16689 @kindex V p (complex)
16690 @pindex calc-pack
16691 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16692 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16693 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16694 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16695 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16696
16697 @ignore
16698 @mindex v u
16699 @end ignore
16700 @kindex v u (complex)
16701 @kindex V u (complex)
16702 @pindex calc-unpack
16703 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16704 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16705 into its separate components.
16706
16707 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16708 @section Conversions
16709
16710 @noindent
16711 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16712 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16713
16714 @kindex c f
16715 @pindex calc-float
16716 @tindex pfloat
16717 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16718 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16719 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16720 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16721 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16722 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16723 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16724 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16725 format may lose information.
16726
16727 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16728 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16729 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16730 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16731 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16732 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16733
16734 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16735 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16736 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16737 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16738
16739 @kindex H c f
16740 @tindex float
16741 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16742 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16743 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16744 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16745
16746 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16747 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16748 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16749 that appear right now.
16750
16751 @kindex c F
16752 @pindex calc-fraction
16753 @tindex pfrac
16754 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16755 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16756 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16757 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16758 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16759 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16760 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16761 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16762 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16763 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16764 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16765
16766 @kindex H c F
16767 @tindex frac
16768 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16769 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16770 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16771
16772 @kindex c d
16773 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16774 @tindex deg
16775 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16776 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16777 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16778 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16779
16780 @kindex c r
16781 @pindex calc-to-radians
16782 @tindex rad
16783 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16784 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16785
16786 @kindex c h
16787 @pindex calc-to-hms
16788 @tindex hms
16789 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16790 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16791 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16792 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16793 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16794
16795 @pindex calc-from-hms
16796 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16797 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16798
16799 @kindex c p
16800 @kindex I c p
16801 @pindex calc-polar
16802 @tindex polar
16803 @tindex rect
16804 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16805 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16806 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16807 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16808 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16809 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16810 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16811 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16812
16813 @kindex c c
16814 @pindex calc-clean
16815 @tindex pclean
16816 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16817 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16818 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16819 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16820 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16821 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16822 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16823 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16824 number (i.e., pervasively).
16825
16826 If the simplification mode is set below basic simplification, it is raised
16827 for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c} applies the basic
16828 simplifications even if their automatic application is disabled.
16829 @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16830
16831 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16832 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16833 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16834 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16835 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16836
16837 @kindex c 0-9
16838 @pindex calc-clean-num
16839 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16840 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16841 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16842 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16843
16844 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16845 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16846 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16847 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16848 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16849 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16850 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16851
16852 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16853 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16854 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16855 does not clip small numbers.)
16856
16857 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16858 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16859 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16860 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16861 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16862 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16863
16864 @kindex H c 0-9
16865 @kindex H c c
16866 @tindex clean
16867 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16868 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16869
16870 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16871 @section Date Arithmetic
16872
16873 @noindent
16874 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16875 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16876 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16877 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16878 letters.
16879
16880 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16881 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16882 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16883 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16884 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16885 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16886
16887 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16888 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16889 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16890
16891 @menu
16892 * Date Conversions::
16893 * Date Functions::
16894 * Time Zones::
16895 * Business Days::
16896 @end menu
16897
16898 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16899 @subsection Date Conversions
16900
16901 @noindent
16902 @kindex t D
16903 @pindex calc-date
16904 @tindex date
16905 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16906 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD@. The
16907 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16908 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16909 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16910
16911 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16912 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16913 of the following ways:
16914
16915 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16916 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16917 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16918 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16919 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16920 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16921 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16922 month will be used.
16923
16924 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16925 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16926 real-time clock.
16927
16928 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16929 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16930
16931 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16932 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16933 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16934 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16935 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16936 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16937
16938 @kindex t J
16939 @pindex calc-julian
16940 @tindex julian
16941 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16942 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16943 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16944 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC@. A pure date is converted to an
16945 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16946 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16947 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16948 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16949 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16950 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16951 are never time-zone adjusted.
16952
16953 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16954 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16955 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16956 current or specified time zone.
16957
16958 @kindex t U
16959 @pindex calc-unix-time
16960 @tindex unixtime
16961 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16962 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16963 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16964 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16965 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16966 precision, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16967 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16968 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16969 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16970 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16971 suppress the adjustment if so.
16972
16973 @kindex t C
16974 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16975 @tindex tzconv
16976 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16977 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16978 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16979 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16980 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16981 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16982 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16983 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16984 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16985
16986 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16987 @subsection Date Functions
16988
16989 @noindent
16990 @kindex t N
16991 @pindex calc-now
16992 @tindex now
16993 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16994 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16995 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16996 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16997
16998 @kindex t P
16999 @pindex calc-date-part
17000 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
17001 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
17002 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
17003 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
17004
17005 @tindex year
17006 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
17007 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
17008 following functions will also accept a real number for an
17009 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
17010 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
17011 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
17012
17013 @tindex month
17014 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
17015 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
17016
17017 @tindex day
17018 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
17019 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
17020
17021 @tindex hour
17022 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
17023 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
17024 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
17025 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
17026 HMS forms as input.
17027
17028 @tindex minute
17029 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
17030 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
17031
17032 @tindex second
17033 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
17034 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
17035 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
17036 precision, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
17037
17038 @tindex weekday
17039 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
17040 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
17041 to 6 (Saturday).
17042
17043 @tindex yearday
17044 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
17045 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
17046 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
17047
17048 @tindex time
17049 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
17050 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
17051 for a pure date form.
17052
17053 @kindex t M
17054 @pindex calc-new-month
17055 @tindex newmonth
17056 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
17057 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
17058 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
17059 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
17060 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
17061 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
17062 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
17063 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
17064
17065 @kindex t Y
17066 @pindex calc-new-year
17067 @tindex newyear
17068 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
17069 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
17070 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
17071 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
17072 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
17073 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
17074 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
17075 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
17076 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
17077
17078 @kindex t W
17079 @pindex calc-new-week
17080 @tindex newweek
17081 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
17082 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
17083 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
17084 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
17085 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
17086 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
17087
17088 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
17089 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
17090 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
17091 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
17092 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
17093 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
17094 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
17095 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
17096 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
17097 the time to midnight; hint: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
17098 of the @code{weekday} function?).
17099
17100 @ignore
17101 @starindex
17102 @end ignore
17103 @tindex pwday
17104 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
17105 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
17106 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
17107 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
17108 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
17109 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
17110 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
17111 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
17112 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
17113 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
17114 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
17115
17116 @kindex t I
17117 @pindex calc-inc-month
17118 @tindex incmonth
17119 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17120 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17121 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17122 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17123 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17124 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17125 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17126 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17127 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17128 in this case).
17129
17130 @ignore
17131 @starindex
17132 @end ignore
17133 @tindex incyear
17134 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17135 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17136 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17137 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17138 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17139 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17140 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17141 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17142
17143 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17144 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17145 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17146
17147 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17148 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17149
17150 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17151 @subsection Business Days
17152
17153 @noindent
17154 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17155 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17156 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17157 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17158 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17159 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17160
17161 @kindex t +
17162 @kindex t -
17163 @tindex badd
17164 @tindex bsub
17165 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17166 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17167 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17168 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17169 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17170 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17171 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17172 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17173 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17174 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17175 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17176 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17177 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17178 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17179 dates.
17180
17181 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17182 @vindex Holidays
17183 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17184 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17185 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17186 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17187 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17188 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17189 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17190
17191 @itemize @bullet
17192 @item
17193 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17194 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17195
17196 @item
17197 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17198 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17199
17200 @item
17201 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17202 considered to be a holiday.
17203
17204 @item
17205 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17206 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17207 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17208 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17209 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17210 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17211 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17212 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17213 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17214
17215 @item
17216 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17217 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17218
17219 @item
17220 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17221 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17222 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17223 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17224 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17225 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17226 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17227 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17228 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17229 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17230
17231 @item
17232 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17233 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17234 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17235 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17236 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17237 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17238 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17239 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17240 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17241 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17242 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17243 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17244 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17245 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17246 @end itemize
17247
17248 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17249 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17250 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17251
17252 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17253 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17254 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17255 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17256 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17257 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17258
17259 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17260 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17261 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17262 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17263 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17264 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17265 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17266 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17267
17268 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17269 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17270 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17271 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17272 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17273 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17274 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17275 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17276 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17277 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17278 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17279 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17280 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17281 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17282 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17283
17284 @ignore
17285 @starindex
17286 @end ignore
17287 @tindex holiday
17288 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17289 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17290 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17291 business day.
17292
17293 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17294 @subsection Time Zones
17295
17296 @noindent
17297 @cindex Time zones
17298 @cindex Daylight saving time
17299 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17300 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17301 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17302 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17303 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17304 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17305 can't determine the right correction to use.
17306
17307 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17308 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17309 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17310 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17311 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17312 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17313 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17314 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17315 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17316 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17317 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17318 April 7, 1991.
17319
17320 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17321 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17322 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17323 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17324
17325 @pindex calc-time-zone
17326 @ignore
17327 @starindex
17328 @end ignore
17329 @tindex tzone
17330 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17331 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17332 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17333 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17334 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17335 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17336 the normal difference.
17337
17338 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17339 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17340 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17341 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17342 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17343 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17344 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17345 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17346 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17347
17348 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17349 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17350 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17351 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17352
17353 @smallexample
17354 @group
17355 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17356 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17357
17358 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17359 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17360
17361 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17362 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17363 @end group
17364 @end smallexample
17365
17366 @vindex math-tzone-names
17367 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17368 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17369 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17370 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17371 Pacific Time look like this:
17372
17373 @smallexample
17374 @group
17375 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17376 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17377 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17378 @end group
17379 @end smallexample
17380
17381 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17382 @vindex TimeZone
17383 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17384 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17385 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17386 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17387 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17388 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17389 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17390 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17391 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17392 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17393 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17394 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17395 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17396 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17397 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17398 The special time zone name @code{local}
17399 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17400 from the calendar.
17401
17402 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17403 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17404 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17405 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17406
17407 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17408 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17409 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17410 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17411 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17412 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17413 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17414 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17415 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17416 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17417 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17418 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17419 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17420 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17421 the conversion functions.
17422
17423 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17424 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17425 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17426 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17427 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17428
17429 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17430 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17431 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17432 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17433 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17434 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17435 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17436
17437 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17438 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17439 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17440 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17441 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17442 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17443 and the weekday number (0--6).
17444
17445 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17446 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17447 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17448 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17449 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17450 daylight saving hook:
17451
17452 @smallexample
17453 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17454 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17455 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17456 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17457 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17458 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17459 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17460 (t -1))))
17461 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17462 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17463 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17464 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17465 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17466 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17467 (t 0))))
17468 (t 0))
17469 )
17470 @end smallexample
17471
17472 @noindent
17473 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17474 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17475 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17476 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17477 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17478
17479 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17480 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17481 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17482 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17483 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17484 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17485 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17486 later).
17487
17488 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17489 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17490
17491 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17492 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17493 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17494 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17495 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17496 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17497 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17498 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17499 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17500 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17501 is typically represented in.
17502
17503 @ignore
17504 @starindex
17505 @end ignore
17506 @tindex dsadj
17507 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17508 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17509 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17510 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17511 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17512 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17513 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17514
17515 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17516 @section Financial Functions
17517
17518 @noindent
17519 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17520 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17521 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17522
17523 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17524 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17525 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17526 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17527
17528 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17529 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17530 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17531 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17532
17533 @menu
17534 * Percentages::
17535 * Future Value::
17536 * Present Value::
17537 * Related Financial Functions::
17538 * Depreciation Functions::
17539 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17540 @end menu
17541
17542 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17543 @subsection Percentages
17544
17545 @kindex M-%
17546 @pindex calc-percent
17547 @tindex %
17548 @tindex percent
17549 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17550 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17551 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17552 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17553
17554 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17555 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17556 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17557 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17558 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17559 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17560 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17561 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17562
17563 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17564 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17565 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17566 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17567 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17568 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17569
17570 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17571 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17572 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17573 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17574
17575 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17576 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17577 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17578
17579 @kindex c %
17580 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17581 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17582 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17583 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17584 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17585 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17586 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17587 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17588
17589 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17590 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17591 @samp{25%}.
17592
17593 @kindex b %
17594 @pindex calc-percent-change
17595 @tindex relch
17596 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17597 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17598 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17599 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17600 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17601 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17602 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17603 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17604 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17605 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17606
17607 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17608 @subsection Future Value
17609
17610 @noindent
17611 @kindex b F
17612 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17613 @tindex fv
17614 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17615 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17616 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17617 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17618 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17619 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17620 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17621 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17622 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17623 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17624
17625 @kindex I b F
17626 @tindex fvb
17627 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17628 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17629 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17630 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17631 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17632 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17633 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17634 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17635 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17636
17637 @kindex H b F
17638 @tindex fvl
17639 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17640 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17641 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17642 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17643
17644 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17645 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17646 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17647 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17648 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17649
17650 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17651 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17652 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17653 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17654 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17655 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17656 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17657 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17658 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17659 by @code{fvb} directly.
17660
17661 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17662 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17663 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17664 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17665 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17666 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17667 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17668
17669 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17670 @subsection Present Value
17671
17672 @noindent
17673 @kindex b P
17674 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17675 @tindex pv
17676 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17677 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17678 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17679 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17680 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17681 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17682 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17683 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17684 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17685 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17686 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17687 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17688 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17689
17690 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17691 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17692 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17693 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17694 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17695 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17696 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17697 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17698 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17699
17700 @kindex I b P
17701 @tindex pvb
17702 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17703 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17704 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17705 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17706 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17707 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17708
17709 @kindex H b P
17710 @tindex pvl
17711 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17712 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17713 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17714 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17715 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17716 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17717 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17718
17719 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17720 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17721 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17722
17723 @kindex b N
17724 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17725 @tindex npv
17726 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17727 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17728 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17729 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17730 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17731 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17732 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17733
17734 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17735 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17736 not all the same!
17737
17738 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17739 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17740 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17741 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17742 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17743 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17744 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17745 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17746
17747 @kindex I b N
17748 @tindex npvb
17749 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17750 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17751 rather than at the end.
17752
17753 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17754 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17755
17756 @noindent
17757 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17758 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17759
17760 @kindex b M
17761 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17762 @tindex pmt
17763 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17764 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17765 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17766 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17767 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17768
17769 @kindex I b M
17770 @tindex pmtb
17771 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17772 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17773 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17774 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17775
17776 @kindex H b M
17777 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17778 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17779
17780 @kindex b #
17781 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17782 @tindex nper
17783 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17784 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17785 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17786 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17787 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17788 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17789 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17790
17791 @kindex I b #
17792 @tindex nperb
17793 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17794 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17795 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17796 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17797
17798 @kindex H b #
17799 @tindex nperl
17800 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17801 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17802 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17803 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17804 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17805
17806 @kindex b T
17807 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17808 @tindex rate
17809 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17810 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17811 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17812 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17813 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17814
17815 @kindex I b T
17816 @kindex H b T
17817 @tindex rateb
17818 @tindex ratel
17819 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17820 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17821 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17822 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17823 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17824 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17825 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17826
17827 @kindex b I
17828 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17829 @tindex irr
17830 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17831 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17832 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17833 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17834 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17835
17836 @kindex I b I
17837 @tindex irrb
17838 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17839 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17840
17841 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17842 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17843
17844 @noindent
17845 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17846 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17847 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17848 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17849 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17850 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17851
17852 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17853 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17854
17855 @kindex b S
17856 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17857 @tindex sln
17858 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17859 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17860 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17861 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17862 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17863 per year.
17864
17865 @kindex b Y
17866 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17867 @tindex syd
17868 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17869 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17870 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17871 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17872 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17873 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17874 return zero.
17875
17876 @kindex b D
17877 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17878 @tindex ddb
17879 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17880 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17881 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17882
17883 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17884 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17885 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17886
17887 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17888 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17889 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17890 the three depreciation methods:
17891
17892 @example
17893 @group
17894 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17895 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17896 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17897 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17898 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17899 @end group
17900 @end example
17901
17902 @noindent
17903 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17904 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17905 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17906 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17907
17908 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17909 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17910 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17911
17912 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17913 @subsection Definitions
17914
17915 @noindent
17916 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17917 Calc's financial functions.
17918
17919 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17920 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17921 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17922 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17923 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17924 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17925
17926 @ifnottex
17927 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17928 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17929 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17930
17931 @example
17932 n
17933 (1 + rate) - 1
17934 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17935 rate
17936
17937 n
17938 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17939 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17940 rate
17941
17942 n
17943 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17944
17945 -n
17946 1 - (1 + rate)
17947 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17948 rate
17949
17950 -n
17951 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17952 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17953 rate
17954
17955 -n
17956 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17957
17958 -1 -2 -3
17959 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17960
17961 -1 -2
17962 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17963
17964 -n
17965 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17966 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17967 -n
17968 1 - (1 + rate)
17969
17970 -n
17971 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17972 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17973 -n
17974 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17975
17976 amt * rate
17977 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17978 pmt
17979
17980 amt * rate
17981 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17982 pmt * (1 + rate)
17983
17984 amt
17985 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17986 pmt
17987
17988 1/n
17989 pmt
17990 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17991 1/n
17992 amt
17993
17994 cost - salv
17995 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17996 life
17997
17998 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17999 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
18000 life * (life + 1) / 2
18001
18002 book * 2
18003 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
18004 life
18005 @end example
18006 @end ifnottex
18007 @tex
18008 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
18009 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
18010 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
18011 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
18012 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
18013 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
18014 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
18015 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
18016 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
18017 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
18018 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
18019 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
18020 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
18021 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
18022 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
18023 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
18024 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
18025 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
18026 @end tex
18027
18028 @noindent
18029 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
18030
18031 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
18032 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
18033 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
18034 all sorts of inputs.
18035
18036 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
18037 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
18038 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
18039
18040 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
18041 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
18042 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
18043 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
18044 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
18045 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
18046
18047 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
18048 for @samp{rate}.
18049
18050 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
18051 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
18052 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
18053
18054 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
18055 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
18056 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
18057
18058 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
18059 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
18060 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
18061 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
18062 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
18063 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
18064 period.
18065
18066 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
18067 @section Binary Number Functions
18068
18069 @noindent
18070 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
18071 the @kbd{b} prefix.
18072
18073 @cindex Binary numbers
18074 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
18075 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
18076 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
18077 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
18078 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
18079
18080 @cindex Word size for binary operations
18081 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
18082 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
18083 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
18084 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
18085 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
18086
18087 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce twos-complement
18088 integers from
18089 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
18090 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
18091 to
18092 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
18093 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
18094 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
18095 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
18096
18097 @kindex b c
18098 @pindex calc-clip
18099 @tindex clip
18100 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
18101 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
18102 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
18103 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
18104 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
18105 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
18106 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
18107 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
18108 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
18109
18110 @kindex b w
18111 @pindex calc-word-size
18112 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
18113 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
18114 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18115 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18116 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18117 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18118 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18119
18120 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18121 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18122 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18123 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18124 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18125 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18126 integer-valued floats.
18127
18128 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18129 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18130 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18131 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18132
18133 @kindex b a
18134 @pindex calc-and
18135 @tindex and
18136 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18137 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18138 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18139 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18140 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18141
18142 @kindex b o
18143 @pindex calc-or
18144 @tindex or
18145 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18146 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18147 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18148
18149 @kindex b x
18150 @pindex calc-xor
18151 @tindex xor
18152 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18153 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18154 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18155
18156 @kindex b d
18157 @pindex calc-diff
18158 @tindex diff
18159 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18160 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18161 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18162
18163 @kindex b n
18164 @pindex calc-not
18165 @tindex not
18166 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18167 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18168
18169 @kindex b l
18170 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18171 @tindex lsh
18172 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18173 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18174 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18175 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18176 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18177 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18178
18179 @kindex H b l
18180 @kindex H b r
18181 @ignore
18182 @mindex @idots
18183 @end ignore
18184 @kindex H b L
18185 @ignore
18186 @mindex @null
18187 @end ignore
18188 @kindex H b R
18189 @ignore
18190 @mindex @null
18191 @end ignore
18192 @kindex H b t
18193 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18194 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18195 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18196 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18197 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18198
18199 @kindex b r
18200 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18201 @tindex rsh
18202 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18203 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18204 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18205
18206 @kindex b L
18207 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18208 @tindex ash
18209 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18210 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18211 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18212 is performed as described below.
18213
18214 @kindex b R
18215 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18216 @tindex rash
18217 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18218 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18219 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18220 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18221 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18222 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18223 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18224 performs a standard left shift.
18225
18226 @kindex b t
18227 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18228 @tindex rot
18229 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18230 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18231 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18232 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18233 or right.
18234
18235 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18236 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18237 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18238 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18239 bits in a binary integer.
18240
18241 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18242 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18243 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18244 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18245 into a binary integer.
18246
18247 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18248 @chapter Scientific Functions
18249
18250 @noindent
18251 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18252 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18253 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18254 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18255
18256 @kindex P
18257 @pindex calc-pi
18258 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18259 @vindex pi
18260 @kindex H P
18261 @cindex @code{e} variable
18262 @vindex e
18263 @kindex I P
18264 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18265 @vindex gamma
18266 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18267 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18268 @kindex H I P
18269 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18270 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18271 @cindex Golden ratio
18272 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18273 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18274 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18275 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18276 @texline @math{\gamma}
18277 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18278 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18279 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18280 @texline @math{\phi}
18281 @infoline @expr{phi}
18282 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18283 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18284 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18285 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18286 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18287
18288 @ignore
18289 @mindex Q
18290 @end ignore
18291 @ignore
18292 @mindex I Q
18293 @end ignore
18294 @kindex I Q
18295 @tindex sqr
18296 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18297 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18298 computes the square of the argument.
18299
18300 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18301 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18302 interpret a prefix argument.
18303
18304 @menu
18305 * Logarithmic Functions::
18306 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18307 * Advanced Math Functions::
18308 * Branch Cuts::
18309 * Random Numbers::
18310 * Combinatorial Functions::
18311 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18312 @end menu
18313
18314 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18315 @section Logarithmic Functions
18316
18317 @noindent
18318 @kindex L
18319 @pindex calc-ln
18320 @tindex ln
18321 @ignore
18322 @mindex @null
18323 @end ignore
18324 @kindex I E
18325 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18326 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18327 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18328 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18329
18330 @kindex E
18331 @pindex calc-exp
18332 @tindex exp
18333 @ignore
18334 @mindex @null
18335 @end ignore
18336 @kindex I L
18337 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18338 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18339 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18340 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18341
18342 @kindex H L
18343 @kindex H E
18344 @pindex calc-log10
18345 @tindex log10
18346 @tindex exp10
18347 @ignore
18348 @mindex @null
18349 @end ignore
18350 @kindex H I L
18351 @ignore
18352 @mindex @null
18353 @end ignore
18354 @kindex H I E
18355 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18356 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18357 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18358 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18359 by
18360 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18361 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18362
18363 @kindex B
18364 @kindex I B
18365 @pindex calc-log
18366 @tindex log
18367 @tindex alog
18368 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18369 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18370 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18371 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18372 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18373 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18374 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18375 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18376
18377 @kindex f I
18378 @pindex calc-ilog
18379 @tindex ilog
18380 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18381 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18382 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18383 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18384 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18385 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18386 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18387
18388 @kindex f E
18389 @pindex calc-expm1
18390 @tindex expm1
18391 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18392 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18393 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18394 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18395 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18396 @texline @math{e^x}
18397 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18398 is close to one.
18399
18400 @kindex f L
18401 @pindex calc-lnp1
18402 @tindex lnp1
18403 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18404 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18405 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18406 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18407
18408 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18409 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18410
18411 @noindent
18412 @kindex S
18413 @pindex calc-sin
18414 @tindex sin
18415 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18416 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18417 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18418 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18419 on complex numbers.
18420
18421 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18422 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18423 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18424 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18425 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18426
18427 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18428 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18429 the default algebraic simplifications recognize many such
18430 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18431 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18432 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18433 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18434 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18435 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18436 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18437
18438 Calc's algebraic simplifications know all angles which are integer multiples of
18439 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18440 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18441 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18442
18443 @kindex I S
18444 @pindex calc-arcsin
18445 @tindex arcsin
18446 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18447 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18448 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18449 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18450
18451 @kindex H S
18452 @pindex calc-sinh
18453 @tindex sinh
18454 @kindex H I S
18455 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18456 @tindex arcsinh
18457 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18458 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18459 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18460 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18461
18462 @kindex C
18463 @pindex calc-cos
18464 @tindex cos
18465 @ignore
18466 @mindex @idots
18467 @end ignore
18468 @kindex I C
18469 @pindex calc-arccos
18470 @ignore
18471 @mindex @null
18472 @end ignore
18473 @tindex arccos
18474 @ignore
18475 @mindex @null
18476 @end ignore
18477 @kindex H C
18478 @pindex calc-cosh
18479 @ignore
18480 @mindex @null
18481 @end ignore
18482 @tindex cosh
18483 @ignore
18484 @mindex @null
18485 @end ignore
18486 @kindex H I C
18487 @pindex calc-arccosh
18488 @ignore
18489 @mindex @null
18490 @end ignore
18491 @tindex arccosh
18492 @ignore
18493 @mindex @null
18494 @end ignore
18495 @kindex T
18496 @pindex calc-tan
18497 @ignore
18498 @mindex @null
18499 @end ignore
18500 @tindex tan
18501 @ignore
18502 @mindex @null
18503 @end ignore
18504 @kindex I T
18505 @pindex calc-arctan
18506 @ignore
18507 @mindex @null
18508 @end ignore
18509 @tindex arctan
18510 @ignore
18511 @mindex @null
18512 @end ignore
18513 @kindex H T
18514 @pindex calc-tanh
18515 @ignore
18516 @mindex @null
18517 @end ignore
18518 @tindex tanh
18519 @ignore
18520 @mindex @null
18521 @end ignore
18522 @kindex H I T
18523 @pindex calc-arctanh
18524 @ignore
18525 @mindex @null
18526 @end ignore
18527 @tindex arctanh
18528 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18529 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18530 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18531 variants of these functions.
18532
18533 @kindex f T
18534 @pindex calc-arctan2
18535 @tindex arctan2
18536 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18537 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18538 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18539 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18540 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18541 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18542 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18543 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18544 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18545 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18546
18547 @pindex calc-sincos
18548 @ignore
18549 @starindex
18550 @end ignore
18551 @tindex sincos
18552 @ignore
18553 @starindex
18554 @end ignore
18555 @ignore
18556 @mindex arc@idots
18557 @end ignore
18558 @tindex arcsincos
18559 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18560 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18561 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18562 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18563 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18564 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18565
18566 @pindex calc-sec
18567 @tindex sec
18568 @pindex calc-csc
18569 @tindex csc
18570 @pindex calc-cot
18571 @tindex cot
18572 @pindex calc-sech
18573 @tindex sech
18574 @pindex calc-csch
18575 @tindex csch
18576 @pindex calc-coth
18577 @tindex coth
18578 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18579 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
18580 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18581 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18582 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
18583 [@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18584
18585 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18586 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18587
18588 @noindent
18589 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18590 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18591 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18592 will work to arbitrarily large precision. They can not at present
18593 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18594
18595 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18596 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18597 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18598 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18599 slow for some values of the arguments.
18600
18601 @kindex f g
18602 @pindex calc-gamma
18603 @tindex gamma
18604 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18605 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18606 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18607 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18608 integral:
18609 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18610 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18611 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18612
18613 @kindex f G
18614 @tindex gammaP
18615 @ignore
18616 @mindex @idots
18617 @end ignore
18618 @kindex I f G
18619 @ignore
18620 @mindex @null
18621 @end ignore
18622 @kindex H f G
18623 @ignore
18624 @mindex @null
18625 @end ignore
18626 @kindex H I f G
18627 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18628 @ignore
18629 @mindex @null
18630 @end ignore
18631 @tindex gammaQ
18632 @ignore
18633 @mindex @null
18634 @end ignore
18635 @tindex gammag
18636 @ignore
18637 @mindex @null
18638 @end ignore
18639 @tindex gammaG
18640 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18641 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18642 the integral,
18643 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18644 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18645 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18646 definition of the normal gamma function).
18647
18648 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18649 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18650 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18651 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18652 @expr{x} to infinity.
18653
18654 @ifnottex
18655 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18656 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18657 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18658 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18659 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18660 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18661 @end ifnottex
18662 @tex
18663 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18664 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18665 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18666 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18667 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18668 @end tex
18669
18670 @kindex f b
18671 @pindex calc-beta
18672 @tindex beta
18673 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18674 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18675 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18676 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18677 or by
18678 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18679 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18680
18681 @kindex f B
18682 @kindex H f B
18683 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18684 @tindex betaI
18685 @tindex betaB
18686 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18687 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18688 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18689 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18690 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18691 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18692
18693 @kindex f e
18694 @kindex I f e
18695 @pindex calc-erf
18696 @tindex erf
18697 @tindex erfc
18698 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18699 error function
18700 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18701 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18702 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18703 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18704 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18705 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18706
18707 @kindex f j
18708 @kindex f y
18709 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18710 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18711 @tindex besJ
18712 @tindex besY
18713 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18714 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18715 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18716 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18717 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18718 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18719 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18720 Use with care!
18721
18722 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18723 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18724
18725 @noindent
18726 @cindex Branch cuts
18727 @cindex Principal values
18728 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18729 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18730 This section describes the values
18731 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18732 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18733 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18734 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18735 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18736
18737 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18738 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18739 versions of Calc follow the second edition.
18740
18741 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18742 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18743 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18744 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18745 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18746 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18747
18748 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18749 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18750 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18751 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18752
18753 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18754 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18755 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18756 in the right half of the complex plane.
18757
18758 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18759 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18760 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18761 negative real axis.
18762
18763 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18764 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18765 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18766 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18767 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18768
18769 @smallexample
18770 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18771 ----------------------------------------
18772 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18773 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18774 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18775 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18776 @end smallexample
18777
18778 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18779 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18780 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18781 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18782 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18783 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18784
18785 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18786 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18787
18788 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18789 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18790 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18791
18792 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18793 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18794 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18795
18796 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18797 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18798 above @expr{i}.
18799
18800 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18801 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18802 real axis less than 1.
18803
18804 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18805 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18806
18807 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18808 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18809 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18810
18811 @smallexample
18812 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18813 -------------------------------------------------------
18814 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18815 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18816 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18817 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18818 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18819 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18820 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18821 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18822 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18823 @end smallexample
18824
18825 @smallexample
18826 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18827 -----------------------------------------------------
18828 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18829 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18830 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18831 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18832 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18833 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18834 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18835 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18836 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18837 @end smallexample
18838
18839 @smallexample
18840 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18841 -----------------------------------------------------
18842 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18843 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18844 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18845 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18846 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18847 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18848 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18849 @end smallexample
18850
18851 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18852 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18853 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18854
18855 @smallexample
18856 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18857 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18858 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18859 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18860 @end smallexample
18861
18862 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18863 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18864 are not rigorously specified at present.
18865
18866 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18867 @section Random Numbers
18868
18869 @noindent
18870 @kindex k r
18871 @pindex calc-random
18872 @tindex random
18873 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18874 random numbers of various sorts.
18875
18876 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18877 integer @expr{N} in the range
18878 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18879 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18880 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18881
18882 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18883 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18884 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18885 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18886 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18887 the result is a random integer in the range
18888 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18889 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18890
18891 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18892 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18893 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18894 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18895 or
18896 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18897 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18898 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18899
18900 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18901 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18902 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18903 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18904
18905 If @expr{M} is an error form
18906 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18907 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18908 where @var{m} and
18909 @texline @math{\sigma}
18910 @infoline @var{s}
18911 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18912 @var{m} and standard deviation
18913 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18914 @infoline @var{s}.
18915
18916 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18917 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18918 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18919 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18920 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18921 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18922 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18923 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18924 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18925 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18926 extremely small.)
18927
18928 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18929 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18930
18931 @vindex RandSeed
18932 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18933 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18934 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18935 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18936 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18937 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18938 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18939 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18940 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18941 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18942 of random numbers as before.
18943
18944 @pindex calc-rrandom
18945 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18946 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18947
18948 @kindex k a
18949 @pindex calc-random-again
18950 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18951 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18952 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18953 that value of @expr{M}.
18954
18955 @kindex k h
18956 @pindex calc-shuffle
18957 @tindex shuffle
18958 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18959 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18960 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18961 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18962 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18963 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18964 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18965
18966 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18967 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18968 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18969 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18970 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18971 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18972 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18973 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18974 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18975 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18976 each make it into the result vector.)
18977
18978 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18979 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18980 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18981 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18982 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18983 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18984 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18985
18986 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18987 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18988 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18989 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18990 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18991
18992 @menu
18993 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18994 @end menu
18995
18996 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18997 @subsection Random Number Generator
18998
18999 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
19000 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
19001 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
19002 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
19003 characterization.
19004
19005 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs's built-in
19006 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
19007 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
19008 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
19009
19010 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
19011 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
19012 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
19013
19014 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
19015 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
19016 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
19017 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
19018 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
19019 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
19020 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
19021 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
19022
19023 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
19024 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
19025 computing
19026 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
19027 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
19028 This method expands the seed
19029 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
19030 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
19031 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
19032 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
19033 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
19034 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
19035 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
19036 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
19037 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
19038 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
19039 to reseed the generator with that number.
19040
19041 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
19042 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
19043 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
19044 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
19045 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
19046 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
19047 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
19048 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
19049 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
19050 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
19051 damage its randomness.
19052
19053 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
19054 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
19055 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
19056 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
19057 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
19058 value.
19059
19060 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
19061 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
19062 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
19063 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
19064 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
19065 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
19066 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
19067 numbers on the order of
19068 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
19069 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
19070 or
19071 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
19072 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
19073 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
19074 correspond to small integers times
19075 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
19076 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
19077
19078 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
19079 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
19080 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
19081 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
19082 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
19083 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
19084 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
19085 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
19086 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
19087 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
19088
19089 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
19090 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C@. This method
19091 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
19092 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
19093
19094 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
19095 @section Combinatorial Functions
19096
19097 @noindent
19098 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
19099 @kbd{k} key prefix.
19100
19101 @kindex k g
19102 @pindex calc-gcd
19103 @tindex gcd
19104 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
19105 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
19106 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
19107 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
19108 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
19109 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
19110 the operation is left in symbolic form.
19111
19112 @kindex k l
19113 @pindex calc-lcm
19114 @tindex lcm
19115 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19116 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19117 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19118 numbers.
19119
19120 @kindex k E
19121 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
19122 @tindex egcd
19123 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19124 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19125 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
19126 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19127 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19128
19129 @kindex !
19130 @pindex calc-factorial
19131 @tindex fact
19132 @ignore
19133 @mindex @null
19134 @end ignore
19135 @tindex !
19136 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19137 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19138 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19139 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19140 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19141 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19142 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19143 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19144 the commands in this section.
19145
19146 @kindex k d
19147 @pindex calc-double-factorial
19148 @tindex dfact
19149 @ignore
19150 @mindex @null
19151 @end ignore
19152 @tindex !!
19153 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19154 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19155 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19156 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19157 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19158 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19159 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19160
19161 @kindex k c
19162 @pindex calc-choose
19163 @tindex choose
19164 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19165 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19166 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19167 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19168 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19169 real numbers by
19170 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19171 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19172
19173 @kindex H k c
19174 @pindex calc-perm
19175 @tindex perm
19176 @ifnottex
19177 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19178 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19179 @end ifnottex
19180 @tex
19181 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19182 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19183 @end tex
19184
19185 @kindex k b
19186 @kindex H k b
19187 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19188 @tindex bern
19189 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19190 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19191 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19192 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19193 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19194 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19195 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19196
19197 @kindex k e
19198 @kindex H k e
19199 @pindex calc-euler-number
19200 @tindex euler
19201 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19202 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19203 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19204 functions.
19205
19206 @kindex k s
19207 @kindex H k s
19208 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19209 @tindex stir1
19210 @tindex stir2
19211 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19212 computes a Stirling number of the first
19213 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19214 @infoline kind,
19215 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19216 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19217 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19218 @infoline kind.
19219 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19220 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19221 non-empty sets, respectively.
19222
19223 @kindex k p
19224 @pindex calc-prime-test
19225 @cindex Primes
19226 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19227 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19228 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19229 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19230 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19231 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19232 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19233 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19234 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19235 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19236 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19237 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19238 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19239
19240 @ignore
19241 @starindex
19242 @end ignore
19243 @tindex prime
19244 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19245 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19246 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19247 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19248 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19249 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19250
19251 @kindex k f
19252 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19253 @tindex prfac
19254 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19255 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19256 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19257 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19258 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19259 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19260 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19261 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19262 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19263
19264 @kindex k n
19265 @pindex calc-next-prime
19266 @ignore
19267 @mindex nextpr@idots
19268 @end ignore
19269 @tindex nextprime
19270 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19271 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19272 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19273 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19274 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19275 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19276 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19277 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19278 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19279 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19280 prime.
19281
19282 @kindex I k n
19283 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19284 @ignore
19285 @mindex prevpr@idots
19286 @end ignore
19287 @tindex prevprime
19288 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19289 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19290
19291 @kindex k t
19292 @pindex calc-totient
19293 @tindex totient
19294 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19295 Euler ``totient''
19296 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19297 @infoline function,
19298 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19299 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19300
19301 @kindex k m
19302 @pindex calc-moebius
19303 @tindex moebius
19304 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19305 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19306 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19307 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19308 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19309 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19310 the result is zero.
19311
19312 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19313 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19314
19315 @noindent
19316 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19317 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19318 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19319 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19320 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19321 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19322 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19323 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19324
19325 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19326 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19327 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19328 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19329 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19330 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19331
19332 @kindex k B
19333 @kindex I k B
19334 @pindex calc-utpb
19335 @tindex utpb
19336 @tindex ltpb
19337 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19338 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19339 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19340 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19341 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19342 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19343 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19344
19345 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19346 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19347 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19348 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19349 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19350 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19351 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19352 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19353 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19354 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19355 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19356
19357 @kindex k C
19358 @pindex calc-utpc
19359 @tindex utpc
19360 @ignore
19361 @mindex @idots
19362 @end ignore
19363 @kindex I k C
19364 @ignore
19365 @mindex @null
19366 @end ignore
19367 @tindex ltpc
19368 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19369 @texline @math{\nu}
19370 @infoline @expr{v}
19371 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19372 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19373
19374 @kindex k F
19375 @pindex calc-utpf
19376 @tindex utpf
19377 @ignore
19378 @mindex @idots
19379 @end ignore
19380 @kindex I k F
19381 @ignore
19382 @mindex @null
19383 @end ignore
19384 @tindex ltpf
19385 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19386 various statistical tests. The parameters
19387 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19388 @infoline @expr{v1}
19389 and
19390 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19391 @infoline @expr{v2}
19392 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19393 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19394
19395 @kindex k N
19396 @pindex calc-utpn
19397 @tindex utpn
19398 @ignore
19399 @mindex @idots
19400 @end ignore
19401 @kindex I k N
19402 @ignore
19403 @mindex @null
19404 @end ignore
19405 @tindex ltpn
19406 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19407 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19408 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19409 @infoline @expr{s}.
19410 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19411 would exceed @expr{x}.
19412
19413 @kindex k P
19414 @pindex calc-utpp
19415 @tindex utpp
19416 @ignore
19417 @mindex @idots
19418 @end ignore
19419 @kindex I k P
19420 @ignore
19421 @mindex @null
19422 @end ignore
19423 @tindex ltpp
19424 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19425 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19426 Poisson random events will occur.
19427
19428 @kindex k T
19429 @pindex calc-ltpt
19430 @tindex utpt
19431 @ignore
19432 @mindex @idots
19433 @end ignore
19434 @kindex I k T
19435 @ignore
19436 @mindex @null
19437 @end ignore
19438 @tindex ltpt
19439 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19440 with
19441 @texline @math{\nu}
19442 @infoline @expr{v}
19443 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19444 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19445 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19446 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19447 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19448 where
19449 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19450 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19451 and
19452 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19453 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19454 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19455 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19456
19457 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19458 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19459 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19460 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19461 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19462
19463 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19464 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19465
19466 @noindent
19467 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19468 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19469 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19470 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19471 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19472
19473 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19474 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19475 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19476 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19477 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19478
19479 @menu
19480 * Packing and Unpacking::
19481 * Building Vectors::
19482 * Extracting Elements::
19483 * Manipulating Vectors::
19484 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19485 * Set Operations::
19486 * Statistical Operations::
19487 * Reducing and Mapping::
19488 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19489 @end menu
19490
19491 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19492 @section Packing and Unpacking
19493
19494 @noindent
19495 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19496 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19497 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19498 vectors.
19499
19500 @kindex v p
19501 @kindex V p
19502 @pindex calc-pack
19503 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19504 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19505 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19506 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19507 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19508 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19509 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19510 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19511
19512 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19513 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19514 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19515 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19516
19517 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19518
19519 @table @cite
19520 @item -1
19521 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19522 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19523 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19524 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19525 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19526 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19527 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19528 components are not suitable.)
19529
19530 @item -2
19531 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19532 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19533 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19534 mode.
19535
19536 @item -3
19537 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19538 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19539 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19540 number.
19541
19542 @item -4
19543 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19544 may be real numbers or formulas.
19545
19546 @item -5
19547 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19548 must be real numbers.
19549
19550 @item -6
19551 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19552 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19553
19554 @item -7
19555 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19556
19557 @item -8
19558 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19559
19560 @item -9
19561 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19562
19563 @item -10
19564 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19565
19566 @item -11
19567 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19568 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19569 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19570 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19571
19572 @item -12
19573 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19574 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19575 is desired.
19576
19577 @item -13
19578 A real number is converted into a date form.
19579
19580 @item -14
19581 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19582
19583 @item -15
19584 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19585 @end table
19586
19587 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19588 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19589 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19590 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19591 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19592 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19593 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19594 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19595 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19596 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19597
19598 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19599 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19600 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19601 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19602 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19603
19604 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19605 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19606 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19607 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19608 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19609
19610 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19611 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19612 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19613 @texline @math{2\times3}
19614 @infoline 2x3
19615 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19616 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19617 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19618
19619 @ignore
19620 @starindex
19621 @end ignore
19622 @tindex pack
19623 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19624 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19625 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19626 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19627 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19628 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19629 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19630 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19631 by the mode.
19632
19633 @kindex v u
19634 @kindex V u
19635 @pindex calc-unpack
19636 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19637 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19638 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19639 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19640 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19641 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19642
19643 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19644 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19645 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19646 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19647 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19648 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19649 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19650
19651 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19652 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19653 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19654 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19655 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19656 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19657 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19658 is not a composite object.
19659
19660 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19661 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19662 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19663 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19664 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19665 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19666 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19667 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19668
19669 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19670 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19671 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19672 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19673 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19674 original object.
19675
19676 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19677 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19678 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19679 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19680
19681 @ignore
19682 @starindex
19683 @end ignore
19684 @tindex unpack
19685 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19686 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19687 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19688 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19689 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19690 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19691
19692 @ignore
19693 @starindex
19694 @end ignore
19695 @tindex unpackt
19696 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19697 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19698 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19699 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19700 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19701 The identity for re-building the original object is
19702 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19703 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19704 name and a vector of arguments.)
19705
19706 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19707 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19708 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19709 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19710
19711 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19712 @section Building Vectors
19713
19714 @noindent
19715 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19716 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19717
19718 @kindex |
19719 @pindex calc-concat
19720 @ignore
19721 @mindex @null
19722 @end ignore
19723 @tindex |
19724 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19725 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19726 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19727 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19728 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19729 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19730
19731 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19732 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19733 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19734 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19735 one-row matrix.
19736
19737 @kindex H |
19738 @tindex append
19739 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19740 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19741 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19742 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19743 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19744
19745 @kindex I |
19746 @kindex H I |
19747 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19748 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19749 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19750
19751 @kindex v d
19752 @kindex V d
19753 @pindex calc-diag
19754 @tindex diag
19755 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19756 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19757 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19758 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19759 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19760 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19761 the prefix argument is required.
19762
19763 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19764 @texline @math{3\times3}
19765 @infoline 3x3
19766 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19767 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19768 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19769
19770 @kindex v i
19771 @kindex V i
19772 @pindex calc-ident
19773 @tindex idn
19774 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19775 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19776 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19777 this command prompts for one.
19778
19779 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19780 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19781 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19782 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19783 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19784 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19785 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19786 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19787 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19788 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19789 dimensions.
19790
19791 @kindex v x
19792 @kindex V x
19793 @pindex calc-index
19794 @tindex index
19795 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19796 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19797 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19798 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19799 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19800
19801 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19802 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19803 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19804 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19805 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19806 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19807 of numbers or formulas.
19808
19809 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19810 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19811 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19812 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19813 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19814 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19815
19816 @kindex v b
19817 @kindex V b
19818 @pindex calc-build-vector
19819 @tindex cvec
19820 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19821 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19822 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19823 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19824 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19825 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19826
19827 @kindex v h
19828 @kindex V h
19829 @kindex I v h
19830 @kindex I V h
19831 @pindex calc-head
19832 @pindex calc-tail
19833 @tindex head
19834 @tindex tail
19835 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19836 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19837 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19838 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19839
19840 @kindex v k
19841 @kindex V k
19842 @pindex calc-cons
19843 @tindex cons
19844 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19845 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19846 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19847 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19848 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19849
19850 @kindex H v h
19851 @kindex H V h
19852 @tindex rhead
19853 @ignore
19854 @mindex @idots
19855 @end ignore
19856 @kindex H I v h
19857 @kindex H I V h
19858 @ignore
19859 @mindex @null
19860 @end ignore
19861 @kindex H v k
19862 @kindex H V k
19863 @ignore
19864 @mindex @null
19865 @end ignore
19866 @tindex rtail
19867 @ignore
19868 @mindex @null
19869 @end ignore
19870 @tindex rcons
19871 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19872 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19873 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19874 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19875 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19876 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19877 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19878
19879 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19880 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19881
19882 @noindent
19883 @kindex v r
19884 @kindex V r
19885 @pindex calc-mrow
19886 @tindex mrow
19887 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19888 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19889 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19890 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19891 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19892 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19893
19894 @cindex Permutations, applying
19895 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19896 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19897 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19898 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19899 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19900 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19901
19902 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19903 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19904 submatrix is returned.
19905
19906 @cindex Subscript notation
19907 @kindex a _
19908 @pindex calc-subscript
19909 @tindex subscr
19910 @tindex _
19911 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19912 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19913 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19914 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19915 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19916 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19917 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19918 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19919 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19920 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19921
19922 @tindex mrrow
19923 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19924 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19925 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19926 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19927 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19928
19929 @tindex getdiag
19930 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19931 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19932 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19933
19934 @kindex v c
19935 @kindex V c
19936 @pindex calc-mcol
19937 @tindex mcol
19938 @tindex mrcol
19939 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19940 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19941 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19942 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19943 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19944 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19945
19946 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19947 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19948 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19949 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19950 of matrix @expr{m}.
19951
19952 @kindex v s
19953 @kindex V s
19954 @pindex calc-subvector
19955 @tindex subvec
19956 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19957 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19958 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19959 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19960 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19961 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19962 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19963 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19964
19965 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19966 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19967 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19968 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19969 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19970 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19971 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19972
19973 @kindex I v s
19974 @kindex I V s
19975 @tindex rsubvec
19976 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19977 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19978 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19979 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19980 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19981
19982 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19983 vectors one element at a time.
19984
19985 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19986 @section Manipulating Vectors
19987
19988 @noindent
19989 @kindex v l
19990 @kindex V l
19991 @pindex calc-vlength
19992 @tindex vlen
19993 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19994 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19995 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19996 command.
19997
19998 @kindex H v l
19999 @kindex H V l
20000 @tindex mdims
20001 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
20002 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
20003 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
20004 its argument is a
20005 @texline @math{2\times3}
20006 @infoline 2x3
20007 matrix.
20008
20009 @kindex v f
20010 @kindex V f
20011 @pindex calc-vector-find
20012 @tindex find
20013 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
20014 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
20015 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
20016 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
20017 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
20018 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
20019
20020 @kindex v a
20021 @kindex V a
20022 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
20023 @tindex arrange
20024 @cindex Arranging a matrix
20025 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
20026 @cindex Flattening a matrix
20027 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
20028 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
20029 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
20030 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
20031 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
20032 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
20033 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
20034 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
20035 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
20036 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
20037 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
20038 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
20039 @texline @math{1\times4}
20040 @infoline 1x4
20041 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
20042 @texline @math{4\times1}
20043 @infoline 4x1
20044 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
20045 @texline @math{2\times2}
20046 @infoline 2x2
20047 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
20048 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
20049 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
20050
20051 @cindex Sorting data
20052 @kindex v S
20053 @kindex V S
20054 @kindex I v S
20055 @kindex I V S
20056 @pindex calc-sort
20057 @tindex sort
20058 @tindex rsort
20059 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
20060 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
20061 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
20062 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
20063 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
20064 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
20065 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
20066 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
20067 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
20068 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
20069 alphabetical order by this command.
20070
20071 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
20072
20073 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
20074 @cindex Inverse of permutation
20075 @cindex Index tables
20076 @cindex Rank tables
20077 @kindex v G
20078 @kindex V G
20079 @kindex I v G
20080 @kindex I V G
20081 @pindex calc-grade
20082 @tindex grade
20083 @tindex rgrade
20084 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
20085 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
20086 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
20087 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
20088 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
20089 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
20090 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
20091 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
20092 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
20093 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
20094 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
20095 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
20096 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
20097
20098 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
20099 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
20100 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
20101 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
20102 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
20103 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
20104 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
20105 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
20106 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
20107 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
20108 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
20109
20110 @cindex Histograms
20111 @kindex v H
20112 @kindex V H
20113 @pindex calc-histogram
20114 @ignore
20115 @mindex histo@idots
20116 @end ignore
20117 @tindex histogram
20118 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
20119 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
20120 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
20121 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
20122 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
20123 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
20124 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
20125 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
20126 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
20127 input vector.)
20128
20129 If no prefix is given, then you will be prompted for a vector which
20130 will be used to determine the bins. (If a positive integer is given at
20131 this prompt, it will be still treated as if it were given as a
20132 prefix.) Each bin will consist of the interval of numbers closest to
20133 the corresponding number of this new vector; if the vector
20134 @expr{[a, b, c, ...]} is entered at the prompt, the bins will be
20135 @expr{(-inf, (a+b)/2]}, @expr{((a+b)/2, (b+c)/2]}, etc. The result of
20136 this command will be a vector counting how many elements of the
20137 original vector are in each bin.
20138
20139 The result will then be a vector with the same length as this new vector;
20140 each element of the new vector will be replaced by the number of
20141 elements of the original vector which are closest to it.
20142
20143 @kindex H v H
20144 @kindex H V H
20145 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20146 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20147 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20148 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20149 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20150 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20151
20152 @kindex v t
20153 @kindex V t
20154 @pindex calc-transpose
20155 @tindex trn
20156 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20157 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20158 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20159 a one-column matrix.
20160
20161 @kindex v v
20162 @kindex V v
20163 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
20164 @tindex rev
20165 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
20166 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20167 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20168 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20169 a matrix.)
20170
20171 @kindex v m
20172 @kindex V m
20173 @pindex calc-mask-vector
20174 @tindex vmask
20175 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20176 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20177 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20178 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20179 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20180 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20181 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20182 @xref{Logical Operations}.
20183
20184 @kindex v e
20185 @kindex V e
20186 @pindex calc-expand-vector
20187 @tindex vexp
20188 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20189 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20190 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20191 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20192 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20193 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20194 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20195 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20196 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20197
20198 @kindex H v e
20199 @kindex H V e
20200 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20201 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20202 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20203 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20204 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20205 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20206 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20207 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20208 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20209
20210 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20211 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20212 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20213 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20214 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20215 masking using vectors.
20216
20217 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20218 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20219
20220 @noindent
20221 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20222 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20223 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20224 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20225 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20226
20227 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20228 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20229 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20230 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20231
20232 @kindex v J
20233 @kindex V J
20234 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20235 @tindex ctrn
20236 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20237 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20238
20239 @ignore
20240 @mindex A
20241 @end ignore
20242 @kindex A (vectors)
20243 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20244 @ignore
20245 @mindex abs
20246 @end ignore
20247 @tindex abs (vectors)
20248 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20249 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20250 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20251 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20252 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20253 from that point to the origin.
20254
20255 @kindex v n
20256 @kindex V n
20257 @pindex calc-rnorm
20258 @tindex rnorm
20259 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20260 infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20261 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20262 a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20263 the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
20264
20265 @kindex v N
20266 @kindex V N
20267 @pindex calc-cnorm
20268 @tindex cnorm
20269 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20270 the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
20271 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20272 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20273 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20274 not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20275 vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
20276
20277 @kindex v C
20278 @kindex V C
20279 @pindex calc-cross
20280 @tindex cross
20281 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20282 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20283 exactly three elements.
20284
20285 @ignore
20286 @mindex &
20287 @end ignore
20288 @kindex & (matrices)
20289 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20290 @ignore
20291 @mindex inv
20292 @end ignore
20293 @tindex inv (matrices)
20294 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20295 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20296 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20297 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20298 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20299 quickly in the future.
20300
20301 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20302 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20303 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20304 by a matrix.
20305
20306 @kindex v D
20307 @kindex V D
20308 @pindex calc-mdet
20309 @tindex det
20310 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20311 determinant of a square matrix.
20312
20313 @kindex v L
20314 @kindex V L
20315 @pindex calc-mlud
20316 @tindex lud
20317 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20318 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20319 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20320 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20321 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20322 and the third is upper-triangular.
20323
20324 @kindex v T
20325 @kindex V T
20326 @pindex calc-mtrace
20327 @tindex tr
20328 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20329 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20330 elements of the matrix.
20331
20332 @kindex v K
20333 @kindex V K
20334 @pindex calc-kron
20335 @tindex kron
20336 The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20337 the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20338
20339 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20340 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20341
20342 @noindent
20343 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20344 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20345 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20346 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20347 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20348 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20349 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20350 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20351 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20352 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20353 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20354 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20355 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20356
20357 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20358 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20359 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20360 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20361 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20362 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20363
20364 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20365 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20366 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20367 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20368
20369 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20370 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20371 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20372
20373 @kindex v +
20374 @kindex V +
20375 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20376 @tindex rdup
20377 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20378 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20379 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20380 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20381 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20382 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20383 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20384 them.
20385
20386 @kindex v V
20387 @kindex V V
20388 @pindex calc-set-union
20389 @tindex vunion
20390 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20391 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20392 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20393 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20394 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20395
20396 @kindex v ^
20397 @kindex V ^
20398 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20399 @tindex vint
20400 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20401 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20402 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20403 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20404 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20405 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20406 notation for set
20407 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20408 @infoline union
20409 and
20410 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20411 @infoline intersection.
20412
20413 @kindex v -
20414 @kindex V -
20415 @pindex calc-set-difference
20416 @tindex vdiff
20417 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20418 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20419 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20420 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20421 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20422 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20423 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20424 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20425 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20426 enough to express in a few intervals).
20427
20428 @kindex v X
20429 @kindex V X
20430 @pindex calc-set-xor
20431 @tindex vxor
20432 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20433 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20434 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20435 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20436 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20437
20438 @kindex v ~
20439 @kindex V ~
20440 @pindex calc-set-complement
20441 @tindex vcompl
20442 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20443 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20444 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20445 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20446 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20447
20448 @kindex v F
20449 @kindex V F
20450 @pindex calc-set-floor
20451 @tindex vfloor
20452 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20453 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20454 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20455 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20456 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20457 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20458 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20459 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20460
20461 @kindex v E
20462 @kindex V E
20463 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20464 @tindex venum
20465 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20466 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20467 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20468 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20469 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20470
20471 @kindex v :
20472 @kindex V :
20473 @pindex calc-set-span
20474 @tindex vspan
20475 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20476 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20477 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20478 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20479 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20480
20481 @kindex v #
20482 @kindex V #
20483 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20484 @tindex vcard
20485 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20486 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20487 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20488 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20489
20490 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20491 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20492 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20493 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20494 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20495 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20496 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20497 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20498 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20499 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20500 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20501 convenient to you.
20502
20503 @kindex b p
20504 @kindex b u
20505 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20506 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20507 @tindex vpack
20508 @tindex vunpack
20509 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20510 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20511 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20512 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20513 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20514 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20515 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20516 (binary) prefix key.
20517
20518 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20519 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20520 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20521 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20522 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20523 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20524 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20525 representation
20526 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20527 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20528
20529 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20530 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20531
20532 @noindent
20533 @cindex Statistical functions
20534 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20535 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20536 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20537 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20538 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20539 Vetterling.
20540
20541 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20542 a shifted letter or other character.
20543
20544 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20545 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20546
20547 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20548 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20549
20550 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20551 probability distribution functions.
20552
20553 @menu
20554 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20555 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20556 @end menu
20557
20558 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20559 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20560
20561 @noindent
20562 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20563 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20564 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20565 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20566 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20567 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20568 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20569
20570 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20571 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20572 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20573 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20574
20575 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20576 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20577 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20578 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20579 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20580 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20581 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20582
20583 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20584 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20585 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20586 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20587 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20588 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20589 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20590 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20591 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20592 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20593
20594 @kindex u #
20595 @pindex calc-vector-count
20596 @tindex vcount
20597 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20598 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20599 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20600 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20601 simply computes the length of the vector.
20602
20603 @kindex u +
20604 @kindex u *
20605 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20606 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20607 @tindex vsum
20608 @tindex vprod
20609 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20610 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20611 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20612 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20613 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20614 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20615 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20616
20617 @kindex u X
20618 @kindex u N
20619 @pindex calc-vector-max
20620 @pindex calc-vector-min
20621 @tindex vmax
20622 @tindex vmin
20623 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20624 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20625 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20626 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20627 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20628 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20629 plus or minus infinity.
20630
20631 @kindex u M
20632 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20633 @tindex vmean
20634 @cindex Mean of data values
20635 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20636 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20637 If the inputs are error forms
20638 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20639 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20640 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20641 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20642 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20643 @tex
20644 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20645 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20646 @end tex
20647 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20648 values divided by the count of the values.
20649
20650 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20651 error
20652 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20653 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20654 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20655 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20656 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20657 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20658 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20659 weight is completely negligible.)
20660
20661 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20662 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20663 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20664 and maximum values of the interval.
20665
20666 @kindex I u M
20667 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20668 @tindex vmeane
20669 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20670 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20671 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20672 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20673 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20674 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20675 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20676 @tex
20677 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20678 @end tex
20679 If the inputs are plain
20680 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20681 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20682 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20683 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20684 deviation.)
20685 @tex
20686 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20687 @end tex
20688
20689 @kindex H u M
20690 @pindex calc-vector-median
20691 @tindex vmedian
20692 @cindex Median of data values
20693 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20694 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20695 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20696 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20697 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20698 The median function is different from the other functions in
20699 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20700 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20701 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20702 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20703 ignored.
20704
20705 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20706 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20707 the same as the mean.
20708
20709 @kindex H I u M
20710 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20711 @tindex vhmean
20712 @cindex Harmonic mean
20713 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20714 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20715 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20716 of the values.
20717 @tex
20718 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20719 @end tex
20720
20721 @kindex u G
20722 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20723 @tindex vgmean
20724 @cindex Geometric mean
20725 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20726 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20727 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20728 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20729 of the data values.
20730 @tex
20731 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20732 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20733 @end tex
20734
20735 @kindex H u G
20736 @tindex agmean
20737 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20738 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20739 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20740 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20741 @tex
20742 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20743 @end tex
20744
20745 @cindex Root-mean-square
20746 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20747 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20748
20749 @kindex u S
20750 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20751 @tindex vsdev
20752 @cindex Standard deviation
20753 @cindex Sample statistics
20754 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20755 computes the standard
20756 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20757 @infoline deviation
20758 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20759 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20760 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20761 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20762 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20763 @tex
20764 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20765 @end tex
20766
20767 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20768 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20769 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20770 limits, divided by
20771 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20772 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20773 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20774 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20775
20776 @kindex I u S
20777 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20778 @tindex vpsdev
20779 @cindex Population statistics
20780 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20781 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20782 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20783 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20784 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20785 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20786 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20787 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20788 only an estimate of the true mean.
20789 @tex
20790 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20791 @end tex
20792
20793 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20794 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20795 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20796
20797 @kindex H u S
20798 @kindex H I u S
20799 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20800 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20801 @tindex vvar
20802 @tindex vpvar
20803 @cindex Variance of data values
20804 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20805 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20806 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20807 is the
20808 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20809 @infoline square
20810 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20811 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20812 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20813
20814 @ignore
20815 @starindex
20816 @end ignore
20817 @tindex vflat
20818 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20819 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20820 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20821 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20822
20823 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20824 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20825
20826 @noindent
20827 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20828 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20829 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20830 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20831 the stack, which must be an
20832 @texline @math{N\times2}
20833 @infoline Nx2
20834 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20835 of actual vectors and matrices.
20836
20837 @kindex u C
20838 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20839 @tindex vcov
20840 @cindex Covariance
20841 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20842 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20843 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20844 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20845 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20846 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20847 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20848 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20849 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20850 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20851 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20852 input errors.
20853 @tex
20854 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20855 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20856 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20857 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20858 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20859 $$
20860 @end tex
20861
20862 @kindex I u C
20863 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20864 @tindex vpcov
20865 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20866 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20867 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20868 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20869
20870 @kindex H u C
20871 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20872 @tindex vcorr
20873 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20874 @cindex Linear correlation
20875 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20876 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20877 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20878 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20879 between sample or population statistics here.)
20880 @tex
20881 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20882 @end tex
20883
20884 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20885 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20886
20887 @noindent
20888 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20889 elements of vectors.
20890
20891 @kindex v A
20892 @kindex V A
20893 @pindex calc-apply
20894 @tindex apply
20895 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20896 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20897 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20898 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20899 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20900 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20901 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20902
20903 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20904 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20905
20906 @menu
20907 * Specifying Operators::
20908 * Mapping::
20909 * Reducing::
20910 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20911 * Generalized Products::
20912 @end menu
20913
20914 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20915 @subsection Specifying Operators
20916
20917 @noindent
20918 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20919 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20920 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20921 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20922 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20923 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20924 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20925 element as its argument.)
20926
20927 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20928 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20929 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20930 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20931 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20932 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20933 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20934 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20935 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20936 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20937 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20938 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20939 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20940 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20941 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20942
20943 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20944 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20945 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20946 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20947 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20948 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20949 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20950 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20951 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20952 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20953
20954 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20955 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20956 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20957 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20958 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20959 entry interacts with the stack.)
20960
20961 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20962 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20963 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20964 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20965 prompted for an argument list.
20966
20967 @cindex Nameless functions
20968 @cindex Generic functions
20969 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20970 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20971 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20972 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20973 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20974 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20975 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20976 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20977 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20978 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20979 can get it back later if you wish.
20980
20981 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20982 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20983 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20984 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20985 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20986
20987 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20988 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20989 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20990 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20991 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20992 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20993 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20994
20995 @cindex Lambda expressions
20996 @ignore
20997 @starindex
20998 @end ignore
20999 @tindex lambda
21000 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
21001 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
21002 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
21003 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
21004 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
21005 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
21006 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
21007
21008 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
21009 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
21010 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
21011 called.)
21012
21013 @tindex add
21014 @tindex sub
21015 @ignore
21016 @mindex @idots
21017 @end ignore
21018 @tindex mul
21019 @ignore
21020 @mindex @null
21021 @end ignore
21022 @tindex div
21023 @ignore
21024 @mindex @null
21025 @end ignore
21026 @tindex pow
21027 @ignore
21028 @mindex @null
21029 @end ignore
21030 @tindex neg
21031 @ignore
21032 @mindex @null
21033 @end ignore
21034 @tindex mod
21035 @ignore
21036 @mindex @null
21037 @end ignore
21038 @tindex vconcat
21039 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
21040 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
21041 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
21042 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
21043 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
21044 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
21045 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
21046 @code{vconcat}.
21047
21048 @ignore
21049 @starindex
21050 @end ignore
21051 @tindex call
21052 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
21053 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
21054 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
21055 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
21056 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
21057 as @samp{x + 2y}).
21058
21059 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
21060 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
21061 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
21062 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
21063 about it.)
21064
21065 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
21066 @subsection Mapping
21067
21068 @noindent
21069 @kindex v M
21070 @kindex V M
21071 @pindex calc-map
21072 @tindex map
21073 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
21074 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
21075 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
21076 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
21077 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
21078 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
21079 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
21080 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
21081 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
21082 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
21083 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
21084 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
21085
21086 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
21087 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
21088 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
21089 produce another
21090 @texline @math{3\times2}
21091 @infoline 3x2
21092 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
21093
21094 @tindex mapr
21095 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
21096 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
21097 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
21098 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
21099 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
21100 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
21101 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
21102 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
21103 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
21104
21105 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
21106 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
21107 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
21108 their individual elements.
21109
21110 @tindex mapc
21111 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
21112 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
21113 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
21114 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
21115 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
21116 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
21117
21118 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
21119 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
21120 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
21121 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
21122
21123 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
21124 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
21125 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
21126 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
21127 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
21128 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
21129
21130 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
21131 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
21132 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
21133 column.
21134
21135 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
21136 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
21137 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
21138 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
21139 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
21140 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
21141 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
21142 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
21143 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
21144 mapped over the elements of each row.)
21145
21146 @tindex mapa
21147 @tindex mapd
21148 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
21149 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
21150 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
21151 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
21152 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
21153 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
21154 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
21155 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
21156
21157 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
21158 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
21159 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
21160 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
21161
21162 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
21163 @subsection Reducing
21164
21165 @noindent
21166 @kindex v R
21167 @kindex V R
21168 @pindex calc-reduce
21169 @tindex reduce
21170 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21171 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21172 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21173 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21174 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21175 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21176 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21177 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21178
21179 @kindex I v R
21180 @kindex I V R
21181 @tindex rreduce
21182 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21183 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21184 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21185 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21186 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21187 in power series expansions.
21188
21189 @kindex v U
21190 @kindex V U
21191 @tindex accum
21192 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21193 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21194 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21195 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21196 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21197 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21198
21199 @kindex I v U
21200 @kindex I V U
21201 @tindex raccum
21202 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21203 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21204 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21205
21206 @tindex reducea
21207 @tindex rreducea
21208 @tindex reduced
21209 @tindex rreduced
21210 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21211 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21212 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21213 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21214 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21215 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21216 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21217 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21218 b + e, c + f]}.
21219
21220 @tindex reducer
21221 @tindex rreducer
21222 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21223 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21224 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21225 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21226 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21227 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21228 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21229
21230 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21231 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21232
21233 @tindex reducec
21234 @tindex rreducec
21235 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21236 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21237
21238 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21239 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21240 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21241 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21242
21243 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21244 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21245
21246 @noindent
21247 @kindex H v R
21248 @kindex H V R
21249 @tindex nest
21250 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21251 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21252 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21253 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21254 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21255 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21256 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21257
21258 @kindex H v U
21259 @kindex H V U
21260 @tindex anest
21261 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21262 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21263 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21264 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21265 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21266
21267 @kindex H I v R
21268 @kindex H I V R
21269 @tindex fixp
21270 @cindex Fixed points
21271 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21272 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21273 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21274 no longer changes.
21275
21276 @kindex H I v U
21277 @kindex H I V U
21278 @tindex afixp
21279 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21280 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21281 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21282 by @code{fixp}.
21283
21284 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21285 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21286 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21287 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21288 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21289 to converge to 0.739085.)
21290
21291 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21292 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21293 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21294 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21295 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21296 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21297 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21298
21299 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21300 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21301 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21302 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21303 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21304 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21305 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21306 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21307
21308 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21309 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21310 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21311 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21312 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21313 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21314 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21315 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21316 exactly equal.)
21317
21318 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21319 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21320 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21321 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21322
21323 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21324 @subsection Generalized Products
21325
21326 @kindex v O
21327 @kindex V O
21328 @pindex calc-outer-product
21329 @tindex outer
21330 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21331 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21332 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21333 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21334 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21335 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21336 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21337
21338 @kindex v I
21339 @kindex V I
21340 @pindex calc-inner-product
21341 @tindex inner
21342 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21343 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21344 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21345 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21346 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21347 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21348 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21349 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21350 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21351 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21352 generalized dot product.
21353
21354 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21355 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21356 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21357 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21358 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21359
21360 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21361 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21362
21363 @noindent
21364 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21365 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21366 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21367 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21368 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21369 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21370
21371 @kindex v <
21372 @kindex V <
21373 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21374 @kindex v =
21375 @kindex V =
21376 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21377 @kindex v >
21378 @kindex V >
21379 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21380 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21381 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21382 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21383 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21384
21385 @kindex v [
21386 @kindex V [
21387 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21388 @kindex v @{
21389 @kindex V @{
21390 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21391 @kindex v (
21392 @kindex V (
21393 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21394 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21395 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21396 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21397 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21398 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21399 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21400 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21401 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21402 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21403 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21404
21405 @kindex V ]
21406 @kindex v ]
21407 @kindex V )
21408 @kindex v )
21409 @kindex V @}
21410 @kindex v @}
21411 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21412 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21413 ``big'' style display of matrices, for matrices which have more than
21414 one row. It prompts for a string of code letters; currently
21415 implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables brackets on each row
21416 of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer brackets in opposite
21417 corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which enables commas or
21418 semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last. The default format
21419 is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format was fixed at @samp{ROC}.)
21420 Here are some example matrices:
21421
21422 @example
21423 @group
21424 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21425 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21426 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21427
21428 RO ROC
21429
21430 @end group
21431 @end example
21432 @noindent
21433 @example
21434 @group
21435 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21436 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21437 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21438
21439 O OC
21440
21441 @end group
21442 @end example
21443 @noindent
21444 @example
21445 @group
21446 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21447 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21448 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21449
21450 R @r{blank}
21451 @end group
21452 @end example
21453
21454 @noindent
21455 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21456 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21457 the others are useful for display only.
21458
21459 @kindex v ,
21460 @kindex V ,
21461 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21462 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21463 off in vector and matrix display.
21464
21465 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21466 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21467 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21468 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21469 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21470 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21471 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21472 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21473 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21474
21475 @kindex v .
21476 @kindex V .
21477 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21478 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21479 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21480 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21481 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21482 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21483 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21484 improve Calc's display speed.
21485
21486 @kindex t .
21487 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21488 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21489 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21490 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21491 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21492 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21493 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21494 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21495 that involve the trail.
21496
21497 @kindex v /
21498 @kindex V /
21499 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21500 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21501 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21502 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21503 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21504 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21505 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21506
21507 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21508 @chapter Algebra
21509
21510 @noindent
21511 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21512 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21513 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21514 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21515 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21516 is discussed.
21517
21518 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21519 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21520 for anything else'') prefix.
21521
21522 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21523 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21524
21525 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21526 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21527 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21528 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21529 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21530 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21531 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21532
21533 @menu
21534 * Selecting Subformulas::
21535 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21536 * Simplifying Formulas::
21537 * Polynomials::
21538 * Calculus::
21539 * Solving Equations::
21540 * Numerical Solutions::
21541 * Curve Fitting::
21542 * Summations::
21543 * Logical Operations::
21544 * Rewrite Rules::
21545 @end menu
21546
21547 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21548 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21549
21550 @noindent
21551 @cindex Selections
21552 @cindex Sub-formulas
21553 @cindex Parts of formulas
21554 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21555 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21556 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21557 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21558 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21559 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21560
21561 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21562 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21563 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21564
21565 @menu
21566 * Making Selections::
21567 * Changing Selections::
21568 * Displaying Selections::
21569 * Operating on Selections::
21570 * Rearranging with Selections::
21571 @end menu
21572
21573 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21574 @subsection Making Selections
21575
21576 @noindent
21577 @kindex j s
21578 @pindex calc-select-here
21579 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21580 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21581 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21582 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21583 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21584 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21585 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21586
21587 @smallexample
21588 @group
21589 3 ___
21590 (a + b) + V c
21591 1: ---------------
21592 2 x + 1
21593 @end group
21594 @end smallexample
21595
21596 @noindent
21597 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21598 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21599 to
21600
21601 @smallexample
21602 @group
21603 . ...
21604 .. . b. . . .
21605 1* ...............
21606 . . . .
21607 @end group
21608 @end smallexample
21609
21610 @noindent
21611 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21612 to a dot. (If the customizable variable
21613 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the characters
21614 not part of the sub-formula are de-emphasized by using a less
21615 noticeable face instead of using dots. @pxref{Displaying Selections}.)
21616 The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21617 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21618 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21619 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21620 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21621
21622 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21623 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21624
21625 @smallexample
21626 @group
21627 . ...
21628 (a + b) . . .
21629 1* ...............
21630 . . . .
21631 @end group
21632 @end smallexample
21633
21634 @noindent
21635 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21636 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21637 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21638 would have had the same effect.
21639
21640 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21641 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21642 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21643 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21644
21645 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21646 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21647 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21648 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21649 and so on.
21650
21651 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21652 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21653
21654 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21655 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21656 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21657 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21658 cursor on any stack entry.
21659
21660 @kindex j a
21661 @pindex calc-select-additional
21662 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21663 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21664 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21665 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21666 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21667 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21668
21669 @kindex j o
21670 @pindex calc-select-once
21671 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21672 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21673 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21674 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21675 by the cursor.
21676
21677 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21678 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21679 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21680 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21681
21682 @kindex j S
21683 @kindex j O
21684 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21685 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21686 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21687 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21688 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21689 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21690 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21691 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21692 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21693 commands.
21694
21695 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21696 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21697 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21698 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21699 entire four-term sum.
21700
21701 @kindex j b
21702 @pindex calc-break-selections
21703 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21704 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21705 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21706 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21707 obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21708 right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21709 with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21710 c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21711 considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21712 although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21713 as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21714 U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21715 (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21716
21717 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21718 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21719 you get.
21720
21721 @kindex j u
21722 @pindex calc-unselect
21723 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21724 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21725 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21726 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21727 position.
21728
21729 @kindex j c
21730 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21731 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21732 stack elements.
21733
21734 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21735 @subsection Changing Selections
21736
21737 @noindent
21738 @kindex j m
21739 @pindex calc-select-more
21740 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21741 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21742 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21743
21744 @smallexample
21745 @group
21746 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21747 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21748 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21749 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21750 @end group
21751 @end smallexample
21752
21753 @noindent
21754 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21755 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21756 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21757
21758 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21759 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21760 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21761 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21762 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21763
21764 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21765 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21766 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21767 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21768
21769 @kindex j l
21770 @pindex calc-select-less
21771 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21772 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21773 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21774 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21775 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21776
21777 @kindex j 1-9
21778 @pindex calc-select-part
21779 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21780 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21781 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21782 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21783 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21784 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21785 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21786 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21787
21788 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21789 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21790 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21791 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21792 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21793
21794 @kindex j n
21795 @kindex j p
21796 @pindex calc-select-next
21797 @pindex calc-select-previous
21798 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21799 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21800 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21801 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21802 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21803 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21804 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21805 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21806 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21807 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21808
21809 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21810 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21811 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21812
21813 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21814 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21815 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21816 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21817 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21818 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21819 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21820 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21821 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21822
21823 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21824 @subsection Displaying Selections
21825
21826 @noindent
21827 @kindex j d
21828 @pindex calc-show-selections
21829 @vindex calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
21830 @vindex calc-selected-face
21831 @vindex calc-nonselected-face
21832 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21833 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21834 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21835 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21836 by @samp{#} signs:
21837
21838 @smallexample
21839 @group
21840 3 ... # ___
21841 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21842 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21843 . . . . 2 x + 1
21844 @end group
21845 @end smallexample
21846 If the customizable variable
21847 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the
21848 non-selected portion of the formula will be de-emphasized by using a
21849 less noticeable face (@code{calc-nonselected-face}) instead of dots
21850 and the selected sub-formula will be highlighted by using a more
21851 noticeable face (@code{calc-selected-face}) instead of @samp{#}
21852 signs. (@pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
21853
21854 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21855 @subsection Operating on Selections
21856
21857 @noindent
21858 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21859 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21860 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21861 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21862 given stack element.)
21863
21864 @kindex j e
21865 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21866 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21867 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21868 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21869 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21870 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21871 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21872
21873 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21874 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21875 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21876 element.
21877
21878 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21879 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21880 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21881 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21882 portion to the top of the stack.
21883
21884 @smallexample
21885 @group
21886 3 ... ... ___
21887 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21888 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21889 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21890
21891 3 3
21892 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21893 @end group
21894 @end smallexample
21895
21896 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21897 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21898 the complete, edited formula.
21899
21900 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21901 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21902
21903 @kindex j '
21904 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21905 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21906 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21907 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21908 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21909 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21910 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21911 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21912 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21913 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21914
21915 @kindex j `
21916 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21917 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21918 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21919 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21920 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21921
21922 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21923 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21924 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21925 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21926
21927 @smallexample
21928 @group
21929 ###
21930 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21931 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21932 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21933 @end group
21934 @end smallexample
21935
21936 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21937 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21938 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21939 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21940 and resimplifies.
21941
21942 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21943 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21944 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21945
21946 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21947 @pindex calc-del-selection
21948 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21949 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21950 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21951 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21952 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21953
21954 @kindex j @key{RET}
21955 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21956 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21957 command.)
21958
21959 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21960 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21961 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21962 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21963
21964 @smallexample
21965 @group
21966 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21967 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21968 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21969 V 4 - 2 x
21970 @end group
21971 @end smallexample
21972
21973 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21974 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21975 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21976 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21977 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21978 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21979 the command will abort with an error message.
21980
21981 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21982 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21983 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21984 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21985
21986 @smallexample
21987 @group
21988 .. . .. .
21989 1* .......... 1* ...........
21990 ......... ..........
21991 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21992 @end group
21993 @end smallexample
21994
21995 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21996 normally have canceled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21997 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21998 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21999 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
22000 to be simplified.
22001
22002 @smallexample
22003 @group
22004 17 y 17 y
22005 1: ----------- 1: ----------
22006 __________ _________
22007 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
22008 @end group
22009 @end smallexample
22010
22011 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
22012 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
22013
22014 @noindent
22015 @kindex j R
22016 @pindex calc-commute-right
22017 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
22018 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
22019 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
22020 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
22021
22022 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
22023 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
22024 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
22025 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
22026
22027 @smallexample
22028 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
22029 @end smallexample
22030
22031 @noindent
22032 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
22033 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
22034 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
22035 mathematical meaning of the formula.
22036
22037 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
22038 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
22039 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
22040 course be drastically changed.
22041
22042 @smallexample
22043 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
22044
22045 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
22046 @end smallexample
22047
22048 @kindex j L
22049 @pindex calc-commute-left
22050 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
22051 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
22052
22053 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
22054 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
22055 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
22056 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
22057 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
22058
22059 @kindex j D
22060 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
22061 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
22062 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
22063 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
22064 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
22065 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
22066 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
22067 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
22068 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
22069
22070 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
22071 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
22072 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
22073 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
22074 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
22075 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
22076
22077 @vindex DistribRules
22078 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
22079 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
22080 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
22081 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
22082 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
22083 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
22084 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
22085
22086 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
22087 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
22088 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
22089 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
22090
22091 @kindex j M
22092 @pindex calc-sel-merge
22093 @vindex MergeRules
22094 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
22095 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
22096 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
22097 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
22098 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
22099 the relevant rules.
22100
22101 @kindex j C
22102 @pindex calc-sel-commute
22103 @vindex CommuteRules
22104 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
22105 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
22106 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
22107 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
22108 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
22109 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
22110 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
22111 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
22112 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
22113
22114 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
22115 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
22116 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
22117 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
22118 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
22119 manipulations described in this section.
22120
22121 @kindex j N
22122 @pindex calc-sel-negate
22123 @vindex NegateRules
22124 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
22125 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
22126 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
22127 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
22128 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
22129 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
22130 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
22131 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
22132
22133 @kindex j &
22134 @pindex calc-sel-invert
22135 @vindex InvertRules
22136 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
22137 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
22138 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
22139 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
22140
22141 @kindex j E
22142 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
22143 @vindex JumpRules
22144 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
22145 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
22146 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
22147 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
22148 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
22149 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
22150
22151 @kindex j I
22152 @kindex H j I
22153 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
22154 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
22155 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
22156 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
22157 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
22158 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
22159 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
22160 as well as equations.
22161
22162 @kindex j *
22163 @kindex j /
22164 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
22165 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
22166 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
22167 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
22168 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It performs the
22169 default algebraic simplifications before re-forming the
22170 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
22171 providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
22172 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
22173 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
22174
22175 If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
22176 simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
22177 this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
22178 1 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
22179 distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
22180 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
22181 top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
22182 normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
22183 to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
22184 expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
22185
22186 If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
22187 of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
22188 example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
22189 wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
22190 the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
22191 a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
22192 @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
22193 you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
22194 bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
22195 generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
22196 integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
22197 expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
22198
22199 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
22200 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
22201 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
22202 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
22203 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
22204 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
22205 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
22206 message.
22207
22208 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
22209 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
22210 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
22211 back by the formula.
22212
22213 @kindex j +
22214 @kindex j -
22215 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22216 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22217 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22218 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22219 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22220 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22221 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22222 results.
22223
22224 @kindex j U
22225 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
22226 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22227 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22228 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22229 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22230 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22231 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22232
22233 @kindex j v
22234 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22235 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22236 basic simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22237 These simplifications would normally be done automatically
22238 on all results, but may have been partially inhibited by
22239 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22240 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22241 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22242
22243 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22244 the default algebraic simplifications to the selected
22245 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22246 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22247 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22248 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22249 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22250 sub-formula.
22251
22252 @kindex j "
22253 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22254 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22255 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22256
22257 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22258 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22259
22260 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22261 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22262
22263 @noindent
22264 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22265 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22266 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22267 formula).
22268
22269 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22270 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22271 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22272 from the second-to-top stack level.
22273
22274 @kindex a v
22275 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22276 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22277 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22278 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22279 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22280 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22281 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22282
22283 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22284 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22285 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22286
22287 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22288 using Calc's algebraic simplifications; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}.
22289 If you give a numeric prefix of 3 or more, it uses Extended
22290 Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22291
22292 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22293 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22294 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22295 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22296 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22297 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22298 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22299 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22300 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22301
22302 @tindex evalv
22303 @tindex evalvn
22304 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22305 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22306 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22307 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22308 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22309 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22310 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22311
22312 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22313 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22314 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22315 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22316 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22317 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22318 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22319 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22320 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22321 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22322 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22323 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22324
22325 @kindex a "
22326 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22327 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22328 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22329 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22330 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22331 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22332 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22333 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22334 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22335 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22336 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22337 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22338 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22339 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22340 top-level function call.
22341
22342 @kindex a M
22343 @pindex calc-map-equation
22344 @tindex mapeq
22345 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22346 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22347 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22348 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22349 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22350 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22351 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22352 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22353 respective sides of a new equation.
22354
22355 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22356 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22357 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22358 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22359 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22360 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22361 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22362 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22363 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the algebraic simplifications
22364 can reduce to @samp{2 < b}.
22365
22366 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22367 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22368 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22369 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22370 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22371
22372 @kindex H a M
22373 @tindex mapeqp
22374 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22375 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22376 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22377 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22378 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22379
22380 @kindex I a M
22381 @tindex mapeqr
22382 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22383 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22384 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22385 working with small positive angles.
22386
22387 @kindex a b
22388 @pindex calc-substitute
22389 @tindex subst
22390 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22391 all occurrences
22392 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22393 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22394 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22395 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22396 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22397 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22398 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22399 doing substitutions.
22400
22401 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22402 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22403 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22404 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22405 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22406 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22407 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22408
22409 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22410 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22411 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22412 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22413 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22414 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22415 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22416 these limitations.
22417
22418 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22419 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22420 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22421 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22422 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22423
22424 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22425 @section Simplifying Formulas
22426
22427 @noindent
22428 @kindex a s
22429 @kindex I a s
22430 @kindex H a s
22431 @pindex calc-simplify
22432 @tindex simplify
22433
22434 The sections below describe all the various kinds of
22435 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22436 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22437 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22438 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22439 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22440 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22441 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22442
22443 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22444 simplification occurs automatically. Normally the algebraic
22445 simplifications described below occur. If you have turned on a
22446 simplification mode which does not do these algebraic simplifications,
22447 you can still apply them to a formula with the @kbd{a s}
22448 (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command.
22449
22450 There are some simplifications that, while sometimes useful, are never
22451 done automatically. For example, the @kbd{I} prefix can be given to
22452 @kbd{a s}; the @kbd{I a s} command will change any trigonometric
22453 function to the appropriate combination of @samp{sin}s and @samp{cos}s
22454 before simplifying. This can be useful in simplifying even mildly
22455 complicated trigonometric expressions. For example, while the algebraic
22456 simplifications can reduce @samp{sin(x) csc(x)} to @samp{1}, they will not
22457 simplify @samp{sin(x)^2 csc(x)}. The command @kbd{I a s} can be used to
22458 simplify this latter expression; it will transform @samp{sin(x)^2
22459 csc(x)} into @samp{sin(x)}. However, @kbd{I a s} will also perform
22460 some ``simplifications'' which may not be desired; for example, it
22461 will transform @samp{tan(x)^2} into @samp{sin(x)^2 / cos(x)^2}. The
22462 Hyperbolic prefix @kbd{H} can be used similarly; the @kbd{H a s} will
22463 replace any hyperbolic functions in the formula with the appropriate
22464 combinations of @samp{sinh}s and @samp{cosh}s before simplifying.
22465
22466
22467 @menu
22468 * Basic Simplifications::
22469 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22470 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22471 * Simplification of Units::
22472 @end menu
22473
22474 @node Basic Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22475 @subsection Basic Simplifications
22476
22477 @noindent
22478 @cindex Basic simplifications
22479 This section describes basic simplifications which Calc performs in many
22480 situations. For example, both binary simplifications and algebraic
22481 simplifications begin by performing these basic simplifications. You
22482 can type @kbd{m I} to restrict the simplifications done on the stack to
22483 these simplifications.
22484
22485 The most basic simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22486 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22487 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22488 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22489 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22490 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22491 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22492 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22493
22494 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22495 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22496 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22497 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22498 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22499 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22500 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22501 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22502
22503 Most commands apply at least these basic simplifications to all
22504 arguments they take from the stack, perform a particular operation,
22505 then simplify the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the
22506 common special case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and
22507 @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}], the arguments are simply popped from the stack
22508 and collected into a suitable function call, which is then simplified
22509 (the arguments being simplified first as part of the process, as
22510 described above).
22511
22512 Even the basic set of simplifications are too numerous to describe
22513 completely here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22514 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22515 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22516 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22517
22518 @tex
22519 \bigskip
22520 @end tex
22521
22522 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22523 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22524 will also be applied before any of the basic simplifications.
22525 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22526
22527 @tex
22528 \bigskip
22529 @end tex
22530
22531 And now, on with the basic simplifications:
22532
22533 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22534 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22535 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22536 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22537 (by default) a right-associative form for products,
22538 @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22539 rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22540 Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22541 and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22542 associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22543 below.
22544
22545 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22546 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22547 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22548 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22549 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22550 If you are using Basic Simplification mode, Calc assumes you have put
22551 the terms into the order you want and generally leaves that order alone,
22552 with the consequence that formulas like the above will only be
22553 simplified if you explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command.
22554 @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
22555
22556 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22557 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22558 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22559 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22560 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22561 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22562 negative-looking.
22563
22564 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22565 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22566 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22567 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22568 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22569 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22570 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22571 simplifications.)
22572
22573 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22574 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22575 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22576 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22577 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22578 using the distributive law.
22579
22580 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22581 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22582 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22583 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22584 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22585 square of the number of terms; Calc omits potentially slow
22586 operations like this in basic simplification mode.
22587
22588 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22589 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22590 to @expr{-a}.
22591
22592 @tex
22593 \bigskip
22594 @end tex
22595
22596 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22597 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22598 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22599 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22600 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22601 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22602
22603 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22604 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22605 numbers.
22606
22607 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22608 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22609
22610 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22611 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22612 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22613 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22614 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22615
22616 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22617 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22618 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22619 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22620 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22621 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22622 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22623 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22624 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22625 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22626
22627 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22628 power is changed to use division:
22629 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22630 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22631 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22632 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22633 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22634
22635 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22636 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22637
22638 @tex
22639 \bigskip
22640 @end tex
22641
22642 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22643 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22644 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22645 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22646 respectively.
22647
22648 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22649 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22650 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22651
22652 The expression
22653 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22654 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22655 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22656 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22657 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22658 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22659 for any power @expr{c}.
22660
22661 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22662 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22663 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22664 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22665 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22666
22667 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22668 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22669 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22670 described for multiplication.
22671
22672 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22673 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22674 is canceled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22675 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22676 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22677
22678 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22679 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22680 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22681
22682 @tex
22683 \bigskip
22684 @end tex
22685
22686 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22687 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22688 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22689 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22690 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22691 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22692
22693 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22694 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22695 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22696 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22697 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22698 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22699 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22700 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22701 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22702 (In other words,
22703 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22704 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22705 is safe to simplify, but
22706 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22707 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22708 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22709 variables satisfy these requirements.
22710
22711 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22712 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22713 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22714 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22715
22716 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22717 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22718 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22719
22720 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22721 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22722 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22723
22724 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22725 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22726 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22727 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22728
22729 Also, note that
22730 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22731 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22732 is changed to
22733 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22734 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22735 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22736
22737 @tex
22738 \bigskip
22739 @end tex
22740
22741 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22742 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22743 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22744 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22745 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22746 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22747 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22748 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22749 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22750 @expr{n} is an integer.
22751
22752 @tex
22753 \bigskip
22754 @end tex
22755
22756 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22757 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22758 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22759 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22760 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22761 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22762
22763 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22764 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22765 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22766 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22767 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22768
22769 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22770 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22771 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22772
22773 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22774 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22775 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22776 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22777 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22778 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22779 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22780
22781 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22782 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22783 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The algebraic
22784 simplifications described in the next section do provide some
22785 simplifications for these functions, though.
22786
22787 One important simplification that does occur is that
22788 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22789 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22790 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22791 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22792
22793 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22794 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22795 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22796 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22797 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22798 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22799
22800 Most other Calc functions have few if any basic simplifications
22801 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22802 suitable numbers.
22803
22804 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Basic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22805 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22806
22807 @noindent
22808 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22809 @kindex a s
22810 @kindex m A
22811 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22812 the algebraic simplification mode, which is the default simplification
22813 mode. If you have switched to a different simplification mode, you can
22814 switch back with the @kbd{m A} command. Even in other simplification
22815 modes, the @kbd{a s} command will use these algebraic simplifications to
22816 simplify the formula.
22817
22818 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22819 to be applied. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22820 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22821 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22822 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22823 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22824 the original expression, the process repeats with the basic
22825 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22826 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22827
22828 @tex
22829 \bigskip
22830 @end tex
22831
22832 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22833 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22834 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22835 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22836 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22837
22838 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22839 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22840 adjacent terms, but Calc's algebraic simplifications compare all pairs
22841 of terms including non-adjacent ones.
22842
22843 @tex
22844 \bigskip
22845 @end tex
22846
22847 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22848 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22849 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the basic
22850 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22851 but the algebraic simplifications; it first rewrites the sum to
22852 @expr{x y + x y} which can then be recognized as a sum of identical
22853 terms.
22854
22855 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22856 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22857 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22858 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22859
22860 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22861 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22862 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22863
22864 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22865 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22866 use for adjacent terms of products.
22867
22868 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22869 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22870 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22871 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22872 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22873 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22874 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22875
22876 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22877 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22878 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22879 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22880 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22881
22882 @tex
22883 \bigskip
22884 @end tex
22885
22886 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22887 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22888 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22889 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22890 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22891 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22892 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is canceled out;
22893 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22894
22895 Non-constant common factors are not found even by algebraic
22896 simplifications. To cancel the factor @expr{a} in
22897 @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first use @kbd{j M} on the product
22898 @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be
22899 simplified successfully.
22900
22901 @tex
22902 \bigskip
22903 @end tex
22904
22905 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22906 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22907 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22908 will no longer occur. This is not done by the basic
22909 simplifications; in case someone (unwisely) wants to use the name
22910 @code{i} for a variable unrelated to complex numbers, they can use
22911 basic simplification mode.
22912
22913 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22914 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22915 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22916 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22917 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22918 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22919 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22920 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22921 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22922
22923 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22924 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22925 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22926 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22927
22928 @tex
22929 \bigskip
22930 @end tex
22931
22932 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22933 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22934 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22935 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22936 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22937
22938 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22939 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22940 canceled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22941 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22942 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22943 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22944 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22945
22946 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22947 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22948 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22949 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22950 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22951 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22952 declared to be an integer.
22953
22954 @tex
22955 \bigskip
22956 @end tex
22957
22958 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22959 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22960 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22961 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22962 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22963 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22964 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22965 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22966
22967 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22968 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22969 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22970 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22971 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22972 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22973
22974 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22975 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22976 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22977 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22978
22979 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22980 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22981 hyperbolic functions.
22982
22983 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22984 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22985 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22986 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22987 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22988 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22989 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22990 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22991 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22992
22993 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22994 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22995 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22996 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22997 and
22998 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22999 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
23000 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
23001 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
23002 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
23003 is a suitable multiple of
23004 @texline @math{\pi i}
23005 @infoline @expr{pi i}
23006 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
23007 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
23008 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
23009 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
23010 negative imaginary.
23011
23012 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
23013 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
23014 function.
23015
23016 @tex
23017 \bigskip
23018 @end tex
23019
23020 Equations and inequalities are simplified by canceling factors
23021 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
23022 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is canceled.
23023 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
23024 canceled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
23025 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
23026 are canceled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
23027 sign is known.
23028
23029 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
23030 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
23031 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
23032 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
23033 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
23034 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
23035 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
23036
23037 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23038 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
23039
23040 @noindent
23041 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
23042 @cindex Extended simplification
23043 @kindex a e
23044 @kindex m E
23045 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
23046 @ignore
23047 @mindex esimpl@idots
23048 @end ignore
23049 @tindex esimplify
23050 Calc is capable of performing some simplifications which may sometimes
23051 be desired but which are not ``safe'' in all cases. The @kbd{a e}
23052 (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
23053 applies the algebraic simplifications as well as these extended, or
23054 ``unsafe'', simplifications. Use this only if you know the values in
23055 your formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these
23056 simplifications are valid. You can use Extended Simplification mode
23057 (@kbd{m E}) to have these simplifications done automatically.
23058
23059 The symbolic integrator uses these extended simplifications; one effect
23060 of this is that the integrator's results must be used with caution.
23061 Where an integral table will often attach conditions like ``for positive
23062 @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic integration programs)
23063 will simply produce an unqualified result.
23064
23065 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
23066 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
23067 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
23068 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
23069 to any specific part of a formula.
23070
23071 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied when
23072 the extended simplifications are used. These are applied in addition to
23073 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
23074 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
23075
23076 Following is a complete list of the ``unsafe'' simplifications.
23077
23078 @tex
23079 \bigskip
23080 @end tex
23081
23082 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
23083 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified.
23084 For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
23085 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
23086 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
23087 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
23088 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
23089 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
23090 functions always produce.
23091
23092 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
23093 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
23094 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
23095 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
23096 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
23097 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
23098 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
23099 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
23100 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
23101
23102 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
23103 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
23104 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
23105 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
23106
23107 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
23108 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
23109 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
23110
23111 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
23112 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
23113 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
23114 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
23115
23116 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
23117 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
23118 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
23119 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
23120
23121 Common factors are canceled from products on both sides of an
23122 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
23123 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never canceled from
23124 inequalities: Even the extended simplifications are not bold enough to
23125 reduce @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
23126 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
23127 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
23128 both sides of an inequality.
23129
23130 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23131 @subsection Simplification of Units
23132
23133 @noindent
23134 The simplifications described in this section (as well as the algebraic
23135 simplifications) are applied when units need to be simplified. They can
23136 be applied using the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command, or
23137 will be done automatically in Units Simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
23138 @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
23139
23140 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
23141 units simplifications. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
23142 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
23143
23144 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
23145 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
23146
23147 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
23148 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
23149 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
23150 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
23151 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
23152 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
23153
23154 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
23155 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
23156 leading unit are modified accordingly.
23157
23158 When canceling and combining units in products and quotients,
23159 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
23160 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
23161 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
23162 are not combined in this way.
23163
23164 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
23165 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
23166 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
23167
23168 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
23169 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
23170 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
23171 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
23172 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
23173
23174 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
23175 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
23176 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
23177
23178 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
23179 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
23180 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
23181 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
23182 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
23183 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
23184 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
23185 real.)
23186
23187 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
23188 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
23189 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
23190 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
23191 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
23192 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
23193 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
23194 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
23195 replaced by approximately
23196 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
23197 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
23198 which is then changed to
23199 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
23200 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
23201 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
23202
23203 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
23204 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
23205 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
23206 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
23207 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
23208 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
23209
23210 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
23211 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
23212 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
23213 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
23214
23215 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
23216 @section Polynomials
23217
23218 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
23219 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
23220 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
23221 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
23222 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
23223 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
23224 involving the base variable.
23225
23226 @kindex a f
23227 @pindex calc-factor
23228 @tindex factor
23229 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
23230 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
23231 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
23232 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
23233 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23234
23235 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23236 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23237 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23238 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23239 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23240 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23241 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23242 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23243 rewrite mechanism.
23244
23245 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23246 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23247 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23248 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23249 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23250 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23251 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23252 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23253 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23254 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23255 version of Calc.)
23256
23257 @vindex FactorRules
23258 @ignore
23259 @starindex
23260 @end ignore
23261 @tindex thecoefs
23262 @ignore
23263 @starindex
23264 @end ignore
23265 @ignore
23266 @mindex @idots
23267 @end ignore
23268 @tindex thefactors
23269 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23270 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23271 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23272 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23273 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23274 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23275 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23276 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23277 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23278 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23279 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23280 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23281 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23282 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23283 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23284 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23285 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23286 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23287
23288 @kindex H a f
23289 @tindex factors
23290 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23291 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23292 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23293 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23294 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23295 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23296 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23297 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23298 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23299 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23300 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23301
23302 @kindex a c
23303 @pindex calc-collect
23304 @tindex collect
23305 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23306 formula as a
23307 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23308 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23309 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23310 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23311 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23312 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23313 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23314 not be expanded.
23315
23316 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23317 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23318 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23319 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23320 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23321
23322 @kindex a x
23323 @pindex calc-expand
23324 @tindex expand
23325 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23326 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23327 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23328 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23329 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23330 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23331
23332 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23333 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23334 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23335 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23336 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23337 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23338 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23339 do not do.)
23340
23341 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23342 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23343 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23344 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23345 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23346 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23347 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23348 the way in one step.
23349
23350 @kindex a a
23351 @pindex calc-apart
23352 @tindex apart
23353 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23354 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23355 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23356 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23357 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23358 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23359 chooses the base variable automatically.
23360
23361 @kindex a n
23362 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23363 @tindex nrat
23364 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23365 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23366 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23367 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23368 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23369 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23370
23371 @kindex a \
23372 @pindex calc-poly-div
23373 @tindex pdiv
23374 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23375 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23376 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23377 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23378 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23379 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23380 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23381 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23382 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23383
23384 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23385 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23386 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23387 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23388 above.
23389
23390 @kindex a %
23391 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23392 @tindex prem
23393 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23394 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23395 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23396 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23397 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23398 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23399
23400 @kindex a /
23401 @kindex H a /
23402 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23403 @tindex pdivrem
23404 @tindex pdivide
23405 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23406 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23407 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23408 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23409 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23410 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23411
23412 @kindex a g
23413 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23414 @tindex pgcd
23415 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23416 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23417 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23418 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23419 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23420 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23421 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23422 leaving a remainder.)
23423
23424 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23425 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23426 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23427 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23428 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23429 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23430 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23431
23432 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23433 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23434 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23435
23436 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23437 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23438
23439 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23440 @section Calculus
23441
23442 @noindent
23443 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23444 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23445 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23446 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23447 readable way.
23448
23449 @menu
23450 * Differentiation::
23451 * Integration::
23452 * Customizing the Integrator::
23453 * Numerical Integration::
23454 * Taylor Series::
23455 @end menu
23456
23457 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23458 @subsection Differentiation
23459
23460 @noindent
23461 @kindex a d
23462 @kindex H a d
23463 @pindex calc-derivative
23464 @tindex deriv
23465 @tindex tderiv
23466 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23467 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23468 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23469 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23470 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23471 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23472 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23473 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23474 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23475 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23476 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23477
23478 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23479 @var{n}th derivative.
23480
23481 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23482 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23483 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23484 answer!
23485
23486 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23487 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23488 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23489 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23490 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23491
23492 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23493 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23494 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23495 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23496 derivative of @code{f}.
23497
23498 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23499 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23500 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23501 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23502 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23503 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23504 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23505 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23506
23507 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23508 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23509 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23510 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23511 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23512 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23513 argument once).
23514
23515 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23516 @subsection Integration
23517
23518 @noindent
23519 @kindex a i
23520 @pindex calc-integral
23521 @tindex integ
23522 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23523 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23524 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23525 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23526 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23527 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23528 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23529 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23530 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23531 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23532 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23533 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23534 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23535 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23536
23537 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23538 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23539 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23540 lower limit and an upper limit.
23541
23542 @ifnottex
23543 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23544 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23545 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23546 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23547 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23548 @end ifnottex
23549 @tex
23550 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23551 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23552 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23553 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23554 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23555 @end tex
23556
23557 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23558 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23559 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23560 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23561 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23562 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23563 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23564 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23565 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23566 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23567 Calc's solution for
23568 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23569 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23570 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23571 constant factor of
23572 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23573 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23574 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23575
23576 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23577 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23578 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23579 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23580 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23581
23582 @vindex IntegLimit
23583 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23584 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23585 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23586 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23587 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23588 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23589 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23590 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23591 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23592 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23593 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23594 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23595
23596 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23597 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23598 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23599 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23600 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23601
23602 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23603 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23604
23605 @noindent
23606 @vindex IntegRules
23607 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23608 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23609 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23610 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23611 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23612 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23613 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23614 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23615 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23616 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23617 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23618 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23619 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23620 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23621 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23622 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23623
23624 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23625 @ignore
23626 @starindex
23627 @end ignore
23628 @tindex Ei
23629 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23630 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23631 integral'' function
23632 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23633 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23634 was invented to describe it.
23635 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23636 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23637 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23638 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23639 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23640 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23641 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23642 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23643 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23644
23645 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23646 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23647 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23648 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23649 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23650 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23651 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23652 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23653 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23654 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23655 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23656 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23657 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23658
23659 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23660 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23661 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23662 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23663 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23664 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23665 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23666 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23667 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23668 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23669 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23670 it need not be.
23671
23672 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23673 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23674 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23675 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23676 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23677 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23678 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23679 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23680 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23681 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23682 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23683 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23684 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23685 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23686
23687 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23688 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23689 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23690 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23691 forever!)
23692
23693 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23694 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23695 every time the integrator uses algebraic simplifications to simplify an
23696 intermediate result. For example, putting the rule
23697 @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to
23698 convert the @code{twice} function into a form it knows whenever
23699 integration is attempted.
23700
23701 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23702 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23703 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23704 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23705 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23706 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23707 do this.)
23708
23709 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23710 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23711 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23712 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23713 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23714 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23715 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23716 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23717 (It also does algebraic simplifications, without @code{IntegSimpRules},
23718 after that to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23719 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23720 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23721 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23722 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23723 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23724 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23725 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23726 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23727
23728 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23729 @subsection Numerical Integration
23730
23731 @noindent
23732 @kindex a I
23733 @pindex calc-num-integral
23734 @tindex ninteg
23735 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23736 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23737 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23738 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23739 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23740 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23741
23742 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23743 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23744 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23745 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23746 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23747 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23748 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23749 determine the value of the integral.
23750
23751 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23752 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23753 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23754 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23755 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23756 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23757
23758 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23759 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23760 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23761 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23762 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23763 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23764 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23765
23766 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23767 @subsection Taylor Series
23768
23769 @noindent
23770 @kindex a t
23771 @pindex calc-taylor
23772 @tindex taylor
23773 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23774 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23775 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23776 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23777 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23778 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23779 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23780 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23781 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23782
23783 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23784 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23785 Taylor series.
23786
23787 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23788 @section Solving Equations
23789
23790 @noindent
23791 @kindex a S
23792 @pindex calc-solve-for
23793 @tindex solve
23794 @cindex Equations, solving
23795 @cindex Solving equations
23796 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23797 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23798 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23799 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23800 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23801 form @expr{X = 0}.
23802
23803 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23804 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23805 be; for example, solving
23806 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23807 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23808 for @expr{b} is impossible
23809 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23810 produce the result
23811 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23812 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23813 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23814 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23815 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23816 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23817 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23818 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23819
23820 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23821 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23822 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23823 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23824
23825 @menu
23826 * Multiple Solutions::
23827 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23828 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23829 @end menu
23830
23831 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23832 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23833
23834 @noindent
23835 @kindex H a S
23836 @tindex fsolve
23837 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23838 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23839 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23840 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23841 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23842 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23843 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23844 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23845 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23846 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23847 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23848 of these variables.
23849
23850 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23851 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23852 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23853 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23854 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23855 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23856 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23857 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23858
23859 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23860 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23861 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23862 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23863 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23864 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23865 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23866 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23867
23868 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23869 @vindex GenCount
23870 @ignore
23871 @starindex
23872 @end ignore
23873 @tindex an
23874 @ignore
23875 @starindex
23876 @end ignore
23877 @tindex as
23878 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23879 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23880 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23881 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23882 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23883 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23884 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23885 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23886 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23887 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23888 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23889 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23890 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23891 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23892
23893 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23894 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23895
23896 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23897 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23898 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23899
23900 @kindex I a S
23901 @kindex H I a S
23902 @tindex finv
23903 @tindex ffinv
23904 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23905 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23906 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23907 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23908 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23909 fully general inverse, as described above.
23910
23911 @kindex a P
23912 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23913 @tindex roots
23914 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23915 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23916 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23917 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23918 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23919 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23920 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23921 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23922 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23923 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23924 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23925 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23926 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23927
23928 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23929 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23930 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23931 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23932 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23933 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23934 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23935 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23936 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23937 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23938 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23939 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23940 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23941 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23942 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23943 are all numbers (real or complex).
23944
23945 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23946 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23947
23948 @noindent
23949 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23950 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23951 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23952 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23953 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23954 at the prompt.)
23955
23956 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23957 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23958 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23959 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23960 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23961 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23962 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23963 command.
23964
23965 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23966 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23967 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23968 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23969 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23970 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23971 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23972 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23973 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23974 nonlinear systems.
23975
23976 @ignore
23977 @starindex
23978 @end ignore
23979 @tindex elim
23980 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23981 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23982 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23983 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23984 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23985 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23986 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23987 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23988 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23989 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23990 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23991 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23992
23993 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23994 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23995 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23996 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23997 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23998 by one.
23999
24000 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
24001 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
24002 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
24003 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
24004 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
24005 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
24006 variables you requested.)
24007
24008 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
24009 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
24010 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
24011
24012 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
24013 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
24014
24015 @noindent
24016 @ignore
24017 @starindex
24018 @end ignore
24019 @tindex poly
24020 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
24021 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
24022 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
24023 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
24024 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
24025 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
24026 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
24027 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
24028 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
24029 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
24030 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
24031 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
24032
24033 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
24034 @cindex Degree of polynomial
24035 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
24036 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
24037 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
24038 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
24039 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
24040
24041 @ignore
24042 @starindex
24043 @end ignore
24044 @tindex gpoly
24045 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
24046 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
24047 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
24048 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
24049 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
24050 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
24051 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
24052 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
24053 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
24054 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
24055 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
24056 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
24057 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
24058 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
24059 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
24060 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
24061 is considered trivial.
24062
24063 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
24064 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
24065
24066 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
24067 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
24068 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
24069 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
24070 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
24071
24072 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
24073 discover:
24074
24075 @smallexample
24076 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
24077 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
24078 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
24079 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
24080 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
24081 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
24082 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
24083 @end smallexample
24084
24085 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
24086 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
24087 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
24088 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
24089 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
24090 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
24091 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
24092 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
24093
24094 @ignore
24095 @starindex
24096 @end ignore
24097 @tindex pdeg
24098 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
24099 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
24100 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
24101 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
24102 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
24103 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
24104 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
24105 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
24106 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
24107 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
24108 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
24109 (minus infinity).
24110
24111 @ignore
24112 @starindex
24113 @end ignore
24114 @tindex plead
24115 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
24116 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
24117 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
24118 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
24119 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
24120
24121 @ignore
24122 @starindex
24123 @end ignore
24124 @tindex pcont
24125 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
24126 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
24127 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
24128 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
24129 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
24130 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
24131 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
24132 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
24133 coefficient.
24134
24135 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
24136 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
24137 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
24138 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
24139 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
24140 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
24141 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
24142 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
24143 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
24144 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
24145
24146 @ignore
24147 @starindex
24148 @end ignore
24149 @tindex pprim
24150 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
24151 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
24152 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
24153 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
24154 terms.
24155
24156 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
24157 @section Numerical Solutions
24158
24159 @noindent
24160 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
24161 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
24162 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
24163 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
24164 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
24165
24166 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
24167 on numerical data.)
24168
24169 @menu
24170 * Root Finding::
24171 * Minimization::
24172 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
24173 @end menu
24174
24175 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
24176 @subsection Root Finding
24177
24178 @noindent
24179 @kindex a R
24180 @pindex calc-find-root
24181 @tindex root
24182 @cindex Newton's method
24183 @cindex Roots of equations
24184 @cindex Numerical root-finding
24185 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
24186 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
24187 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
24188 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
24189
24190 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
24191 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
24192 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
24193 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
24194 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
24195 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
24196 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
24197 this command.
24198
24199 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
24200 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
24201 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
24202 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
24203 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
24204 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
24205 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
24206 the equation yourself.)
24207
24208 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
24209 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
24210
24211 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
24212 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
24213 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
24214 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
24215 to real numbers inside that interval.
24216
24217 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
24218 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
24219 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
24220 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
24221 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
24222 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
24223 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
24224
24225 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
24226 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
24227 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
24228 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
24229 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
24230 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
24231
24232 @kindex H a R
24233 @tindex wroot
24234 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
24235 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
24236 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
24237 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
24238 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
24239
24240 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24241 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24242 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24243 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24244 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24245
24246 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24247 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24248 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24249 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24250
24251 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24252 @subsection Minimization
24253
24254 @noindent
24255 @kindex a N
24256 @kindex H a N
24257 @kindex a X
24258 @kindex H a X
24259 @pindex calc-find-minimum
24260 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24261 @tindex minimize
24262 @tindex maximize
24263 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24264 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24265 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24266 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24267 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24268 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24269 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24270 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24271 with the minimum value itself.
24272
24273 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24274 have more than one minimum; some, like
24275 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24276 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24277 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24278 ``global'' minimum of
24279 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24280 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24281 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24282 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24283 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24284 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24285
24286 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24287 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24288 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24289 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24290 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24291 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24292 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24293 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24294
24295 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24296 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24297 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24298 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24299 answer.
24300
24301 @ignore
24302 @mindex wmin@idots
24303 @end ignore
24304 @tindex wminimize
24305 @ignore
24306 @mindex wmax@idots
24307 @end ignore
24308 @tindex wmaximize
24309 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24310 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24311 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24312
24313 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24314 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24315 negative of the formula you supply.
24316
24317 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24318 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24319 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24320 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24321 be minimized over the reals.
24322
24323 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24324 @subsection Systems of Equations
24325
24326 @noindent
24327 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24328 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24329 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24330 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24331 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24332 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24333 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24334 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24335 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24336 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24337 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24338 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24339 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24340
24341 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24342 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24343 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24344 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24345 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24346 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24347 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24348
24349 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24350 @section Curve Fitting
24351
24352 @noindent
24353 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24354 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24355 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24356 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24357 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24358 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24359 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24360
24361 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24362 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24363 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24364 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24365
24366 @menu
24367 * Linear Fits::
24368 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24369 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24370 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24371 * Curve Fitting Details::
24372 * Interpolation::
24373 @end menu
24374
24375 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24376 @subsection Linear Fits
24377
24378 @noindent
24379 @kindex a F
24380 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24381 @tindex fit
24382 @cindex Linear regression
24383 @cindex Least-squares fits
24384 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24385 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24386 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24387 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24388 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24389 fit for the data.
24390
24391 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24392 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24393 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24394 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24395 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24396 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24397 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24398 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24399
24400 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24401 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24402 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24403 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24404
24405 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24406 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24407 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24408 @texline @math{2\times N}
24409 @infoline 2xN
24410 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24411 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24412 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24413 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24414
24415 If you happen to have an
24416 @texline @math{N\times2}
24417 @infoline Nx2
24418 matrix instead of a
24419 @texline @math{2\times N}
24420 @infoline 2xN
24421 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24422
24423 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24424 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24425
24426 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24427 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24428 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24429 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24430 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24431 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24432 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24433
24434 For example, suppose the data matrix
24435
24436 @ifnottex
24437 @example
24438 @group
24439 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24440 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24441 @end group
24442 @end example
24443 @end ifnottex
24444 @tex
24445 \beforedisplay
24446 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24447 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24448 $$
24449 \afterdisplay
24450 @end tex
24451
24452 @noindent
24453 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24454 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24455 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24456 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24457 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24458 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24459 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24460 formula.
24461
24462 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24463 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24464 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24465 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24466 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24467 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24468
24469 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24470 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24471 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24472 the equations that go into the trail.
24473
24474 @tex
24475 \bigskip
24476 @end tex
24477
24478 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24479 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24480 The result is:
24481
24482 @example
24483 2.6 + 2.2 x
24484 @end example
24485
24486 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24487 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24488
24489 @example
24490 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24491 @end example
24492
24493 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24494 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24495 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24496 error measure
24497
24498 @ifnottex
24499 @example
24500 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24501 @end example
24502 @end ifnottex
24503 @tex
24504 \beforedisplay
24505 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24506 \afterdisplay
24507 @end tex
24508
24509 @noindent
24510 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24511 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24512 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24513 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24514 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24515 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24516 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24517 for which the error
24518 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24519 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24520 is as small as possible.
24521
24522 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24523 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24524
24525 @tex
24526 \bigskip
24527 @end tex
24528
24529 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24530 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24531 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24532 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24533 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24534
24535 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24536 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24537 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24538 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24539 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24540
24541 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24542 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24543
24544 @noindent
24545 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24546 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24547 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24548 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24549 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24550
24551 @example
24552 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24553 @end example
24554
24555 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24556 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24557 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24558 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24559 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24560 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24561 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24562 won't help.)
24563
24564 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24565 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24566 line slightly to improve the fit.
24567
24568 @example
24569 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24570 @end example
24571
24572 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24573 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24574 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24575 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24576 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24577
24578 @example
24579 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24580 @end example
24581
24582 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24583 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24584 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24585 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24586 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24587 results.
24588
24589 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24590 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24591 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24592 automatically.
24593
24594 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24595 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24596 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24597 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24598 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24599 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24600
24601 @tex
24602 \bigskip
24603 @end tex
24604
24605 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24606 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24607 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24608 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24609 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24610
24611 Given the data matrix,
24612
24613 @example
24614 @group
24615 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24616 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24617 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24618 @end group
24619 @end example
24620
24621 @noindent
24622 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24623 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24624 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24625
24626 @example
24627 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24628 @end example
24629
24630 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24631 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24632
24633 @tex
24634 \bigskip
24635 @end tex
24636
24637 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24638 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24639 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24640 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24641 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24642 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24643 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24644 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24645 message.
24646
24647 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24648 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24649 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24650 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24651 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24652
24653 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24654 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24655
24656 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24657 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24658
24659 @noindent
24660 @kindex H a F
24661 @tindex efit
24662 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24663 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24664 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24665 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24666
24667 @example
24668 3. + 2. x
24669 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24670 @end example
24671
24672 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24673 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24674 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24675
24676 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24677 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24678 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24679 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24680 row contains error forms
24681 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24682 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24683 then the
24684 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24685 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24686 statistic is now,
24687
24688 @ifnottex
24689 @example
24690 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24691 @end example
24692 @end ifnottex
24693 @tex
24694 \beforedisplay
24695 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24696 \afterdisplay
24697 @end tex
24698
24699 @noindent
24700 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24701 the fitting operation.
24702
24703 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24704 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24705 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24706 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24707 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24708 used for the data point.
24709
24710 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24711 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24712 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24713 estimates.
24714
24715 If the input contains error forms but all the
24716 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24717 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24718 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24719 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24720 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24721 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24722 is simply scaled uniformly by
24723 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24724 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24725 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24726 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24727 @kbd{H a F}.
24728
24729 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24730 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24731 interpreted.
24732
24733 @tex
24734 \bigskip
24735 @end tex
24736
24737 @kindex I a F
24738 @tindex xfit
24739 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24740 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24741
24742 @enumerate
24743 @item
24744 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24745 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24746 produced.
24747
24748 @item
24749 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24750 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24751 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24752 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24753 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24754
24755 @item
24756 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24757 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24758 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24759 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24760 are the variances
24761 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24762 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24763 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24764 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24765 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24766 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24767 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24768 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24769 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24770 are defined as
24771 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24772 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24773
24774 @item
24775 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24776 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24777 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24778 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24779
24780 @item
24781 The value of
24782 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24783 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24784 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24785 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24786 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24787 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24788 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24789 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24790
24791 @item
24792 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24793 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24794 function using
24795 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24796 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24797 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24798 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24799 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24800 particular,
24801 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24802 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24803 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24804 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24805 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24806
24807 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24808 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24809 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24810 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24811 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24812 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24813 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24814 over to use for a confidence test.
24815 @end enumerate
24816
24817 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24818 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24819
24820 @noindent
24821 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24822 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24823 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24824
24825 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24826
24827 @table @kbd
24828 @item 1
24829 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24830 @item 2-9
24831 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24832 @item e
24833 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24834 @item E
24835 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24836 @item x
24837 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24838 @item X
24839 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24840 @item l
24841 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24842 @item L
24843 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24844 @item ^
24845 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24846 @item p
24847 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24848 @item q
24849 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24850 @item g
24851 Gaussian.
24852 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24853 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24854 @item s
24855 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24856 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24857 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24858 @item b
24859 Logistic bell curve.
24860 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24861 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24862 @item o
24863 Hubbert linearization.
24864 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24865 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24866 @end table
24867
24868 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24869 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24870 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24871 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24872 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24873
24874 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24875 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24876 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24877 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24878 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24879 before the model key.
24880
24881 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24882 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24883 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24884 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24885 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24886 matches the problem.
24887
24888 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24889 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24890 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24891 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24892 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24893 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24894
24895 @tex
24896 \bigskip
24897 @end tex
24898
24899 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24900 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24901 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24902 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24903
24904 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24905 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24906 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24907 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24908 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24909 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24910 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24911 model.
24912
24913 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24914 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24915 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24916 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24917 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24918 and thus does not need a name.
24919
24920 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24921 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24922 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24923 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24924 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24925 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24926 variables.
24927
24928 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24929 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24930 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24931 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24932 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24933 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24934 in the model formula will become parameters.
24935
24936 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24937 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24938 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24939 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24940 a linear model.
24941
24942 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24943 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24944 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24945 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24946 which are parameters.
24947
24948 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24949 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24950 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24951 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24952 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24953 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24954
24955 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24956 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24957
24958 @tex
24959 \bigskip
24960 @end tex
24961
24962 @vindex Model1
24963 @vindex Model2
24964 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24965 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24966 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24967 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24968 accept for a model on the stack.
24969
24970 @tex
24971 \bigskip
24972 @end tex
24973
24974 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24975 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24976 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24977 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24978 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24979 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24980 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24981 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24982 @texline @math{3\times360}
24983 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24984 degrees.
24985 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24986 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24987 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24988 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24989 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24990 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24991 even approximately.
24992
24993 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24994 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24995 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24996 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24997 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24998 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24999 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
25000
25001 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
25002 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
25003
25004 @noindent
25005 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
25006 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
25007 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
25008 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
25009 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
25010
25011 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
25012 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
25013 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
25014 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
25015
25016 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
25017 to try to put the problem into the form
25018
25019 @smallexample
25020 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
25021 @end smallexample
25022
25023 @noindent
25024 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
25025 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
25026 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
25027 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
25028 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
25029
25030 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
25031 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
25032 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
25033 can be rewritten as follows:
25034
25035 @example
25036 y = a x^b
25037 y = a exp(b ln(x))
25038 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
25039 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
25040 @end example
25041
25042 @noindent
25043 which matches the desired form with
25044 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
25045 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
25046 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
25047 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
25048 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
25049 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
25050 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
25051 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
25052 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
25053 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
25054 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
25055 and @expr{b = B}.
25056
25057 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
25058 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
25059
25060 @example
25061 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
25062 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
25063 @end example
25064
25065 @noindent
25066 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
25067 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
25068 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
25069 @expr{H = x^2}.
25070
25071 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
25072 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
25073 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
25074
25075 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
25076 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
25077 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
25078 iterative method to refine the approximations.
25079
25080 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
25081 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
25082 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
25083 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
25084 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
25085 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
25086 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
25087 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
25088 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
25089 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
25090 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
25091 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
25092
25093 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
25094 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
25095 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
25096
25097 @tex
25098 \bigskip
25099 @end tex
25100
25101 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
25102 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
25103 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
25104 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25105 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25106 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
25107 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
25108 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
25109 command can do the same thing by brute force.
25110
25111 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
25112 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
25113 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
25114 to be minimized would be the value of
25115 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25116 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25117 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
25118
25119 @smallexample
25120 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
25121 @end smallexample
25122
25123 @noindent
25124 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
25125 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
25126 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
25127 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
25128 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
25129 were used by itself to solve the problem).
25130
25131 @tex
25132 \bigskip
25133 @end tex
25134
25135 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
25136 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
25137 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
25138 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
25139 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
25140 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
25141 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
25142 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
25143 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
25144 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
25145 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
25146 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
25147 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
25148 and so on.
25149
25150 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
25151 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
25152 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
25153 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
25154 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
25155 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
25156 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
25157 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
25158 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
25159
25160 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
25161 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
25162 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
25163 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
25164 nontrivial filter functions.
25165
25166 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
25167 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
25168 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
25169 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
25170 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
25171 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
25172 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
25173 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
25174 form. The error part of that result is used for
25175 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
25176 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
25177 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
25178 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
25179 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
25180 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
25181 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
25182 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
25183 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
25184 arithmetic with no error forms.
25185
25186 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
25187 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
25188 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
25189 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
25190 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
25191 @texline @math{\sigma}
25192 @infoline @expr{sigma}
25193 for the data point with no further ado.)
25194
25195 @tex
25196 \bigskip
25197 @end tex
25198
25199 @vindex FitRules
25200 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
25201 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
25202 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
25203 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
25204 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
25205 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
25206 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
25207
25208 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
25209
25210 @ignore
25211 @starindex
25212 @end ignore
25213 @tindex fitvar
25214 @ignore
25215 @starindex
25216 @end ignore
25217 @ignore
25218 @mindex @idots
25219 @end ignore
25220 @tindex fitparam
25221 @ignore
25222 @starindex
25223 @end ignore
25224 @ignore
25225 @mindex @null
25226 @end ignore
25227 @tindex fitmodel
25228 @ignore
25229 @starindex
25230 @end ignore
25231 @ignore
25232 @mindex @null
25233 @end ignore
25234 @tindex fitsystem
25235 @ignore
25236 @starindex
25237 @end ignore
25238 @ignore
25239 @mindex @null
25240 @end ignore
25241 @tindex fitdummy
25242 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
25243 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
25244 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
25245 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
25246 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
25247 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
25248 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
25249 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
25250 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
25251
25252 @smallexample
25253 @group
25254 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
25255 @end group
25256 @end smallexample
25257
25258 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25259 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25260 changes are possible.)
25261
25262 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25263 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25264
25265 @example
25266 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25267 @end example
25268
25269 @noindent
25270 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25271 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25272 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25273 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25274 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25275 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25276 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25277
25278 The power law model eventually boils down to
25279
25280 @smallexample
25281 @group
25282 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25283 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25284 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25285 @end group
25286 @end smallexample
25287
25288 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25289 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25290 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25291 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25292 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25293 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25294 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25295 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25296 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25297 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25298 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25299 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25300 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25301
25302 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25303 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25304 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25305 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25306 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25307 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25308 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25309 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25310 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25311 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25312 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25313 raw parameters, for now.)
25314
25315 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25316 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25317 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25318 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25319 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25320 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25321 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25322 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25323 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25324 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25325 raw parameters needed.
25326
25327 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25328 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25329 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25330 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25331 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25332 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25333 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25334 least-squares solver wants to see.
25335
25336 @ignore
25337 @starindex
25338 @end ignore
25339 @ignore
25340 @mindex hasfit@idots
25341 @end ignore
25342 @tindex hasfitparams
25343 @ignore
25344 @starindex
25345 @end ignore
25346 @ignore
25347 @mindex @null
25348 @end ignore
25349 @tindex hasfitvars
25350 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25351 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25352 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25353 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25354 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25355 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25356 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25357 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25358 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25359
25360 @tex
25361 \bigskip
25362 @end tex
25363
25364 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25365 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25366 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25367 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25368 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25369 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25370 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25371 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25372 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25373 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25374
25375 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25376 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25377 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25378 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25379 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25380
25381 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25382 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25383 and variables, as discussed previously.
25384
25385 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25386 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25387 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25388 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25389
25390 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25391 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25392
25393 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25394 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25395
25396 @kindex a p
25397 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25398 @tindex polint
25399 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25400 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25401 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25402 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25403 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25404 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25405 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25406 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25407 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25408
25409 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25410 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25411 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25412 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25413 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25414 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25415
25416 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25417 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25418
25419 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25420 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25421 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25422 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25423 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25424 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25425
25426 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25427 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25428
25429 @kindex H a p
25430 @tindex ratint
25431 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25432 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25433 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25434 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25435 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25436 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25437
25438 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25439 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25440 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25441 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25442 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25443 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25444
25445 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25446 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25447 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25448 capabilities to fit.)
25449
25450 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25451 @section Summations
25452
25453 @noindent
25454 @cindex Summation of a series
25455 @kindex a +
25456 @pindex calc-summation
25457 @tindex sum
25458 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25459 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25460 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25461 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25462 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25463 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25464 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25465 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25466 produces the result 55.
25467 @tex
25468 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25469 @end tex
25470
25471 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25472 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25473 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25474 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25475 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25476 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25477 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25478 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25479 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25480
25481 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25482 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25483 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25484 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25485 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25486 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25487 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25488 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25489 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25490
25491 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25492 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25493 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25494 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25495 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25496 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25497 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25498 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25499 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25500 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25501
25502 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25503 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25504 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25505 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25506 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25507 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25508
25509 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25510 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25511 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25512 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25513 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25514 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25515 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25516 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25517
25518 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25519 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25520 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25521 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25522 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25523 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25524
25525 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25526 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25527 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25528 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25529 after algebraic simplification, evaluate to an integer.
25530
25531 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25532 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25533 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25534 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25535 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25536 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25537 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25538 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25539
25540 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25541 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25542 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25543 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25544 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25545 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25546 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25547
25548 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25549 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25550 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25551 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25552 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25553 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25554 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25555 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25556 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25557 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25558 closed form.
25559
25560 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25561 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25562 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25563 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25564 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25565 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25566 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25567 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25568 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25569 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25570 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25571 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25572 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25573 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25574
25575 @cindex Alternating sums
25576 @kindex a -
25577 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25578 @tindex asum
25579 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25580 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25581 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25582 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25583 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25584 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25585 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25586 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25587 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25588 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25589 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25590 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25591
25592 @cindex Product of a sequence
25593 @kindex a *
25594 @pindex calc-product
25595 @tindex prod
25596 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25597 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25598 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25599 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25600 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25601
25602 @kindex a T
25603 @pindex calc-tabulate
25604 @tindex table
25605 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25606 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25607 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25608 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25609 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25610
25611 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25612 @section Logical Operations
25613
25614 @noindent
25615 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25616 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25617 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25618 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25619 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25620 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25621 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25622 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25623 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25624 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25625 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25626 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25627 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25628 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25629
25630 @kindex a =
25631 @pindex calc-equal-to
25632 @tindex eq
25633 @tindex =
25634 @tindex ==
25635 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25636 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25637 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25638 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25639 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25640 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25641 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25642 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25643 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25644
25645 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25646 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25647 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25648 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25649 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25650 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25651 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25652 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25653 zero if not.
25654
25655 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25656 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25657 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25658 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25659 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25660 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25661 variables).
25662
25663 @kindex a #
25664 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25665 @tindex neq
25666 @tindex !=
25667 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25668 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25669 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25670 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25671 distinct numbers.
25672
25673 @kindex a <
25674 @tindex lt
25675 @ignore
25676 @mindex @idots
25677 @end ignore
25678 @kindex a >
25679 @ignore
25680 @mindex @null
25681 @end ignore
25682 @kindex a [
25683 @ignore
25684 @mindex @null
25685 @end ignore
25686 @kindex a ]
25687 @pindex calc-less-than
25688 @pindex calc-greater-than
25689 @pindex calc-less-equal
25690 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25691 @ignore
25692 @mindex @null
25693 @end ignore
25694 @tindex gt
25695 @ignore
25696 @mindex @null
25697 @end ignore
25698 @tindex leq
25699 @ignore
25700 @mindex @null
25701 @end ignore
25702 @tindex geq
25703 @ignore
25704 @mindex @null
25705 @end ignore
25706 @tindex <
25707 @ignore
25708 @mindex @null
25709 @end ignore
25710 @tindex >
25711 @ignore
25712 @mindex @null
25713 @end ignore
25714 @tindex <=
25715 @ignore
25716 @mindex @null
25717 @end ignore
25718 @tindex >=
25719 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25720 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25721 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25722 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25723 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25724
25725 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25726 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25727 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25728 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25729 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25730 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25731 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25732 involve both equations and inequalities, are not allowed.
25733
25734 @kindex a .
25735 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25736 @tindex rmeq
25737 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25738 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25739 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25740 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25741 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25742 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25743 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25744 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25745 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25746 taking the lefthand side.
25747
25748 @kindex a &
25749 @pindex calc-logical-and
25750 @tindex land
25751 @tindex &&
25752 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25753 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25754 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25755 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25756 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25757
25758 @kindex a |
25759 @pindex calc-logical-or
25760 @tindex lor
25761 @tindex ||
25762 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25763 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25764 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25765 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25766 zero.
25767
25768 @kindex a !
25769 @pindex calc-logical-not
25770 @tindex lnot
25771 @tindex !
25772 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25773 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25774 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25775 number.
25776
25777 @kindex a :
25778 @pindex calc-logical-if
25779 @tindex if
25780 @ignore
25781 @mindex ? :
25782 @end ignore
25783 @tindex ?
25784 @ignore
25785 @mindex @null
25786 @end ignore
25787 @tindex :
25788 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25789 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25790 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25791 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25792 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25793 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25794 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25795 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25796 @code{condition}.
25797
25798 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25799 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25800 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25801 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25802
25803 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25804 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25805 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25806 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25807 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25808 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25809 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25810
25811 @kindex a @{
25812 @pindex calc-in-set
25813 @tindex in
25814 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25815 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25816 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25817 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25818 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25819 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25820 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25821 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25822 of this sort.
25823
25824 @ignore
25825 @starindex
25826 @end ignore
25827 @tindex typeof
25828 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25829 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25830 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25831
25832 @example
25833 1 Integer
25834 2 Fraction
25835 3 Floating-point number
25836 4 HMS form
25837 5 Rectangular complex number
25838 6 Polar complex number
25839 7 Error form
25840 8 Interval form
25841 9 Modulo form
25842 10 Date-only form
25843 11 Date/time form
25844 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25845 100 Variable
25846 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25847 102 Matrix
25848 @end example
25849
25850 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25851 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25852
25853 @ignore
25854 @starindex
25855 @end ignore
25856 @tindex integer
25857 @ignore
25858 @starindex
25859 @end ignore
25860 @tindex real
25861 @ignore
25862 @starindex
25863 @end ignore
25864 @tindex constant
25865 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25866 The @samp{real(a)} function
25867 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25868 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25869 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25870 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25871 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25872 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25873 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25874
25875 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25876 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25877 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25878 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25879 literally an integer constant.
25880
25881 @ignore
25882 @starindex
25883 @end ignore
25884 @tindex refers
25885 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25886 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25887 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25888 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25889 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25890 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25891
25892 @ignore
25893 @starindex
25894 @end ignore
25895 @tindex negative
25896 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25897 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25898 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25899 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25900 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25901 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25902 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25903 as a rewrite rule condition).
25904
25905 @ignore
25906 @starindex
25907 @end ignore
25908 @tindex variable
25909 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25910 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25911 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25912 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25913
25914 @ignore
25915 @starindex
25916 @end ignore
25917 @tindex nonvar
25918 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25919 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25920 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25921 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25922 often good enough.
25923
25924 @ignore
25925 @starindex
25926 @end ignore
25927 @tindex lin
25928 @ignore
25929 @starindex
25930 @end ignore
25931 @tindex linnt
25932 @ignore
25933 @starindex
25934 @end ignore
25935 @tindex islin
25936 @ignore
25937 @starindex
25938 @end ignore
25939 @tindex islinnt
25940 @cindex Linearity testing
25941 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25942 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25943 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25944 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25945 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25946 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25947 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25948 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25949 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25950 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25951 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25952 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25953 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25954 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25955 returns true.
25956
25957 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25958 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25959 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25960 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25961 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25962 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25963 linear in @expr{x}).
25964
25965 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25966 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25967 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25968 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25969 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25970 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25971 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25972 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25973 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25974 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25975
25976 @ignore
25977 @starindex
25978 @end ignore
25979 @tindex istrue
25980 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25981 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25982 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25983 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25984 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25985 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25986 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25987 in symbolic form.)
25988
25989 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25990 @section Rewrite Rules
25991
25992 @noindent
25993 @cindex Rewrite rules
25994 @cindex Transformations
25995 @cindex Pattern matching
25996 @kindex a r
25997 @pindex calc-rewrite
25998 @tindex rewrite
25999 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
26000 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
26001 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
26002 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
26003 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
26004 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
26005 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
26006 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
26007 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
26008
26009 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
26010 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
26011 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
26012 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
26013 Calc formulas.
26014
26015 @menu
26016 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
26017 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
26018 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
26019 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
26020 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
26021 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
26022 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
26023 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
26024 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
26025 * Matching Commands::
26026 * Automatic Rewrites::
26027 * Debugging Rewrites::
26028 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
26029 @end menu
26030
26031 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26032 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
26033
26034 @noindent
26035 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
26036 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
26037 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
26038 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
26039 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
26040 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
26041 assignments in special ways.
26042
26043 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
26044 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
26045 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
26046 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
26047 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
26048
26049 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
26050 rules.
26051
26052 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
26053 in several ways:
26054
26055 @enumerate
26056 @item
26057 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
26058 @item
26059 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
26060 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
26061 @item
26062 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
26063 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
26064 @item
26065 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
26066 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
26067 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
26068 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
26069 @item
26070 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
26071 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
26072 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
26073 @end enumerate
26074
26075 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
26076 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
26077 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
26078
26079 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
26080 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
26081 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
26082 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
26083 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
26084 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
26085
26086 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
26087 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
26088 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
26089 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
26090 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
26091 reason to store your rules in a variable.
26092
26093 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
26094 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
26095 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
26096
26097 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26098 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
26099
26100 @noindent
26101 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
26102 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
26103 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
26104 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
26105 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
26106 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
26107 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
26108 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
26109 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
26110 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
26111 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
26112
26113 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
26114 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
26115 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
26116 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
26117 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
26118
26119 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
26120 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
26121 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
26122 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
26123 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
26124
26125 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
26126 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
26127 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
26128 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
26129
26130 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
26131 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
26132 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
26133 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
26134 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
26135
26136 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
26137 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
26138 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
26139 change at a time.
26140
26141 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26142 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
26143
26144 @noindent
26145 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
26146 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
26147 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
26148 is present in the
26149 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
26150 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
26151 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
26152 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
26153 with Calc's algebraic simplifications. If the result is a nonzero
26154 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
26155 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
26156 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
26157 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
26158 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
26159
26160 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
26161 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
26162 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
26163 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
26164 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
26165 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
26166 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
26167 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
26168 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
26169
26170 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
26171 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
26172 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
26173 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
26174 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
26175 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
26176 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
26177 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
26178 the condition.
26179
26180 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
26181 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
26182 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
26183
26184 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
26185 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
26186
26187 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
26188 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
26189 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
26190 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
26191 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
26192 matched.
26193
26194 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
26195 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
26196 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
26197 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
26198 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
26199 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
26200 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
26201 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
26202 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
26203
26204 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
26205 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
26206 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
26207 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
26208 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
26209 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
26210 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
26211 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
26212 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
26213
26214 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
26215 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
26216 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
26217 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
26218 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
26219 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
26220 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
26221 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
26222 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
26223
26224 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26225 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
26226
26227 @noindent
26228 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
26229 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
26230 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
26231 account:
26232
26233 @smallexample
26234 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
26235 @end smallexample
26236
26237 For example, the rewrite rule:
26238
26239 @example
26240 a x + b x := (a + b) x
26241 @end example
26242
26243 @noindent
26244 will match formulas of the form,
26245
26246 @example
26247 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
26248 @end example
26249
26250 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
26251 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
26252
26253 @example
26254 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
26255 @end example
26256
26257 @noindent
26258 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26259
26260 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26261 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26262 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26263
26264 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26265 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26266 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26267 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26268 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26269 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26270 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26271 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26272
26273 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26274 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26275 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26276 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26277 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26278 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26279 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26280 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26281 from occurring.
26282
26283 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26284 the rule
26285
26286 @example
26287 f(-x) := -f(x)
26288 @end example
26289
26290 @noindent
26291 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26292 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26293 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26294 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26295 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26296 condition is:
26297
26298 @example
26299 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26300 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26301 @end example
26302
26303 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26304 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26305
26306 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26307 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26308 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26309 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26310
26311 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26312 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26313 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26314 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26315 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26316 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26317 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26318 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26319 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26320 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26321
26322 Even more subtle is the rule set
26323
26324 @example
26325 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26326 @end example
26327
26328 @noindent
26329 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26330 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26331 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26332 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26333 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26334 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26335 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26336 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26337 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26338 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26339 rule will have to be added.
26340
26341 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26342 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26343 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26344 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26345 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26346
26347 @example
26348 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26349 @end example
26350
26351 @noindent
26352 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26353 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26354 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26355 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26356 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26357 conjugate of a real number.)
26358
26359 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26360
26361 @example
26362 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26363 @end example
26364
26365 @noindent
26366 will match the formula
26367
26368 @example
26369 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26370 @end example
26371
26372 @noindent
26373 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26374 formulas like
26375
26376 @example
26377 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26378 @end example
26379
26380 @noindent
26381 producing, respectively,
26382
26383 @example
26384 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26385 @end example
26386
26387 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26388 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26389
26390 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26391 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26392 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26393 with @samp{a = -1}.
26394
26395 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26396
26397 @example
26398 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26399 @end example
26400
26401 @noindent
26402 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26403
26404 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26405 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26406 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26407 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26408 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26409 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26410 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26411 for a multiplication, not a division.
26412
26413 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26414 by 1,
26415
26416 @example
26417 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26418 @end example
26419
26420 @noindent
26421 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26422 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26423
26424 @example
26425 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26426 @end example
26427
26428 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26429 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26430
26431 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26432
26433 @example
26434 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26435 @end example
26436
26437 @noindent
26438 into the form
26439
26440 @example
26441 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26442 @end example
26443
26444 @noindent
26445 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26446 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26447 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26448 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26449 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26450
26451 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26452 following rule,
26453
26454 @example
26455 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26456 @end example
26457
26458 @noindent
26459 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26460 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26461 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26462 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26463 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26464 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26465 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26466
26467 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26468 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26469 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26470
26471 @example
26472 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26473 @end example
26474
26475 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26476 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26477 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26478 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26479 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26480 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26481 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26482 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26483
26484 @smallexample
26485 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26486 max min re im conj arg
26487 @end smallexample
26488
26489 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26490 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26491 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26492 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26493 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26494 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26495 For example,
26496
26497 @example
26498 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26499 @end example
26500
26501 @noindent
26502 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26503 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26504 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26505 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26506 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26507 further and use
26508
26509 @example
26510 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26511 @end example
26512
26513 @noindent
26514 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26515
26516 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26517 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26518 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26519
26520 @example
26521 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26522 @end example
26523
26524 @noindent
26525 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26526
26527 @example
26528 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26529 @end example
26530
26531 @noindent
26532 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26533 effect!
26534
26535 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26536 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26537 in the rule
26538
26539 @example
26540 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26541 @end example
26542
26543 @noindent
26544 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26545 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26546 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26547 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26548 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26549 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26550 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26551 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26552 marker on the righthand side:
26553
26554 @example
26555 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26556 @end example
26557
26558 @noindent
26559 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26560 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26561 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26562
26563 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26564 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26565
26566 @noindent
26567 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26568 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26569 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26570 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26571
26572 @ignore
26573 @starindex
26574 @end ignore
26575 @tindex import
26576 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26577 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26578 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26579 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26580 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26581 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26582 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26583 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26584 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26585 @texline @math{v_1},
26586 @infoline @expr{v1},
26587 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26588 @texline @math{x_1}
26589 @infoline @expr{x1}
26590 and so on. (If
26591 @texline @math{v_1}
26592 @infoline @expr{v1}
26593 is used as a function name, then
26594 @texline @math{x_1}
26595 @infoline @expr{x1}
26596 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26597 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26598 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26599 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26600 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26601
26602 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26603
26604 @table @samp
26605 @item quote(x)
26606 @ignore
26607 @starindex
26608 @end ignore
26609 @tindex quote
26610 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26611 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26612 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26613 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26614 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26615 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26616 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26617 as a result in this case.)
26618
26619 @item plain(x)
26620 @ignore
26621 @starindex
26622 @end ignore
26623 @tindex plain
26624 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26625 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26626 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26627 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26628 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26629 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26630 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26631 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26632
26633 @item opt(x,def)
26634 @ignore
26635 @starindex
26636 @end ignore
26637 @tindex opt
26638 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26639 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26640 the argument or element is optional.
26641 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26642 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26643 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26644 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26645 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26646 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26647
26648 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26649 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26650 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26651 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26652 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26653 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26654 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26655 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26656 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26657
26658 @item condition(x,c)
26659 @ignore
26660 @starindex
26661 @end ignore
26662 @tindex condition
26663 @tindex ::
26664 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26665 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26666
26667 @item pand(x,y)
26668 @ignore
26669 @starindex
26670 @end ignore
26671 @tindex pand
26672 @tindex &&&
26673 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26674 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26675 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26676
26677 @item por(x,y)
26678 @ignore
26679 @starindex
26680 @end ignore
26681 @tindex por
26682 @tindex |||
26683 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26684 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26685
26686 @item pnot(x)
26687 @ignore
26688 @starindex
26689 @end ignore
26690 @tindex pnot
26691 @tindex !!!
26692 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26693 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26694
26695 @item cons(h,t)
26696 @ignore
26697 @mindex cons
26698 @end ignore
26699 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26700 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26701 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26702 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26703 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26704 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26705 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26706
26707 @item rcons(t,h)
26708 @ignore
26709 @mindex rcons
26710 @end ignore
26711 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26712 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26713 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26714 to @expr{t}.
26715
26716 @item apply(f,args)
26717 @ignore
26718 @mindex apply
26719 @end ignore
26720 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26721 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26722 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26723 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26724 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26725 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26726 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26727 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26728 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26729 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26730 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26731 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26732 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26733 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26734 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26735
26736 @example
26737 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26738 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26739 @end example
26740
26741 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26742 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26743 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26744 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26745 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26746 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26747 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26748
26749 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26750 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26751 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26752
26753 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26754 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26755 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26756 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26757 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26758 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26759 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26760 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26761 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26762 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26763
26764 @item select(x)
26765 @ignore
26766 @starindex
26767 @end ignore
26768 @tindex select
26769 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26770 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26771 @end table
26772
26773 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26774
26775 @table @samp
26776 @item quote(x)
26777 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26778 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26779 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26780 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26781 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26782 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26783 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26784 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26785 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26786 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26787
26788 @item plain(x)
26789 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26790 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26791 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26792 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26793 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26794 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26795 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26796
26797 @item cons(h,t)
26798 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26799 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26800 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26801 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26802 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26803 have been turned off.
26804
26805 @item rcons(t,h)
26806 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26807 the vector @expr{t}.
26808
26809 @item apply(f,args)
26810 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26811 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26812 is also a regular Calc function.
26813
26814 @item eval(x)
26815 @ignore
26816 @starindex
26817 @end ignore
26818 @tindex eval
26819 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26820 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26821 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26822 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26823 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26824 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26825 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26826
26827 @item evalsimp(x)
26828 @ignore
26829 @starindex
26830 @end ignore
26831 @tindex evalsimp
26832 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26833 way, then algebraically simplified.
26834
26835 @item evalextsimp(x)
26836 @ignore
26837 @starindex
26838 @end ignore
26839 @tindex evalextsimp
26840 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26841 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26842
26843 @item select(x)
26844 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26845 @end table
26846
26847 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26848
26849 @table @samp
26850 @item let(v := x)
26851 @ignore
26852 @starindex
26853 @end ignore
26854 @tindex let
26855 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26856 The algebraic simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26857 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26858 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26859 of simplification. The result of @expr{x} is then bound to the
26860 meta-variable @expr{v}. As usual, if this meta-variable has already
26861 been matched to something else the two values must be equal; if the
26862 meta-variable is new then it is bound to the result of the expression.
26863 This variable can then appear in later conditions, and on the righthand
26864 side of the rule.
26865 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26866 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26867 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26868 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26869 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26870 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26871
26872 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26873 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26874 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26875 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26876
26877 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26878 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26879 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26880 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26881 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26882 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26883 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26884 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26885 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26886 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26887 be bound to @code{ia}.
26888
26889 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26890 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26891 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26892 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26893 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26894 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26895 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26896 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26897 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26898 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26899
26900 @ignore
26901 @starindex
26902 @end ignore
26903 @tindex ierf
26904 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26905 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26906 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26907 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26908 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26909 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26910
26911 @example
26912 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26913 @end example
26914
26915 @item matches(v,p)
26916 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26917 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26918 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26919 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26920 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26921 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26922 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26923 rule.
26924
26925 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26926 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26927 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26928
26929 @item remember
26930 @vindex remember
26931 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26932 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26933 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26934 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26935 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26936 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26937 contains any variables.
26938
26939 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26940 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26941 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26942 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26943 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26944 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26945
26946 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26947 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26948 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26949 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26950 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26951 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26952 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26953
26954 @item remember(c)
26955 @ignore
26956 @starindex
26957 @end ignore
26958 @tindex remember
26959 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26960 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26961 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26962 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26963 @end table
26964
26965 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26966 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26967
26968 @noindent
26969 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26970 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26971 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26972 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26973 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26974
26975 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26976 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26977 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26978
26979 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26980 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26981 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26982 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26983
26984 @example
26985 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26986 @end example
26987
26988 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26989
26990 @example
26991 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26992 @end example
26993
26994 @ignore
26995 @starindex
26996 @end ignore
26997 @tindex ends
26998 Here's another interesting example:
26999
27000 @example
27001 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
27002 @end example
27003
27004 @noindent
27005 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
27006 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
27007 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
27008
27009 @example
27010 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
27011 @end example
27012
27013 @noindent
27014 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
27015 one-element vector.
27016
27017 @tex
27018 \bigskip
27019 @end tex
27020
27021 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
27022 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
27023 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
27024
27025 @ignore
27026 @starindex
27027 @end ignore
27028 @tindex curve
27029 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
27030
27031 @example
27032 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
27033 @end example
27034
27035 @noindent
27036 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
27037
27038 Here is a larger example:
27039
27040 @example
27041 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
27042 @end example
27043
27044 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
27045 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
27046 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
27047
27048 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
27049 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
27050
27051 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
27052 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
27053 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
27054 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
27055 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
27056 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
27057 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
27058 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
27059
27060 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
27061 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
27062 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
27063 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
27064
27065 @example
27066 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
27067 @end example
27068
27069 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
27070 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
27071
27072 @tex
27073 \bigskip
27074 @end tex
27075
27076 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
27077 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
27078 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
27079
27080 For example,
27081
27082 @example
27083 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
27084 @end example
27085
27086 @noindent
27087 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
27088 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
27089 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
27090
27091 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
27092 then an equivalent rule would be:
27093
27094 @example
27095 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
27096 @end example
27097
27098 @noindent
27099 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
27100 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
27101 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
27102 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
27103 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
27104 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
27105 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
27106
27107 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
27108 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
27109
27110 @example
27111 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
27112 @end example
27113
27114 @noindent
27115 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
27116 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
27117
27118 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
27119 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
27120 matched last. Thus
27121
27122 @example
27123 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
27124 @end example
27125
27126 @noindent
27127 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
27128 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
27129 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
27130 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
27131 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
27132 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
27133
27134 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27135 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
27136
27137 @noindent
27138 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
27139 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
27140 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
27141 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
27142 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
27143 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
27144 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
27145 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
27146
27147 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
27148 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
27149 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
27150 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
27151 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
27152 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
27153 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
27154 anywhere in the formula.
27155
27156 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
27157 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
27158 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
27159 side actually comes out to something different than the original
27160 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
27161 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
27162 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
27163 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
27164 forms.
27165
27166 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
27167 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
27168 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
27169 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
27170 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
27171
27172 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
27173 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
27174 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
27175 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
27176
27177 @ignore
27178 @starindex
27179 @end ignore
27180 @ignore
27181 @mindex iter@idots
27182 @end ignore
27183 @tindex iterations
27184 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
27185 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
27186 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
27187 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
27188 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
27189 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
27190 rule set.
27191
27192 @example
27193 [ iterations(1),
27194 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
27195 @end example
27196
27197 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
27198 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
27199 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
27200 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
27201 that was matched.
27202
27203 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
27204
27205 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
27206 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
27207 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
27208
27209 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
27210 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
27211 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
27212 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
27213 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
27214 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
27215 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
27216 are omitted, 100 is used.
27217
27218 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27219 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
27220
27221 @noindent
27222 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
27223 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
27224 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
27225 phases occur during the rewriting process.
27226
27227 @ignore
27228 @starindex
27229 @end ignore
27230 @tindex phase
27231 @vindex all
27232 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
27233 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
27234 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
27235 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
27236 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
27237 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
27238
27239 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
27240 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
27241 ascending order. For example, the rule set
27242
27243 @example
27244 @group
27245 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
27246 phase(1),
27247 f1(x) := g1(x),
27248 phase(2),
27249 f2(x) := g2(x),
27250 phase(3),
27251 f3(x) := g3(x),
27252 phase(1,2),
27253 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
27254 @end group
27255 @end example
27256
27257 @noindent
27258 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27259 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27260 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27261 and @code{f3}.
27262
27263 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27264 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27265 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27266 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27267 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27268 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27269 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27270 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27271 100 by default, is reached.)
27272
27273 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27274 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27275 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27276 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27277 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27278 in the formula.
27279
27280 @ignore
27281 @starindex
27282 @end ignore
27283 @tindex schedule
27284 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27285 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27286 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27287 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27288 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27289 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27290 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27291 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27292 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27293 moving on to phase 3.
27294
27295 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27296 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27297 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27298 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27299 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27300 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27301 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27302 touches.
27303
27304 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27305 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27306 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27307 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27308 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27309 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27310 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27311
27312 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27313 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27314 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27315 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27316 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27317 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27318
27319 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27320 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27321 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27322 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27323 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27324 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27325 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27326 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27327 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27328 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27329 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27330
27331 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27332 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27333 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27334 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27335 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27336 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27337 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27338
27339 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27340 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27341
27342 @noindent
27343 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27344 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27345 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27346 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27347 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27348
27349 @kindex j r
27350 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27351 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27352 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27353 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27354 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27355 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27356 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27357 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27358 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27359
27360 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27361 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27362 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27363 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27364 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27365 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27366
27367 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27368 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27369 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27370 formula will be unselected.
27371
27372 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27373 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27374 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27375 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27376 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27377 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27378 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27379 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27380
27381 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27382 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27383 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27384 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27385
27386 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27387 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27388 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27389 at stack level 1.)
27390
27391 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27392 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27393 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27394 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27395 target and the rewrite rules).
27396
27397 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27398 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27399 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27400 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27401 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27402 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27403
27404 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27405 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27406 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27407 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27408 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27409 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27410 both with and without selections.
27411
27412 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27413 @subsection Matching Commands
27414
27415 @noindent
27416 @kindex a m
27417 @pindex calc-match
27418 @tindex match
27419 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27420 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27421 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27422 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27423 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27424 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27425 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27426 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27427 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27428 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27429 of the patterns.
27430
27431 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27432 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27433
27434 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27435
27436 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27437 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27438 all the positive vector elements.
27439
27440 @kindex I a m
27441 @tindex matchnot
27442 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27443 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27444
27445 @ignore
27446 @starindex
27447 @end ignore
27448 @tindex matches
27449 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27450 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27451 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27452 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27453
27454 @ignore
27455 @starindex
27456 @end ignore
27457 @tindex vmatches
27458 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27459 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27460 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27461 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27462 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27463
27464 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27465 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27466
27467 @noindent
27468 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27469 @vindex EvalRules
27470 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27471 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27472 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27473 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27474 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27475
27476 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27477 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27478 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27479 set would be,
27480
27481 @smallexample
27482 @group
27483 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27484 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27485 @end group
27486 @end smallexample
27487
27488 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27489 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27490 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27491 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27492 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27493 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27494 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27495
27496 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27497 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27498 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27499 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27500 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27501 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27502 applies rules from the top down.
27503
27504 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27505 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27506
27507 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27508 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27509 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27510 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27511 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27512 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27513 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27514 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27515 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27516 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27517 or ran too long'' message.
27518
27519 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27520 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27521 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27522 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27523 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27524 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27525 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27526 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27527 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27528 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27529 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27530 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27531 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27532
27533 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27534 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27535 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27536 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27537 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27538 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27539 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27540 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27541 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27542 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27543 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27544 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27545 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27546
27547 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27548 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27549 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27550 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27551
27552 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27553 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27554 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27555 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27556 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27557 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27558 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27559 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27560
27561 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27562 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27563 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27564 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27565 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27566 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27567 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27568 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27569 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27570 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27571 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27572 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27573 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27574 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27575
27576 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27577 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27578 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27579 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27580 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27581 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27582 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27583 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27584 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27585 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27586 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27587 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27588 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27589
27590 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27591 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27592
27593 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27594 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27595 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27596 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27597 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27598 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27599 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27600
27601 @smallexample
27602 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27603 @end smallexample
27604
27605 @noindent
27606 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27607 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27608 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27609 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27610
27611 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27612 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27613 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27614 but only when algebraic simplifications are used to simplify the
27615 formula. The variable @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose.
27616 The @kbd{a s} command will apply @code{EvalRules} and
27617 @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as well as all of its built-in
27618 simplifications.
27619
27620 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27621 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27622 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of algebraic
27623 simplifications. It then applies its own built-in simplifications
27624 throughout the formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with
27625 applying the default simplifications) until no further changes are
27626 possible.
27627
27628 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27629 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27630 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27631 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27632 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27633 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27634 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27635 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27636 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27637
27638 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27639 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27640
27641 @noindent
27642 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27643 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27644 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27645 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27646 noted.
27647
27648 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27649 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27650
27651 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27652 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27653 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27654 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27655 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27656 be needlessly slow.
27657
27658 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27659 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27660
27661 @noindent
27662 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27663 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27664 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27665 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27666 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27667 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27668 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27669
27670 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27671 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27672 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27673 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27674 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27675 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27676 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27677
27678 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27679 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27680 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27681 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27682 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27683 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27684 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27685 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27686
27687 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27688 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27689 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27690 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27691 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27692 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27693 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27694 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27695 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27696 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27697
27698 @cindex Quaternions
27699 The following rule set, contributed by
27700 @texline Fran\c cois
27701 @infoline Francois
27702 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27703 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27704 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27705 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27706 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27707 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27708 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27709 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27710 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27711 @key{RET}}.
27712
27713 @smallexample
27714 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27715 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27716 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27717 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27718 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27719 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27720 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27721 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27722 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27723 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27724 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27725 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27726 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27727 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27728 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27729 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27730 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27731 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27732 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27733 @end smallexample
27734
27735 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27736 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27737 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27738 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27739 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27740 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27741 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27742
27743 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27744 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27745 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27746 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27747 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27748 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27749
27750 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27751 @chapter Operating on Units
27752
27753 @noindent
27754 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27755 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27756 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27757 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27758 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27759
27760 @menu
27761 * Basic Operations on Units::
27762 * The Units Table::
27763 * Predefined Units::
27764 * User-Defined Units::
27765 * Logarithmic Units::
27766 * Musical Notes::
27767 @end menu
27768
27769 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27770 @section Basic Operations on Units
27771
27772 @noindent
27773 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27774 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27775 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27776 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27777 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27778 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27779 formula.
27780
27781 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27782 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27783 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27784 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27785 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27786 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27787
27788 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27789 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27790 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27791 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27792 representation of one millimeter.
27793
27794 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27795 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27796 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27797
27798 @kindex u s
27799 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27800 @ignore
27801 @mindex usimpl@idots
27802 @end ignore
27803 @tindex usimplify
27804 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27805 simplifies a units
27806 expression. It uses Calc's algebraic simplifications to simplify the
27807 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27808 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27809 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27810 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27811 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27812 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27813 automatically at all times.
27814
27815 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27816 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27817 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27818 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27819 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27820 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27821 applied to units expressions, in which case
27822 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27823 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27824 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27825
27826 @kindex u c
27827 @pindex calc-convert-units
27828 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27829 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27830 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27831 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27832 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27833 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27834 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27835 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27836 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27837
27838 @kindex u t
27839 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27840 @cindex Temperature conversion
27841 The @kbd{u c} command treats temperature units (like @samp{degC} and
27842 @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example, @kbd{u c} converts
27843 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10 degrees Celsius
27844 corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit. To convert absolute
27845 temperatures, you can use the @kbd{u t}
27846 (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command. The value on the stack
27847 must be a simple units expression with units of temperature only.
27848 This command would convert @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the
27849 equivalent temperature on the Fahrenheit scale.
27850
27851 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27852 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27853 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27854 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27855 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27856 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27857 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27858
27859 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27860 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27861 units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27862 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27863 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27864 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27865 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27866 input units.
27867
27868 If you want to disallow using inconsistent units, you can set the customizable variable
27869 @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} to @code{t} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). In this case,
27870 if you request units which are inconsistent with the original units, you will be warned about
27871 it and no conversion will occur.
27872
27873 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27874 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27875 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27876 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27877 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27878 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27879 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27880 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27881
27882 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27883 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27884 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27885 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27886 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27887 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27888
27889 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27890 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27891 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27892 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27893 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27894 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27895 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27896
27897 @cindex Composite units
27898 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27899 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27900 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27901 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27902 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27903 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27904 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27905 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27906 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27907 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27908 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27909 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27910 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27911
27912 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27913 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27914 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27915 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27916 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27917 converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27918
27919 @kindex u b
27920 @pindex calc-base-units
27921 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27922 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27923 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27924 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27925
27926 Like the @kbd{u c} command, the @kbd{u b} command treats temperature
27927 units as relative temperatures.
27928
27929 @kindex u r
27930 @pindex calc-remove-units
27931 @kindex u x
27932 @pindex calc-extract-units
27933 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27934 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27935 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27936 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27937 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27938 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27939
27940 @kindex u a
27941 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27942 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27943 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27944 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27945 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27946 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27947 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27948 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27949 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27950 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27951
27952 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27953 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27954 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27955 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27956 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27957 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27958 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27959 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27960 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27961 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27962 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27963 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27964 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27965 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27966 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27967 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27968
27969 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27970 @section The Units Table
27971
27972 @noindent
27973 @kindex u v
27974 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27975 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27976 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27977 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27978 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27979 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27980 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27981 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27982 and steradians.
27983
27984 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27985 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27986 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27987 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27988 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27989 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27990
27991 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27992 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27993 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27994
27995 @kindex u V
27996 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27997 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27998 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27999 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
28000 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
28001 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
28002 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
28003 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
28004
28005 @kindex u g
28006 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
28007 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
28008 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
28009 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
28010 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
28011 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
28012 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
28013 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
28014 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
28015 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
28016
28017 @kindex u e
28018 @pindex calc-explain-units
28019 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
28020 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
28021 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
28022 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
28023 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
28024 column of the Units Table.
28025
28026 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
28027 @section Predefined Units
28028
28029 @noindent
28030 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
28031 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
28032 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
28033 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
28034 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
28035 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
28036 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
28037 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
28038 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
28039 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
28040 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
28041 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
28042 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
28043 International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
28044 kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
28045 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
28046 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
28047 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
28048 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
28049 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
28050 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
28051 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
28052
28053 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
28054 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
28055 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
28056 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
28057 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
28058 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
28059 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
28060 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
28061
28062 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
28063 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
28064 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
28065 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
28066 of the various temperature scales.
28067
28068 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
28069 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
28070
28071 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
28072 @tex
28073 for \AA ngstroms.
28074 @end tex
28075 @ifnottex
28076 for Angstroms.
28077 @end ifnottex
28078
28079 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
28080 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
28081 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
28082 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
28083 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
28084 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
28085 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
28086 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
28087 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
28088 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
28089 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
28090 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
28091
28092 When Calc is using the @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} language mode (@pxref{TeX
28093 and LaTeX Language Modes}), the @TeX{} specific unit names will not
28094 use the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
28095 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example. To avoid conflicts,
28096 the unit names for pint and parsec will simply be @samp{pint} and
28097 @samp{parsec} instead of @samp{pt} and @samp{pc}.
28098
28099
28100 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
28101 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
28102 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
28103 preferable to @code{e}.
28104
28105 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
28106 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
28107 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
28108
28109 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
28110 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
28111
28112 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
28113 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
28114
28115 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
28116 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
28117 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
28118 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
28119 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
28120 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
28121 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
28122 units.
28123
28124 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
28125 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
28126 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
28127 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
28128 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
28129 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
28130 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
28131 really is unitless.)
28132
28133 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
28134
28135 @node User-Defined Units, Logarithmic Units, Predefined Units, Units
28136 @section User-Defined Units
28137
28138 @noindent
28139 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
28140 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
28141
28142 @kindex u 0-9
28143 @pindex calc-quick-units
28144 @vindex Units
28145 @cindex @code{Units} variable
28146 @cindex Quick units
28147 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
28148 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
28149 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
28150 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
28151 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
28152 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
28153 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
28154 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
28155 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
28156 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
28157 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
28158 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
28159
28160 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
28161 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
28162 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
28163 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
28164 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
28165 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
28166
28167 @kindex u d
28168 @pindex calc-define-unit
28169 @cindex User-defined units
28170 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
28171 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
28172 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
28173 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
28174 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
28175 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
28176 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
28177 appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
28178 be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
28179 asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
28180 command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
28181 for a string that will be used to display the definition.
28182
28183 @kindex u u
28184 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
28185 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
28186 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
28187 however.
28188
28189 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
28190 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
28191 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
28192 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
28193 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
28194
28195 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
28196 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
28197 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
28198 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
28199 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
28200 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
28201 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
28202 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
28203 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
28204
28205 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
28206 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
28207
28208 @kindex u p
28209 @pindex calc-permanent-units
28210 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
28211 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
28212 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
28213 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so that the
28214 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
28215 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
28216 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
28217 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28218
28219 @node Logarithmic Units, Musical Notes, User-Defined Units, Units
28220 @section Logarithmic Units
28221
28222 The units @code{dB} (decibels) and @code{Np} (nepers) are logarithmic
28223 units which are manipulated differently than standard units. Calc
28224 provides commands to work with these logarithmic units.
28225
28226 Decibels and nepers are used to measure power quantities as well as
28227 field quantities (quantities whose squares are proportional to power);
28228 these two types of quantities are handled slightly different from each
28229 other. By default the Calc commands work as if power quantities are
28230 being used; with the @kbd{H} prefix the Calc commands work as if field
28231 quantities are being used.
28232
28233 The decibel level of a power
28234 @infoline @math{P1},
28235 @texline @math{P_1},
28236 relative to a reference power
28237 @infoline @math{P0},
28238 @texline @math{P_0},
28239 is defined to be
28240 @infoline @math{10 log10(P1/P0) dB}.
28241 @texline @math{10 \log_{10}(P_{1}/P_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28242 (The factor of 10 is because a decibel, as its name implies, is
28243 one-tenth of a bel. The bel, named after Alexander Graham Bell, was
28244 considered to be too large of a unit and was effectively replaced by
28245 the decibel.) If @math{F} is a field quantity with power
28246 @math{P=k F^2}, then a reference quantity of
28247 @infoline @math{F0}
28248 @texline @math{F_0}
28249 would correspond to a power of
28250 @infoline @math{P0=k F0^2}.
28251 @texline @math{P_{0}=kF_{0}^2}.
28252 If
28253 @infoline @math{P1=k F1^2},
28254 @texline @math{P_{1}=kF_{1}^2},
28255 then
28256
28257 @ifnottex
28258 @example
28259 10 log10(P1/P0) = 10 log10(F1^2/F0^2) = 20 log10(F1/F0).
28260 @end example
28261 @end ifnottex
28262 @tex
28263 $$ 10 \log_{10}(P_1/P_0) = 10 \log_{10}(F_1^2/F_0^2) = 20
28264 \log_{10}(F_1/F_0)$$
28265 @end tex
28266
28267 @noindent
28268 In order to get the same decibel level regardless of whether a field
28269 quantity or the corresponding power quantity is used, the decibel
28270 level of a field quantity
28271 @infoline @math{F1},
28272 @texline @math{F_1},
28273 relative to a reference
28274 @infoline @math{F0},
28275 @texline @math{F_0},
28276 is defined as
28277 @infoline @math{20 log10(F1/F0) dB}.
28278 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(F_{1}/F_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28279 For example, the decibel value of a sound pressure level of
28280 @infoline @math{60 uPa}
28281 @texline @math{60 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28282 relative to
28283 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28284 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28285 (the threshold of human hearing) is
28286 @infoline @math{20 log10(60 uPa/ 20 uPa) dB = 20 log10(3) dB},
28287 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(60 \mu{\rm Pa}/20 \mu{\rm Pa}) {\rm dB} = 20 \log_{10}(3) {\rm dB}},
28288 which is about
28289 @infoline @math{9.54 dB}.
28290 @texline @math{9.54 {\rm dB}}.
28291 Note that in taking the ratio, the original units cancel and so these
28292 logarithmic units are dimensionless.
28293
28294 Nepers (named after John Napier, who is credited with inventing the
28295 logarithm) are similar to bels except they use natural logarithms instead
28296 of common logarithms. The neper level of a power
28297 @infoline @math{P1},
28298 @texline @math{P_1},
28299 relative to a reference power
28300 @infoline @math{P0},
28301 @texline @math{P_0},
28302 is
28303 @infoline @math{(1/2) ln(P1/P0) Np}.
28304 @texline @math{(1/2) \ln(P_1/P_0) {\rm Np}}.
28305 The neper level of a field
28306 @infoline @math{F1},
28307 @texline @math{F_1},
28308 relative to a reference field
28309 @infoline @math{F0},
28310 @texline @math{F_0},
28311 is
28312 @infoline @math{ln(F1/F0) Np}.
28313 @texline @math{\ln(F_1/F_0) {\rm Np}}.
28314
28315 @vindex calc-lu-power-reference
28316 @vindex calc-lu-field-reference
28317 For power quantities, Calc uses
28318 @infoline @math{1 mW}
28319 @texline @math{1 {\rm mW}}
28320 as the default reference quantity; this default can be changed by changing
28321 the value of the customizable variable
28322 @code{calc-lu-power-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
28323 For field quantities, Calc uses
28324 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28325 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28326 as the default reference quantity; this is the value used in acoustics
28327 which is where decibels are commonly encountered. This default can be
28328 changed by changing the value of the customizable variable
28329 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). A
28330 non-default reference quantity will be read from the stack if the
28331 capital @kbd{O} prefix is used.
28332
28333 @kindex l q
28334 @pindex calc-lu-quant
28335 @tindex lupquant
28336 @tindex lufquant
28337 The @kbd{l q} (@code{calc-lu-quant}) [@code{lupquant}]
28338 command computes the power quantity corresponding to a given number of
28339 logarithmic units. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix, @kbd{O l q}, the
28340 reference level will be read from the top of the stack. (In an
28341 algebraic formula, @code{lupquant} can be given an optional second
28342 argument which will be used for the reference level.) For example,
28343 @code{20 dB @key{RET} l q} will return @code{100 mW};
28344 @code{20 dB @key{RET} 4 W @key{RET} O l q} will return @code{400 W}.
28345 The @kbd{H l q} [@code{lufquant}] command behaves like @kbd{l q} but
28346 computes field quantities instead of power quantities.
28347
28348 @kindex l d
28349 @pindex calc-db
28350 @tindex dbpower
28351 @tindex dbfield
28352 @kindex l n
28353 @pindex calc-np
28354 @tindex nppower
28355 @tindex npfield
28356 The @kbd{l d} (@code{calc-db}) [@code{dbpower}] command will compute
28357 the decibel level of a power quantity using the default reference
28358 level; @kbd{H l d} [@code{dbfield}] will compute the decibel level of
28359 a field quantity. The commands @kbd{l n} (@code{calc-np})
28360 [@code{nppower}] and @kbd{H l n} [@code{npfield}] will similarly
28361 compute neper levels. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix these commands
28362 will read a reference level from the stack; in an algebraic formula
28363 the reference level can be given as an optional second argument.
28364
28365 @kindex l +
28366 @pindex calc-lu-plus
28367 @tindex lupadd
28368 @tindex lufadd
28369 @kindex l -
28370 @pindex calc-lu-minus
28371 @tindex lupsub
28372 @tindex lufsub
28373 @kindex l *
28374 @pindex calc-lu-times
28375 @tindex lupmul
28376 @tindex lufmul
28377 @kindex l /
28378 @pindex calc-lu-divide
28379 @tindex lupdiv
28380 @tindex lufdiv
28381 The sum of two power or field quantities doesn't correspond to the sum
28382 of the corresponding decibel or neper levels. If the powers
28383 corresponding to decibel levels
28384 @infoline @math{D1}
28385 @texline @math{D_1}
28386 and
28387 @infoline @math{D2}
28388 @texline @math{D_2}
28389 are added, the corresponding decibel level ``sum'' will be
28390
28391 @ifnottex
28392 @example
28393 10 log10(10^(D1/10) + 10^(D2/10)) dB.
28394 @end example
28395 @end ifnottex
28396 @tex
28397 $$ 10 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/10} + 10^{D_2/10}) {\rm dB}.$$
28398 @end tex
28399
28400 @noindent
28401 When field quantities are combined, it often means the corresponding
28402 powers are added and so the above formula might be used. In
28403 acoustics, for example, the sound pressure level is a field quantity
28404 and so the decibels are often defined using the field formula, but the
28405 sound pressure levels are combined as the sound power levels, and so
28406 the above formula should be used. If two field quantities themselves
28407 are added, the new decibel level will be
28408
28409 @ifnottex
28410 @example
28411 20 log10(10^(D1/20) + 10^(D2/20)) dB.
28412 @end example
28413 @end ifnottex
28414 @tex
28415 $$ 20 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/20} + 10^{D_2/20}) {\rm dB}.$$
28416 @end tex
28417
28418 @noindent
28419 If the power corresponding to @math{D} dB is multiplied by a number @math{N},
28420 then the corresponding decibel level will be
28421
28422 @ifnottex
28423 @example
28424 D + 10 log10(N) dB,
28425 @end example
28426 @end ifnottex
28427 @tex
28428 $$ D + 10 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB},$$
28429 @end tex
28430
28431 @noindent
28432 if a field quantity is multiplied by @math{N} the corresponding decibel level
28433 will be
28434
28435 @ifnottex
28436 @example
28437 D + 20 log10(N) dB.
28438 @end example
28439 @end ifnottex
28440 @tex
28441 $$ D + 20 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB}.$$
28442 @end tex
28443
28444 @noindent
28445 There are similar formulas for combining nepers. The @kbd{l +}
28446 (@code{calc-lu-plus}) [@code{lupadd}] command will ``add'' two
28447 logarithmic unit power levels this way; with the @kbd{H} prefix,
28448 @kbd{H l +} [@code{lufadd}] will add logarithmic unit field levels.
28449 Similarly, logarithmic units can be ``subtracted'' with @kbd{l -}
28450 (@code{calc-lu-minus}) [@code{lupsub}] or @kbd{H l -} [@code{lufsub}].
28451 The @kbd{l *} (@code{calc-lu-times}) [@code{lupmul}] and @kbd{H l *}
28452 [@code{lufmul}] commands will ``multiply'' a logarithmic unit by a
28453 number; the @kbd{l /} (@code{calc-lu-divide}) [@code{lupdiv}] and
28454 @kbd{H l /} [@code{lufdiv}] commands will ``divide'' a logarithmic
28455 unit by a number. Note that the reference quantities don't play a role
28456 in this arithmetic.
28457
28458 @node Musical Notes, , Logarithmic Units, Units
28459 @section Musical Notes
28460
28461 Calc can convert between musical notes and their associated
28462 frequencies. Notes can be given using either scientific pitch
28463 notation or midi numbers. Since these note systems are basically
28464 logarithmic scales, Calc uses the @kbd{l} prefix for functions
28465 operating on notes.
28466
28467 Scientific pitch notation refers to a note by giving a letter
28468 A through G, possibly followed by a flat or sharp) with a subscript
28469 indicating an octave number. Each octave starts with C and ends with
28470 B and
28471 @c increasing each note by a semitone will result
28472 @c in the sequence @expr{C}, @expr{C} sharp, @expr{D}, @expr{E} flat, @expr{E},
28473 @c @expr{F}, @expr{F} sharp, @expr{G}, @expr{A} flat, @expr{A}, @expr{B}
28474 @c flat and @expr{B}.
28475 the octave numbered 0 was chosen to correspond to the lowest
28476 audible frequency. Using this system, middle C (about 261.625 Hz)
28477 corresponds to the note @expr{C} in octave 4 and is denoted
28478 @expr{C_4}. Any frequency can be described by giving a note plus an
28479 offset in cents (where a cent is a ratio of frequencies so that a
28480 semitone consists of 100 cents).
28481
28482 The midi note number system assigns numbers to notes so that
28483 @expr{C_(-1)} corresponds to the midi note number 0 and @expr{G_9}
28484 corresponds to the midi note number 127. A midi controller can have
28485 up to 128 keys and each midi note number from 0 to 127 corresponds to
28486 a possible key.
28487
28488 @kindex l s
28489 @pindex calc-spn
28490 @tindex spn
28491 The @kbd{l s} (@code{calc-spn}) [@code{spn}] command converts either
28492 a frequency or a midi number to scientific pitch notation. For
28493 example, @code{500 Hz} gets converted to
28494 @code{B_4 + 21.3094853649 cents} and @code{84} to @code{C_6}.
28495
28496
28497 @kindex l m
28498 @pindex calc-midi
28499 @tindex midi
28500 The @kbd{l m} (@code{calc-midi}) [@code{midi}] command converts either
28501 a frequency or a note given in scientific pitch notation to the
28502 corresponding midi number. For example, @code{C_6} gets converted to 84
28503 and @code{440 Hz} to 69.
28504
28505 @kindex l f
28506 @pindex calc-freq
28507 @tindex freq
28508 The @kbd{l f} (@code{calc-freq}) [@code{freq}] command converts either
28509 either a midi number or a note given in scientific pitch notation to
28510 the corresponding frequency. For example, @code{Asharp_2 + 30 cents}
28511 gets converted to @code{118.578040134 Hz} and @code{55} to
28512 @code{195.99771799 Hz}.
28513
28514 Since the frequencies of notes are not usually given exactly (and are
28515 typically irrational), the customizable variable
28516 @code{calc-note-threshold} determines how close (in cents) a frequency
28517 needs to be to a note to be recognized as that note
28518 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). This variable has a default value of
28519 @code{1}. For example, middle @var{C} is approximately
28520 @expr{261.625565302 Hz}; this frequency is often shortened to
28521 @expr{261.625 Hz}. Without @code{calc-note-threshold} (or a value of
28522 @expr{0}), Calc would convert @code{261.625 Hz} to scientific pitch
28523 notation @code{B_3 + 99.9962592773 cents}; with the default value of
28524 @code{1}, Calc converts @code{261.625 Hz} to @code{C_4}.
28525
28526
28527
28528 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
28529 @chapter Storing and Recalling
28530
28531 @noindent
28532 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
28533 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
28534 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
28535 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
28536
28537 @menu
28538 * Storing Variables::
28539 * Recalling Variables::
28540 * Operations on Variables::
28541 * Let Command::
28542 * Evaluates-To Operator::
28543 @end menu
28544
28545 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
28546 @section Storing Variables
28547
28548 @noindent
28549 @kindex s s
28550 @pindex calc-store
28551 @cindex Storing variables
28552 @cindex Quick variables
28553 @vindex q0
28554 @vindex q9
28555 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
28556 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
28557 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
28558 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
28559 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
28560
28561 @kindex s t
28562 @pindex calc-store-into
28563 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
28564 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
28565 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
28566
28567 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
28568 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
28569 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
28570 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
28571 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
28572 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
28573 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
28574 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
28575
28576 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
28577 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
28578 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
28579 righthand sides simultaneously.
28580
28581 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
28582 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
28583 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28584 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28585 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28586 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28587
28588 @kindex s 0-9
28589 @kindex t 0-9
28590 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28591 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28592 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28593 for trail and time/date commands.)
28594
28595 @kindex s +
28596 @kindex s -
28597 @ignore
28598 @mindex @idots
28599 @end ignore
28600 @kindex s *
28601 @ignore
28602 @mindex @null
28603 @end ignore
28604 @kindex s /
28605 @ignore
28606 @mindex @null
28607 @end ignore
28608 @kindex s ^
28609 @ignore
28610 @mindex @null
28611 @end ignore
28612 @kindex s |
28613 @ignore
28614 @mindex @null
28615 @end ignore
28616 @kindex s n
28617 @ignore
28618 @mindex @null
28619 @end ignore
28620 @kindex s &
28621 @ignore
28622 @mindex @null
28623 @end ignore
28624 @kindex s [
28625 @ignore
28626 @mindex @null
28627 @end ignore
28628 @kindex s ]
28629 @pindex calc-store-plus
28630 @pindex calc-store-minus
28631 @pindex calc-store-times
28632 @pindex calc-store-div
28633 @pindex calc-store-power
28634 @pindex calc-store-concat
28635 @pindex calc-store-neg
28636 @pindex calc-store-inv
28637 @pindex calc-store-decr
28638 @pindex calc-store-incr
28639 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28640 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28641 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28642 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28643 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28644 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28645
28646 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28647 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28648 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28649 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28650 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28651 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28652 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28653 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28654 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28655 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28656 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28657 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28658 forwards and backwards:
28659
28660 @example
28661 @group
28662 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28663 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28664 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28665 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28666 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28667 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28668 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28669 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28670 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28671 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28672 @end group
28673 @end example
28674
28675 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28676 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28677 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28678 minus-two minus the variable.
28679
28680 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28681 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28682 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28683
28684 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28685 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28686 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28687 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28688 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28689 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28690 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28691
28692 @kindex s m
28693 @pindex calc-store-map
28694 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28695 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28696 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28697 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28698 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28699 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28700 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28701 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28702 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28703 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28704 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28705
28706 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28707 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28708 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28709 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28710 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28711 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28712 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28713
28714 @kindex s x
28715 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28716 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28717 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28718 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28719
28720 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28721 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28722 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28723
28724 @kindex s u
28725 @pindex calc-unstore
28726 @cindex Void variables
28727 @cindex Un-storing variables
28728 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28729 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28730 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28731 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28732 void state.
28733
28734 @kindex s c
28735 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28736 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28737 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28738 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28739 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28740 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28741 current precision.
28742
28743 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28744 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28745 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28746 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28747 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28748 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28749 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28750 normally void).
28751
28752 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28753 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28754 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28755 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28756 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28757 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28758 @kbd{s c}.
28759
28760 @kindex s k
28761 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28762 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28763 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28764 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28765 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28766 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28767 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28768 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28769 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28770 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28771 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28772
28773 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28774 @section Recalling Variables
28775
28776 @noindent
28777 @kindex s r
28778 @pindex calc-recall
28779 @cindex Recalling variables
28780 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28781 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28782 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28783 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28784 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28785
28786 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28787 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28788 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28789 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28790 latter will produce an error message.
28791
28792 @kindex r 0-9
28793 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28794 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
28795
28796 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28797 @section Other Operations on Variables
28798
28799 @noindent
28800 @kindex s e
28801 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28802 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28803 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28804 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28805 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28806 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28807 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28808 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28809 description of editing.
28810
28811 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28812 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28813 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28814 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28815 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28816 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28817 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28818 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28819 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28820 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28821
28822 @kindex s A
28823 @kindex s D
28824 @ignore
28825 @mindex @idots
28826 @end ignore
28827 @kindex s E
28828 @ignore
28829 @mindex @null
28830 @end ignore
28831 @kindex s F
28832 @ignore
28833 @mindex @null
28834 @end ignore
28835 @kindex s G
28836 @ignore
28837 @mindex @null
28838 @end ignore
28839 @kindex s H
28840 @ignore
28841 @mindex @null
28842 @end ignore
28843 @kindex s I
28844 @ignore
28845 @mindex @null
28846 @end ignore
28847 @kindex s L
28848 @ignore
28849 @mindex @null
28850 @end ignore
28851 @kindex s P
28852 @ignore
28853 @mindex @null
28854 @end ignore
28855 @kindex s R
28856 @ignore
28857 @mindex @null
28858 @end ignore
28859 @kindex s T
28860 @ignore
28861 @mindex @null
28862 @end ignore
28863 @kindex s U
28864 @ignore
28865 @mindex @null
28866 @end ignore
28867 @kindex s X
28868 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28869 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28870 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28871 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28872 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28873 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28874 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28875 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28876 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28877 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28878 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28879 @pindex calc-store-Units
28880 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28881 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28882 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28883
28884 @table @kbd
28885 @item s A
28886 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28887 @item s D
28888 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28889 @item s E
28890 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Basic Simplifications}.
28891 @item s F
28892 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28893 @item s G
28894 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28895 @item s H
28896 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28897 @item s I
28898 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28899 @item s L
28900 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28901 @item s P
28902 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28903 @item s R
28904 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28905 @item s T
28906 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28907 @item s U
28908 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28909 @item s X
28910 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28911 @end table
28912
28913 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28914 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28915
28916 @kindex s p
28917 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28918 @cindex Storing variables
28919 @cindex Permanent variables
28920 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28921 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28922 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28923 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so
28924 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28925 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28926 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28927 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28928 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28929
28930 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28931 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28932 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28933 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28934 and @code{PlotRejects};
28935 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28936 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28937 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28938 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28939
28940 @kindex s i
28941 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28942 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28943 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28944 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28945 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28946 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28947 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28948 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28949 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28950 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28951 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28952
28953 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28954 @section The Let Command
28955
28956 @noindent
28957 @kindex s l
28958 @pindex calc-let
28959 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28960 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28961 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28962 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28963 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28964 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28965
28966 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28967 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28968 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28969 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28970 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28971 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28972 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28973 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28974 by these commands.
28975
28976 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28977 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28978 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28979
28980 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28981 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28982 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28983
28984 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28985 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28986 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28987 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28988 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28989 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28990
28991 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28992 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28993
28994 @noindent
28995 @tindex evalto
28996 @tindex =>
28997 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28998 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28999 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
29000 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
29001 other language modes like Pascal and @LaTeX{}.) This is a binary
29002 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
29003 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
29004
29005 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
29006 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
29007 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
29008 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
29009 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
29010 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
29011
29012 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
29013 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
29014 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
29015
29016 @kindex s =
29017 @pindex calc-evalto
29018 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
29019 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
29020 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
29021 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
29022 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
29023
29024 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
29025 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
29026 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
29027 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
29028 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
29029 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
29030 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
29031 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
29032 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
29033 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
29034 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
29035 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
29036 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
29037 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
29038 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
29039
29040 @kindex m C
29041 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
29042 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
29043 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
29044 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
29045 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
29046 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
29047 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
29048 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
29049
29050 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
29051 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
29052 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
29053 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
29054 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
29055 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
29056 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
29057
29058 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
29059 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
29060 formula @samp{arcsin(sin(x))} will not be handled by Calc's algebraic
29061 simplifications, but Calc's unsafe simplifications will reduce it to
29062 @samp{x}. If you enter @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) =>} normally, the result
29063 will be @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))}. If you change to
29064 Extended Simplification mode, the result will be
29065 @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a e}
29066 once will have no effect on @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))},
29067 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
29068 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
29069 affected by commands like @kbd{a e}.
29070
29071 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
29072 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
29073 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
29074 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
29075 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
29076 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
29077 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
29078 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
29079 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
29080 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
29081
29082 @smallexample
29083 @group
29084 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
29085 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
29086 . . .
29087
29088 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
29089 @end group
29090 @end smallexample
29091
29092 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
29093 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
29094 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
29095 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
29096 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
29097 side effects.
29098
29099 @kindex s :
29100 @pindex calc-assign
29101 @tindex assign
29102 @tindex :=
29103 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
29104 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
29105 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
29106 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
29107 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
29108 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
29109 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
29110 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
29111 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
29112
29113 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
29114 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
29115 treatment to @samp{=>}.
29116
29117 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
29118 @chapter Graphics
29119
29120 @noindent
29121 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
29122 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
29123 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
29124 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
29125 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
29126 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
29127
29128 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
29129 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
29130 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable in
29131 your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some
29132 Lisp variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
29133 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are using
29134 the X window system or MS-Windows, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
29135 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are using a
29136 Unix or GNU system without X, Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display
29137 graphs using simple character graphics that will work on any
29138 Posix-compatible terminal.
29139
29140 @menu
29141 * Basic Graphics::
29142 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
29143 * Managing Curves::
29144 * Graphics Options::
29145 * Devices::
29146 @end menu
29147
29148 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
29149 @section Basic Graphics
29150
29151 @noindent
29152 @kindex g f
29153 @pindex calc-graph-fast
29154 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
29155 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
29156 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
29157 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
29158 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
29159 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
29160 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
29161 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
29162 to indicate the points themselves.
29163
29164 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
29165 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
29166 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
29167
29168 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
29169 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
29170 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
29171
29172 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
29173 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
29174 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
29175 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
29176 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
29177 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
29178 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
29179 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
29180 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
29181
29182 @ignore
29183 @starindex
29184 @end ignore
29185 @tindex xy
29186 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
29187 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
29188 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
29189 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
29190 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
29191 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
29192 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
29193 will be a circle.
29194
29195 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
29196 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
29197 variables.
29198
29199 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
29200 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
29201 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
29202 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
29203 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
29204 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
29205 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
29206 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
29207 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
29208
29209 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
29210 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
29211
29212 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
29213 @vindex PlotRejects
29214 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
29215 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
29216 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
29217 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
29218 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
29219 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
29220 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
29221 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
29222 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
29223 @code{PlotRejects}.
29224
29225 @kindex g c
29226 @pindex calc-graph-clear
29227 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
29228 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
29229 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
29230 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
29231 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
29232 window if there is one.
29233
29234 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
29235 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
29236
29237 @kindex g F
29238 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
29239 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
29240 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
29241 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
29242
29243 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
29244 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
29245 are several options for these values.
29246
29247 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
29248 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
29249 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
29250 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
29251 result is a surface plot where
29252 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
29253 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
29254 is the height of the point
29255 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
29256 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
29257 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29258 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
29259 description of the @samp{set view} command.
29260
29261 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
29262 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
29263
29264 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
29265 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
29266 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
29267 of values from the input vectors.
29268
29269 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
29270 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
29271 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
29272 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
29273 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
29274 3D surface.
29275
29276 @ignore
29277 @starindex
29278 @end ignore
29279 @tindex xyz
29280 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
29281 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
29282 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
29283 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
29284 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
29285 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
29286 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
29287 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
29288 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
29289 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
29290 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
29291 vectors with more than 5 elements.
29292
29293 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
29294 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
29295 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
29296 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
29297 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
29298
29299 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
29300 variables containing the relevant data.
29301
29302 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
29303 @section Managing Curves
29304
29305 @noindent
29306 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
29307 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
29308 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
29309 by using these commands directly.
29310
29311 @kindex g a
29312 @pindex calc-graph-add
29313 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
29314 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
29315 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
29316 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
29317 on the same axes.
29318
29319 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
29320 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
29321 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
29322 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
29323 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
29324 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
29325 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
29326 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
29327 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
29328 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
29329 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
29330 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
29331 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29332
29333 @vindex PlotData1
29334 @vindex PlotData2
29335 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
29336 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
29337 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
29338 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
29339 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
29340 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
29341 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
29342 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
29343
29344 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
29345 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
29346 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
29347 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
29348 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
29349 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
29350
29351 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
29352 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
29353 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
29354
29355 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
29356 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
29357 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
29358 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
29359 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
29360 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
29361
29362 For example, to plot
29363 @texline @math{\sin n x}
29364 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
29365 for integers @expr{n}
29366 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
29367 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
29368 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
29369 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
29370 command.
29371
29372 @kindex g A
29373 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
29374 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
29375 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
29376 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
29377 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
29378 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
29379 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
29380 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
29381 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
29382 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
29383 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29384
29385 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
29386 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
29387 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
29388 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
29389 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
29390 check for this.)
29391
29392 @kindex g d
29393 @pindex calc-graph-delete
29394 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
29395 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
29396 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
29397 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
29398
29399 @kindex g H
29400 @pindex calc-graph-hide
29401 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
29402 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
29403 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
29404 point styles will be retained.
29405
29406 @kindex g j
29407 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
29408 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
29409 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
29410 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
29411 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
29412 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
29413 affect the last curve in the list.
29414
29415 @kindex g p
29416 @pindex calc-graph-plot
29417 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
29418 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
29419 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
29420 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
29421 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
29422 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
29423 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
29424 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
29425 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
29426
29427 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
29428 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
29429 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
29430 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
29431 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
29432 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
29433 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
29434
29435 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
29436 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
29437 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
29438 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
29439 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
29440 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
29441 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
29442
29443 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
29444 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
29445 the current graph is three-dimensional.
29446
29447 @kindex g P
29448 @pindex calc-graph-print
29449 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
29450 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
29451 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
29452 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
29453 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
29454 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
29455 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
29456 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
29457 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
29458 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
29459 always plot to the printer.
29460
29461 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
29462 @section Graphics Options
29463
29464 @noindent
29465 @kindex g g
29466 @pindex calc-graph-grid
29467 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
29468 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
29469 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
29470 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
29471 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
29472 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
29473
29474 @kindex g b
29475 @pindex calc-graph-border
29476 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
29477 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
29478 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29479
29480 @kindex g k
29481 @pindex calc-graph-key
29482 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
29483 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
29484 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
29485 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
29486 curves on the same graph.
29487
29488 @kindex g N
29489 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
29490 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
29491 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
29492 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
29493 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
29494 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
29495 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
29496 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
29497 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
29498 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
29499 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
29500 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
29501 will be computed for the surface.
29502
29503 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
29504 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
29505 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
29506 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
29507 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
29508 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
29509 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
29510 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
29511 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
29512
29513 @kindex g h
29514 @pindex calc-graph-header
29515 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
29516 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
29517 The default title is blank (no title).
29518
29519 @kindex g n
29520 @pindex calc-graph-name
29521 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
29522 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
29523 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
29524 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
29525 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
29526 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
29527 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
29528 not used.
29529
29530 @kindex g t
29531 @kindex g T
29532 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
29533 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
29534 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
29535 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
29536 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
29537 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
29538 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
29539 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
29540 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
29541
29542 @kindex g r
29543 @kindex g R
29544 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
29545 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
29546 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
29547 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
29548 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
29549 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
29550 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
29551 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
29552 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
29553 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
29554 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
29555
29556 @kindex g l
29557 @kindex g L
29558 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
29559 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
29560 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
29561 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
29562 be logarithmic instead of linear.
29563
29564 @kindex g C-l
29565 @kindex g C-r
29566 @kindex g C-t
29567 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
29568 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
29569 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
29570 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
29571 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
29572 for the ``z'' axis.
29573
29574 @kindex g z
29575 @kindex g Z
29576 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
29577 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
29578 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
29579 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
29580 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
29581 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29582 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29583 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29584 not available for 3D plots.
29585
29586 @kindex g s
29587 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
29588 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29589 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29590 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29591 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29592 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29593 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29594 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29595 available for any device.
29596
29597 @kindex g S
29598 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
29599 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29600 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29601 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29602 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29603 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29604 the error bars on or off.
29605
29606 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29607 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29608 @vindex LineStyles
29609 @vindex PointStyles
29610 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29611 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29612 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29613 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29614 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29615 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29616 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29617 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29618 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29619 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29620
29621 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29622 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29623 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29624 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29625 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29626
29627 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29628 @section Graphical Devices
29629
29630 @noindent
29631 @kindex g D
29632 @pindex calc-graph-device
29633 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29634 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29635 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29636 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29637 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29638
29639 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29640 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29641 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29642 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29643 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29644 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29645 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), @code{windows} on MS-Windows, or
29646 otherwise @code{dumb} under GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or
29647 @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0. This is the initial default
29648 value.
29649
29650 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29651 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29652 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29653 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29654 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29655 dumb terminals will be
29656 @texline @math{80\times24}
29657 @infoline 80x24
29658 characters. The graph is displayed in
29659 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29660 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29661 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29662
29663 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29664 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29665 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29666 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29667 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29668 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29669 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29670 of the four directions.
29671
29672 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29673 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29674 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29675 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29676 plot on any text-only printer.
29677
29678 @kindex g O
29679 @pindex calc-graph-output
29680 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of the
29681 output file used by GNUPLOT@. For some devices, notably @code{x11} and
29682 @code{windows}, there is no output file and this information is not
29683 used. Many other ``devices'' are really file formats like
29684 @code{postscript}; in these cases the output in the desired format
29685 goes into the file you name with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout
29686 @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write to its standard output stream,
29687 i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}. This is the default setting.
29688
29689 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29690 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29691 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29692 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29693 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29694 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29695 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29696 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29697 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29698
29699 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29700 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29701 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29702 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29703 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29704 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29705
29706 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29707 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29708 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29709 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29710 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29711 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29712
29713 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29714 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29715 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29716 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29717 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29718 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29719 You may wish to configure the default and
29720 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29721 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29722 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29723 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29724 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29725
29726 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29727 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29728 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29729 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29730 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29731 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29732 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29733 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29734
29735 @kindex g x
29736 @pindex calc-graph-display
29737 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29738 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29739 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29740 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29741
29742 @kindex g X
29743 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29744 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29745 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29746 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29747 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29748 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29749 window in the upper-left corner of the screen. This command has no
29750 effect if the current device is @code{windows}.
29751
29752 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29753 session with GNUPLOT@. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29754 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29755 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29756 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29757 something has gone wrong@footnote{
29758 On MS-Windows, due to the peculiarities of how the Windows version of
29759 GNUPLOT (called @command{wgnuplot}) works, the GNUPLOT responses are
29760 not communicated back to Calc. Instead, you need to look them up in
29761 the GNUPLOT command window that is displayed as in normal interactive
29762 usage of GNUPLOT.
29763 }.
29764
29765 @kindex g C
29766 @pindex calc-graph-command
29767 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29768 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29769 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29770 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29771 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29772
29773 @kindex g v
29774 @kindex g V
29775 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29776 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29777 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29778 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29779 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29780 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29781 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29782 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29783 buffer is hidden again. (Note that on MS-Windows, the @samp{*Gnuplot
29784 Trail*} buffer will usually show nothing of interest, because
29785 GNUPLOT's responses are not communicated back to Calc.)
29786
29787 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29788 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29789 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29790 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29791 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29792 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29793 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29794 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29795 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29796 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29797 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29798 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29799 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29800 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29801 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29802 with @kbd{g p}.
29803
29804 @kindex g q
29805 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29806 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29807 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29808 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29809 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29810 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29811 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29812
29813 @kindex g K
29814 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29815 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29816 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29817 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29818 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29819
29820 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29821 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29822
29823 @noindent
29824 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29825 other Emacs editing buffers.
29826
29827 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29828 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29829
29830 @menu
29831 * Killing From Stack::
29832 * Yanking Into Stack::
29833 * Saving Into Registers::
29834 * Inserting From Registers::
29835 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29836 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29837 * X Cut and Paste::
29838 @end menu
29839
29840 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29841 @section Killing from the Stack
29842
29843 @noindent
29844 @kindex C-k
29845 @pindex calc-kill
29846 @kindex M-k
29847 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29848 @kindex C-w
29849 @pindex calc-kill-region
29850 @kindex M-w
29851 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29852 @kindex M-C-w
29853 @cindex Kill ring
29854 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29855 ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29856 Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29857 one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29858 @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29859 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29860 although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29861 ``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29862 only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29863 the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29864 @kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29865 to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29866 deleting anything.
29867
29868 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29869 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29870 the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29871 Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29872 text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29873 including line numbers if they are enabled.
29874
29875 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29876 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29877 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29878 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29879 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29880 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29881 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29882 newline.
29883
29884 @node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29885 @section Yanking into the Stack
29886
29887 @noindent
29888 @kindex C-y
29889 @pindex calc-yank
29890 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29891 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29892 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29893 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29894 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29895 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29896 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29897 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29898 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29899 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29900 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29901 difference.)
29902
29903 @node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29904 @section Saving into Registers
29905
29906 @noindent
29907 @kindex r s
29908 @pindex calc-copy-to-register
29909 @pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29910 @pindex calc-append-to-register
29911 @cindex Registers
29912 An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29913 registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29914 saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29915 commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29916 entries.
29917
29918 Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29919 each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29920 region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29921 register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29922 You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29923 you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29924 register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29925 argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29926 register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29927
29928 It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29929 command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29930 then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29931 contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29932 similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29933 region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29934 @kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29935 added to the register.
29936
29937 @node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29938 @section Inserting from Registers
29939 @noindent
29940 @kindex r i
29941 @pindex calc-insert-register
29942 The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29943 register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29944 Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29945 within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29946 inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29947 register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29948
29949 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
29950 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29951
29952 @noindent
29953 @kindex C-x * g
29954 @pindex calc-grab-region
29955 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29956 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29957 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29958 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29959 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29960 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29961 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29962 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29963
29964 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29965 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29966 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29967 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29968 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29969 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29970 delete given that prefix argument.
29971
29972 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29973 line.
29974
29975 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29976 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29977 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29978 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29979 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29980 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29981 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29982 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29983
29984 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29985 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29986
29987 @kindex C-x * r
29988 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29989 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29990 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29991 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29992 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29993 whose contents are parsed.
29994
29995 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29996 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29997 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29998
29999 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
30000 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
30001 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
30002 is ignored.
30003
30004 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
30005 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
30006 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
30007 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
30008 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
30009 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
30010
30011 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
30012 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
30013 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
30014 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
30015 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
30016 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
30017 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
30018 as @samp{[2*a]}.
30019
30020 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
30021 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
30022 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
30023 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
30024 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
30025
30026 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
30027 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
30028 @texline @math{1\times1}
30029 @infoline 1x1
30030 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
30031
30032 @kindex C-x * :
30033 @kindex C-x * _
30034 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
30035 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
30036 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
30037 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
30038 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
30039 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
30040 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
30041 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
30042 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
30043 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
30044
30045 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
30046 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
30047 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
30048 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
30049 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
30050
30051 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
30052 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
30053 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
30054 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
30055 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
30056 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
30057
30058 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
30059 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
30060 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
30061 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
30062 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
30063 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
30064 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
30065
30066 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
30067 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
30068
30069 @noindent
30070 @kindex y
30071 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
30072 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
30073 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
30074 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
30075 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
30076 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
30077 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
30078 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
30079 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
30080
30081 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
30082 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
30083 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
30084 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
30085 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
30086 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
30087 latter strips off the trailing newline.
30088
30089 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
30090 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
30091 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
30092 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
30093 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
30094 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
30095 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
30096 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
30097 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
30098 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
30099
30100 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
30101 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
30102 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
30103 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
30104 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
30105 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
30106 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
30107 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
30108 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
30109 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
30110 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
30111 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
30112 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
30113 to overwriting one complete number with another.
30114
30115 @kindex C-x * y
30116 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
30117 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
30118 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
30119
30120 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
30121 @section X Cut and Paste
30122
30123 @noindent
30124 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
30125 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
30126 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
30127
30128 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
30129 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
30130 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
30131 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
30132 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
30133 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
30134 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
30135 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
30136 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
30137 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
30138 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
30139
30140 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
30141 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
30142 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
30143 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
30144 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
30145 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
30146 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
30147 in the Calc window.
30148
30149 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
30150 @chapter Keypad Mode
30151
30152 @noindent
30153 @kindex C-x * k
30154 @pindex calc-keypad
30155 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
30156 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
30157 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
30158 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
30159 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
30160 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
30161 calculations with the mouse.
30162
30163 @pindex full-calc-keypad
30164 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
30165 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
30166 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
30167 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
30168 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
30169
30170 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
30171 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
30172 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
30173 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
30174
30175 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
30176 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
30177 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
30178
30179 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
30180 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
30181 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
30182 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
30183 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
30184 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
30185 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
30186 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
30187
30188 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
30189 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
30190 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
30191 original buffer.
30192
30193 @menu
30194 * Keypad Main Menu::
30195 * Keypad Functions Menu::
30196 * Keypad Binary Menu::
30197 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
30198 * Keypad Modes Menu::
30199 @end menu
30200
30201 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
30202 @section Main Menu
30203
30204 @smallexample
30205 @group
30206 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
30207 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
30208 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30209 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
30210 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30211 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
30212 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30213 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
30214 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
30215 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
30216 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30217 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
30218 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30219 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
30220 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30221 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
30222 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
30223 @end group
30224 @end smallexample
30225
30226 @noindent
30227 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
30228 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
30229 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
30230 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
30231
30232 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
30233 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
30234 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
30235 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
30236 or any other function key.
30237
30238 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
30239 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
30240 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
30241 stack.
30242
30243 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
30244 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
30245 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
30246 below and in the following sections.
30247
30248 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
30249 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
30250
30251 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
30252 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
30253 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
30254
30255 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
30256 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
30257 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
30258 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
30259
30260 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
30261 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
30262 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
30263 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
30264 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
30265
30266 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
30267 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
30268 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
30269 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
30270
30271 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
30272 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
30273 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
30274 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
30275
30276 @table @kbd
30277 @item INV +/-
30278 is the same as @key{1/x}.
30279 @item INV +
30280 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
30281 @item INV -
30282 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
30283 @item INV *
30284 is the same as @key{y^x}.
30285 @item INV /
30286 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
30287 @item HYP/INV 1
30288 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
30289 @item HYP/INV 2
30290 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
30291 @item HYP/INV 3
30292 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
30293 @item INV/HYP 4
30294 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
30295 @item INV/HYP 5
30296 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
30297 @item INV 6
30298 is the same as @key{ABS}.
30299 @item INV 7
30300 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
30301 @item INV 8
30302 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
30303 @item INV 9
30304 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
30305 @item INV 0
30306 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
30307 @item INV .
30308 is the same as @key{PREC}.
30309 @item INV ENTER
30310 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
30311 @item HYP ENTER
30312 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
30313 @item INV HYP ENTER
30314 is the same as @key{OVER}.
30315 @item HYP +/-
30316 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
30317 @item HYP EEX
30318 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
30319 @item INV EEX
30320 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
30321 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
30322 by the two limits of the interval.
30323 @end table
30324
30325 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
30326 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
30327 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
30328 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
30329 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
30330 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
30331
30332 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
30333 @section Functions Menu
30334
30335 @smallexample
30336 @group
30337 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
30338 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
30339 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30340 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
30341 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30342 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
30343 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30344 @end group
30345 @end smallexample
30346
30347 @noindent
30348 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
30349 prefix keys.
30350
30351 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
30352 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
30353
30354 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
30355 extracts the imaginary part.
30356
30357 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
30358 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
30359 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
30360 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
30361 same limit as last time.
30362
30363 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
30364
30365 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
30366 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30367 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30368
30369 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
30370 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
30371
30372 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
30373 finds the previous prime.
30374
30375 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
30376 @section Binary Menu
30377
30378 @smallexample
30379 @group
30380 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
30381 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
30382 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30383 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
30384 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30385 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
30386 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30387 @end group
30388 @end smallexample
30389
30390 @noindent
30391 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
30392 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
30393 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
30394
30395 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
30396 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
30397
30398 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
30399 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
30400 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
30401 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
30402
30403 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
30404 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
30405 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
30406 The initial word size is 32 bits.
30407
30408 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
30409 @section Vectors Menu
30410
30411 @smallexample
30412 @group
30413 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
30414 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
30415 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30416 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
30417 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30418 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
30419 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30420 @end group
30421 @end smallexample
30422
30423 @noindent
30424 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
30425
30426 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
30427 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
30428 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
30429 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
30430 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
30431 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
30432 rows into a matrix.
30433
30434 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
30435 components separately.
30436
30437 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
30438 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
30439 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
30440 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
30441 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
30442
30443 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
30444 identity matrix.
30445
30446 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
30447
30448 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
30449
30450 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
30451 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
30452
30453 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
30454 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
30455 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
30456 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
30457
30458 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
30459 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
30460 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
30461
30462 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
30463 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
30464 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
30465
30466 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
30467 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
30468 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
30469 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
30470 all the elements of a vector.
30471
30472 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
30473 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
30474 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
30475 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
30476 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
30477 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
30478 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
30479 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
30480 the formula @samp{x^y}.
30481
30482 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
30483 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
30484 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
30485 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
30486 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
30487 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
30488 @expr{t}, respectively.
30489
30490 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
30491 @section Modes Menu
30492
30493 @smallexample
30494 @group
30495 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
30496 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
30497 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30498 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
30499 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30500 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
30501 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30502 @end group
30503 @end smallexample
30504
30505 @noindent
30506 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
30507
30508 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
30509 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
30510 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
30511 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
30512 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
30513
30514 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
30515 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
30516 well as to the left.
30517
30518 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
30519 for trigonometric functions.
30520
30521 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
30522 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
30523 fractional or floating-point results.
30524
30525 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
30526 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
30527
30528 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
30529 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
30530 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
30531
30532 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
30533 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
30534
30535 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
30536 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
30537 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
30538 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
30539
30540 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
30541 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
30542 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
30543 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
30544 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
30545
30546 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
30547 @chapter Embedded Mode
30548
30549 @noindent
30550 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
30551 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
30552 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
30553 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
30554
30555 @menu
30556 * Basic Embedded Mode::
30557 * More About Embedded Mode::
30558 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
30559 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
30560 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
30561 @end menu
30562
30563 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30564 @section Basic Embedded Mode
30565
30566 @noindent
30567 @kindex C-x * e
30568 @pindex calc-embedded
30569 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
30570 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
30571 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
30572 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
30573 are visiting your own files.
30574
30575 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
30576 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
30577 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to @LaTeX{}.
30578 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
30579 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
30580 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
30581 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
30582 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30583 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
30584 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
30585 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
30586
30587 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
30588 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
30589 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
30590 understands are:
30591
30592 @enumerate
30593 @item
30594 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30595 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30596 @item
30597 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30598 @item
30599 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30600 @item
30601 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30602 @item
30603 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30604 @end enumerate
30605
30606 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30607 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30608 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30609
30610 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30611 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30612 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30613 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30614
30615 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30616 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30617 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30618
30619 @kindex C-x * w
30620 @pindex calc-embedded-word
30621 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30622 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30623 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30624 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30625 backward to delimit the formula.
30626
30627 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30628 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30629 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30630 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30631 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30632 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30633 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30634 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30635 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30636 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30637 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30638
30639 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30640 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30641 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30642 an algebraic entry.
30643
30644 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30645 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30646 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30647 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30648 not affected by Embedded mode.
30649
30650 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30651 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30652 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30653 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30654 find you need to see the entire stack.
30655
30656 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30657 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30658 inequality:
30659
30660 @example
30661 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30662 @end example
30663
30664 @noindent
30665 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30666 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30667 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30668 to match Calc's usual display style:
30669
30670 @example
30671 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30672 @end example
30673
30674 @noindent
30675 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30676 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30677 Embedded mode.
30678
30679 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30680 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30681 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30682 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30683 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30684 needs to be commuted.
30685
30686 @example
30687 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30688 @end example
30689
30690 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30691 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30692 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30693 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30694
30695 @example
30696 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30697 @end example
30698
30699 @noindent
30700 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30701 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30702 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30703 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30704 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30705 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30706 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30707
30708 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30709 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30710 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30711 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30712 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30713 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30714 Embedded mode is concerned.
30715
30716 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30717 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30718 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30719 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30720 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30721 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30722 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30723 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30724 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30725 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30726
30727 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30728 @section More About Embedded Mode
30729
30730 @noindent
30731 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30732 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30733 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30734 written. If the formula contains any @LaTeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30735 it is parsed (i.e., read) in @LaTeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30736 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30737 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30738
30739 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30740 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a @LaTeX{} formula when
30741 not in @LaTeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30742 whatever language mode is in effect.
30743
30744 @tex
30745 \bigskip
30746 @end tex
30747
30748 @kindex d p
30749 @pindex calc-show-plain
30750 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30751 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30752 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30753 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30754 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30755 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30756 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30757 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30758 version.
30759
30760 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30761 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30762 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}, so if your formula is
30763 embedded in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} document its plain version will be
30764 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30765 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30766 in a comment for those modes, also.
30767 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30768 formula delimiters.
30769
30770 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30771 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30772 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30773 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30774 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30775 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30776 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30777 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30778
30779 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30780 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30781 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30782 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30783 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30784 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30785
30786 @tex
30787 \bigskip
30788 @end tex
30789
30790 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30791 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30792 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30793 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30794 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30795 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30796 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30797 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30798 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30799 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30800 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30801 ``plain'' mode.
30802
30803 @tex
30804 \bigskip
30805 @end tex
30806
30807 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30808 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30809 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30810 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30811 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30812
30813 @smallexample
30814 The derivative of
30815
30816 ln(ln(x))
30817
30818 is
30819
30820 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30821
30822 whose value at x = 2 is
30823
30824 @r{(the value)}
30825
30826 and at x = 3 is
30827
30828 @r{(the value)}
30829 @end smallexample
30830
30831 @kindex C-x * d
30832 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30833 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30834 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30835 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30836 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30837 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30838
30839 For this example, you would start with just
30840
30841 @smallexample
30842 The derivative of
30843
30844 ln(ln(x))
30845 @end smallexample
30846
30847 @noindent
30848 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30849 is
30850
30851 @smallexample
30852 The derivative of
30853
30854 ln(ln(x))
30855
30856
30857 ln(ln(x))
30858 @end smallexample
30859
30860 @noindent
30861 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30862 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30863 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30864 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30865 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30866 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30867
30868 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30869 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30870 various formulas and numbers.
30871
30872 @tex
30873 \bigskip
30874 @end tex
30875
30876 @kindex C-x * f
30877 @kindex C-x * '
30878 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30879 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30880 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30881 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30882 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30883 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30884 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30885 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30886 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30887
30888 @kindex C-x * n
30889 @kindex C-x * p
30890 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30891 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30892 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30893 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30894 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30895 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30896 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30897 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30898 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30899 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30900 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30901 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30902 formula, they just move the cursor.
30903
30904 @kindex C-x * `
30905 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30906 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30907 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30908 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30909 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30910
30911 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30912 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30913
30914 @noindent
30915 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30916 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30917 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30918 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30919
30920 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30921
30922 @example
30923 foo := 5
30924 @end example
30925
30926 @noindent
30927 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30928 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30929 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30930 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30931 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30932
30933 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30934 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30935 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30936 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30937 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30938
30939 @example
30940 foo + 7 => 12
30941 @end example
30942
30943 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30944
30945 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30946 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30947
30948 @example
30949 foo := 17
30950
30951 foo + 7 => 24
30952 @end example
30953
30954 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30955 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30956 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30957 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30958 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30959
30960 @example
30961 17
30962
30963 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30964 @end example
30965
30966 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30967 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30968 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30969 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30970
30971 @kindex C-x * j
30972 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30973 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30974 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30975 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30976 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30977 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30978 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30979
30980 @example
30981 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30982 @end example
30983
30984 @noindent
30985 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30986
30987 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30988 mode.
30989
30990 @kindex C-x * u
30991 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30992 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30993 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30994 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30995 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30996 command is a convenient way to do this.
30997
30998 @example
30999 foo := 6
31000
31001 foo + 7 => 13
31002 @end example
31003
31004 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
31005 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
31006 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
31007 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
31008 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
31009 that formula will not be disturbed.
31010
31011 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
31012 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
31013 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
31014 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
31015 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
31016
31017 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
31018 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
31019
31020 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
31021 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
31022 file.
31023
31024 @kindex C-x * a
31025 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
31026 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
31027 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
31028 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
31029 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
31030 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
31031 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
31032 changed.
31033
31034 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
31035 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
31036 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
31037 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
31038 a few lines that look like this:
31039
31040 @example
31041 --- Local Variables: ---
31042 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
31043 --- End: ---
31044 @end example
31045
31046 @noindent
31047 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
31048 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
31049 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
31050 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
31051 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
31052 trailing strings.
31053
31054 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
31055 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
31056 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
31057 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
31058 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
31059 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
31060 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
31061 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
31062 Emacs manual}.
31063
31064 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
31065 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
31066 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
31067 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
31068 saved.
31069
31070 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
31071 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
31072 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
31073 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
31074 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
31075 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
31076
31077 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
31078 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
31079 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
31080 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
31081 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
31082 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
31083 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
31084 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
31085 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
31086 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
31087 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
31088 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
31089 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
31090 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
31091 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
31092
31093 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
31094 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
31095 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
31096 following assignment is used.
31097
31098 @example
31099 x => 1
31100
31101 x := 1
31102
31103 x => 1
31104
31105 x := 2
31106
31107 x => 2
31108 @end example
31109
31110 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
31111 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
31112 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
31113 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
31114 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
31115 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
31116
31117 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
31118 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
31119 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
31120 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
31121 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
31122 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
31123 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
31124
31125 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
31126 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
31127 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
31128 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
31129 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
31130 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
31131 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
31132 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
31133 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
31134 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
31135 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
31136
31137 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31138 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
31139
31140 @kindex m e
31141 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
31142 @noindent
31143 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
31144 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
31145 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
31146 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
31147 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
31148 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
31149
31150 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
31151 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
31152 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
31153 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
31154 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
31155 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
31156
31157 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
31158 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
31159 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
31160 delimiter of the formula.
31161
31162 @example
31163 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
31164 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31165 @end example
31166
31167 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
31168 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
31169 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
31170 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
31171 the file, or up to a line of the form
31172
31173 @example
31174 % [calc-defaults]
31175 @end example
31176
31177 @noindent
31178 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
31179 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
31180 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
31181
31182 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
31183 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
31184 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
31185 below).
31186
31187 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
31188 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
31189 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
31190 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
31191 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
31192 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
31193 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
31194 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
31195 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
31196
31197 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
31198 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
31199 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
31200 one.
31201
31202 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
31203 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
31204 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
31205 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
31206 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
31207 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
31208 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
31209 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
31210 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
31211
31212 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
31213 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
31214 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
31215 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
31216 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
31217 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
31218
31219 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
31220 that look like this, respectively:
31221
31222 @example
31223 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31224 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
31225 @end example
31226
31227 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
31228 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
31229 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
31230 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
31231 yet, is not relevant here.)
31232
31233 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
31234 of the file:
31235
31236 @example
31237 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
31238 @end example
31239
31240 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
31241 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
31242 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
31243 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
31244 formulas in the file.
31245
31246 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
31247 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
31248 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
31249 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
31250 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
31251
31252 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
31253 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
31254 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
31255 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
31256 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
31257 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
31258
31259 @example
31260 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31261 1.23e2
31262
31263 456.
31264 @end example
31265
31266 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
31267 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
31268
31269 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
31270 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
31271 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
31272 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
31273 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el})
31274 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
31275 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
31276 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
31277 annotations at all.
31278
31279 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
31280 for @code{Save} have no effect.
31281
31282 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31283 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
31284
31285 @noindent
31286 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
31287 variables described here. These variables are customizable
31288 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
31289 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
31290 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
31291 the end of the file;
31292 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
31293 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
31294 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
31295
31296 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
31297 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
31298 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
31299 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
31300 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
31301 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
31302 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
31303 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
31304 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
31305 in detail.
31306
31307 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
31308 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
31309 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
31310 Lisp program.
31311
31312 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
31313 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
31314 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
31315 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
31316 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
31317 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
31318 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
31319 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
31320
31321 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
31322 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
31323 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
31324 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
31325 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
31326 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
31327
31328 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
31329 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
31330 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
31331 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
31332 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
31333 one or two dollar signs.
31334
31335 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
31336 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
31337 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
31338
31339 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
31340 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
31341 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
31342 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
31343 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
31344 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
31345 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
31346
31347 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
31348 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
31349 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
31350 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
31351 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
31352 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
31353 account for each of these six backslashes!)
31354
31355 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
31356 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
31357 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
31358 regular expression to match the above example would be
31359 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
31360 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
31361 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
31362 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
31363 case).
31364
31365 @vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
31366 The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
31367 used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
31368 @kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
31369
31370 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
31371 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
31372 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
31373 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
31374 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
31375 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
31376 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
31377 be different for certain major modes.
31378
31379 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
31380 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
31381 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
31382 different for different major modes. Without
31383 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
31384 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
31385
31386 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
31387 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
31388 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
31389 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
31390 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
31391 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
31392 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
31393 the file.
31394
31395 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
31396 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
31397 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
31398 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
31399 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
31400 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
31401 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
31402
31403 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
31404 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
31405 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
31406 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
31407 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
31408 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
31409 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
31410 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
31411 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
31412 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
31413 different for different major modes.
31414 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
31415 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
31416 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
31417 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
31418
31419 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
31420 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
31421 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
31422 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
31423 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
31424 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
31425 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
31426 modes.
31427
31428 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
31429 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
31430 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
31431 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
31432 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
31433 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
31434
31435 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
31436 @chapter Programming
31437
31438 @noindent
31439 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
31440 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
31441
31442 @enumerate
31443 @item
31444 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
31445 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
31446 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
31447 as loops and conditionals.
31448
31449 @item
31450 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
31451 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
31452 as an interactive command.
31453
31454 @item
31455 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
31456 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
31457 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
31458 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
31459 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
31460
31461 @item
31462 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
31463 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
31464 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
31465 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
31466 rewrite rules.
31467 @end enumerate
31468
31469 @kindex z
31470 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
31471 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
31472 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
31473 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
31474 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
31475 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
31476 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
31477
31478 @menu
31479 * Creating User Keys::
31480 * Keyboard Macros::
31481 * Invocation Macros::
31482 * Algebraic Definitions::
31483 * Lisp Definitions::
31484 @end menu
31485
31486 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
31487 @section Creating User Keys
31488
31489 @noindent
31490 @kindex Z D
31491 @pindex calc-user-define
31492 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
31493 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
31494 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
31495
31496 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
31497 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
31498 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
31499 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
31500 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
31501 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
31502 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
31503 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
31504
31505 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
31506 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
31507
31508 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
31509 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
31510 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
31511
31512 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
31513 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
31514 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
31515 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
31516 of a letter if you wish.
31517
31518 @kindex Z U
31519 @pindex calc-user-undefine
31520 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
31521 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
31522 key we defined above.
31523
31524 @kindex Z P
31525 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
31526 @cindex Storing user definitions
31527 @cindex Permanent user definitions
31528 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
31529 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
31530 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
31531 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
31532 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
31533 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}.) For example,
31534 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
31535 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
31536 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
31537 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
31538
31539 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
31540 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
31541 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
31542 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
31543 command will save all of these definitions.
31544 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
31545 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
31546 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
31547 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
31548 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
31549 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
31550 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
31551 or key bindings associated with the function.)
31552
31553 @kindex Z E
31554 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
31555 @cindex Editing user definitions
31556 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
31557 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
31558 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
31559 following sections.
31560
31561 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
31562 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
31563
31564 @noindent
31565 @kindex X
31566 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
31567 @cindex Keyboard macros
31568 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
31569 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
31570 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
31571 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
31572 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
31573 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
31574 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
31575 information.
31576
31577 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
31578 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
31579 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
31580 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
31581 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
31582 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
31583 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
31584 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
31585 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
31586 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
31587 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
31588 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
31589 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
31590
31591 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31592 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31593 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31594 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31595
31596 @menu
31597 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
31598 * Conditionals in Macros::
31599 * Loops in Macros::
31600 * Local Values in Macros::
31601 * Queries in Macros::
31602 @end menu
31603
31604 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31605 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31606
31607 @noindent
31608 @kindex Z K
31609 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31610 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31611 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31612 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31613 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31614 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31615 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31616 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31617 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31618 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31619 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31620 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31621 descriptive command name if you wish.
31622
31623 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31624 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31625 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31626 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31627
31628 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31629 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31630
31631 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31632 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31633 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31634 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31635 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31636 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31637 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31638 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31639 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31640 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31641 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31642 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31643 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31644 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31645 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31646
31647 @kindex C-x * m
31648 @pindex read-kbd-macro
31649 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31650 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31651 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31652 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31653
31654 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31655 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31656
31657 @noindent
31658 @kindex Z [
31659 @kindex Z ]
31660 @pindex calc-kbd-if
31661 @pindex calc-kbd-else
31662 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31663 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31664 @cindex Conditional structures
31665 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31666 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31667 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31668 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31669 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31670 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31671 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31672
31673 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31674 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31675 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31676 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31677 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31678 command is skipped.
31679
31680 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31681 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31682 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31683 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31684 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31685 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31686
31687 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31688 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31689
31690 @kindex Z :
31691 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31692 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31693 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31694 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31695 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31696 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31697 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31698
31699 @kindex Z |
31700 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31701 between any number of alternatives. For example,
31702 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31703 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31704 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31705 it will execute @var{part3}.
31706
31707 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31708 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31709 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31710 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31711 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31712 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31713 does not.
31714
31715 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31716 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31717 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31718 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31719 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31720 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31721 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31722 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31723 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31724
31725 @kindex Z C-g
31726 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31727 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31728 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31729
31730 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31731 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31732
31733 @noindent
31734 @kindex Z <
31735 @kindex Z >
31736 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31737 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31738 @cindex Looping structures
31739 @cindex Iterative structures
31740 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31741 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31742 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31743 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31744 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31745 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31746 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31747 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31748 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31749
31750 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31751 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31752 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31753 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31754 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31755 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31756 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31757 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31758 macro.
31759
31760 @kindex Z /
31761 @pindex calc-break
31762 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31763 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31764 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31765 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31766 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31767 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31768 in the C language.
31769
31770 @kindex Z (
31771 @kindex Z )
31772 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31773 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31774 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31775 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31776 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31777 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31778 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31779 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31780 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31781 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31782 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31783
31784 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31785 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31786 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31787 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31788 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31789 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31790 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31791
31792 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31793 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31794 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31795 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31796 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31797 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31798
31799 @kindex Z @{
31800 @kindex Z @}
31801 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31802 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31803 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31804 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31805 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31806 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31807 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31808 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31809 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31810 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31811 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31812 this feature.)
31813
31814 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31815 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31816 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31817 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31818 as easily as in a macro definition.
31819
31820 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31821 conditional and looping commands.
31822
31823 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31824 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31825
31826 @noindent
31827 @cindex Local variables
31828 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31829 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31830 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31831 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31832 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31833 modes.
31834
31835 @kindex Z `
31836 @kindex Z '
31837 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31838 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31839 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31840 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31841 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31842 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31843
31844 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31845 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31846 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31847 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31848 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31849
31850 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31851 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31852 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31853 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31854 in exceptional conditions.
31855
31856 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31857 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31858 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31859 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31860 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31861 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31862 macros were involved.
31863
31864 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31865 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31866 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31867 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31868 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31869 thereof) are also saved.
31870
31871 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31872 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31873 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31874 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31875 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31876
31877 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31878 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31879 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31880 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31881 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31882 outside the construct.
31883
31884 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31885 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31886 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31887
31888 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31889 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31890
31891 @c @noindent
31892 @c @kindex Z =
31893 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31894 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31895 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31896 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31897 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31898 @c to turn such messages off.
31899
31900 @noindent
31901 @kindex Z #
31902 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31903 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31904 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31905 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31906 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31907 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31908 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31909 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31910 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31911 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31912 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31913 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31914
31915 As an example,
31916 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31917 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31918 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31919 will not be part of the macro.)
31920
31921 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31922 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31923 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31924 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31925 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31926 return control to the keyboard macro.
31927
31928 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31929 @section Invocation Macros
31930
31931 @kindex C-x * z
31932 @kindex Z I
31933 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31934 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31935 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31936 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31937 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31938 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31939 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31940 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31941 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31942 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31943
31944 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31945 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31946 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31947 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31948 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31949 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31950
31951 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31952 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31953 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31954 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31955 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31956
31957 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31958 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31959 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31960
31961 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31962 @section Programming with Formulas
31963
31964 @noindent
31965 @kindex Z F
31966 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31967 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31968 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31969 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31970 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31971 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31972 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31973 non-numeric arguments.
31974
31975 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31976 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31977 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31978 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31979 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31980 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31981 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31982
31983 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31984 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31985 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31986 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31987
31988 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31989 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31990 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31991 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31992 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31993 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31994 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31995 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31996 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31997
31998 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31999 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
32000 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
32001 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
32002 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
32003 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
32004 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
32005 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
32006 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
32007 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
32008 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
32009 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
32010
32011 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
32012 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
32013 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
32014 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
32015 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
32016 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
32017 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
32018
32019 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
32020 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
32021 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
32022 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
32023
32024 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
32025 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
32026 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
32027 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
32028 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
32029 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
32030 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
32031 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
32032 question.
32033
32034 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
32035 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
32036 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
32037 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
32038
32039 @kindex Z G
32040 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
32041 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
32042 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
32043 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
32044 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
32045 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
32046 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
32047 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
32048
32049 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
32050 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
32051 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
32052 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
32053 @kbd{C-x k} to
32054 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
32055 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
32056 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
32057 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
32058
32059 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
32060 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
32061 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
32062
32063 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
32064 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
32065 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
32066 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
32067 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
32068 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
32069 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
32070 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
32071 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
32072
32073 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
32074 @section Programming with Lisp
32075
32076 @noindent
32077 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
32078 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
32079 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
32080 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
32081 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
32082 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
32083 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
32084 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
32085 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
32086
32087 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
32088 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
32089 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
32090 to program the Calculator.
32091
32092 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
32093 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
32094 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
32095 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
32096 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
32097
32098 @menu
32099 * Defining Functions::
32100 * Defining Simple Commands::
32101 * Defining Stack Commands::
32102 * Argument Qualifiers::
32103 * Example Definitions::
32104
32105 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
32106 * Internals::
32107 @end menu
32108
32109 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32110 @subsection Defining New Functions
32111
32112 @noindent
32113 @findex defmath
32114 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
32115 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
32116 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
32117 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
32118 example,
32119
32120 @example
32121 (defmath myfact (n)
32122 (if (> n 0)
32123 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32124 1))
32125 @end example
32126
32127 @noindent
32128 This actually expands to the code,
32129
32130 @example
32131 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32132 (if (math-posp n)
32133 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32134 1))
32135 @end example
32136
32137 @noindent
32138 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
32139
32140 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
32141 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
32142 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
32143 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
32144
32145 @smallexample
32146 (defmath myfact (n)
32147 (if (> n 0)
32148 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32149 (if (= n 0)
32150 1
32151 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
32152 @end smallexample
32153
32154 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
32155 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
32156 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
32157 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
32158 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
32159 efficiently as possible.
32160
32161 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
32162 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
32163 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
32164 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
32165 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
32166 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
32167
32168 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
32169 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
32170 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
32171 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
32172 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
32173 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
32174 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
32175
32176 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
32177 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
32178 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
32179 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
32180 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
32181
32182 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
32183
32184 @itemize @bullet
32185 @item
32186 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
32187 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
32188 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
32189 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
32190 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
32191
32192 @item
32193 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
32194 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
32195 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
32196 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
32197 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
32198 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
32199 into one element of a matrix.
32200
32201 @item
32202 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
32203 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
32204 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
32205 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
32206 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
32207 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
32208 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
32209 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
32210 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
32211 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
32212 things, not just two.
32213
32214 @item
32215 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
32216 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
32217 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
32218 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
32219 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
32220
32221 @item
32222 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
32223 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
32224 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
32225 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
32226
32227 @item
32228 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
32229 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
32230 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
32231 inside the body of the function.
32232 @end itemize
32233
32234 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
32235 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
32236 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
32237 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
32238 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
32239
32240 @smallexample
32241 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
32242 (and (numberp x)
32243 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
32244 @end smallexample
32245
32246 expands to
32247
32248 @smallexample
32249 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
32250 (and (math-numberp x)
32251 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
32252 @end smallexample
32253
32254 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
32255 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
32256 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
32257 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
32258 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
32259
32260 @example
32261 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
32262 @end example
32263
32264 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
32265 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
32266 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
32267 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
32268 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
32269 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
32270 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
32271 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
32272 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
32273 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
32274 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
32275
32276 @example
32277 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
32278 (defmath ... )
32279 (defmath ... )
32280 ))
32281 @end example
32282
32283 @noindent
32284 @vindex calc-define
32285 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
32286 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
32287 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
32288 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
32289 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
32290 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
32291 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
32292 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
32293 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
32294
32295 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
32296 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
32297 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
32298 after Calc itself is loaded.
32299
32300 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
32301 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
32302 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
32303 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
32304
32305 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
32306 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
32307 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
32308 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
32309 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
32310 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
32311 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
32312 protect against this situation, you can put
32313
32314 @example
32315 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32316 @end example
32317
32318 @findex calc-check-defines
32319 @noindent
32320 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
32321 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
32322 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
32323 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
32324
32325 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
32326 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
32327 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
32328 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
32329
32330 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
32331 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
32332
32333 @noindent
32334 @findex interactive
32335 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
32336 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
32337 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
32338 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
32339 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
32340 the command work in the Calc environment.
32341
32342 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
32343 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
32344
32345 @smallexample
32346 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32347 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
32348 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
32349 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32350 @end smallexample
32351
32352 This expands to the pair of definitions,
32353
32354 @smallexample
32355 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
32356 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32357 (interactive "p")
32358 (calc-wrapper
32359 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
32360
32361 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
32362 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32363 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
32364 @end smallexample
32365
32366 @noindent
32367 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
32368 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
32369 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
32370 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
32371
32372 @findex calc-wrapper
32373 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
32374 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
32375
32376 @smallexample
32377 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
32378 (unwind-protect
32379 (save-current-buffer
32380 (calc-select-buffer)
32381 @emph{body of function}
32382 @emph{renumber stack}
32383 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
32384 @emph{realign cursor and window}
32385 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
32386 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
32387 @end smallexample
32388
32389 @findex calc-select-buffer
32390 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
32391 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
32392 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
32393
32394 @findex calc-set-command-flag
32395 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
32396 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
32397 following command flags:
32398
32399 @table @code
32400 @item renum-stack
32401 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
32402 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
32403 @code{calc-push}.
32404
32405 @item clear-message
32406 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
32407 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
32408
32409 @item no-align
32410 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
32411
32412 @item position-point
32413 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
32414 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
32415 this command finishes.
32416
32417 @item keep-flags
32418 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
32419 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
32420
32421 @item do-edit
32422 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
32423
32424 @item hold-trail
32425 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
32426 there.
32427 @end table
32428
32429 @kindex Y
32430 @kindex Y ?
32431 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
32432 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
32433 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
32434 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
32435 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
32436 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
32437 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
32438 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
32439 future versions of Calc.
32440
32441 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
32442 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
32443 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
32444 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
32445 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
32446 within your package.
32447
32448 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
32449 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
32450 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
32451 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
32452 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
32453 if necessary without having to modify the file.
32454
32455 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
32456 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
32457 decreases the precision.
32458
32459 @smallexample
32460 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
32461 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
32462
32463 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
32464 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
32465
32466 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
32467
32468 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
32469 'increase-precision)
32470 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
32471 'decrease-precision)
32472
32473 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
32474 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
32475 calc-Y-help-msgs))
32476
32477 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32478 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32479 (interactive "p")
32480 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32481
32482 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
32483 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
32484 (interactive "p")
32485 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
32486
32487 )) ; end of calc-define property
32488
32489 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32490 @end smallexample
32491
32492 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
32493 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
32494
32495 @noindent
32496 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
32497 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
32498
32499 @example
32500 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
32501 @end example
32502
32503 @noindent
32504 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
32505 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
32506 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
32507 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
32508 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
32509 parameters is valid.
32510
32511 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
32512 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
32513 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
32514 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
32515 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
32516 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
32517
32518 As an example, the definition
32519
32520 @smallexample
32521 (defmath myfact (n)
32522 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32523 (interactive 1 "fact")
32524 (if (> n 0)
32525 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32526 (and (= n 0) 1)))
32527 @end smallexample
32528
32529 @noindent
32530 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
32531 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
32532
32533 @smallexample
32534 (defun calc-myfact ()
32535 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32536 (interactive)
32537 (calc-slow-wrapper
32538 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
32539 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
32540
32541 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32542 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32543 (if (math-posp n)
32544 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32545 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
32546 @end smallexample
32547
32548 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
32549 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
32550 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
32551 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
32552 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
32553
32554 @findex calc-top-list-n
32555 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
32556 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
32557 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
32558 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
32559
32560 @findex calc-enter-result
32561 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
32562 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
32563 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
32564 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
32565 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
32566 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
32567
32568 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
32569 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
32570 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
32571 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
32572 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
32573
32574 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
32575 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
32576 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
32577
32578 @example
32579 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
32580 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
32581 @var{body})
32582 @end example
32583
32584 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
32585 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
32586 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
32587
32588 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
32589 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
32590 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
32591 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32592 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32593
32594 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32595 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
32596
32597 @noindent
32598 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32599 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32600
32601 @example
32602 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32603 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32604 &rest @var{param})
32605 @var{body})
32606 @end example
32607
32608 @noindent
32609 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32610
32611 @example
32612 (@var{qual} @var{param})
32613 @end example
32614
32615 The following qualifiers are recognized:
32616
32617 @table @samp
32618 @item complete
32619 @findex complete
32620 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32621 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32622 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32623 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32624
32625 @item integer
32626 @findex integer
32627 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32628 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32629 formulas are rejected.
32630
32631 @item natnum
32632 @findex natnum
32633 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32634
32635 @item fixnum
32636 @findex fixnum
32637 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32638 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32639 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32640
32641 @item float
32642 @findex float
32643 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32644 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32645 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32646
32647 @item @var{pred}
32648 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32649 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32650
32651 @item not-@var{pred}
32652 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32653 @end table
32654
32655 For example,
32656
32657 @example
32658 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32659 &rest (integer d))
32660 @var{body})
32661 @end example
32662
32663 @noindent
32664 expands to
32665
32666 @example
32667 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32668 (and (math-matrixp b)
32669 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32670 (or (math-constp b)
32671 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32672 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32673 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32674 @var{body})
32675 @end example
32676
32677 @noindent
32678 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32679 body of the function.
32680
32681 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32682 @subsection Example Definitions
32683
32684 @noindent
32685 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32686 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32687 @pxref{Internals}.
32688
32689 @menu
32690 * Bit Counting Example::
32691 * Sine Example::
32692 @end menu
32693
32694 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32695 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
32696
32697 @noindent
32698 @ignore
32699 @starindex
32700 @end ignore
32701 @tindex bcount
32702 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32703 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32704 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32705 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32706 create an intermediate set.
32707
32708 @smallexample
32709 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32710 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32711 (let ((count 0))
32712 (while (> n 0)
32713 (if (oddp n)
32714 (setq count (1+ count)))
32715 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32716 count))
32717 @end smallexample
32718
32719 @noindent
32720 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32721 Emacs Lisp function:
32722
32723 @smallexample
32724 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32725 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32726 (let ((count 0))
32727 (while (math-posp n)
32728 (if (math-oddp n)
32729 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32730 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32731 count))
32732 @end smallexample
32733
32734 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32735 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32736 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32737 involve actual division.
32738
32739 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32740 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32741 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32742 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32743 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32744
32745 @smallexample
32746 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32747 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32748 (let ((count 0))
32749 (while (not (fixnump n))
32750 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32751 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32752 n (car qr))))
32753 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32754
32755 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32756 (let ((count 0))
32757 (while (> n 0)
32758 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32759 n (lsh n -1)))
32760 count))
32761 @end smallexample
32762
32763 @noindent
32764 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32765 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32766 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32767 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32768 uses.
32769
32770 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32771 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32772 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32773 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32774 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32775 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32776 same thing with a single division by 512.
32777
32778 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32779 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32780
32781 @noindent
32782 @ignore
32783 @starindex
32784 @end ignore
32785 @tindex mysin
32786 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32787 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32788 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32789 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32790
32791 @smallexample
32792 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32793 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32794 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32795 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32796 newsum
32797 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32798 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32799 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32800 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32801 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32802 x (* x xnegsqr)
32803 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32804 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32805 (break)) ; then we are done.
32806 (setq sum newsum))
32807 sum))
32808 @end smallexample
32809
32810 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32811 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32812 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32813 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32814 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32815 by a separate algorithm.
32816
32817 @smallexample
32818 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32819 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32820 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32821 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32822 (cond ((complexp x)
32823 (mysin-complex x))
32824 ((< x 0)
32825 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32826 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32827
32828 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32829 (cond ((>= x 7)
32830 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32831 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32832 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32833 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32834 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32835 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32836 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32837 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32838 @end smallexample
32839
32840 @noindent
32841 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32842 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32843 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32844 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32845
32846 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32847 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32848 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32849 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32850 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32851 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32852 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32853 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32854 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32855 that this rule misses.
32856
32857 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32858 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32859 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32860 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32861
32862 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32863 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32864
32865 @noindent
32866 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32867 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32868 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32869 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32870 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32871 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32872 much simpler to use!
32873
32874 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32875 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32876
32877 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32878 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32879 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32880
32881 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32882 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32883 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32884 loaded and initialized for you.
32885
32886 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32887 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32888
32889 @ifinfo
32890 @example
32891
32892 @end example
32893 @end ifinfo
32894 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32895
32896 @noindent
32897 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32898 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32899 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32900 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32901
32902 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32903 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32904 one by one below.
32905
32906 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32907 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32908 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32909 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32910 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32911 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32912
32913 @ifinfo
32914 @example
32915
32916 @end example
32917 @end ifinfo
32918 @subsubsection Error Handling
32919
32920 @noindent
32921 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32922 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32923 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32924 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32925 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32926 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32927
32928 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32929 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32930 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32931 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32932
32933 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32934 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32935 ignored.
32936
32937 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32938 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32939 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32940
32941 @ifinfo
32942 @example
32943
32944 @end example
32945 @end ifinfo
32946 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32947
32948 @noindent
32949 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32950 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32951 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32952 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32953 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32954 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32955
32956 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32957 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32958 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32959
32960 @ifinfo
32961 @example
32962
32963 @end example
32964 @end ifinfo
32965 @subsubsection Default Modes
32966
32967 @noindent
32968 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32969 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32970 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32971 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32972 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32973 mode is used.
32974
32975 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32976 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32977 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32978
32979 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32980 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32981 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32982 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32983 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32984 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32985
32986 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32987 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32988 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32989 of the default of 12.
32990
32991 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32992 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32993 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32994 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32995 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32996
32997 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32998 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32999 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
33000 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
33001 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
33002 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
33003
33004 @ifinfo
33005 @example
33006
33007 @end example
33008 @end ifinfo
33009 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
33010
33011 @noindent
33012 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
33013 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
33014 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
33015 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
33016 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
33017
33018 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
33019 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
33020 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
33021 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
33022 structure.
33023
33024 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
33025 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
33026 an error if that object is not a constant).
33027
33028 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
33029 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
33030 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
33031 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
33032 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
33033 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
33034
33035 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
33036 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
33037 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
33038 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
33039
33040 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
33041 to format it as a string.
33042
33043 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
33044 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
33045 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
33046
33047 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
33048 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
33049 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
33050
33051 @ifinfo
33052 @example
33053
33054 @end example
33055 @end ifinfo
33056 @subsubsection Predicates
33057
33058 @noindent
33059 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
33060 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
33061 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
33062 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
33063
33064 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
33065 one value is less than another.
33066
33067 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
33068 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
33069 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
33070 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
33071 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
33072
33073 @ifinfo
33074 @example
33075
33076 @end example
33077 @end ifinfo
33078 @subsubsection Variable Values
33079
33080 @noindent
33081 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
33082 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
33083 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
33084 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
33085 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
33086 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
33087 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
33088
33089 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
33090 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
33091 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
33092 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
33093 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
33094 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
33095
33096 @example
33097 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
33098 @end example
33099
33100 @ifinfo
33101 @example
33102
33103 @end example
33104 @end ifinfo
33105 @subsubsection Stack Access
33106
33107 @noindent
33108 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
33109 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
33110 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
33111 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
33112 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
33113 usual way).
33114
33115 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
33116 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
33117 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
33118 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
33119 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
33120 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
33121 the stack.
33122
33123 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
33124 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
33125 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
33126 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
33127 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
33128
33129 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
33130 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
33131 as a string.
33132
33133 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
33134 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
33135 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
33136 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
33137 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
33138 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
33139
33140 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
33141 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
33142 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
33143
33144 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
33145 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
33146 the stack buffer if necessary.
33147
33148 @ifinfo
33149 @example
33150
33151 @end example
33152 @end ifinfo
33153 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
33154
33155 @noindent
33156 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
33157 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
33158 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
33159 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
33160 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
33161 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
33162 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
33163
33164 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
33165 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
33166 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
33167 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
33168 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
33169
33170 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
33171 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
33172 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
33173
33174 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
33175
33176 @ifinfo
33177 @example
33178
33179 @end example
33180 @end ifinfo
33181 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
33182
33183 @noindent
33184 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
33185 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
33186 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
33187 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
33188 @code{calc-eval}.
33189
33190 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
33191 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
33192 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
33193 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
33194
33195 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
33196 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
33197 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
33198 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
33199 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
33200 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
33201 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
33202 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
33203 your original buffer when it is done.
33204
33205 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
33206 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
33207
33208 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
33209 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
33210
33211 @ifinfo
33212 @example
33213
33214 @end example
33215 @end ifinfo
33216 @subsubsection Example
33217
33218 @noindent
33219 @findex convert-temp
33220 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
33221 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
33222 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
33223 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
33224 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
33225 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
33226 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
33227
33228 @example
33229 (defun convert-temp ()
33230 (interactive)
33231 (save-excursion
33232 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
33233 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
33234 (bot1 (match-end 1))
33235 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
33236 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
33237 (bot2 (match-end 2))
33238 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
33239 (if (equal type "F")
33240 (setq type "C"
33241 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
33242 (setq type "F"
33243 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
33244 (goto-char top2)
33245 (delete-region top2 bot2)
33246 (insert-before-markers type)
33247 (goto-char top1)
33248 (delete-region top1 bot1)
33249 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
33250 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
33251 (insert number))))
33252 @end example
33253
33254 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
33255 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
33256 instead of after it.
33257
33258 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
33259 @subsection Calculator Internals
33260
33261 @noindent
33262 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
33263 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
33264 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
33265 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
33266 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
33267 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
33268 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
33269 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
33270
33271 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
33272 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
33273 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
33274 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
33275 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
33276 in the remaining component files.
33277
33278 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
33279 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
33280 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
33281 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
33282 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
33283 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
33284 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
33285 prove this file will already be loaded.
33286
33287 @menu
33288 * Data Type Formats::
33289 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
33290 * Stack Lisp Functions::
33291 * Predicates::
33292 * Computational Lisp Functions::
33293 * Vector Lisp Functions::
33294 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
33295 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
33296 * Hooks::
33297 @end menu
33298
33299 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
33300 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
33301
33302 @noindent
33303 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
33304 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
33305 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
33306 which is not a Lisp list.
33307
33308 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
33309 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
33310 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
33311 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
33312 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
33313 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
33314 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
33315
33316 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
33317 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
33318 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
33319 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
33320 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
33321 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
33322
33323 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
33324 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
33325 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
33326 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
33327 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
33328 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
33329
33330 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
33331 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
33332 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
33333 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
33334 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
33335 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
33336 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
33337 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
33338 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
33339 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
33340
33341 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
33342 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
33343 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
33344 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
33345 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
33346
33347 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
33348 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
33349 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
33350 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
33351 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
33352 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
33353 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
33354 negative real number.)
33355
33356 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
33357 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
33358 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
33359 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
33360 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
33361
33362 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
33363 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
33364 January 1, 1 AD@. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
33365 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
33366
33367 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
33368 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
33369 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
33370
33371 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
33372 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
33373 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
33374 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
33375 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
33376 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
33377
33378 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
33379 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
33380 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
33381 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
33382 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
33383 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
33384 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
33385 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
33386 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
33387 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
33388
33389 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
33390 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
33391 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
33392 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
33393 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
33394 generally unused by Calc data structures.
33395
33396 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
33397 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
33398 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
33399 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
33400 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
33401 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
33402 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
33403 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
33404 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
33405 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
33406 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
33407 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
33408 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
33409 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
33410 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
33411 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
33412 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
33413 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
33414 the variable is used.
33415
33416 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
33417 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
33418 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
33419 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
33420 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
33421 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
33422 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
33423 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
33424 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
33425 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
33426 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
33427 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
33428 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
33429 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
33430 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
33431 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
33432 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
33433 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
33434 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
33435
33436 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
33437 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
33438
33439 @noindent
33440 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
33441 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
33442 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
33443 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
33444
33445 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
33446 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
33447 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
33448 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
33449 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
33450 @end defun
33451
33452 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
33453 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
33454 remove it from that list.
33455 @end defun
33456
33457 @defun calc-record-undo rec
33458 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
33459 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
33460 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
33461 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
33462 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
33463 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
33464 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
33465 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
33466 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
33467 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
33468 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
33469 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
33470 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
33471 @end defun
33472
33473 @defun calc-record-why msg args
33474 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
33475 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
33476 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
33477 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
33478 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
33479 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
33480 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
33481 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
33482 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
33483 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
33484 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
33485 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
33486 @end defun
33487
33488 @defun calc-is-inverse
33489 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
33490 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
33491 @end defun
33492
33493 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
33494 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
33495 @end defun
33496
33497 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
33498 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
33499
33500 @noindent
33501 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
33502 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
33503
33504 @defun calc-push-list vals n
33505 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
33506 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
33507 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
33508 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
33509 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
33510 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
33511 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
33512 is an empty list, nothing happens.
33513
33514 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
33515 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
33516 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
33517 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
33518 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
33519 @end defun
33520
33521 @defun calc-top-list n m
33522 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
33523 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
33524 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
33525 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
33526 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
33527 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
33528 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
33529 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
33530 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
33531 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
33532
33533 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
33534 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
33535 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
33536 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
33537 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
33538 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
33539 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
33540 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
33541 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
33542 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
33543 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
33544 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
33545 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
33546 @end defun
33547
33548 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
33549 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
33550 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
33551 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
33552
33553 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
33554 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
33555 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
33556 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
33557 contain selections.
33558 @end defun
33559
33560 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
33561 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
33562 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
33563 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
33564 will be used.
33565 @end defun
33566
33567 @defun calc-normalize n
33568 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
33569 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
33570 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
33571 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
33572 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
33573 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
33574 @end defun
33575
33576 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
33577 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
33578 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
33579 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
33580 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
33581 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
33582 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
33583 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
33584 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
33585 @code{calc-top-list}.
33586 @end defun
33587
33588 @defun calc-top-n m
33589 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
33590 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
33591 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33592 @end defun
33593
33594 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33595 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33596 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33597 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33598 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33599 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33600 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33601
33602 @smallexample
33603 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33604 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33605 @end smallexample
33606
33607 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33608 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33609 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33610 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33611 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33612 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33613 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33614 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33615 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33616 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33617 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33618 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33619 are present.
33620 @end defun
33621
33622 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33623 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33624 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33625 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33626 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33627 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33628
33629 @smallexample
33630 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
33631 (interactive "P")
33632 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33633 @end smallexample
33634 @end defun
33635
33636 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33637 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33638 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33639 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33640 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33641 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33642 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33643 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33644 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33645 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33646 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33647 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33648 top element.
33649 @end defun
33650
33651 @defun calc-stack-size
33652 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33653 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33654 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33655 @end defun
33656
33657 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33658 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33659 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33660 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33661 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33662 line number, not the stack entry itself.
33663 @end defun
33664
33665 @defun calc-substack-height n
33666 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33667 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33668 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33669 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33670 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33671 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33672 entries.)
33673 @end defun
33674
33675 @defun calc-refresh
33676 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33677 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33678 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33679 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33680 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33681 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33682 @end defun
33683
33684 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33685 @subsubsection Predicates
33686
33687 @noindent
33688 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33689 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33690 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33691 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33692 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33693 the full range of Calc data types.
33694
33695 @defun zerop x
33696 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33697 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33698 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33699 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33700 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33701 @end defun
33702
33703 @defun negp x
33704 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33705 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33706 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33707 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33708 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33709 @end defun
33710
33711 @defun posp x
33712 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33713 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33714 @end defun
33715
33716 @defun looks-negp x
33717 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33718 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33719 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33720 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33721 @end defun
33722
33723 @defun integerp x
33724 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33725 @end defun
33726
33727 @defun fixnump x
33728 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33729 @end defun
33730
33731 @defun natnump x
33732 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33733 @end defun
33734
33735 @defun fixnatnump x
33736 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33737 @end defun
33738
33739 @defun num-integerp x
33740 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33741 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33742 the decimal point.
33743 @end defun
33744
33745 @defun messy-integerp x
33746 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33747 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33748 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33749 @end defun
33750
33751 @defun num-natnump x
33752 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33753 @end defun
33754
33755 @defun evenp x
33756 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33757 @end defun
33758
33759 @defun looks-evenp x
33760 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33761 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33762 @end defun
33763
33764 @defun oddp x
33765 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33766 @end defun
33767
33768 @defun ratp x
33769 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33770 fraction.
33771 @end defun
33772
33773 @defun realp x
33774 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33775 or floating-point number.
33776 @end defun
33777
33778 @defun anglep x
33779 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33780 @end defun
33781
33782 @defun floatp x
33783 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33784 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33785 is a float.
33786 @end defun
33787
33788 @defun complexp x
33789 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33790 (but not a real number).
33791 @end defun
33792
33793 @defun rect-complexp x
33794 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33795 @end defun
33796
33797 @defun polar-complexp x
33798 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33799 @end defun
33800
33801 @defun numberp x
33802 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33803 @end defun
33804
33805 @defun scalarp x
33806 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33807 @end defun
33808
33809 @defun vectorp x
33810 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33811 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33812 @end defun
33813
33814 @defun numvecp x
33815 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33816 @end defun
33817
33818 @defun matrixp x
33819 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33820 all of the same size.
33821 @end defun
33822
33823 @defun square-matrixp x
33824 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33825 @end defun
33826
33827 @defun objectp x
33828 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33829 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33830 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33831 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33832 @end defun
33833
33834 @defun objvecp x
33835 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33836 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33837 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33838 @end defun
33839
33840 @defun primp x
33841 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33842 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33843 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33844 and intervals.
33845 @end defun
33846
33847 @defun constp x
33848 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33849 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33850 components are @code{constp}.
33851 @end defun
33852
33853 @defun lessp x y
33854 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33855 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33856 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33857 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33858 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33859 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33860 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33861 @end defun
33862
33863 @defun beforep x y
33864 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33865 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33866 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33867 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33868 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33869 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33870 by Calc's algebraic simplifications to put the terms of a product into
33871 canonical order: This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to
33872 @samp{2 x y}.
33873 @end defun
33874
33875 @defun equal x y
33876 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33877 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33878 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33879 0 and 0.0 as different.
33880 @end defun
33881
33882 @defun math-equal x y
33883 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33884 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33885 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33886 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33887 @end defun
33888
33889 @defun equal-int x n
33890 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33891 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33892 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33893 whenever possible.
33894 @end defun
33895
33896 @defun nearly-equal x y
33897 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33898 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33899 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33900 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33901 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33902 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33903 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33904 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33905 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33906 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33907 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33908 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33909 @end defun
33910
33911 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33912 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33913 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33914 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33915 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33916 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33917 @var{y} must be real.
33918 @end defun
33919
33920 @defun is-true x
33921 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33922 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33923 or a provably non-zero formula.
33924 @end defun
33925
33926 @defun reject-arg val pred
33927 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33928 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33929 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33930 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33931 @end defun
33932
33933 @defun inexact-value
33934 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33935 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33936 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33937 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33938 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33939 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33940 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33941 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33942 @end defun
33943
33944 @defun overflow
33945 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33946 @end defun
33947
33948 @defun underflow
33949 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33950 @end defun
33951
33952 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33953 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33954
33955 @noindent
33956 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33957 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33958 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33959 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33960 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33961 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33962 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33963
33964 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33965 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33966 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33967 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33968 respectively, instead.
33969
33970 @defun normalize val
33971 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33972 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33973 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33974 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33975 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33976 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33977 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33978 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33979 return 6.
33980
33981 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33982 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33983 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33984 the formula still in symbolic form.
33985
33986 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33987 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33988 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33989 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33990 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33991 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33992 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33993 on the stack.
33994 @end defun
33995
33996 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33997 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33998 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33999 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
34000 @end defun
34001
34002 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
34003 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
34004 digits. This is a macro which expands to
34005
34006 @smallexample
34007 (math-normalize
34008 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
34009 @var{body}))
34010 @end smallexample
34011
34012 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
34013 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
34014 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
34015 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
34016 @end defmac
34017
34018 @defun make-frac n d
34019 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
34020 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
34021 @end defun
34022
34023 @defun make-float mant exp
34024 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
34025 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
34026 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
34027 if @var{exp} is out of range.
34028 @end defun
34029
34030 @defun make-sdev x sigma
34031 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
34032 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
34033 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
34034 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
34035 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
34036 @end defun
34037
34038 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
34039 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
34040 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
34041 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
34042 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
34043 @end defun
34044
34045 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
34046 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
34047 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
34048 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
34049 @end defun
34050
34051 @defun make-mod n m
34052 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
34053 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
34054 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
34055 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
34056 @end defun
34057
34058 @defun float x
34059 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
34060 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
34061 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
34062 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
34063 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
34064 @end defun
34065
34066 @defun compare x y
34067 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
34068 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
34069 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
34070 undefined or cannot be determined.
34071 @end defun
34072
34073 @defun numdigs n
34074 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
34075 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
34076 considered to have zero digits.
34077 @end defun
34078
34079 @defun scale-int x n
34080 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
34081 digits with truncation toward zero.
34082 @end defun
34083
34084 @defun scale-rounding x n
34085 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
34086 integer rather than truncating.
34087 @end defun
34088
34089 @defun fixnum n
34090 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
34091 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
34092 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
34093 @end defun
34094
34095 @defun sqr x
34096 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
34097 @end defun
34098
34099 @defun quotient x y
34100 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
34101 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
34102 direction of rounding is undefined.
34103 @end defun
34104
34105 @defun idiv x y
34106 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
34107 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
34108 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
34109 slower than for @code{quotient}.
34110 @end defun
34111
34112 @defun imod x y
34113 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
34114 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
34115 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
34116 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
34117 @end defun
34118
34119 @defun idivmod x y
34120 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
34121 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
34122 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
34123 @end defun
34124
34125 @defun pow x y
34126 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
34127 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
34128 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
34129 @end defun
34130
34131 @defun abs-approx x
34132 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
34133 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
34134 the absolute values of the components.
34135 @end defun
34136
34137 @findex e
34138 @findex gamma-const
34139 @findex ln-2
34140 @findex ln-10
34141 @findex phi
34142 @findex pi-over-2
34143 @findex pi-over-4
34144 @findex pi-over-180
34145 @findex sqrt-two-pi
34146 @findex sqrt-e
34147 @findex two-pi
34148 @defun pi
34149 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
34150 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
34151 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
34152 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
34153 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
34154 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
34155 first are essentially free.
34156 @end defun
34157
34158 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
34159 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
34160 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
34161 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
34162 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
34163 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
34164 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
34165 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
34166 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
34167 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
34168 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
34169 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
34170 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
34171 @end defmac
34172
34173 @findex half-circle
34174 @findex quarter-circle
34175 @defun full-circle symb
34176 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
34177 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
34178 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
34179 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
34180 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
34181 @end defun
34182
34183 @defun power-of-2 n
34184 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
34185 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
34186 particular @var{n} is expensive.
34187 @end defun
34188
34189 @defun integer-log2 n
34190 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
34191 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
34192 return @code{nil}.
34193 @end defun
34194
34195 @defun div-mod a b m
34196 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
34197 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
34198 @end defun
34199
34200 @defun pow-mod a b m
34201 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
34202 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
34203 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
34204 @end defun
34205
34206 @defun isqrt n
34207 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
34208 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
34209 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
34210 @end defun
34211
34212 @defun to-hms a ang
34213 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
34214 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
34215 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
34216 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
34217 @end defun
34218
34219 @defun from-hms a ang
34220 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
34221 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
34222 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
34223 is returned as-is.
34224 @end defun
34225
34226 @defun to-radians a
34227 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
34228 angular mode.
34229 @end defun
34230
34231 @defun from-radians a
34232 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
34233 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
34234 @end defun
34235
34236 @defun to-radians-2 a
34237 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
34238 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
34239 @end defun
34240
34241 @defun from-radians-2 a
34242 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
34243 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
34244 @end defun
34245
34246 @defun random-digit
34247 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
34248 @end defun
34249
34250 @defun random-digits n
34251 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
34252 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
34253 @end defun
34254
34255 @defun random-float
34256 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
34257 @end defun
34258
34259 @defun prime-test n iters
34260 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
34261 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
34262 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
34263 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
34264 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
34265 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
34266 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
34267 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
34268 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
34269 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
34270 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
34271 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
34272 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
34273 @end defun
34274
34275 @defun to-simple-fraction f
34276 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
34277 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
34278 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
34279 fast.
34280 @end defun
34281
34282 @defun to-fraction f tol
34283 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
34284 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
34285 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
34286 @end defun
34287
34288 @defun quarter-integer n
34289 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
34290 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
34291 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
34292 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
34293 returns @code{nil}.
34294 @end defun
34295
34296 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
34297 @subsubsection Vector Functions
34298
34299 @noindent
34300 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
34301 matrices.
34302
34303 @defun math-concat x y
34304 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
34305 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
34306 @end defun
34307
34308 @defun vec-length v
34309 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
34310 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
34311 rows in the matrix.
34312 @end defun
34313
34314 @defun mat-dimens m
34315 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
34316 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
34317 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
34318 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
34319 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
34320 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
34321 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
34322 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
34323 elements.
34324 @end defun
34325
34326 @defun dimension-error
34327 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
34328 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
34329 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
34330 @end defun
34331
34332 @defun build-vector args
34333 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
34334 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
34335 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
34336 @end defun
34337
34338 @defun make-vec obj dims
34339 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
34340 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
34341 filled with 27's.
34342 @end defun
34343
34344 @defun row-matrix v
34345 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
34346 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
34347 leave it alone.
34348 @end defun
34349
34350 @defun col-matrix v
34351 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
34352 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
34353 already a matrix, leave it alone.
34354 @end defun
34355
34356 @defun map-vec f v
34357 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
34358 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
34359 of vector @var{v}.
34360 @end defun
34361
34362 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
34363 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
34364 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
34365 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
34366 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
34367 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
34368 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
34369 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
34370 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
34371 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
34372 @end defun
34373
34374 @defun reduce-vec f v
34375 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
34376 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
34377 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
34378 @end defun
34379
34380 @defun reduce-cols f m
34381 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
34382 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
34383 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
34384 @end defun
34385
34386 @defun mat-row m n
34387 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
34388 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
34389 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
34390 @end defun
34391
34392 @defun mat-col m n
34393 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
34394 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
34395 @end defun
34396
34397 @defun mat-less-row m n
34398 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
34399 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
34400 @end defun
34401
34402 @defun mat-less-col m n
34403 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
34404 @end defun
34405
34406 @defun transpose m
34407 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
34408 @end defun
34409
34410 @defun flatten-vector v
34411 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
34412 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
34413 @end defun
34414
34415 @defun copy-matrix m
34416 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
34417 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
34418 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
34419 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
34420 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
34421 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
34422 @end defun
34423
34424 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
34425 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
34426 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
34427 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
34428 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
34429 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
34430 @var{m}.
34431 @end defun
34432
34433 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
34434 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
34435
34436 @noindent
34437 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
34438 Calculator.
34439
34440 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
34441 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
34442 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
34443 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
34444 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
34445 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
34446 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
34447 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
34448 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
34449 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
34450 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
34451 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
34452 their corresponding sub-formulas.
34453
34454 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
34455 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
34456 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
34457 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
34458 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
34459 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
34460 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
34461 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
34462 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
34463 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
34464 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
34465 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
34466 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
34467 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
34468 @end defun
34469
34470 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
34471 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
34472 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
34473 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
34474 the formula in-place.
34475 @end defun
34476
34477 @defun calc-find-selected-part
34478 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
34479 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
34480 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
34481 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
34482 @end defun
34483
34484 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
34485 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
34486 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
34487 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
34488 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
34489 to reflect the new selection.
34490 @end defun
34491
34492 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
34493 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
34494 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
34495 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
34496 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
34497 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
34498 @end defun
34499
34500 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
34501 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
34502 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
34503 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
34504 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
34505 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
34506 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
34507 This function does not take associativity into account.
34508 @end defun
34509
34510 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
34511 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
34512 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
34513 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
34514 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
34515 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
34516 return the whole expression.
34517 @end defun
34518
34519 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
34520 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
34521 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
34522 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
34523 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
34524 @end defun
34525
34526 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
34527 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
34528 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
34529 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
34530 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
34531 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
34532 function does not take associativity into account.
34533 @end defun
34534
34535 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
34536 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
34537 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
34538 @end defun
34539
34540 @defun simplify expr
34541 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying Calc's algebraic
34542 simplifications. This always returns a copy of the expression; the
34543 structure @var{expr} points to remains unchanged in memory.
34544
34545 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
34546 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
34547 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
34548 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
34549 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
34550 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
34551 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
34552 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
34553 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
34554 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
34555 needed: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
34556 further simplifications were possible.
34557 @end defun
34558
34559 @defun simplify-extended expr
34560 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
34561 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
34562 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
34563 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
34564 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
34565 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
34566 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
34567 before taking any action.
34568 @end defun
34569
34570 @defun simplify-units expr
34571 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
34572 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
34573 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
34574 @end defun
34575
34576 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
34577 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
34578 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
34579 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
34580 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
34581 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
34582 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
34583 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
34584 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
34585 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
34586 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
34587 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
34588 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
34589 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
34590
34591 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34592 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34593 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34594 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34595 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34596
34597 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34598 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34599 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34600 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34601
34602 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34603 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34604 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34605 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34606 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34607
34608 @smallexample
34609 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34610 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34611 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34612 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34613 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34614 (or math-living-dangerously
34615 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34616 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34617 @end smallexample
34618
34619 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34620 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34621 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34622 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34623 @end defmac
34624
34625 @defun common-constant-factor expr
34626 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34627 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34628 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
34629 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
34630 @end defun
34631
34632 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34633 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34634 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34635 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34636 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34637 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34638 square roots:
34639
34640 @smallexample
34641 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34642 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34643 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34644 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34645 (math-normalize
34646 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34647 (math-cancel-common-factor
34648 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34649 @end smallexample
34650 @end defun
34651
34652 @defun frac-gcd a b
34653 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34654 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34655 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34656 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34657 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34658 @end defun
34659
34660 @defun map-tree func expr many
34661 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34662 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34663 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34664 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34665 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34666 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34667 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34668 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34669 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34670 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34671 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34672 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34673 @end defun
34674
34675 @defun compile-rewrites rules
34676 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34677 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34678 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34679 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34680 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34681 message.
34682 @end defun
34683
34684 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34685 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34686 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34687 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34688 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34689 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34690 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34691 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34692 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34693 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34694 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34695 @end defun
34696
34697 @defun rewrite-heads expr
34698 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34699 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34700 @end defun
34701
34702 @defun rewrite expr rules many
34703 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34704 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34705 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34706 times.
34707 @end defun
34708
34709 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34710 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34711 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34712 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34713 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34714 @end defun
34715
34716 @defun deriv expr var value symb
34717 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34718 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34719 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34720 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34721 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34722 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34723 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of nondifferentiable
34724 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34725 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34726
34727 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34728 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34729 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34730 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34731 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34732 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34733 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34734 is defined by
34735
34736 @smallexample
34737 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34738 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34739 @end smallexample
34740
34741 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34742 @smallexample
34743 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34744 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34745 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34746 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34747 @end smallexample
34748 @end defun
34749
34750 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34751 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34752 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34753 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34754 @end defun
34755
34756 @defun integ expr var low high
34757 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34758 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34759 @end defun
34760
34761 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34762 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34763 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34764 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34765 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34766 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34767 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34768 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34769 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34770 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34771 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34772
34773 @smallexample
34774 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34775 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34776 (and int
34777 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34778
34779 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34780 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34781 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34782 @end smallexample
34783
34784 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34785 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34786 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34787 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34788 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34789 result.
34790 @end defmac
34791
34792 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34793 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34794 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34795 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34796 @var{v}.
34797 @end defmac
34798
34799 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34800 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34801 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34802 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34803 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34804 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34805 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34806 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34807 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34808 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34809 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34810
34811 @smallexample
34812 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34813 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34814 @end smallexample
34815
34816 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34817 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34818 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34819 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34820 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34821 @end defun
34822
34823 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34824 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34825 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34826 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34827 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34828 @end defun
34829
34830 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34831 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34832 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34833 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34834 @end defun
34835
34836 @defun expr-contains expr var
34837 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34838 of @var{expr}.
34839
34840 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34841 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34842 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34843 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34844 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34845 @code{eq} to each other.
34846 @end defun
34847
34848 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34849 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34850 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34851 @end defun
34852
34853 @defun expr-depends expr var
34854 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34855 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34856 in common.
34857 @end defun
34858
34859 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34860 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34861 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34862 @end defun
34863
34864 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34865 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34866 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34867 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34868 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34869 @end defun
34870
34871 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34872 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34873 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34874 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34875 are ignored.
34876 @end defun
34877
34878 @defun expr-weight expr
34879 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34880 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34881 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34882 @end defun
34883
34884 @defun expr-height expr
34885 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34886 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34887 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34888 @end defun
34889
34890 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34891 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34892 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34893 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34894 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34895 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34896 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34897 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34898 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34899 a polynomial of degree 0.
34900 @end defun
34901
34902 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34903 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34904 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34905 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34906 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34907 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34908 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34909 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34910 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34911 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34912 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34913 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34914 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34915 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34916 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34917 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34918 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34919 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34920 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34921 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34922 @end defun
34923
34924 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34925 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34926 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34927 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34928 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34929 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34930 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34931 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34932 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34933 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34934 is found.
34935 @end defun
34936
34937 @defun poly-simplify poly
34938 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34939 clipping off trailing zeros.
34940 @end defun
34941
34942 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34943 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34944 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34945 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34946 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34947 @end defun
34948
34949 @defun poly-mul a b
34950 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34951 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34952 @end defun
34953
34954 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34955 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34956 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34957 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34958 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34959 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34960 @end defun
34961
34962 @defun check-unit-name var
34963 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34964 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34965 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34966 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34967 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34968 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34969 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34970 @end defun
34971
34972 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34973 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34974 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34975 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34976 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34977 @end defun
34978
34979 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34980 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34981 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34982 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34983 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34984 @end defun
34985
34986 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34987 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34988 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34989 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34990 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34991 is an expression to substitute for it.
34992 @end defun
34993
34994 @defun remove-units expr
34995 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34996 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34997 @end defun
34998
34999 @defun extract-units expr
35000 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
35001 by ones.
35002 @end defun
35003
35004 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
35005 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
35006
35007 @noindent
35008 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
35009 Calc numbers and formulas.
35010
35011 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
35012 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
35013 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
35014 @end defun
35015
35016 @defun read-number str
35017 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
35018 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
35019 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
35020 @end defun
35021
35022 @defun read-expr str
35023 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
35024 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
35025 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
35026 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
35027 a string describing the problem.
35028 @end defun
35029
35030 @defun read-exprs str
35031 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
35032 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
35033 shown above is returned instead.
35034 @end defun
35035
35036 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
35037 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
35038 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
35039 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
35040 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
35041 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
35042 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
35043 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
35044 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
35045 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
35046 @code{calc-normalize} first.
35047
35048 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
35049 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
35050 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
35051 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
35052 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
35053 that actually appeared in the input.
35054 @end defun
35055
35056 @defun format-number a
35057 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
35058 @end defun
35059
35060 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
35061 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
35062 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
35063 This is a simple format designed
35064 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
35065 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
35066 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
35067 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
35068 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
35069 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
35070 @end defun
35071
35072 @defun format-nice-expr a width
35073 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
35074 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
35075 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
35076 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
35077 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
35078 @end defun
35079
35080 @defun format-value a width
35081 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
35082 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
35083 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
35084 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
35085 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
35086 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
35087 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
35088 window is used.
35089 @end defun
35090
35091 @defun compose-expr a prec
35092 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
35093 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
35094 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
35095 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
35096 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
35097 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
35098 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
35099 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
35100 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
35101 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
35102 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
35103 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
35104 normal function-call notation for that language.
35105 @end defun
35106
35107 @defun composition-to-string c w
35108 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
35109 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
35110 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
35111 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
35112 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
35113 @end defun
35114
35115 @defun comp-width c
35116 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
35117 @end defun
35118
35119 @defun comp-height c
35120 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
35121 @end defun
35122
35123 @defun comp-ascent c
35124 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
35125 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
35126 @end defun
35127
35128 @defun comp-descent c
35129 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
35130 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
35131 @end defun
35132
35133 @defun comp-first-char c
35134 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
35135 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
35136 return @code{nil}.
35137 @end defun
35138
35139 @defun comp-last-char c
35140 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
35141 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
35142 @end defun
35143
35144 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35145 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
35146 @comment
35147 @comment @noindent
35148 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
35149
35150 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35151 @subsubsection Hooks
35152
35153 @noindent
35154 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
35155 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
35156 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
35157 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
35158 other customization-related variables are also described here.
35159
35160 @defvar calc-load-hook
35161 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
35162 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
35163 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
35164 @end defvar
35165
35166 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
35167 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
35168 @end defvar
35169
35170 @defvar calc-start-hook
35171 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
35172 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
35173 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
35174 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
35175 @end defvar
35176
35177 @defvar calc-mode-hook
35178 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
35179 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
35180 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
35181 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
35182 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
35183 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
35184 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
35185 been evaluated yet.
35186 @end defvar
35187
35188 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
35189 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
35190 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
35191 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
35192 per Emacs session.
35193 @end defvar
35194
35195 @defvar calc-end-hook
35196 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
35197 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
35198 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
35199 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
35200 @end defvar
35201
35202 @defvar calc-window-hook
35203 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
35204 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
35205 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
35206 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
35207 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
35208 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
35209 @end defvar
35210
35211 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
35212 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
35213 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
35214 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
35215 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
35216 @end defvar
35217
35218 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
35219 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
35220 @end defvar
35221
35222 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
35223 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
35224 new buffer.
35225 @end defvar
35226
35227 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
35228 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
35229 new formula.
35230 @end defvar
35231
35232 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
35233 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
35234 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
35235 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
35236 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
35237 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
35238 @code{calc-edit} command.)
35239 @end defvar
35240
35241 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
35242 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
35243 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
35244 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
35245 message is inserted.
35246 @end defvar
35247
35248 @defvar calc-reset-hook
35249 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
35250 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
35251 @end defvar
35252
35253 @defvar calc-other-modes
35254 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
35255 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
35256 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
35257 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
35258 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
35259 @end defvar
35260
35261 @defvar calc-mode-map
35262 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
35263 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
35264 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
35265 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
35266 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
35267 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
35268 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
35269 extensions are loaded.
35270 @end defvar
35271
35272 @defvar calc-digit-map
35273 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
35274 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
35275 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
35276 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
35277 @end defvar
35278
35279 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
35280 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
35281 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
35282 @end defvar
35283
35284 @defvar calc-store-var-map
35285 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
35286 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
35287 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
35288 @end defvar
35289
35290 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
35291 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
35292 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
35293 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
35294 @end defvar
35295
35296 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
35297 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
35298 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
35299 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
35300 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
35301 non-default variables are written out.
35302 @end defvar
35303
35304 @defvar calc-local-var-list
35305 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
35306 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
35307 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
35308 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
35309 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
35310 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
35311 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
35312 @end defvar
35313
35314 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
35315 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
35316 @include gpl.texi
35317
35318 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
35319 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
35320 @include doclicense.texi
35321
35322 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
35323 @appendix Customizing Calc
35324
35325 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
35326 to use a different prefix, you can put
35327
35328 @example
35329 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
35330 @end example
35331
35332 @noindent
35333 in your .emacs file.
35334 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
35335 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
35336 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
35337 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
35338 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
35339 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
35340 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
35341
35342 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
35343 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
35344 calculation and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
35345 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
35346 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
35347 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
35348 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
35349 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
35350 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
35351 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
35352
35353 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
35354 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
35355 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
35356 to see how regular expressions work.
35357
35358 @defvar calc-settings-file
35359 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
35360 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
35361 definitions.
35362 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
35363 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
35364 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
35365 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
35366
35367 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.emacs.d/calc.el"}
35368 unless the file @file{~/.calc.el} exists, in which case the default
35369 value will be @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
35370 @end defvar
35371
35372 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
35373 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
35374 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
35375 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
35376 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
35377 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
35378 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
35379 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
35380 @end defvar
35381
35382 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
35383 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
35384 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
35385 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
35386 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
35387 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
35388 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
35389 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
35390 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
35391 to display or print the output.
35392
35393 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
35394 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
35395 @code{"lp %s"}.
35396 @end defvar
35397
35398 @defvar calc-language-alist
35399 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
35400 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
35401 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
35402 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
35403 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
35404 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
35405 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
35406 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
35407 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
35408 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
35409 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
35410
35411 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
35412 @example
35413 ((latex-mode . latex)
35414 (tex-mode . tex)
35415 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
35416 (context-mode . tex)
35417 (nroff-mode . eqn)
35418 (pascal-mode . pascal)
35419 (c-mode . c)
35420 (c++-mode . c)
35421 (fortran-mode . fortran)
35422 (f90-mode . fortran))
35423 @end example
35424 @end defvar
35425
35426 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
35427 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
35428 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35429 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
35430 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
35431 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
35432 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
35433 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
35434 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
35435
35436 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
35437 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
35438 @samp{%} and a space.
35439
35440 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
35441 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
35442 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35443 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
35444 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35445 @example
35446 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
35447 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
35448 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
35449 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
35450 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35451 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35452 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
35453 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
35454 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35455 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35456 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
35457 @end example
35458 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35459 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35460 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35461 @end defvar
35462
35463 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
35464 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
35465 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
35466 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35467 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35468 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
35469 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
35470 They are regular expressions;
35471 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
35472 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
35473 delimiters''.
35474
35475 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
35476 Embedded mode understands by default are:
35477 @enumerate
35478 @item
35479 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
35480 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
35481 @item
35482 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
35483 @item
35484 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
35485 @item
35486 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
35487 @item
35488 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
35489 @end enumerate
35490
35491 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
35492 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35493 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
35494 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35495 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35496 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
35497 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35498 @code{nil}.
35499 @end defvar
35500
35501 @defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
35502 @defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
35503 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35504 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
35505 that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
35506 w}. It is a regular expressions.
35507
35508 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
35509 @code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
35510
35511 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
35512 set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
35513 expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35514 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35515 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35516 @code{nil}.
35517 @end defvar
35518
35519 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
35520 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
35521 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
35522 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35523 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35524 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
35525 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
35526 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
35527 buffer as well as to recognize them.
35528
35529 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
35530 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
35531 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
35532 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
35533 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
35534
35535 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
35536 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35537 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
35538 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35539 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35540 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
35541 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
35542 @example
35543 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
35544 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
35545 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
35546 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
35547 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35548 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35549 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
35550 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
35551 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35552 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35553 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
35554 @end example
35555 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35556 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35557 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35558 @end defvar
35559
35560 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
35561 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
35562 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
35563 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35564 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35565 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
35566 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
35567
35568 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
35569 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
35570 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
35571 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
35572 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
35573 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
35574 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
35575 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
35576 closing newline are omitted.)
35577
35578 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
35579 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35580 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
35581 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35582 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35583 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
35584 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
35585 @code{nil}.
35586 @end defvar
35587
35588 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
35589 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
35590 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
35591 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35592 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35593 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35594 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35595 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35596 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35597
35598 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35599 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35600 @code{"\n"}.
35601 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35602 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35603 lines by themselves.
35604
35605 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35606 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35607 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35608 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35609 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35610 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35611 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35612 @example
35613 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35614 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35615 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35616 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35617 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35618 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35619 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35620 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35621 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35622 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35623 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35624 @end example
35625 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35626 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35627 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35628 @end defvar
35629
35630 @defvar calc-lu-power-reference
35631 @defvarx calc-lu-field-reference
35632 See @ref{Logarithmic Units}.@*
35633 The variables @code{calc-lu-power-reference} and
35634 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} are unit expressions (written as
35635 strings) which Calc will use as reference quantities for logarithmic
35636 units.
35637
35638 The default value of @code{calc-lu-power-reference} is @code{"mW"}
35639 and the default value of @code{calc-lu-field-reference} is
35640 @code{"20 uPa"}.
35641 @end defvar
35642
35643 @defvar calc-note-threshold
35644 See @ref{Musical Notes}.@*
35645 The variable @code{calc-note-threshold} is a number (written as a
35646 string) which determines how close (in cents) a frequency needs to be
35647 to a note to be recognized as that note.
35648
35649 The default value of @code{calc-note-threshold} is 1.
35650 @end defvar
35651
35652 @defvar calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
35653 @defvarx calc-selected-face
35654 @defvarx calc-nonselected-face
35655 See @ref{Displaying Selections}.@*
35656 The variable @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces}
35657 determines how selected sub-formulas are distinguished.
35658 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is nil, then
35659 a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by changing every
35660 character not part of the sub-formula with a dot or by changing every
35661 character in the sub-formula with a @samp{#} sign.
35662 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is t,
35663 then a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by displaying the
35664 non-selected portion of the formula with @code{calc-nonselected-face}
35665 or by displaying the selected sub-formula with
35666 @code{calc-nonselected-face}.
35667 @end defvar
35668
35669 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35670 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
35671 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35672 formulas in normal language modes. If
35673 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35674 multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35675 right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35676 as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35677 @code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35678 (and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
35679 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35680 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35681 @end defvar
35682
35683 @defvar calc-ensure-consistent-units
35684 When converting units, the variable @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35685 determines whether or not the target units need to be consistent with the
35686 original units. If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is @code{nil}, then
35687 the target units don't need to have the same dimensions as the original units;
35688 for example, converting @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will produce @samp{30.48 m/s}.
35689 If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is non-@code{nil}, then the target units
35690 need to have the same dimensions as the original units; for example, converting
35691 @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will result in an error, since @samp{ft/s} and @samp{m}
35692 have different dimensions. The default value of @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35693 is @code{nil}.
35694 @end defvar
35695
35696 @defvar calc-undo-length
35697 The variable @code{calc-undo-length} determines the number of undo
35698 steps that Calc will keep track of when @code{calc-quit} is called.
35699 If @code{calc-undo-length} is a non-negative integer, then this is the
35700 number of undo steps that will be preserved; if
35701 @code{calc-undo-length} has any other value, then all undo steps will
35702 be preserved. The default value of @code{calc-undo-length} is @expr{100}.
35703 @end defvar
35704
35705 @defvar calc-gregorian-switch
35706 See @ref{Date Forms}.@*
35707 The variable @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is either a list of integers
35708 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} or @code{nil}.
35709 If it is @code{nil}, then Calc's date forms always represent Gregorian dates.
35710 Otherwise, @code{calc-gregorian-switch} represents the date that the
35711 calendar switches from Julian dates to Gregorian dates;
35712 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} will be the first Gregorian
35713 date. The customization buffer will offer several standard dates to
35714 choose from, or the user can enter their own date.
35715
35716 The default value of @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is @code{nil}.
35717 @end defvar
35718
35719 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35720 @appendix Reporting Bugs
35721
35722 @noindent
35723 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35724
35725 @example
35726 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35727 @end example
35728
35729 @noindent
35730 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35731 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35732 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35733 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35734 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35735 regular mailbox.
35736
35737 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35738 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35739 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35740 them right in.
35741
35742 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35743 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35744 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35745 so any efforts can be coordinated.
35746
35747 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35748 repository. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35749
35750 @c [summary]
35751 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35752 @appendix Calc Summary
35753
35754 @noindent
35755 This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
35756 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35757 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35758 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35759 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35760 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35761 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35762 command name refer to notes at the end.
35763
35764 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35765 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35766 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35767
35768 @iftex
35769 @begingroup
35770 @tex
35771 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35772 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35773 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35774 \leavevmode%
35775 {\smallfonts
35776 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35777 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35778 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35779 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35780 \thinspace%
35781 {\tt#5}%
35782 {\sl#6}%
35783 }}%
35784 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35785 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35786 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35787 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35788 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35789 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35790 @end tex
35791 @let@:=@sumsep
35792 @let@r=@sumrow
35793 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35794 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35795 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35796 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35797 @end iftex
35798 @format
35799 @iftex
35800 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35801 @let@c@sumbreak
35802 @end iftex
35803 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35804 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35805 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35806 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35807 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35808 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35809 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35810 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35811 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35812 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35813 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35814 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35815 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35816 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35817 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35818 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35819 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35820 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35821 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35822 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35823 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35824 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35825 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35826 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35827 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35828 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35829 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35830 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35831
35832 @c
35833 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35834 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35835 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35836 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35837 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35838 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35839 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35840 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35841 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35842
35843 @c
35844 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35845 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35846 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35847
35848 @c
35849 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35850 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35851 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35852 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35853 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35854 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35855 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35856 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35857 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35858 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35859 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35860 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35861 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35862 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35863 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35864 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35865 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35866
35867 @c
35868 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35869 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35870 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35871 @r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35872 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35873 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35874 @r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35875 @r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35876 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35877
35878 @c
35879 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35880 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35881 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35882 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35883 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35884 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35885 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35886
35887 @c
35888 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35889 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35890 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35891 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35892 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35893 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35894 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35895
35896 @c
35897 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35898 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35899 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35900 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35901 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35902 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35903
35904 @c
35905 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35906 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35907 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35908 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35909 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35910 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35911 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35912
35913 @c
35914 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35915 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35916 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35917 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35918 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35919 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35920 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35921 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35922 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35923 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35924 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35925 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35926 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35927 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35928 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35929 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35930 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35931 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35932 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35933 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35934 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35935 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35936 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35937 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35938 @r{ @: O @:command @: 32 @:@:Option}
35939 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35940 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35941 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35942 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35943 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35944 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35945 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35946 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35947 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35948 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35949 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35950 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35951 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35952 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35953 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35954 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35955 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35956 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35957 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35958 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35959
35960 @c
35961 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35962 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35963 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35964 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35965 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35966 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35967 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35968 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35969 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35970 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35971 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35972 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35973 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35974
35975 @c
35976 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35977 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35978 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35979 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35980
35981 @c
35982 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35983 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35984 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35985 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35986
35987 @c
35988 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35989 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35990 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35991 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35992 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35993 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35994 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35995 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35996 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35997 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35998 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35999 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
36000 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
36001 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
36002 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
36003 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
36004 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
36005 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
36006 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
36007 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
36008
36009 @c
36010 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36011 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36012 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36013 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
36014 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
36015 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
36016 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
36017 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
36018 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
36019 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
36020 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
36021 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
36022 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
36023 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
36024 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
36025 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
36026 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
36027 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
36028 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
36029
36030 @c
36031 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
36032 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
36033 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
36034 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
36035 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
36036 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
36037 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
36038 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
36039 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
36040 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
36041 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
36042 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
36043 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
36044 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
36045 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
36046
36047 @c
36048 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
36049 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
36050 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
36051 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
36052 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
36053 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
36054 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
36055 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
36056 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
36057 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
36058 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
36059 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
36060 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
36061 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
36062 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
36063 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
36064 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
36065 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
36066 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
36067 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
36068 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
36069 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
36070 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
36071
36072 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
36073 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
36074 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
36075 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
36076
36077 @c
36078 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
36079 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
36080 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
36081 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
36082 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
36083 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
36084 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
36085 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
36086 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
36087 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
36088 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
36089
36090 @c
36091 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
36092 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
36093
36094 @c
36095 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
36096
36097 @c
36098 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
36099 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
36100 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
36101 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
36102 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
36103 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
36104 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
36105 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
36106 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
36107 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
36108 @r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
36109 @r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
36110
36111 @c
36112 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
36113 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
36114 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
36115 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
36116
36117 @c
36118 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
36119 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
36120 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
36121 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
36122 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
36123 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
36124 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
36125 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
36126 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
36127 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
36128 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
36129 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
36130 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
36131 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
36132 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
36133 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
36134 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
36135 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
36136
36137 @c
36138 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
36139 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
36140 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
36141 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
36142 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
36143 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
36144 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
36145 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
36146 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
36147 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
36148 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
36149 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
36150
36151 @c
36152 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
36153 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
36154
36155 @c
36156 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
36157 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
36158 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
36159 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
36160 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
36161 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
36162 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
36163 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
36164 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
36165 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
36166 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
36167 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
36168
36169 @c
36170 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
36171 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
36172 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
36173 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
36174 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
36175 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
36176 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
36177 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
36178 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
36179 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
36180 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
36181 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
36182 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
36183 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
36184 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
36185 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
36186 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
36187
36188 @c
36189 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
36190 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
36191 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
36192 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
36193 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
36194 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
36195 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
36196 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
36197 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
36198 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
36199 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
36200 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
36201 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
36202 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
36203 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
36204 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
36205 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
36206 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
36207 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
36208
36209 @c
36210 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
36211 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
36212 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
36213 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
36214 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
36215 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
36216 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
36217 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
36218 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
36219 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
36220 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
36221 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
36222 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
36223 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
36224 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
36225 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
36226
36227 @c
36228 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
36229 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
36230 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
36231
36232 @c
36233 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
36234 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
36235 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
36236 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
36237 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
36238 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
36239 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
36240 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
36241 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
36242 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
36243
36244 @c
36245 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
36246 @r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
36247 @r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
36248 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
36249 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
36250 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
36251
36252 @c
36253 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
36254 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
36255 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
36256 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
36257 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
36258
36259 @c
36260 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
36261 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
36262 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
36263 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
36264 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
36265 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
36266 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
36267 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
36268 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
36269 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
36270 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
36271 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
36272 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
36273 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
36274
36275 @c
36276 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
36277 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
36278 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
36279 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
36280 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
36281 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
36282 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
36283 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
36284 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
36285 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
36286 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
36287 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
36288
36289 @c
36290 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
36291 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
36292 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
36293 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
36294 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
36295 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
36296 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
36297 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
36298 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
36299 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
36300 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
36301 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
36302 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
36303 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
36304 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
36305 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
36306 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
36307 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
36308 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
36309 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
36310
36311 @c
36312 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
36313 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
36314 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
36315 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
36316 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
36317 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36318 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36319 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
36320 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
36321 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
36322 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
36323 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
36324 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
36325
36326 @c
36327 @r{ a b@: l + @: @: @:lupadd@:(a,b)}
36328 @r{ a b@: H l + @: @: @:lufadd@:(a,b)}
36329 @r{ a b@: l - @: @: @:lupsub@:(a,b)}
36330 @r{ a b@: H l - @: @: @:lufsub@:(a,b)}
36331 @r{ a b@: l * @: @: @:lupmul@:(a,b)}
36332 @r{ a b@: H l * @: @: @:lufmul@:(a,b)}
36333 @r{ a b@: l / @: @: @:lupdiv@:(a,b)}
36334 @r{ a b@: H l / @: @: @:lufdiv@:(a,b)}
36335 @r{ a@: l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a)}
36336 @r{ a b@: O l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a,b)}
36337 @r{ a@: H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a)}
36338 @r{ a b@: O H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a,b)}
36339 @r{ a@: l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a)}
36340 @r{ a b@: O l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a,b)}
36341 @r{ a@: H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a)}
36342 @r{ a b@: O H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a,b)}
36343 @r{ a@: l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a)}
36344 @r{ a b@: O l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a,b)}
36345 @r{ a@: H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a)}
36346 @r{ a b@: O H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a,b)}
36347 @r{ a@: l s @: @: @:spn@:(a)}
36348 @r{ a@: l m @: @: @:midi@:(a)}
36349 @r{ a@: l f @: @: @:freq@:(a)}
36350
36351 @c
36352 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
36353 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
36354 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
36355 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
36356 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
36357 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
36358 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
36359 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
36360 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
36361 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
36362 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
36363 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
36364 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
36365 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
36366 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
36367
36368 @c
36369 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
36370 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
36371 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
36372 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
36373 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
36374 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
36375 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
36376 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
36377 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
36378 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
36379 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
36380
36381 @c
36382 @r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
36383 @r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
36384
36385 @c
36386 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
36387 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
36388 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
36389 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
36390 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
36391 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
36392 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
36393 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
36394 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
36395 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
36396 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
36397 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
36398 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
36399 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
36400 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
36401 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
36402 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
36403
36404 @c
36405 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
36406 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
36407 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
36408 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
36409 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
36410 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
36411 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
36412 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
36413 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
36414 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
36415 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
36416 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
36417 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
36418
36419 @c
36420 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
36421 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
36422 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
36423 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
36424 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
36425 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
36426 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
36427 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
36428 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
36429 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
36430 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
36431
36432 @c
36433 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
36434 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
36435 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
36436 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
36437 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
36438
36439 @c
36440 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
36441 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
36442 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
36443 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
36444 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
36445 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
36446 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
36447 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
36448 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
36449 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
36450 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
36451 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
36452 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
36453
36454 @c
36455 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36456 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36457 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
36458 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
36459 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
36460 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
36461 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
36462 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
36463 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
36464 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
36465 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
36466 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
36467 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
36468 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
36469 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
36470 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
36471 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
36472 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
36473 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
36474
36475 @c
36476 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
36477 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
36478
36479 @c
36480 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
36481 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
36482 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
36483 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
36484 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
36485 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
36486 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
36487 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
36488 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
36489 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
36490 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
36491 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
36492 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
36493 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
36494
36495 @c
36496 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
36497 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
36498 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
36499 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
36500 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
36501 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
36502 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
36503 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
36504 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
36505 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
36506 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
36507 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
36508 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
36509 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
36510 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
36511 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
36512
36513 @c
36514 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
36515 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
36516 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
36517
36518 @c
36519 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
36520 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
36521 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
36522 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
36523 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
36524 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
36525 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
36526 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
36527 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
36528 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
36529
36530 @c
36531 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
36532 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
36533 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
36534 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
36535 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
36536 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
36537
36538 @c
36539 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
36540
36541 @c
36542 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
36543 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
36544 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
36545 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
36546 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36547 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
36548 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
36549 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
36550 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
36551 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
36552 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
36553 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
36554 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
36555 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
36556 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
36557 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
36558 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
36559 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
36560 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
36561 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
36562 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
36563 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
36564 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
36565 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
36566 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36567 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
36568 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
36569 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
36570 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
36571 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
36572 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
36573 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
36574
36575 @c
36576 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
36577 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
36578 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
36579 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
36580 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
36581 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
36582 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
36583 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
36584 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
36585 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
36586 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
36587 @r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
36588 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
36589 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
36590 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
36591 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
36592 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
36593 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
36594 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
36595 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
36596 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
36597 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
36598 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
36599 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
36600 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
36601 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
36602 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
36603 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
36604 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
36605
36606 @c
36607 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
36608
36609 @c
36610 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
36611
36612 @c
36613 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
36614 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
36615 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
36616 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
36617
36618 @c
36619 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
36620 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
36621 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
36622 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
36623 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
36624 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
36625 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
36626
36627 @c
36628 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
36629
36630 @c
36631 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
36632 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
36633 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
36634
36635 @c
36636 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
36637 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
36638 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
36639 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
36640 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
36641 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
36642 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
36643 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
36644 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
36645 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
36646 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
36647
36648 @end format
36649
36650 @noindent
36651 NOTES
36652
36653 @enumerate
36654 @c 1
36655 @item
36656 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36657 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
36658 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
36659 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
36660
36661 @c 2
36662 @item
36663 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36664 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
36665 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
36666
36667 @c 3
36668 @item
36669 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
36670 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
36671 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
36672
36673 @c 4
36674 @item
36675 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
36676
36677 @c 5
36678 @item
36679 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
36680 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
36681
36682 @c 6
36683 @item
36684 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
36685 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
36686
36687 @c 7
36688 @item
36689 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
36690 1=Basic simplifications, 2=Algebraic simplifications, 3=Extended simplifications
36691
36692 @c 8
36693 @item
36694 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36695
36696 @c 9
36697 @item
36698 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36699 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36700
36701 @c 10
36702 @item
36703 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36704 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36705
36706 @c 11
36707 @item
36708 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36709
36710 @c 12
36711 @item
36712 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36713 prefix always clears the mode.
36714
36715 @c 13
36716 @item
36717 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36718
36719 @c 14
36720 @item
36721 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36722 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36723 @iftex
36724 {@advance@tableindent10pt
36725 @end iftex
36726 @table @asis
36727 @item Integer
36728 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36729 @item Float
36730 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36731 @item 0.0
36732 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36733 @item Error form
36734 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36735 @item Interval
36736 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36737 @item Vector
36738 Random element from the vector.
36739 @end table
36740 @iftex
36741 }
36742 @end iftex
36743
36744 @c 15
36745 @item
36746 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36747 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36748
36749 @c 16
36750 @item
36751 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36752 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36753
36754 @c 17
36755 @item
36756 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0--6, 0--31, or 0--366).
36757
36758 @c 18
36759 @item
36760 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36761 the new units.
36762
36763 @c 19
36764 @item
36765 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36766 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36767
36768 @c 20
36769 @item
36770 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36771 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36772 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36773 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36774
36775 @c 21
36776 @item
36777 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36778 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36779 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36780 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36781
36782 @c 22
36783 @item
36784 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36785 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36786 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36787 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36788 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36789 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36790 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36791 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36792 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36793
36794 @c 23
36795 @item
36796 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36797 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36798 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36799 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36800 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36801 or @code{d} for ``down.''
36802
36803 @c 24
36804 @item
36805 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36806 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36807 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36808 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36809 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36810 @iftex
36811 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
36812 @end iftex
36813 @table @cite
36814 @item -1
36815 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36816 @item -2
36817 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36818 @item -3
36819 (@var{3}) HMS form.
36820 @item -4
36821 (@var{2}) Error form.
36822 @item -5
36823 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
36824 @item -6
36825 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
36826 @item -7
36827 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36828 @item -8
36829 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36830 @item -9
36831 (@var{2}) Open interval.
36832 @item -10
36833 (@var{2}) Fraction.
36834 @item -11
36835 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36836 @item -12
36837 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36838 @item -13
36839 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36840 @item -14
36841 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36842 @item -15
36843 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36844 @end table
36845 @iftex
36846 }
36847 @end iftex
36848
36849 @c 25
36850 @item
36851 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36852 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36853 the input vector.
36854
36855 @c 26
36856 @item
36857 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36858
36859 @c 27
36860 @item
36861 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36862
36863 @c 28
36864 @item
36865 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36866
36867 @c 29
36868 @item
36869 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36870
36871 @c 30
36872 @item
36873 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36874 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36875 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36876 of the result of the edit.
36877
36878 @c 31
36879 @item
36880 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36881
36882 @c 32
36883 @item
36884 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36885
36886 @c 33
36887 @item
36888 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36889 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36890
36891 @c 34
36892 @item
36893 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36894 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36895 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36896 backward by that many lines.
36897
36898 @c 35
36899 @item
36900 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36901 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36902 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36903 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36904
36905 @c 36
36906 @item
36907 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36908 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36909 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36910 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36911
36912 @c 37
36913 @item
36914 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36915
36916 @c 38
36917 @item
36918 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36919 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36920
36921 @c 39
36922 @item
36923 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36924 @expr{v - v_0}.
36925
36926 @c 40
36927 @item
36928 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36929 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36930 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36931 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36932 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36933
36934 @c 41
36935 @item
36936 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36937
36938 @c 42
36939 @item
36940 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36941 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36942
36943 @c 43
36944 @item
36945 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36946 value for this graph.
36947
36948 @c 44
36949 @item
36950 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36951
36952 @c 45
36953 @item
36954 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36955 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36956 otherwise.
36957
36958 @c 46
36959 @item
36960 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36961 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36962 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36963 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36964 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36965 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36966 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36967 to evaluate variables.
36968
36969 @c 47
36970 @item
36971 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36972 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36973 assigns
36974 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36975 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36976
36977 @c 48
36978 @item
36979 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36980 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36981 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36982 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36983 and a vector from the stack.
36984
36985 @c 49
36986 @item
36987 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36988 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36989
36990 @c 50
36991 @item
36992 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36993 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36994 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36995
36996 @c 51
36997 @item
36998 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36999 default 2D resolution.
37000
37001 @c 52
37002 @item
37003 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
37004 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
37005 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
37006 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
37007 @end enumerate
37008
37009 @iftex
37010 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
37011 @page
37012 @endgroup
37013 @end iftex
37014
37015
37016 @c [end-summary]
37017
37018 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
37019 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
37020
37021 @printindex ky
37022
37023 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
37024 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
37025
37026 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
37027 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
37028 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
37029 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
37030
37031 @printindex pg
37032
37033 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
37034 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
37035
37036 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
37037 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
37038 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
37039 @iftex
37040 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
37041 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
37042 @end iftex
37043
37044 @printindex tp
37045
37046 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
37047 @unnumbered Concept Index
37048
37049 @printindex cp
37050
37051 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
37052 @unnumbered Index of Variables
37053
37054 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
37055 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
37056 corresponding Lisp variable.
37057
37058 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
37059 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
37060
37061 @printindex vr
37062
37063 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
37064 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
37065
37066 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
37067 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
37068 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
37069 @samp{math-}.
37070
37071 @printindex fn
37072
37073 @bye